gdb/doc: move @menu to the end of the node
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988--2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 Weimin Pan, David Faust and Jose E. Marchesi contributed support for
561 the Linux kernel BPF virtual architecture. This work was sponsored by
562 Oracle.
563
564 @node Sample Session
565 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
566
567 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
568 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
569 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
570
571 @iftex
572 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
573 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
574 @end iftex
575
576 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
577 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
578
579 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
580 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
581 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
582 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
583 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
584 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
585 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
586 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
587 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
588
589 @smallexample
590 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
591 $ @b{./m4}
592 @b{define(foo,0000)}
593
594 @b{foo}
595 0000
596 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
597
598 @b{bar}
599 0000
600 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
601
602 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
603 @b{baz}
604 @b{Ctrl-d}
605 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
606 @end smallexample
607
608 @noindent
609 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
610
611 @smallexample
612 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
613 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
614 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
615 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
616 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
617 the conditions.
618 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
619 for details.
620
621 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
622 (@value{GDBP})
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
627 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
628 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
629 that examples fit in this manual.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
633 @end smallexample
634
635 @noindent
636 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
637 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
638 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
639 @code{break} command.
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
643 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
644 @end smallexample
645
646 @noindent
647 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
648 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
649 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
650
651 @smallexample
652 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
653 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
654 @b{define(foo,0000)}
655
656 @b{foo}
657 0000
658 @end smallexample
659
660 @noindent
661 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
662 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
663 context where it stops.
664
665 @smallexample
666 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
667
668 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
669 at builtin.c:879
670 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
671 @end smallexample
672
673 @noindent
674 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
675 the next line of the current function.
676
677 @smallexample
678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
679 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
680 : nil,
681 @end smallexample
682
683 @noindent
684 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
685 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
686 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
687 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
691 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692 at input.c:530
693 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
694 @end smallexample
695
696 @noindent
697 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
698 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
699 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
700 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
701 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
702 stack frame for each active subroutine.
703
704 @smallexample
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
706 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
707 at input.c:530
708 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
709 at builtin.c:882
710 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
711 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
712 at macro.c:71
713 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
714 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
715 @end smallexample
716
717 @noindent
718 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
719 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
720 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
721
722 @smallexample
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
724 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
726 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
727 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
728 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
729 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
730 : xstrdup(rq);
731 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
732 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
733 @end smallexample
734
735 @noindent
736 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
737 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
738 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
739 (@code{print}) to see their values.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
743 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
745 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
750 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
751 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
755 533 xfree(rquote);
756 534
757 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
758 : xstrdup (lq);
759 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
760 : xstrdup (rq);
761 537
762 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
763 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
764 540 @}
765 541
766 542 void
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
771 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
772
773 @smallexample
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
775 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
777 540 @}
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
779 $3 = 9
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
781 $4 = 7
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
786 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
787 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
788 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
789 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
790 assignments.
791
792 @smallexample
793 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
794 $5 = 7
795 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
796 $6 = 9
797 @end smallexample
798
799 @noindent
800 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
801 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
802 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
803 example that caused trouble initially:
804
805 @smallexample
806 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
807 Continuing.
808
809 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
810
811 baz
812 0000
813 @end smallexample
814
815 @noindent
816 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
817 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
818 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @b{Ctrl-d}
822 Program exited normally.
823 @end smallexample
824
825 @noindent
826 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
827 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
828 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
829
830 @smallexample
831 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
832 @end smallexample
833
834 @node Invocation
835 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
836
837 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
838 The essentials are:
839 @itemize @bullet
840 @item
841 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
842 @item
843 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
844 @end itemize
845
846 @menu
847 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
848 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
849 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
850 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
851 @end menu
852
853 @node Invoking GDB
854 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
855
856 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
857 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
858
859 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
860 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
861
862 The command-line options described here are designed
863 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
864 options may effectively be unavailable.
865
866 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
867 specifying an executable program:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
875 specified:
876
877 @smallexample
878 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
879 @end smallexample
880
881 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument or use option
882 @code{-p}, if you want to debug a running process:
883
884 @smallexample
885 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
886 @value{GDBP} -p 1234
887 @end smallexample
888
889 @noindent
890 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234}. With option @option{-p} you
891 can omit the @var{program} filename.
892
893 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
894 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
895 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
896 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
897 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
898
899 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
900 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
901 option processing.
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
904 @end smallexample
905 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
906 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
907
908 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
909 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
910 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
911
912 @smallexample
913 @value{GDBP} --silent
914 @end smallexample
915
916 @noindent
917 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
918 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
919
920 @noindent
921 Type
922
923 @smallexample
924 @value{GDBP} -help
925 @end smallexample
926
927 @noindent
928 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
929 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
930
931 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
932 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
933 @samp{-x} option is used.
934
935
936 @menu
937 * File Options:: Choosing files
938 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
939 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
940 * Initialization Files:: Initialization Files
941 @end menu
942
943 @node File Options
944 @subsection Choosing Files
945
946 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
947 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
948 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
949 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
950 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
951 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
952 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
953 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
954 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
955 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
956 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
957 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
958 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
959
960 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
961 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
962 argument and ignore it.
963
964 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
965 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
966 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
967 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
968 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
969
970 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
971 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
972 @c it.
973
974 @table @code
975 @item -symbols @var{file}
976 @itemx -s @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--symbols}
978 @cindex @code{-s}
979 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
980
981 @item -exec @var{file}
982 @itemx -e @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--exec}
984 @cindex @code{-e}
985 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
986 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
987
988 @item -se @var{file}
989 @cindex @code{--se}
990 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
991 file.
992
993 @item -core @var{file}
994 @itemx -c @var{file}
995 @cindex @code{--core}
996 @cindex @code{-c}
997 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
998
999 @item -pid @var{number}
1000 @itemx -p @var{number}
1001 @cindex @code{--pid}
1002 @cindex @code{-p}
1003 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
1004
1005 @item -command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -x @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--command}
1008 @cindex @code{-x}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1010 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1011 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1012
1013 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-ex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1018
1019 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1020 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1021
1022 @smallexample
1023 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1024 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1025 @end smallexample
1026
1027 @item -init-command @var{file}
1028 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1029 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1030 @cindex @code{-ix}
1031 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1032 after loading gdbinit files).
1033 @xref{Startup}.
1034
1035 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1036 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1037 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1038 @cindex @code{-iex}
1039 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1040 after loading gdbinit files).
1041 @xref{Startup}.
1042
1043 @item -directory @var{directory}
1044 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1045 @cindex @code{--directory}
1046 @cindex @code{-d}
1047 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1048
1049 @item -r
1050 @itemx -readnow
1051 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1052 @cindex @code{-r}
1053 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1054 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1055 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1056
1057 @item --readnever
1058 @anchor{--readnever}
1059 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1060 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1061 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1062 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1063 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1064 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1065 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1066 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1067 @end table
1068
1069 @node Mode Options
1070 @subsection Choosing Modes
1071
1072 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1073 batch mode or quiet mode.
1074
1075 @table @code
1076 @anchor{-nx}
1077 @item -nx
1078 @itemx -n
1079 @cindex @code{--nx}
1080 @cindex @code{-n}
1081 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files
1082 (@pxref{Initialization Files}).
1083
1084 @anchor{-nh}
1085 @item -nh
1086 @cindex @code{--nh}
1087 Do not execute commands found in any home directory initialization
1088 file (@pxref{Initialization Files,,Home directory initialization
1089 file}). The system wide and current directory initialization files
1090 are still loaded.
1091
1092 @item -quiet
1093 @itemx -silent
1094 @itemx -q
1095 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1096 @cindex @code{--silent}
1097 @cindex @code{-q}
1098 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1099 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1100
1101 @item -batch
1102 @cindex @code{--batch}
1103 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1104 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1105 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1106 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1107 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1108 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1109 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1110
1111 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1112 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1113 make this more useful, the message
1114
1115 @smallexample
1116 Program exited normally.
1117 @end smallexample
1118
1119 @noindent
1120 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1121 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1122 mode.
1123
1124 @item -batch-silent
1125 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1126 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1127 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1128 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1129 for an interactive session.
1130
1131 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1132 messages, for example.
1133
1134 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1135 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1136
1137 @item -return-child-result
1138 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1139 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1140 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1141
1142 @itemize @bullet
1143 @item
1144 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1145 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1146 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1147 @item
1148 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1149 @item
1150 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1151 the exit code will be -1.
1152 @end itemize
1153
1154 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1155 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1156 interface.
1157
1158 @item -nowindows
1159 @itemx -nw
1160 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1161 @cindex @code{-nw}
1162 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1163 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1164 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1165
1166 @item -windows
1167 @itemx -w
1168 @cindex @code{--windows}
1169 @cindex @code{-w}
1170 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1171 used if possible.
1172
1173 @item -cd @var{directory}
1174 @cindex @code{--cd}
1175 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1176 instead of the current directory.
1177
1178 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1179 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1180 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1181 @cindex @code{-D}
1182 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1183 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1184 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1185
1186 @item -fullname
1187 @itemx -f
1188 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1189 @cindex @code{-f}
1190 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1191 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1192 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1193 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1194 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1195 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1196 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1197 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1198 frame.
1199
1200 @item -annotate @var{level}
1201 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1202 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1203 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1204 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1205 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1206 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1207 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1208 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1209 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1210
1211 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1212 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1213
1214 @item --args
1215 @cindex @code{--args}
1216 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1217 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1218 This option stops option processing.
1219
1220 @item -baud @var{bps}
1221 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1222 @cindex @code{--baud}
1223 @cindex @code{-b}
1224 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1225 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1226
1227 @item -l @var{timeout}
1228 @cindex @code{-l}
1229 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1230 for remote debugging.
1231
1232 @item -tty @var{device}
1233 @itemx -t @var{device}
1234 @cindex @code{--tty}
1235 @cindex @code{-t}
1236 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1237 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1238
1239 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1240 @item -tui
1241 @cindex @code{--tui}
1242 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1243 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1244 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1245 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1246 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1247 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1248
1249 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1250 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1251 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1252 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1253 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1254 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1255
1256 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi3}) causes
1257 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} version 3 (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1258 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 9.1. @sc{gdb/mi}
1259 version 2 (@code{mi2}), included in @value{GDBN} 6.0 and version 1 (@code{mi1}),
1260 included in @value{GDBN} 5.3, are also available. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1261 interfaces are no longer supported.
1262
1263 @item -write
1264 @cindex @code{--write}
1265 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1266 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1267 (@pxref{Patching}).
1268
1269 @item -statistics
1270 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1271 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1272 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1273
1274 @item -version
1275 @cindex @code{--version}
1276 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1277 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1278
1279 @item -configuration
1280 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1281 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1282 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1283 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1284
1285 @end table
1286
1287 @node Startup
1288 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1289 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1290
1291 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1292
1293 @enumerate
1294 @item
1295 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1296 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1297
1298 @item
1299 @cindex init file
1300 Reads the system wide initialization file and the files from the
1301 system wide initialization directory, @pxref{System Wide Init Files}.
1302
1303 @item
1304 Reads the initialization file (if any) in your home directory and
1305 executes all the commands in that file, @pxref{Home Directory Init
1306 File}.
1307
1308 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1309 @item
1310 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1311 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1312 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1313 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1314 gets loaded.
1315
1316 @item
1317 Processes command line options and operands.
1318
1319 @item
1320 Reads and executes the commands from the initialization file (if any)
1321 in the current working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load
1322 local-gdbinit} is set to @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current
1323 Directory}). This is only done if the current directory is different
1324 from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one init file,
1325 one generic in your home directory, and another, specific to the
1326 program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1327 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Init File in the Current Directory during
1328 Startup}.
1329
1330 @item
1331 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1332 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1333 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1334 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1335
1336 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1337 you must do something like the following:
1338
1339 @smallexample
1340 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1341 @end smallexample
1342
1343 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1344 off too late.
1345
1346 @item
1347 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1348 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1349 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1350
1351 @item
1352 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1353 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1354 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1355 @end enumerate
1356
1357 @node Initialization Files
1358 @subsection Initialization Files
1359 @cindex init file name
1360
1361 During startup (@pxref{Startup}) @value{GDBN} will execute commands
1362 from several initialization files. These initialization files use the
1363 same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command Files}) and are
1364 processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way.
1365
1366 To display the list of initialization files loaded by @value{GDBN} at
1367 startup, in the order they will be loaded, you can use @kbd{gdb
1368 --help}.
1369
1370 As the system wide and home directory initialization files are
1371 processed before most command line options, changes to settings
1372 (e.g. @samp{set complaints}) can affect subsequent processing of
1373 command line options and operands.
1374
1375 The following sections describe where @value{GDBN} looks for the
1376 initialization and the order that the files are searched for.
1377
1378 @anchor{System Wide Init Files}
1379 @subsubsection System wide initialization files
1380
1381 There are two locations that are searched for system wide
1382 initialization files. Both of these locations are always checked:
1383
1384 @table @code
1385
1386 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1387 This is a single system-wide initialization file. Its location is
1388 specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit} configure option
1389 (@pxref{System-wide configuration}). It is loaded first when
1390 @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options have been processed.
1391
1392 @item @file{system.gdbinit.d}
1393 This is the system-wide initialization directory. Its location is
1394 specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit-dir} configure option
1395 (@pxref{System-wide configuration}). Files in this directory are
1396 loaded in alphabetical order immediately after @file{system.gdbinit}
1397 (if enabled) when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1398 have been processed. Files need to have a recognized scripting
1399 language extension (@file{.py}/@file{.scm}) or be named with a
1400 @file{.gdb} extension to be interpreted as regular @value{GDBN}
1401 commands. @value{GDBN} will not recurse into any subdirectories of
1402 this directory.
1403
1404 @end table
1405
1406 It is possible to prevent the system wide initialization files from
1407 being loaded using the @samp{-nx} command line option, @pxref{Mode
1408 Options,,Choosing Modes}.
1409
1410 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1411 @subsubsection Home directory initialization file
1412 @cindex @file{gdbinit}
1413 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1414 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1415
1416 After loading the system wide initialization files @value{GDBN} will
1417 look for an initialization file in the users home
1418 directory@footnote{On DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the
1419 one pointed to by the @code{HOME} environment variable.}. There are a
1420 number of locations that @value{GDBN} will search in the home
1421 directory, these locations are searched in order and @value{GDBN} will
1422 load the first file that it finds, and subsequent locations will not
1423 be checked.
1424
1425 On non-Apple hosts the locations searched are:
1426 @table @file
1427 @item $XDG_CONFIG_HOME/gdb/gdbinit
1428 @item $HOME/.config/gdb/gdbinit
1429 @item $HOME/.gdbinit
1430 @end table
1431
1432 While on Apple hosts the locations searched are:
1433 @table @file
1434 @item $HOME/Library/Preferences/gdb/gdbinit
1435 @item $HOME/.gdbinit
1436 @end table
1437
1438 It is possible to prevent the home directory initialization file from
1439 being loaded using the @samp{-nx} or @samp{-nh} command line options,
1440 @pxref{Mode Options,,Choosing Modes}.
1441
1442 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead of
1443 @file{.gdbinit} or @file{gdbinit}, due to the limitations of file
1444 names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows port of @value{GDBN}
1445 uses the standard name, but if it finds a @file{gdb.ini} file in your
1446 home directory, it warns you about that and suggests to rename the
1447 file to the standard name.
1448
1449 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1450 @subsubsection Local directory initialization file
1451
1452 @value{GDBN} will check the current directory for a file called
1453 @file{.gdbinit}. It is loaded last, after command line options
1454 other than @samp{-x} and @samp{-ex} have been processed. The command
1455 line options @samp{-x} and @samp{-ex} are processed last, after
1456 @file{.gdbinit} has been loaded, @pxref{File Options,,Choosing
1457 Files}.
1458
1459 If the file in the current directory was already loaded as the home
1460 directory initialization file then it will not be loaded a second
1461 time.
1462
1463 It is possible to prevent the local directory initialization file from
1464 being loaded using the @samp{-nx} command line option, @pxref{Mode
1465 Options,,Choosing Modes}.
1466
1467 @node Quitting GDB
1468 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1469 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1470 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1471
1472 @table @code
1473 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1474 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1475 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1476 @itemx q
1477 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1478 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1479 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1480 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1481 error code.
1482 @end table
1483
1484 @cindex interrupt
1485 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1486 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1487 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1488 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1489 until a time when it is safe.
1490
1491 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1492 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1493 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1494
1495 @node Shell Commands
1496 @section Shell Commands
1497
1498 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1499 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1500 just use the @code{shell} command.
1501
1502 @table @code
1503 @kindex shell
1504 @kindex !
1505 @cindex shell escape
1506 @item shell @var{command-string}
1507 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1508 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1509 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1510 On GNU and Unix systems, the environment variable @code{SHELL}, if it
1511 exists, determines which shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses
1512 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on GNU and Unix systems,
1513 @file{cmd.exe} on MS-Windows, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1514 @end table
1515
1516 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1517 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1518 @value{GDBN}:
1519
1520 @table @code
1521 @kindex make
1522 @cindex calling make
1523 @item make @var{make-args}
1524 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1525 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1526 @end table
1527
1528 @table @code
1529 @kindex pipe
1530 @kindex |
1531 @cindex send the output of a gdb command to a shell command
1532 @anchor{pipe}
1533 @item pipe [@var{command}] | @var{shell_command}
1534 @itemx | [@var{command}] | @var{shell_command}
1535 @itemx pipe -d @var{delim} @var{command} @var{delim} @var{shell_command}
1536 @itemx | -d @var{delim} @var{command} @var{delim} @var{shell_command}
1537 Executes @var{command} and sends its output to @var{shell_command}.
1538 Note that no space is needed around @code{|}.
1539 If no @var{command} is provided, the last command executed is repeated.
1540
1541 In case the @var{command} contains a @code{|}, the option @code{-d @var{delim}}
1542 can be used to specify an alternate delimiter string @var{delim} that separates
1543 the @var{command} from the @var{shell_command}.
1544
1545 Example:
1546 @smallexample
1547 @group
1548 (gdb) p var
1549 $1 = @{
1550 black = 144,
1551 red = 233,
1552 green = 377,
1553 blue = 610,
1554 white = 987
1555 @}
1556 @end group
1557 @group
1558 (gdb) pipe p var|wc
1559 7 19 80
1560 (gdb) |p var|wc -l
1561 7
1562 @end group
1563 @group
1564 (gdb) p /x var
1565 $4 = @{
1566 black = 0x90,
1567 red = 0xe9,
1568 green = 0x179,
1569 blue = 0x262,
1570 white = 0x3db
1571 @}
1572 (gdb) ||grep red
1573 red => 0xe9,
1574 @end group
1575 @group
1576 (gdb) | -d ! echo this contains a | char\n ! sed -e 's/|/PIPE/'
1577 this contains a PIPE char
1578 (gdb) | -d xxx echo this contains a | char!\n xxx sed -e 's/|/PIPE/'
1579 this contains a PIPE char!
1580 (gdb)
1581 @end group
1582 @end smallexample
1583 @end table
1584
1585 The convenience variables @code{$_shell_exitcode} and @code{$_shell_exitsignal}
1586 can be used to examine the exit status of the last shell command launched
1587 by @code{shell}, @code{make}, @code{pipe} and @code{|}.
1588 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}.
1589
1590 @node Logging Output
1591 @section Logging Output
1592 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1593 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1594
1595 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1596 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1597
1598 @table @code
1599 @kindex set logging
1600 @item set logging on
1601 Enable logging.
1602 @item set logging off
1603 Disable logging.
1604 @cindex logging file name
1605 @item set logging file @var{file}
1606 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1607 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1608 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1609 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1610 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1611 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1612 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1613 @item set logging debugredirect [on|off]
1614 By default, @value{GDBN} debug output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1615 Set @code{debugredirect} if you want debug output to go only to the log file.
1616 @kindex show logging
1617 @item show logging
1618 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1619 @end table
1620
1621 You can also redirect the output of a @value{GDBN} command to a
1622 shell command. @xref{pipe}.
1623 @node Commands
1624 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1625
1626 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1627 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1628 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1629 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1630 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1631
1632 @menu
1633 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1634 * Command Settings:: How to change default behavior of commands
1635 * Completion:: Command completion
1636 * Command Options:: Command options
1637 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1638 @end menu
1639
1640 @node Command Syntax
1641 @section Command Syntax
1642
1643 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1644 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1645 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1646 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1647 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1648 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1649
1650 @cindex abbreviation
1651 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1652 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1653 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1654 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1655 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1656 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1657 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1658
1659 @cindex repeating commands
1660 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1661 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1662 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1663 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1664 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1665 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1666 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1667
1668 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1669 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1670 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1671
1672 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1673 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1674 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1675 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1676 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1677
1678 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1679 @cindex comment
1680 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1681 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1682 Files,,Command Files}).
1683
1684 @cindex repeating command sequences
1685 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1686 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1687 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1688 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1689 for editing.
1690
1691
1692 @node Command Settings
1693 @section Command Settings
1694 @cindex default behavior of commands, changing
1695 @cindex default settings, changing
1696
1697 Many commands change their behavior according to command-specific
1698 variables or settings. These settings can be changed with the
1699 @code{set} subcommands. For example, the @code{print} command
1700 (@pxref{Data, ,Examining Data}) prints arrays differently depending on
1701 settings changeable with the commands @code{set print elements
1702 NUMBER-OF-ELEMENTS} and @code{set print array-indexes}, among others.
1703
1704 You can change these settings to your preference in the gdbinit files
1705 loaded at @value{GDBN} startup. @xref{Startup}.
1706
1707 The settings can also be changed interactively during the debugging
1708 session. For example, to change the limit of array elements to print,
1709 you can do the following:
1710 @smallexample
1711 (@value{GDBN}) set print elements 10
1712 (@value{GDBN}) print some_array
1713 $1 = @{0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90...@}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716 The above @code{set print elements 10} command changes the number of
1717 elements to print from the default of 200 to 10. If you only intend
1718 this limit of 10 to be used for printing @code{some_array}, then you
1719 must restore the limit back to 200, with @code{set print elements
1720 200}.
1721
1722 Some commands allow overriding settings with command options. For
1723 example, the @code{print} command supports a number of options that
1724 allow overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set
1725 print} subcommands. @xref{print options}. The example above could be
1726 rewritten as:
1727 @smallexample
1728 (@value{GDBN}) print -elements 10 -- some_array
1729 $1 = @{0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90...@}
1730 @end smallexample
1731
1732 Alternatively, you can use the @code{with} command to change a setting
1733 temporarily, for the duration of a command invocation.
1734
1735 @table @code
1736 @kindex with command
1737 @kindex w @r{(@code{with})}
1738 @cindex settings
1739 @cindex temporarily change settings
1740 @item with @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
1741 @itemx w @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
1742 Temporarily set @var{setting} to @var{value} for the duration of
1743 @var{command}.
1744
1745 @var{setting} is any setting you can change with the @code{set}
1746 subcommands. @var{value} is the value to assign to @code{setting}
1747 while running @code{command}.
1748
1749 If no @var{command} is provided, the last command executed is
1750 repeated.
1751
1752 If a @var{command} is provided, it must be preceded by a double dash
1753 (@code{--}) separator. This is required because some settings accept
1754 free-form arguments, such as expressions or filenames.
1755
1756 For example, the command
1757 @smallexample
1758 (@value{GDBN}) with print array on -- print some_array
1759 @end smallexample
1760 @noindent
1761 is equivalent to the following 3 commands:
1762 @smallexample
1763 (@value{GDBN}) set print array on
1764 (@value{GDBN}) print some_array
1765 (@value{GDBN}) set print array off
1766 @end smallexample
1767
1768 The @code{with} command is particularly useful when you want to
1769 override a setting while running user-defined commands, or commands
1770 defined in Python or Guile. @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
1771
1772 @smallexample
1773 (@value{GDBN}) with print pretty on -- my_complex_command
1774 @end smallexample
1775
1776 To change several settings for the same command, you can nest
1777 @code{with} commands. For example, @code{with language ada -- with
1778 print elements 10} temporarily changes the language to Ada and sets a
1779 limit of 10 elements to print for arrays and strings.
1780
1781 @end table
1782
1783 @node Completion
1784 @section Command Completion
1785
1786 @cindex completion
1787 @cindex word completion
1788 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1789 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1790 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1791 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, command options, and the names of symbols
1792 in your program.
1793
1794 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1795 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1796 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1797 enter it). For example, if you type
1798
1799 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1800 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1801 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1802 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1803 @smallexample
1804 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1805 @end smallexample
1806
1807 @noindent
1808 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1809 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1810
1811 @smallexample
1812 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1813 @end smallexample
1814
1815 @noindent
1816 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1817 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1818 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1819 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1820 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1821 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1822
1823 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1824 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1825 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1826 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1827 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1828 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1829 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1830 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1831 example:
1832
1833 @smallexample
1834 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1835 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1836 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1837 make_abs_section make_function_type
1838 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1839 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1840 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1841 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1842 @end smallexample
1843
1844 @noindent
1845 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1846 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1847 command.
1848
1849 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1850 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1851 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1852 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1853 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1854
1855 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1856 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1857 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1861 main
1862 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1863 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1864 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1865 @end smallexample
1866
1867 @noindent
1868 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1869
1870 @table @code
1871 @kindex set max-completions
1872 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1873 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1874 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1875 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1876 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1877 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1878 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1879 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1880 completion slow.
1881 @kindex show max-completions
1882 @item show max-completions
1883 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1884 during completion.
1885 @end table
1886
1887 @cindex quotes in commands
1888 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1889 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1890 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1891 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1892 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1893 @value{GDBN} commands.
1894
1895 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1896 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1897 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1898 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1899 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1900 Operators}).
1901
1902 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1903 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1904 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1905 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1906 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1907 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1908 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1909 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1910 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1911
1912 @smallexample
1913 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1914 func<int>() func<float>()
1915 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1916 @end smallexample
1917
1918 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1919 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1920 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1921 function:
1922
1923 @smallexample
1924 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1925 func<int>() func<float>()
1926 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1927 @end smallexample
1928
1929 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1930 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1931 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1932 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1933 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1934 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1935
1936 @smallexample
1937 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1938 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1939 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1940 bubble(double)
1941 @end smallexample
1942
1943 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1944 require quoting.
1945
1946 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1947 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1948 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1949 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1950
1951 @cindex completion of structure field names
1952 @cindex structure field name completion
1953 @cindex completion of union field names
1954 @cindex union field name completion
1955 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1956 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1957 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1958 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1959 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1960 left-hand-side:
1961
1962 @smallexample
1963 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1964 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1965 to_data to_isatty to_write
1966 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1967 to_flush to_read
1968 @end smallexample
1969
1970 @noindent
1971 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1972 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1973 follows:
1974
1975 @smallexample
1976 struct ui_file
1977 @{
1978 int *magic;
1979 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1980 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1981 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1982 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1983 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1984 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1985 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1986 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1987 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1988 void *to_data;
1989 @}
1990 @end smallexample
1991
1992 @node Command Options
1993 @section Command options
1994
1995 @cindex command options
1996 Some commands accept options starting with a leading dash. For
1997 example, @code{print -pretty}. Similarly to command names, you can
1998 abbreviate a @value{GDBN} option to the first few letters of the
1999 option name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous, and you can also use
2000 the @key{TAB} key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word
2001 in an option (or to show you the alternatives available, if there is
2002 more than one possibility).
2003
2004 @cindex command options, raw input
2005 Some commands take raw input as argument. For example, the print
2006 command processes arbitrary expressions in any of the languages
2007 supported by @value{GDBN}. With such commands, because raw input may
2008 start with a leading dash that would be confused with an option or any
2009 of its abbreviations, e.g.@: @code{print -p} (short for @code{print
2010 -pretty} or printing negative @code{p}?), if you specify any command
2011 option, then you must use a double-dash (@code{--}) delimiter to
2012 indicate the end of options.
2013
2014 @cindex command options, boolean
2015
2016 Some options are described as accepting an argument which can be
2017 either @code{on} or @code{off}. These are known as @dfn{boolean
2018 options}. Similarly to boolean settings commands---@code{on} and
2019 @code{off} are the typical values, but any of @code{1}, @code{yes} and
2020 @code{enable} can also be used as ``true'' value, and any of @code{0},
2021 @code{no} and @code{disable} can also be used as ``false'' value. You
2022 can also omit a ``true'' value, as it is implied by default.
2023
2024 For example, these are equivalent:
2025
2026 @smallexample
2027 (@value{GDBP}) print -object on -pretty off -element unlimited -- *myptr
2028 (@value{GDBP}) p -o -p 0 -e u -- *myptr
2029 @end smallexample
2030
2031 You can discover the set of options some command accepts by completing
2032 on @code{-} after the command name. For example:
2033
2034 @smallexample
2035 (@value{GDBP}) print -@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
2036 -address -max-depth -raw-values -union
2037 -array -null-stop -repeats -vtbl
2038 -array-indexes -object -static-members
2039 -elements -pretty -symbol
2040 @end smallexample
2041
2042 Completion will in some cases guide you with a suggestion of what kind
2043 of argument an option expects. For example:
2044
2045 @smallexample
2046 (@value{GDBP}) print -elements @key{TAB}@key{TAB}
2047 NUMBER unlimited
2048 @end smallexample
2049
2050 Here, the option expects a number (e.g., @code{100}), not literal
2051 @code{NUMBER}. Such metasyntactical arguments are always presented in
2052 uppercase.
2053
2054 (For more on using the @code{print} command, see @ref{Data, ,Examining
2055 Data}.)
2056
2057 @node Help
2058 @section Getting Help
2059 @cindex online documentation
2060 @kindex help
2061
2062 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
2063 using the command @code{help}.
2064
2065 @table @code
2066 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
2067 @item help
2068 @itemx h
2069 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
2070 display a short list of named classes of commands:
2071
2072 @smallexample
2073 (@value{GDBP}) help
2074 List of classes of commands:
2075
2076 aliases -- User-defined aliases of other commands
2077 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2078 data -- Examining data
2079 files -- Specifying and examining files
2080 internals -- Maintenance commands
2081 obscure -- Obscure features
2082 running -- Running the program
2083 stack -- Examining the stack
2084 status -- Status inquiries
2085 support -- Support facilities
2086 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
2087 stopping the program
2088 user-defined -- User-defined commands
2089
2090 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
2091 commands in that class.
2092 Type "help" followed by command name for full
2093 documentation.
2094 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
2095 (@value{GDBP})
2096 @end smallexample
2097 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
2098
2099 @item help @var{class}
2100 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
2101 list of the individual commands in that class. If a command has
2102 aliases, the aliases are given after the command name, separated by
2103 commas. If an alias has default arguments, the full definition of
2104 the alias is given after the first line.
2105 For example, here is the help display for the class @code{status}:
2106
2107 @smallexample
2108 (@value{GDBP}) help status
2109 Status inquiries.
2110
2111 List of commands:
2112
2113 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
2114 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
2115 info, inf, i -- Generic command for showing things
2116 about the program being debugged
2117 info address, iamain -- Describe where symbol SYM is stored.
2118 alias iamain = info address main
2119 info all-registers -- List of all registers and their contents,
2120 for selected stack frame.
2121 ...
2122 show, info set -- Generic command for showing things
2123 about the debugger
2124
2125 Type "help" followed by command name for full
2126 documentation.
2127 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
2128 (@value{GDBP})
2129 @end smallexample
2130
2131 @item help @var{command}
2132 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
2133 short paragraph on how to use that command. If that command has
2134 one or more aliases, @value{GDBN} will display a first line with
2135 the command name and all its aliases separated by commas.
2136 This first line will be followed by the full definition of all aliases
2137 having default arguments.
2138
2139 @kindex apropos
2140 @item apropos [-v] @var{regexp}
2141 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
2142 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
2143 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. The optional flag @samp{-v},
2144 which stands for @samp{verbose}, indicates to output the full documentation
2145 of the matching commands and highlight the parts of the documentation
2146 matching @var{regexp}. For example:
2147
2148 @smallexample
2149 apropos alias
2150 @end smallexample
2151
2152 @noindent
2153 results in:
2154
2155 @smallexample
2156 @group
2157 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
2158 aliases -- User-defined aliases of other commands
2159 @end group
2160 @end smallexample
2161
2162 @noindent
2163 while
2164
2165 @smallexample
2166 apropos -v cut.*thread apply
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 results in the below output, where @samp{cut for 'thread apply}
2171 is highlighted if styling is enabled.
2172
2173 @smallexample
2174 @group
2175 taas -- Apply a command to all threads (ignoring errors
2176 and empty output).
2177 Usage: taas COMMAND
2178 shortcut for 'thread apply all -s COMMAND'
2179
2180 tfaas -- Apply a command to all frames of all threads
2181 (ignoring errors and empty output).
2182 Usage: tfaas COMMAND
2183 shortcut for 'thread apply all -s frame apply all -s COMMAND'
2184 @end group
2185 @end smallexample
2186
2187 @kindex complete
2188 @item complete @var{args}
2189 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
2190 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
2191 command you want completed. For example:
2192
2193 @smallexample
2194 complete i
2195 @end smallexample
2196
2197 @noindent results in:
2198
2199 @smallexample
2200 @group
2201 if
2202 ignore
2203 info
2204 inspect
2205 @end group
2206 @end smallexample
2207
2208 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
2209 @end table
2210
2211 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
2212 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
2213 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
2214 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
2215 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
2216 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
2217 Index}.
2218
2219 @c @group
2220 @table @code
2221 @kindex info
2222 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
2223 @item info
2224 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
2225 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
2226 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
2227 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
2228 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
2229 @w{@code{help info}}.
2230
2231 @kindex set
2232 @item set
2233 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
2234 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
2235 @code{set prompt $}.
2236
2237 @kindex show
2238 @item show
2239 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
2240 @value{GDBN} itself.
2241 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
2242 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
2243 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
2244 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
2245
2246 @kindex info set
2247 To display all the settable parameters and their current
2248 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
2249 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
2250 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
2251 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
2252 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
2253 @end table
2254 @c @end group
2255
2256 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
2257 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
2258
2259 @table @code
2260 @kindex show version
2261 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
2262 @item show version
2263 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2264 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
2265 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
2266 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
2267 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
2268 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
2269 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2270 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
2271 @value{GDBN}.
2272
2273 @kindex show copying
2274 @kindex info copying
2275 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
2276 @item show copying
2277 @itemx info copying
2278 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
2279
2280 @kindex show warranty
2281 @kindex info warranty
2282 @item show warranty
2283 @itemx info warranty
2284 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
2285 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2286
2287 @kindex show configuration
2288 @item show configuration
2289 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
2290 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
2291 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
2292 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
2293 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
2294 your report.
2295
2296 @end table
2297
2298 @node Running
2299 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
2300
2301 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
2302 debugging information when you compile it.
2303
2304 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
2305 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
2306 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
2307 kill a child process.
2308
2309 @menu
2310 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
2311 * Starting:: Starting your program
2312 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
2313 * Environment:: Your program's environment
2314
2315 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
2316 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
2317 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
2318 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
2319 * Inferiors Connections and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors
2320 connections and programs
2321 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
2322 * Forks:: Debugging forks
2323 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2324 @end menu
2325
2326 @node Compilation
2327 @section Compiling for Debugging
2328
2329 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
2330 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
2331 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
2332 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
2333 and addresses in the executable code.
2334
2335 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2336 the compiler.
2337
2338 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2339 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2340 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2341 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2342 executables containing debugging information.
2343
2344 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2345 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2346 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2347 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2348 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2349
2350 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2351 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2352 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2353
2354 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2355 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2356 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2357 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2358 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2359 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2360
2361 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2362 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2363 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2364
2365 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2366 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2367 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2368 format in @value{GDBN}.
2369
2370 @need 2000
2371 @node Starting
2372 @section Starting your Program
2373 @cindex starting
2374 @cindex running
2375
2376 @table @code
2377 @kindex run
2378 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2379 @item run
2380 @itemx r
2381 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2382 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2383 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2384 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2385 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2386
2387 @end table
2388
2389 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2390 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2391 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2392 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2393 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2394 message like this one:
2395
2396 @smallexample
2397 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2398 Try "help target" or "continue".
2399 @end smallexample
2400
2401 @noindent
2402 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2403 first (@pxref{load}).
2404
2405 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2406 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2407 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2408 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2409 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2410 divided into four categories:
2411
2412 @table @asis
2413 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2414 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2415 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2416 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2417 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2418 the arguments.
2419 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2420 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2421 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2422 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2423 below for details).
2424
2425 @item The @emph{environment.}
2426 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2427 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2428 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2429 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2430
2431 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2432 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2433 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2434 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2435 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2436 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2437 Directory}.
2438
2439 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2440 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2441 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2442 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2443 set a different device for your program.
2444 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2445
2446 @cindex pipes
2447 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2448 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2449 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2450 wrong program.
2451 @end table
2452
2453 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2454 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2455 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2456 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2457 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2458
2459 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2460 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2461 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2462 your current breakpoints.
2463
2464 @table @code
2465 @kindex start
2466 @item start
2467 @cindex run to main procedure
2468 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2469 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2470 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2471 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2472 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2473 procedure, depending on the language used.
2474
2475 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2476 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2477 the @samp{run} command.
2478
2479 @cindex elaboration phase
2480 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2481 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2482 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2483 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2484 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2485 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2486 will remain to halt execution.
2487
2488 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2489 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2490 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2491 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2492 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2493
2494 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2495 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2496 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2497 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2498 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2499 use the @code{starti} command.
2500
2501 @kindex starti
2502 @item starti
2503 @cindex run to first instruction
2504 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2505 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2506 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2507 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2508 the start of the elaboration phase.
2509
2510 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2511 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2512 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2513 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2514 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2515 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2516 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2517 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2518 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2519 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2520 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2521 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2522
2523 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2524 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2525 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2526 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2527
2528 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2529 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2530 environment:
2531
2532 @smallexample
2533 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2534 (@value{GDBP}) run
2535 @end smallexample
2536
2537 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2538 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2539
2540 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2541 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2542 @item set startup-with-shell
2543 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2544 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2545 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2546 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2547 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2548 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2549 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2550 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2551 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2552 startup failures such as:
2553
2554 @smallexample
2555 (@value{GDBP}) run
2556 Starting program: ./a.out
2557 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2558 @end smallexample
2559
2560 @noindent
2561 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2562 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2563 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2564 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2565 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2566 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2567
2568 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2569 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2570 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2571 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2572 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2573 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2574
2575 By default, if the current inferior is not connected to any target yet
2576 (e.g., with @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your
2577 program as a native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine.
2578 If you're sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine,
2579 you can tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target
2580 automatically with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off}
2581 command.
2582
2583 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if the current inferior is not
2584 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2585 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2586
2587 If @code{off}, and if the current inferior is not connected to a
2588 target already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2589
2590 @smallexample
2591 (@value{GDBP}) run
2592 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2593 @end smallexample
2594
2595 If the current inferior is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN}
2596 always uses it with the @code{run} command.
2597
2598 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2599 @code{target native} command. For example,
2600
2601 @smallexample
2602 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2603 (@value{GDBP}) run
2604 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2605 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2606 (@value{GDBP}) run
2607 Starting program: ./a.out
2608 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2609 @end smallexample
2610
2611 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2612 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2613 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2614 disconnect.
2615
2616 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2617 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2618 proc}, @code{info os}.
2619
2620 @kindex set disable-randomization
2621 @item set disable-randomization
2622 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2623 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2624 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2625 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2626 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2627
2628 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2629 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2630
2631 @smallexample
2632 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2633 @end smallexample
2634
2635 @item set disable-randomization off
2636 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2637 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2638 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2639 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2640 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2641 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2642
2643 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2644 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2645 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2646 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2647 a code at its expected addresses.
2648
2649 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2650 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2651 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2652 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2653 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2654 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2655 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2656 a randomly chosen address.
2657
2658 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2659 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2660 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2661 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2662 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2663
2664 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2665 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2666
2667 @item show disable-randomization
2668 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2669 the virtual address space of the started program.
2670
2671 @end table
2672
2673 @node Arguments
2674 @section Your Program's Arguments
2675
2676 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2677 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2678 @code{run} command.
2679 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2680 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2681 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2682 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2683 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2684
2685 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2686 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2687 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2688 the program, not by the shell.
2689
2690 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2691 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2692
2693 @table @code
2694 @kindex set args
2695 @item set args
2696 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2697 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2698 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2699 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2700 it again without arguments.
2701
2702 @kindex show args
2703 @item show args
2704 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2705 @end table
2706
2707 @node Environment
2708 @section Your Program's Environment
2709
2710 @cindex environment (of your program)
2711 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2712 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2713 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2714 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2715 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2716 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2717 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2718
2719 @table @code
2720 @kindex path
2721 @item path @var{directory}
2722 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2723 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2724 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2725 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2726 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2727 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2728 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2729
2730 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2731 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2732 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2733 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2734 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2735 @var{directory} to the search path.
2736 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2737 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2738
2739 @kindex show paths
2740 @item show paths
2741 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2742 environment variable).
2743
2744 @kindex show environment
2745 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2746 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2747 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2748 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2749 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2750
2751 @kindex set environment
2752 @anchor{set environment}
2753 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2754 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2755 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2756 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2757 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2758 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2759 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2760 null value.
2761 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2762 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2763
2764 For example, this command:
2765
2766 @smallexample
2767 set env USER = foo
2768 @end smallexample
2769
2770 @noindent
2771 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2772 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2773 are not actually required.)
2774
2775 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2776 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2777 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2778 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2779 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2780
2781 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2782 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2783 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2784
2785 @kindex unset environment
2786 @anchor{unset environment}
2787 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2788 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2789 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2790 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2791 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2792
2793 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2794 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2795 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2796 @end table
2797
2798 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2799 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2800 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2801 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2802 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2803 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2804 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2805 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2806 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2807 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2808
2809 @node Working Directory
2810 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2811
2812 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2813 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2814 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2815 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2816 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2817 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2818 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2819 debugging.
2820
2821 @table @code
2822 @kindex set cwd
2823 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2824 @anchor{set cwd command}
2825 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2826 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2827 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2828 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2829 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2830 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2831 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2832 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2833 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2834 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2835 fallback.
2836
2837 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2838 the @code{cd} command.
2839 @xref{cd command}.
2840
2841 @kindex show cwd
2842 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2843 @item show cwd
2844 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2845 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2846 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2847
2848 @kindex cd
2849 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2850 @anchor{cd command}
2851 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2852 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2853 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2854
2855 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2856 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2857 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2858 @xref{set cwd command}.
2859
2860 @kindex pwd
2861 @item pwd
2862 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2863 @end table
2864
2865 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2866 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2867 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2868 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2869 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2870 current working directory of the debuggee.
2871
2872 @node Input/Output
2873 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2874
2875 @cindex redirection
2876 @cindex i/o
2877 @cindex terminal
2878 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2879 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2880 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2881 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2882 running your program.
2883
2884 @table @code
2885 @kindex info terminal
2886 @item info terminal
2887 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2888 program is using.
2889 @end table
2890
2891 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2892 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2893
2894 @smallexample
2895 run > outfile
2896 @end smallexample
2897
2898 @noindent
2899 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2900
2901 @kindex tty
2902 @cindex controlling terminal
2903 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2904 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2905 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2906 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2907 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2908
2909 @smallexample
2910 tty /dev/ttyb
2911 @end smallexample
2912
2913 @noindent
2914 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2915 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2916 that as their controlling terminal.
2917
2918 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2919 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2920 terminal.
2921
2922 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2923 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2924 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2925 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2926
2927 @cindex inferior tty
2928 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2929 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2930 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2931 program.
2932
2933 @table @code
2934 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2935 @kindex set inferior-tty
2936 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2937 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2938 @value{GDBN}.
2939
2940 @item show inferior-tty
2941 @kindex show inferior-tty
2942 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2943 @end table
2944
2945 @node Attach
2946 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2947 @kindex attach
2948 @cindex attach
2949
2950 @table @code
2951 @item attach @var{process-id}
2952 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2953 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2954 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2955 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2956 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2957
2958 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2959 executing the command.
2960 @end table
2961
2962 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2963 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2964 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2965 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2966
2967 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2968 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2969 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2970 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2971 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2972 Specify Files}.
2973
2974 @anchor{set exec-file-mismatch}
2975 If the debugger can determine that the executable file running in the
2976 process it is attaching to does not match the current exec-file loaded
2977 by @value{GDBN}, the option @code{exec-file-mismatch} specifies how to
2978 handle the mismatch. @value{GDBN} tries to compare the files by
2979 comparing their build IDs (@pxref{build ID}), if available.
2980
2981 @table @code
2982 @kindex exec-file-mismatch
2983 @cindex set exec-file-mismatch
2984 @item set exec-file-mismatch @samp{ask|warn|off}
2985
2986 Whether to detect mismatch between the current executable file loaded
2987 by @value{GDBN} and the executable file used to start the process. If
2988 @samp{ask}, the default, display a warning and ask the user whether to
2989 load the process executable file; if @samp{warn}, just display a
2990 warning; if @samp{off}, don't attempt to detect a mismatch.
2991 If the user confirms loading the process executable file, then its symbols
2992 will be loaded as well.
2993
2994 @cindex show exec-file-mismatch
2995 @item show exec-file-mismatch
2996 Show the current value of @code{exec-file-mismatch}.
2997
2998 @end table
2999
3000 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
3001 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
3002 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
3003 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
3004 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
3005 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
3006 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
3007
3008 @table @code
3009 @kindex detach
3010 @item detach
3011 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
3012 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
3013 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
3014 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
3015 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
3016 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
3017 executing the command.
3018 @end table
3019
3020 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
3021 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
3022 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
3023 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
3024 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
3025 Messages}).
3026
3027 @node Kill Process
3028 @section Killing the Child Process
3029
3030 @table @code
3031 @kindex kill
3032 @item kill
3033 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
3034 @end table
3035
3036 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
3037 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
3038 is running.
3039
3040 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
3041 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
3042 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
3043 outside the debugger.
3044
3045 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
3046 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
3047 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
3048 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
3049 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
3050 breakpoint settings).
3051
3052 @node Inferiors Connections and Programs
3053 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors Connections and Programs
3054
3055 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
3056 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
3057 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
3058 before starting another). On some systems @value{GDBN} may even let
3059 you debug several programs simultaneously on different remote systems.
3060 In the most general case, you can have multiple threads of execution
3061 in each of multiple processes, launched from multiple executables,
3062 running on different machines.
3063
3064 @cindex inferior
3065 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
3066 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
3067 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
3068 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
3069 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
3070 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
3071 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
3072 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
3073 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
3074 threads running in it.
3075
3076 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
3077 inferiors}}:
3078
3079 @table @code
3080 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
3081 @item info inferiors
3082 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
3083 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
3084 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
3085 the display to just the requested inferiors.
3086
3087 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
3088
3089 @enumerate
3090 @item
3091 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3092
3093 @item
3094 the target system's inferior identifier
3095
3096 @item
3097 the target connection the inferior is bound to, including the unique
3098 connection number assigned by @value{GDBN}, and the protocol used by
3099 the connection.
3100
3101 @item
3102 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
3103
3104 @end enumerate
3105
3106 @noindent
3107 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
3108 indicates the current inferior.
3109
3110 For example,
3111 @end table
3112 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3113
3114 @smallexample
3115 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3116 Num Description Connection Executable
3117 * 1 process 3401 1 (native) goodbye
3118 2 process 2307 2 (extended-remote host:10000) hello
3119 @end smallexample
3120
3121 To find out what open target connections exist at any moment, use
3122 @w{@code{info connections}}:
3123
3124 @table @code
3125 @kindex info connections [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
3126 @item info connections
3127 Print a list of all open target connections currently being managed by
3128 @value{GDBN}. By default all connections are printed, but the
3129 argument @var{id}@dots{} -- a space separated list of connections
3130 numbers -- can be used to limit the display to just the requested
3131 connections.
3132
3133 @value{GDBN} displays for each connection (in this order):
3134
3135 @enumerate
3136 @item
3137 the connection number assigned by @value{GDBN}.
3138
3139 @item
3140 the protocol used by the connection.
3141
3142 @item
3143 a textual description of the protocol used by the connection.
3144
3145 @end enumerate
3146
3147 @noindent
3148 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the connection number indicates the
3149 connection of the current inferior.
3150
3151 For example,
3152 @end table
3153 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3154
3155 @smallexample
3156 (@value{GDBP}) info connections
3157 Num What Description
3158 * 1 extended-remote host:10000 Extended remote serial target in gdb-specific protocol
3159 2 native Native process
3160 3 core Local core dump file
3161 @end smallexample
3162
3163 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
3164
3165 @table @code
3166 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
3167 @item inferior @var{infno}
3168 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
3169 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
3170 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
3171 @end table
3172
3173 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
3174 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
3175 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
3176 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
3177 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
3178 information on convenience variables.
3179
3180 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
3181 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
3182 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
3183 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
3184 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
3185 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
3186
3187 @table @code
3188 @kindex add-inferior
3189 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ] [-no-connection ]
3190 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
3191 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
3192 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
3193 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
3194 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
3195
3196 By default, the new inferior begins connected to the same target
3197 connection as the current inferior. For example, if the current
3198 inferior was connected to @code{gdbserver} with @code{target remote},
3199 then the new inferior will be connected to the same @code{gdbserver}
3200 instance. The @samp{-no-connection} option starts the new inferior
3201 with no connection yet. You can then for example use the @code{target
3202 remote} command to connect to some other @code{gdbserver} instance,
3203 use @code{run} to spawn a local program, etc.
3204
3205 @kindex clone-inferior
3206 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
3207 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
3208 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
3209 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
3210 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
3211
3212 @smallexample
3213 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3214 Num Description Connection Executable
3215 * 1 process 29964 1 (native) helloworld
3216 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
3217 Added inferior 2.
3218 1 inferiors added.
3219 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3220 Num Description Connection Executable
3221 * 1 process 29964 1 (native) helloworld
3222 2 <null> 1 (native) helloworld
3223 @end smallexample
3224
3225 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
3226
3227 @kindex remove-inferiors
3228 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3229 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
3230 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
3231 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
3232
3233 @end table
3234
3235 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
3236 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
3237 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
3238 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
3239
3240 @table @code
3241 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3242 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
3243 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
3244 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
3245 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
3246 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
3247
3248 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3249 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3250 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
3251 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
3252 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
3253 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
3254 @end table
3255
3256 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
3257 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
3258 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
3259 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
3260
3261
3262 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
3263 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
3264
3265 @table @code
3266 @kindex set print inferior-events
3267 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
3268 @item set print inferior-events
3269 @itemx set print inferior-events on
3270 @itemx set print inferior-events off
3271 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
3272 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
3273 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
3274 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
3275
3276 @kindex show print inferior-events
3277 @item show print inferior-events
3278 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
3279 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
3280 @end table
3281
3282 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
3283 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
3284 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
3285
3286
3287 Occasionally, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
3288 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
3289 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
3290 info program-spaces}} command.
3291
3292 @table @code
3293 @kindex maint info program-spaces
3294 @item maint info program-spaces
3295 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
3296 @value{GDBN}.
3297
3298 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
3299
3300 @enumerate
3301 @item
3302 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3303
3304 @item
3305 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
3306 the @code{file} command.
3307
3308 @end enumerate
3309
3310 @noindent
3311 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
3312 indicates the current program space.
3313
3314 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
3315 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
3316 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
3317
3318 @smallexample
3319 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
3320 Id Executable
3321 * 1 hello
3322 2 goodbye
3323 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
3324 @end smallexample
3325
3326 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
3327 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
3328 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
3329 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
3330 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
3331
3332 @smallexample
3333 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
3334 Id Executable
3335 * 1 vfork-test
3336 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
3337 @end smallexample
3338
3339 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
3340 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
3341 @end table
3342
3343 @node Threads
3344 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
3345
3346 @cindex threads of execution
3347 @cindex multiple threads
3348 @cindex switching threads
3349 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
3350 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
3351 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
3352 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
3353 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
3354 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
3355 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
3356
3357 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
3358 programs:
3359
3360 @itemize @bullet
3361 @item automatic notification of new threads
3362 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
3363 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
3364 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
3365 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
3366 @item thread-specific breakpoints
3367 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
3368 messages on thread start and exit.
3369 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
3370 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
3371 isn't compatible with the program.
3372 @end itemize
3373
3374 @cindex focus of debugging
3375 @cindex current thread
3376 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
3377 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
3378 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
3379 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
3380 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
3381
3382 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
3383 @cindex thread identifier (system)
3384 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
3385 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
3386 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
3387 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
3388 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
3389 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
3390 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
3391 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
3392
3393 @smallexample
3394 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
3395 @end smallexample
3396
3397 @noindent
3398 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
3399 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
3400 further qualifier.
3401
3402 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
3403 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
3404 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
3405 @c program?
3406 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
3407 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
3408 @c threads ab initio?
3409
3410 @anchor{thread numbers}
3411 @cindex thread number, per inferior
3412 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
3413 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
3414 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
3415 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
3416 between threads of different inferiors.
3417
3418 @cindex qualified thread ID
3419 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3420 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3421 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3422 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3423 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3424 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3425 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3426 inferior.
3427
3428 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3429 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3430 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3431 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3432
3433 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3434 @cindex thread ID lists
3435 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3436 argument. A list element can be:
3437
3438 @enumerate
3439 @item
3440 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3441 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3442 @samp{1}.
3443
3444 @item
3445 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3446 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3447 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3448
3449 @item
3450 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3451 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3452 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3453 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3454 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3455
3456 @end enumerate
3457
3458 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3459 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3460 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3461 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3462 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3463 7.1}.
3464
3465
3466 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3467 @cindex global thread number
3468 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3469 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3470 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3471 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3472 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3473 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3474
3475 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3476 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3477 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3478
3479 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3480 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3481 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3482 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3483 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3484 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3485 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3486 general information on convenience variables.
3487
3488 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3489 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3490 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3491
3492 @smallexample
3493 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3494 @end smallexample
3495
3496 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3497
3498 @smallexample
3499 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3500 @end smallexample
3501
3502 @table @code
3503 @kindex info threads
3504 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3505
3506 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3507 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3508 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3509 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3510
3511 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3512
3513 @enumerate
3514 @item
3515 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3516
3517 @item
3518 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3519 option was specified
3520
3521 @item
3522 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3523
3524 @item
3525 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3526 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3527 program itself.
3528
3529 @item
3530 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3531 @end enumerate
3532
3533 @noindent
3534 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3535 indicates the current thread.
3536
3537 For example,
3538 @end table
3539 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3540
3541 @smallexample
3542 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3543 Id Target Id Frame
3544 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3545 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3546 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3547 at threadtest.c:68
3548 @end smallexample
3549
3550 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3551 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3552 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3553
3554 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3555 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3556
3557 @smallexample
3558 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3559 Id GId Target Id Frame
3560 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3561 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3562 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3563 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3564 @end smallexample
3565
3566 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3567 Solaris-specific command:
3568
3569 @table @code
3570 @item maint info sol-threads
3571 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3572 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3573 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3574 @end table
3575
3576 @table @code
3577 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3578 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3579 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3580 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3581 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3582 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3583
3584 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3585 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3586
3587 @smallexample
3588 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3589 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3590 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3591 8 printf ("hello\n");
3592 @end smallexample
3593
3594 @noindent
3595 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3596 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3597 threads.
3598
3599 @anchor{thread apply all}
3600 @kindex thread apply
3601 @cindex apply command to several threads
3602 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3603 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3604 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3605 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3606 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3607 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3608 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3609 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3610
3611 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3612 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3613 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3614 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3615 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3616
3617 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3618 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3619 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3620 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3621
3622 @table @code
3623 @item -c
3624 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3625 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3626 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3627 @item -s
3628 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3629 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3630 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3631 are not printed.
3632 @item -q
3633 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3634 information.
3635 @end table
3636
3637 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3638
3639 @kindex taas
3640 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3641 @item taas [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
3642 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}}.
3643 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3644
3645 The @code{taas} command accepts the same options as the @code{thread
3646 apply all} command. @xref{thread apply all}.
3647
3648 @kindex tfaas
3649 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3650 @item tfaas [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
3651 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s -- frame apply all -s [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}}.
3652 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3653 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3654 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3655 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3656 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3657 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3658 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3659
3660 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3661 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3662 is, using:
3663 @smallexample
3664 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3665 @end smallexample
3666
3667 The @code{tfaas} command accepts the same options as the @code{frame
3668 apply} command. @xref{Frame Apply,,frame apply}.
3669
3670 @kindex thread name
3671 @cindex name a thread
3672 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3673 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3674 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3675 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3676
3677 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3678 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3679 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3680 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3681 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3682
3683 @kindex thread find
3684 @cindex search for a thread
3685 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3686 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3687 matches the supplied regular expression.
3688
3689 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3690 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3691 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3692 is the LWP id.
3693
3694 @smallexample
3695 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3696 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3697 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3698 Id Target Id Frame
3699 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3700 @end smallexample
3701
3702 @kindex set print thread-events
3703 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3704 @item set print thread-events
3705 @itemx set print thread-events on
3706 @itemx set print thread-events off
3707 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3708 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3709 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3710 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3711 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3712
3713 @kindex show print thread-events
3714 @item show print thread-events
3715 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3716 have started and exited.
3717 @end table
3718
3719 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3720 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3721 programs with multiple threads.
3722
3723 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3724 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3725
3726 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3727 @table @code
3728 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3729 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3730 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3731 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3732 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3733 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3734 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3735 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3736 macro.
3737
3738 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3739 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3740 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3741 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3742 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3743 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3744
3745 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3746 refers to the default system directories that are
3747 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3748 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3749 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3750
3751 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3752 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3753 was loaded in the inferior process.
3754
3755 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3756 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3757 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3758 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3759 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3760 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3761 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3762
3763 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3764 only on some platforms.
3765
3766 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3767 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3768 Display current libthread_db search path.
3769
3770 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3771 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3772 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3773 @item set debug libthread-db
3774 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3775 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3776 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3777 @end table
3778
3779 @node Forks
3780 @section Debugging Forks
3781
3782 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3783 @cindex multiple processes
3784 @cindex processes, multiple
3785 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3786 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3787 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3788 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3789 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3790 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3791 will cause it to terminate.
3792
3793 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3794 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3795 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3796 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3797 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3798 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3799 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3800 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3801 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3802 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3803
3804 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3805 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3806 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3807 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3808
3809 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3810 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3811 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3812
3813 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3814 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3815
3816 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3817 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3818
3819 @table @code
3820 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3821 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3822 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3823 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3824 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3825
3826 @table @code
3827 @item parent
3828 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3829 unimpeded. This is the default.
3830
3831 @item child
3832 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3833 unimpeded.
3834
3835 @end table
3836
3837 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3838 @item show follow-fork-mode
3839 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3840 @end table
3841
3842 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3843 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3844 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3845
3846 @table @code
3847 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3848 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3849 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3850 retain debugger control over them both.
3851
3852 @table @code
3853 @item on
3854 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3855 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3856 independently. This is the default.
3857
3858 @item off
3859 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3860 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3861 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3862 is held suspended.
3863
3864 @end table
3865
3866 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3867 @item show detach-on-fork
3868 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3869 @end table
3870
3871 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3872 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3873 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3874 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3875 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors Connections and
3876 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors Connections and Programs}).
3877
3878 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3879 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3880 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3881 command. @xref{Inferiors Connections and Programs, ,Debugging
3882 Multiple Inferiors Connections and Programs}.
3883
3884 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3885 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3886 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3887 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3888 the child process's @code{main}.
3889
3890 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3891 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3892
3893 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3894 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3895 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3896 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3897 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3898 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3899 command.
3900
3901 @table @code
3902 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3903 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3904
3905 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3906 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3907
3908 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3909
3910 @table @code
3911 @item new
3912 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3913 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3914 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3915 original inferior.
3916
3917 For example:
3918
3919 @smallexample
3920 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3921 (gdb) info inferior
3922 Id Description Executable
3923 * 1 <null> prog1
3924 (@value{GDBP}) run
3925 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3926 Program exited normally.
3927 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3928 Id Description Executable
3929 1 <null> prog1
3930 * 2 <null> prog2
3931 @end smallexample
3932
3933 @item same
3934 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3935 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3936 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3937 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3938 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3939
3940 For example:
3941
3942 @smallexample
3943 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3944 Id Description Executable
3945 * 1 <null> prog1
3946 (@value{GDBP}) run
3947 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3948 Program exited normally.
3949 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3950 Id Description Executable
3951 * 1 <null> prog2
3952 @end smallexample
3953
3954 @end table
3955 @end table
3956
3957 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3958 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3959
3960 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3961 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3962 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3963
3964 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3965 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3966
3967 @cindex checkpoint
3968 @cindex restart
3969 @cindex bookmark
3970 @cindex snapshot of a process
3971 @cindex rewind program state
3972
3973 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3974 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3975 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3976 later.
3977
3978 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3979 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3980 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3981 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3982 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3983
3984 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3985 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3986 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3987 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3988 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3989 start again from there.
3990
3991 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3992 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3993
3994 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3995
3996 @table @code
3997 @kindex checkpoint
3998 @item checkpoint
3999 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
4000 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
4001 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
4002
4003 @kindex info checkpoints
4004 @item info checkpoints
4005 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
4006 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
4007 listed:
4008
4009 @table @code
4010 @item Checkpoint ID
4011 @item Process ID
4012 @item Code Address
4013 @item Source line, or label
4014 @end table
4015
4016 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
4017 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
4018 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
4019 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
4020 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
4021 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
4022 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
4023
4024 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
4025 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
4026 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
4027 the debugger.
4028
4029 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
4030 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
4031 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
4032
4033 @end table
4034
4035 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
4036 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
4037 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
4038 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
4039 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
4040 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
4041 previously read data can be read again.
4042
4043 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
4044 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
4045 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
4046 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
4047 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
4048 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
4049
4050 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
4051 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
4052 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
4053 different execution path this time.
4054
4055 @cindex checkpoints and process id
4056 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
4057 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
4058 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
4059 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
4060 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
4061 potentially pose a problem.
4062
4063 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
4064
4065 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
4066 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
4067 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
4068 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
4069 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
4070 next.
4071
4072 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
4073 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
4074 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
4075 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
4076 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
4077
4078 @node Stopping
4079 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
4080
4081 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
4082 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
4083 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
4084
4085 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
4086 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
4087 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
4088 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
4089 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
4090 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
4091 explicitly request this information at any time.
4092
4093 @table @code
4094 @kindex info program
4095 @item info program
4096 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
4097 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
4098 @end table
4099
4100 @menu
4101 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
4102 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
4103 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
4104 Skipping over functions and files
4105 * Signals:: Signals
4106 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4107 @end menu
4108
4109 @node Breakpoints
4110 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
4111
4112 @cindex breakpoints
4113 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
4114 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
4115 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
4116 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
4117 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
4118 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
4119 program.
4120
4121 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
4122 the executable is run.
4123
4124 @cindex watchpoints
4125 @cindex data breakpoints
4126 @cindex memory tracing
4127 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
4128 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
4129 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
4130 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
4131 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
4132 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
4133 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
4134 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
4135 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
4136 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
4137 same commands.
4138
4139 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
4140 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
4141 Automatic Display}.
4142
4143 @cindex catchpoints
4144 @cindex breakpoint on events
4145 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
4146 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
4147 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
4148 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
4149 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
4150 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
4151 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4152
4153 @cindex breakpoint numbers
4154 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
4155 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4156 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
4157 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
4158 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
4159 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
4160 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
4161 enable it again.
4162
4163 @cindex breakpoint ranges
4164 @cindex breakpoint lists
4165 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
4166 @cindex lists of breakpoints
4167 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
4168 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
4169 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
4170 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
4171 are operated on.
4172
4173 @menu
4174 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
4175 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
4176 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
4177 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
4178 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
4179 * Conditions:: Break conditions
4180 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
4181 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
4182 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
4183 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
4184 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4185 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4186 @end menu
4187
4188 @node Set Breaks
4189 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
4190
4191 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
4192 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
4193 @c
4194 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
4195
4196 @kindex break
4197 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
4198 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
4199 @cindex latest breakpoint
4200 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
4201 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
4202 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
4203 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
4204 convenience variables.
4205
4206 @table @code
4207 @item break @var{location}
4208 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
4209 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
4210 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
4211 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
4212 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
4213
4214 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
4215 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
4216 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
4217 that situation.
4218
4219 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
4220 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
4221 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
4222
4223 @item break
4224 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
4225 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
4226 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
4227 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
4228 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
4229 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
4230 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
4231 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
4232 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
4233 inside loops.
4234
4235 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
4236 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
4237 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
4238 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
4239 existed when your program stopped.
4240
4241 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
4242 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
4243 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
4244 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
4245 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
4246 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
4247 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
4248
4249 The breakpoint may be mapped to multiple locations. If the breakpoint
4250 condition @var{cond} is invalid at some but not all of the locations,
4251 the locations for which the condition is invalid are disabled. For
4252 example, @value{GDBN} reports below that two of the three locations
4253 are disabled.
4254
4255 @smallexample
4256 (@value{GDBP}) break func if a == 10
4257 warning: failed to validate condition at location 0x11ce, disabling:
4258 No symbol "a" in current context.
4259 warning: failed to validate condition at location 0x11b6, disabling:
4260 No symbol "a" in current context.
4261 Breakpoint 1 at 0x11b6: func. (3 locations)
4262 @end smallexample
4263
4264 Locations that are disabled because of the condition are denoted by an
4265 uppercase @code{N} in the output of the @code{info breakpoints}
4266 command:
4267
4268 @smallexample
4269 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
4270 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4271 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4272 stop only if a == 10
4273 1.1 N* 0x00000000000011b6 in ...
4274 1.2 y 0x00000000000011c2 in ...
4275 1.3 N* 0x00000000000011ce in ...
4276 (*): Breakpoint condition is invalid at this location.
4277 @end smallexample
4278
4279 If the breakpoint condition @var{cond} is invalid in the context of
4280 @emph{all} the locations of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN} refuses to
4281 define the breakpoint. For example, if variable @code{foo} is an
4282 undefined variable:
4283
4284 @smallexample
4285 (@value{GDBP}) break func if foo
4286 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4287 @end smallexample
4288
4289 @item break @dots{} -force-condition if @var{cond}
4290 There may be cases where the condition @var{cond} is invalid at all
4291 the current locations, but the user knows that it will be valid at a
4292 future location; for example, because of a library load. In such
4293 cases, by using the @code{-force-condition} keyword before @samp{if},
4294 @value{GDBN} can be forced to define the breakpoint with the given
4295 condition expression instead of refusing it.
4296
4297 @smallexample
4298 (@value{GDBP}) break func -force-condition if foo
4299 warning: failed to validate condition at location 1, disabling:
4300 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4301 warning: failed to validate condition at location 2, disabling:
4302 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4303 warning: failed to validate condition at location 3, disabling:
4304 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4305 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1158: test.c:18. (3 locations)
4306 @end smallexample
4307
4308 This causes all the present locations where the breakpoint would
4309 otherwise be inserted, to be disabled, as seen in the example above.
4310 However, if there exist locations at which the condition is valid, the
4311 @code{-force-condition} keyword has no effect.
4312
4313 @kindex tbreak
4314 @item tbreak @var{args}
4315 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
4316 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
4317 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
4318 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
4319
4320 @kindex hbreak
4321 @cindex hardware breakpoints
4322 @item hbreak @var{args}
4323 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
4324 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
4325 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
4326 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
4327 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
4328 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
4329 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
4330 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
4331 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
4332 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
4333 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
4334 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
4335 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
4336 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
4337 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
4338 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4339 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4340 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4341
4342 @kindex thbreak
4343 @item thbreak @var{args}
4344 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
4345 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
4346 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
4347 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
4348 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
4349 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
4350 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
4351 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
4352
4353 @kindex rbreak
4354 @cindex regular expression
4355 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
4356 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
4357 @item rbreak @var{regex}
4358 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
4359 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
4360 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
4361 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
4362 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
4363 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
4364
4365 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
4366 to print the list of all breakpoints it sets according to the
4367 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
4368 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
4369 language of the breakpoint's function, other values mean to use
4370 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
4371
4372 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
4373 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
4374 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
4375 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
4376 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
4377 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
4378
4379 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
4380 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
4381 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
4382 classes.
4383
4384 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
4385 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
4386 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
4387
4388 @smallexample
4389 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
4390 @end smallexample
4391
4392 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
4393 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
4394 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
4395 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
4396 every function in a given file:
4397
4398 @smallexample
4399 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
4400 @end smallexample
4401
4402 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
4403 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
4404
4405 @kindex info breakpoints
4406 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
4407 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4408 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4409 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
4410 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
4411 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
4412 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
4413
4414 @table @emph
4415 @item Breakpoint Numbers
4416 @item Type
4417 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
4418 @item Disposition
4419 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
4420 @item Enabled or Disabled
4421 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
4422 that are not enabled.
4423 @item Address
4424 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
4425 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
4426 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
4427 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
4428 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
4429 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
4430 @item What
4431 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
4432 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
4433 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
4434 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
4435 @end table
4436
4437 @noindent
4438 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
4439 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
4440 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
4441 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
4442 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
4443 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
4444
4445 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
4446 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
4447 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
4448 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
4449
4450 @noindent
4451 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
4452 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
4453 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
4454 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
4455 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
4456
4457 @noindent
4458 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
4459 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
4460 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
4461 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
4462 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
4463 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
4464
4465 @noindent
4466 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
4467 @code{info break} also displays that count.
4468
4469 @end table
4470
4471 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
4472 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
4473 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
4474 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4475
4476 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
4477 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
4478 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
4479 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
4480
4481 @itemize @bullet
4482 @item
4483 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
4484
4485 @item
4486 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
4487 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
4488
4489 @item
4490 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
4491 correspond to any number of instantiations.
4492
4493 @item
4494 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
4495 several places where that function is inlined.
4496 @end itemize
4497
4498 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4499 the relevant locations.
4500
4501 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4502 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4503 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4504 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4505 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4506 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4507 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4508
4509 For example:
4510
4511 @smallexample
4512 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4513 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4514 stop only if i==1
4515 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4516 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4517 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4518 @end smallexample
4519
4520 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4521 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4522 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4523 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4524 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4525 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4526 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4527 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4528 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4529 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4530 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4531
4532 @cindex pending breakpoints
4533 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4534 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4535 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4536 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4537 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4538 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4539 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4540 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4541 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4542 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4543 is not yet resolved.
4544
4545 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4546 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4547 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4548 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4549 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4550 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4551
4552 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4553 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4554 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4555 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4556
4557 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4558 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4559 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4560
4561 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4562 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4563 address specification to an address:
4564
4565 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4566 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4567 @table @code
4568 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4569 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4570 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4571
4572 @item set breakpoint pending on
4573 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4574 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4575
4576 @item set breakpoint pending off
4577 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4578 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4579 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4580
4581 @item show breakpoint pending
4582 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4583 @end table
4584
4585 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4586 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4587 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4588
4589 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4590 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4591 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4592 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4593 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4594 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4595 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4596 breakpoints.
4597
4598 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4599
4600 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4601 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4602 @table @code
4603 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4604 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4605 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4606 breakpoint must be used.
4607
4608 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4609 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4610 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4611 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4612 @end table
4613
4614 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4615 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4616 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4617 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4618 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4619 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4620 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4621 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4622 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4623
4624 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4625 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4626 @table @code
4627 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4628 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4629 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4630 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4631
4632 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4633 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4634 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4635 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4636 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4637 @end table
4638
4639 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4640 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4641 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4642
4643 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4644 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4645
4646 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4647
4648 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4649 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4650 @table @code
4651 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4652 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4653 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4654 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4655 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4656
4657 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4658 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4659 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4660 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4661 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4662 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4663 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4664 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4665 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4666 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4667 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4668 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4669 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4670
4671 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4672 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4673 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4674 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4675 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4676 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4677 @end table
4678
4679
4680 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4681 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4682 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4683 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4684 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4685 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4686 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4687 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4688
4689
4690 @node Set Watchpoints
4691 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4692
4693 @cindex setting watchpoints
4694 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4695 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4696 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4697 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4698 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4699
4700 @itemize @bullet
4701 @item
4702 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4703
4704 @item
4705 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4706 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4707 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4708
4709 @item
4710 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4711 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4712 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4713 @end itemize
4714
4715 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4716 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4717 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4718 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4719 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4720 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4721 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4722 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4723 the expression changes.
4724
4725 @cindex software watchpoints
4726 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4727 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4728 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4729 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4730 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4731 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4732 culprit.)
4733
4734 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4735 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4736 slow down the running of your program.
4737
4738 @table @code
4739 @kindex watch
4740 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4741 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4742 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4743 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4744 to watch the value of a single variable:
4745
4746 @smallexample
4747 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4748 @end smallexample
4749
4750 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4751 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4752 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4753 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4754 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4755 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4756
4757 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4758 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4759 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4760 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4761 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4762 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4763 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4764 error.
4765
4766 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4767 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4768 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4769 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4770 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4771 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4772 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4773 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4774 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4775 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4776 Examples:
4777
4778 @smallexample
4779 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4780 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4781 @end smallexample
4782
4783 @kindex rwatch
4784 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4785 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4786 by the program.
4787
4788 @kindex awatch
4789 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4790 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4791 or written into by the program.
4792
4793 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4794 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4795 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4796 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4797 @end table
4798
4799 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4800 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4801 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4802 a never-changing value:
4803
4804 @smallexample
4805 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4806 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4807 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4808 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4809 @end smallexample
4810
4811 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4812 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4813 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4814 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4815 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4816 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4817
4818 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4819 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4820 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4821 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4822 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4823 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4824 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4825 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4826
4827 @table @code
4828 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4829 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4830 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4831
4832 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4833 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4834 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4835 @end table
4836
4837 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4838 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4839 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4840
4841 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4842
4843 @smallexample
4844 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4845 @end smallexample
4846
4847 @noindent
4848 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4849
4850 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4851 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4852 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4853 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4854 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4855 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4856 will print a message like this:
4857
4858 @smallexample
4859 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4860 @end smallexample
4861
4862 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4863 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4864 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4865 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4866 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4867 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4868 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4869 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4870
4871 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4872 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4873 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4874 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4875 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4876 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4877
4878 @smallexample
4879 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4880 @end smallexample
4881
4882 @noindent
4883 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4884
4885 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4886 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4887 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4888 expression with separately allocated resources.
4889
4890 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4891 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4892 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4893
4894 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4895 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4896 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4897 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4898 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4899 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4900 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4901 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4902 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4903
4904 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4905 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4906 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4907 watched expression from every thread.
4908
4909 @quotation
4910 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4911 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4912 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4913 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4914 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4915 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4916 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4917 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4918 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4919 @end quotation
4920
4921 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4922
4923 @node Set Catchpoints
4924 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4925 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4926 @cindex exception handlers
4927 @cindex event handling
4928
4929 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4930 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4931 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4932
4933 @table @code
4934 @kindex catch
4935 @item catch @var{event}
4936 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4937
4938 @table @code
4939 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4940 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4941 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4942 @kindex catch throw
4943 @kindex catch rethrow
4944 @kindex catch catch
4945 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4946 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4947
4948 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4949 regular expression will be caught.
4950
4951 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4952 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4953 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4954 exception being thrown.
4955
4956 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4957 @value{GDBN}:
4958
4959 @itemize @bullet
4960 @item
4961 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4962 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4963 supported.
4964
4965 @item
4966 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4967 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4968 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4969 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4970 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4971 built.
4972
4973 @item
4974 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4975 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4976
4977 @item
4978 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4979 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4980 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4981 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4982
4983 @item
4984 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4985 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4986 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4987 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4988 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4989 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4990 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4991 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4992 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4993
4994 @item
4995 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4996
4997 @item
4998 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4999 @end itemize
5000
5001 @item exception @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
5002 @kindex catch exception
5003 @cindex Ada exception catching
5004 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
5005 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
5006 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
5007 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
5008 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
5009
5010 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
5011 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
5012 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
5013 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
5014 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
5015 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
5016 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
5017 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
5018
5019 @vindex $_ada_exception@r{, convenience variable}
5020 The convenience variable @code{$_ada_exception} holds the address of
5021 the exception being thrown. This can be useful when setting a
5022 condition for such a catchpoint.
5023
5024 @item exception unhandled
5025 @kindex catch exception unhandled
5026 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program. The
5027 convenience variable @code{$_ada_exception} is set as for @code{catch
5028 exception}.
5029
5030 @item handlers @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
5031 @kindex catch handlers
5032 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
5033 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
5034 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
5035 specified at the end of the command
5036 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
5037 only when this specific exception is handled.
5038 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
5039
5040 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
5041 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
5042 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
5043 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
5044 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
5045 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
5046 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
5047 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
5048 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
5049
5050 The convenience variable @code{$_ada_exception} is set as for
5051 @code{catch exception}.
5052
5053 @item assert
5054 @kindex catch assert
5055 A failed Ada assertion. Note that the convenience variable
5056 @code{$_ada_exception} is @emph{not} set by this catchpoint.
5057
5058 @item exec
5059 @kindex catch exec
5060 @cindex break on fork/exec
5061 A call to @code{exec}.
5062
5063 @anchor{catch syscall}
5064 @item syscall
5065 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
5066 @kindex catch syscall
5067 @cindex break on a system call.
5068 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
5069 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
5070 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
5071 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
5072 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
5073 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
5074 will be caught.
5075
5076 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
5077 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
5078 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
5079 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
5080
5081 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
5082 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
5083 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
5084 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
5085
5086 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
5087 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
5088 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
5089 available choices.
5090
5091 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
5092 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
5093 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
5094 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
5095 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
5096 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
5097 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
5098 behind the OS upgrades).
5099
5100 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
5101 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
5102 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
5103 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
5104 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
5105 available in every system. You can use the command completion
5106 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
5107 syscall groups available on your environment.
5108
5109 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
5110 arguments to it:
5111
5112 @smallexample
5113 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
5114 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
5115 (@value{GDBP}) r
5116 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
5117
5118 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
5119 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
5120 (@value{GDBP}) c
5121 Continuing.
5122
5123 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
5124 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
5125 (@value{GDBP})
5126 @end smallexample
5127
5128 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
5129
5130 @smallexample
5131 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
5132 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
5133 (@value{GDBP}) r
5134 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
5135
5136 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
5137 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
5138 (@value{GDBP}) c
5139 Continuing.
5140
5141 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
5142 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
5143 (@value{GDBP})
5144 @end smallexample
5145
5146 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
5147 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
5148 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
5149
5150 @smallexample
5151 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
5152 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
5153 (@value{GDBP}) r
5154 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
5155
5156 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
5157 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
5158 (@value{GDBP}) c
5159 Continuing.
5160
5161 Program exited normally.
5162 (@value{GDBP})
5163 @end smallexample
5164
5165 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
5166
5167 @smallexample
5168 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
5169 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
5170 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
5171 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
5172 (@value{GDBP}) r
5173 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
5174
5175 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
5176 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
5177
5178 (@value{GDBP}) c
5179 Continuing.
5180 @end smallexample
5181
5182 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
5183 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
5184 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
5185 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
5186
5187 @smallexample
5188 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
5189 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
5190 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
5191 (@value{GDBP})
5192 @end smallexample
5193
5194 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
5195 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
5196 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
5197 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
5198 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
5199 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
5200
5201 @smallexample
5202 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
5203 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
5204 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
5205 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
5206 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
5207 (@value{GDBP})
5208 @end smallexample
5209
5210 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
5211
5212 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
5213 number. In this case, you would see something like:
5214
5215 @smallexample
5216 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
5217 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
5218 @end smallexample
5219
5220 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
5221
5222 @item fork
5223 @kindex catch fork
5224 A call to @code{fork}.
5225
5226 @item vfork
5227 @kindex catch vfork
5228 A call to @code{vfork}.
5229
5230 @item load @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
5231 @itemx unload @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
5232 @kindex catch load
5233 @kindex catch unload
5234 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
5235 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
5236 matches one of the affected libraries.
5237
5238 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5239 @kindex catch signal
5240 The delivery of a signal.
5241
5242 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
5243 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
5244 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
5245
5246 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
5247 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
5248 signal names.
5249
5250 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
5251 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
5252 will be caught.
5253
5254 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
5255 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
5256 catchpoint.
5257
5258 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
5259 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
5260 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
5261 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
5262 commands.
5263
5264 @end table
5265
5266 @item tcatch @var{event}
5267 @kindex tcatch
5268 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
5269 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
5270
5271 @end table
5272
5273 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
5274
5275
5276 @node Delete Breaks
5277 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
5278
5279 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
5280 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
5281 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
5282 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
5283 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
5284 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
5285
5286 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
5287 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
5288 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
5289 their breakpoint numbers.
5290
5291 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
5292 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
5293 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
5294
5295 @table @code
5296 @kindex clear
5297 @item clear
5298 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
5299 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
5300 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
5301 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
5302
5303 @item clear @var{location}
5304 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
5305 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
5306 most useful ones are listed below:
5307
5308 @table @code
5309 @item clear @var{function}
5310 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
5311 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
5312
5313 @item clear @var{linenum}
5314 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5315 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
5316 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
5317 @end table
5318
5319 @cindex delete breakpoints
5320 @kindex delete
5321 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
5322 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5323 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
5324 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
5325 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
5326 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
5327 @end table
5328
5329 @node Disabling
5330 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
5331
5332 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
5333 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
5334 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
5335 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
5336 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
5337
5338 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
5339 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
5340 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
5341 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
5342 do not know which numbers to use.
5343
5344 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
5345 affects all of its locations.
5346
5347 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
5348 different states of enablement:
5349
5350 @itemize @bullet
5351 @item
5352 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
5353 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
5354 @item
5355 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
5356 @item
5357 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
5358 disabled.
5359 @item
5360 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
5361 N times, then becomes disabled.
5362 @item
5363 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
5364 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
5365 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
5366 @end itemize
5367
5368 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
5369 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
5370
5371 @table @code
5372 @kindex disable
5373 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
5374 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5375 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
5376 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
5377 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
5378 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
5379 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
5380
5381 @kindex enable
5382 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5383 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
5384 become effective once again in stopping your program.
5385
5386 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
5387 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
5388 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
5389
5390 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
5391 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
5392 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
5393 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
5394 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
5395 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
5396 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
5397
5398 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
5399 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
5400 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
5401 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
5402 @end table
5403
5404 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
5405 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
5406 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
5407 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
5408 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
5409 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
5410 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
5411 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
5412 Stepping}.)
5413
5414 @node Conditions
5415 @subsection Break Conditions
5416 @cindex conditional breakpoints
5417 @cindex breakpoint conditions
5418
5419 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5420 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
5421 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
5422 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
5423 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
5424 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
5425 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
5426 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
5427
5428 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
5429 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
5430 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
5431 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
5432 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
5433
5434 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
5435 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
5436 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
5437 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
5438 one.
5439
5440 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
5441 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
5442 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
5443 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
5444 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
5445 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
5446 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
5447 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
5448 conditions for the
5449 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
5450 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
5451
5452 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
5453 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
5454 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
5455 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
5456 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
5457 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
5458
5459 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
5460 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
5461 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
5462 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
5463 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
5464
5465 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
5466 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
5467 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
5468 with the @code{condition} command.
5469
5470 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
5471 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
5472 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
5473 catchpoint.
5474
5475 @table @code
5476 @kindex condition
5477 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
5478 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
5479 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
5480 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
5481 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
5482 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
5483 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
5484 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
5485 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
5486 prints an error message:
5487
5488 @smallexample
5489 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5490 @end smallexample
5491
5492 @noindent
5493 @value{GDBN} does
5494 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
5495 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
5496 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5497
5498 @item condition -force @var{bnum} @var{expression}
5499 When the @code{-force} flag is used, define the condition even if
5500 @var{expression} is invalid at all the current locations of breakpoint
5501 @var{bnum}. This is similar to the @code{-force-condition} option
5502 of the @code{break} command.
5503
5504 @item condition @var{bnum}
5505 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
5506 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
5507 @end table
5508
5509 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
5510 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
5511 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
5512 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
5513 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5514 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5515 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5516 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5517 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5518 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5519 your program reaches it.
5520
5521 @table @code
5522 @kindex ignore
5523 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5524 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5525 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5526 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5527 takes no action.
5528
5529 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5530 a count of zero.
5531
5532 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5533 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5534 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5535 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5536
5537 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5538 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5539 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5540
5541 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5542 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5543 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5544 Variables}.
5545 @end table
5546
5547 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5548
5549
5550 @node Break Commands
5551 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5552
5553 @cindex breakpoint commands
5554 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5555 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5556 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5557 enable other breakpoints.
5558
5559 @table @code
5560 @kindex commands
5561 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5562 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5563 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5564 @itemx end
5565 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5566 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5567 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5568
5569 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5570 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5571
5572 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5573 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5574 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5575 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5576 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5577 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5578 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5579 Expressions}).
5580 @end table
5581
5582 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5583 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5584
5585 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5586 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5587 that resumes execution.
5588
5589 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5590 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5591 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5592 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5593 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5594
5595 @kindex silent
5596 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5597 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5598 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5599 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5600 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5601 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5602
5603 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5604 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5605 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5606
5607 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5608 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5609
5610 @smallexample
5611 break foo if x>0
5612 commands
5613 silent
5614 printf "x is %d\n",x
5615 cont
5616 end
5617 @end smallexample
5618
5619 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5620 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5621 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5622 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5623 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5624 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5625 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5626
5627 @smallexample
5628 break 403
5629 commands
5630 silent
5631 set x = y + 4
5632 cont
5633 end
5634 @end smallexample
5635
5636 @node Dynamic Printf
5637 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5638
5639 @cindex dynamic printf
5640 @cindex dprintf
5641 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5642 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5643 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5644 having to recompile it.
5645
5646 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5647 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5648 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5649 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5650 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5651 redirects to files and so forth.
5652
5653 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5654 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5655 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5656 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5657 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5658 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5659 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5660
5661 @table @code
5662 @kindex dprintf
5663 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5664 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5665 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5666 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5667
5668 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5669 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5670 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5671 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5672 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5673 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5674
5675 @table @code
5676 @item gdb
5677 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5678 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5679
5680 @item call
5681 @kindex dprintf-style call
5682 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5683 @code{printf}).
5684
5685 @item agent
5686 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5687 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5688 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5689 support running commands on the target.
5690 @end table
5691
5692 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5693 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5694 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5695 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5696 command.
5697
5698 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5699 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5700 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5701 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5702 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5703 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5704
5705 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5706 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5707 you could do the following:
5708
5709 @example
5710 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5711 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5712 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5713 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5714 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5715 (gdb) info break
5716 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5717 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5718 continue
5719 (gdb)
5720 @end example
5721
5722 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5723 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5724 the variable settings.
5725
5726 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5727 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5728 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5729 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5730 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5731 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5732
5733 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5734 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5735 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5736
5737 @end table
5738
5739 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5740 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5741 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5742 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5743 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5744 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5745
5746 @node Save Breakpoints
5747 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5748
5749 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5750 breakpoints}} command.
5751
5752 @table @code
5753 @kindex save breakpoints
5754 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5755 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5756 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5757 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5758 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5759 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5760 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5761 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5762 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5763 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5764 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5765 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5766 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5767 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5768 that can no longer be recreated.
5769 @end table
5770
5771 @node Static Probe Points
5772 @subsection Static Probe Points
5773
5774 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5775 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5776 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5777 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5778 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5779
5780 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5781 ELF-compatible systems:
5782
5783 @itemize @bullet
5784
5785 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5786 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5787 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5788 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5789 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5790 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5791 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5792 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5793
5794 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5795 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5796 C@t{++} languages.
5797 @end itemize
5798
5799 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5800 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5801 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5802 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5803 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5804 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5805 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5806 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5807 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5808
5809 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5810 probes}, with optional arguments:
5811
5812 @table @code
5813 @kindex info probes
5814 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5815 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5816 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5817 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5818
5819 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5820 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5821 probes from all providers are listed.
5822
5823 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5824 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5825 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5826
5827 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5828 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5829 given, all object files are considered.
5830
5831 @item info probes all
5832 List the available static probes, from all types.
5833 @end table
5834
5835 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5836 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5837 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5838 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5839 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5840
5841 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5842 commands, with optional arguments:
5843
5844 @table @code
5845 @kindex enable probes
5846 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5847 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5848 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5849 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5850
5851 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5852 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5853 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5854
5855 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5856 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5857 given, all object files are considered.
5858
5859 @kindex disable probes
5860 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5861 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5862 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5863 @end table
5864
5865 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5866 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5867 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5868 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5869 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5870 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5871 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5872 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5873 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5874 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5875 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5876 at the current probe point.
5877
5878 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5879 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5880 an error message.
5881
5882
5883 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5884 @node Error in Breakpoints
5885 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5886
5887 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5888 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5889
5890 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5891 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5892 @smallexample
5893 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5894 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5895 @end smallexample
5896
5897 @noindent
5898 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5899 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5900 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5901
5902 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5903 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5904
5905 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5906 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5907 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5908
5909 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5910 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5911 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5912 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5913
5914 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5915 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5916 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5917 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5918 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5919 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5920 first in the bundle.
5921
5922 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5923 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5924 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5925 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5926 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5927 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5928 is hit.
5929
5930 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5931 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5932
5933 @smallexample
5934 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5935 @end smallexample
5936
5937 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5938 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5939 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5940 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5941 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5942 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5943 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5944 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5945
5946 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5947 adjusted breakpoints:
5948
5949 @smallexample
5950 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5951 to 0x00010410.
5952 @end smallexample
5953
5954 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5955 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5956 frequently than expected.
5957
5958 @node Continuing and Stepping
5959 @section Continuing and Stepping
5960
5961 @cindex stepping
5962 @cindex continuing
5963 @cindex resuming execution
5964 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5965 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5966 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5967 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5968 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5969 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5970 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5971 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5972 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5973 handlers}).)
5974
5975 @table @code
5976 @kindex continue
5977 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5978 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5979 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5980 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5981 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5982 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5983 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5984 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5985 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5986 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5987
5988 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5989 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5990 @code{continue} is ignored.
5991
5992 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5993 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5994 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5995 @code{continue}.
5996 @end table
5997
5998 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5999 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
6000 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
6001 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
6002
6003 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
6004 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
6005 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
6006 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
6007 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
6008 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
6009
6010 @table @code
6011 @kindex step
6012 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
6013 @item step
6014 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
6015 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
6016 abbreviated @code{s}.
6017
6018 @quotation
6019 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
6020 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
6021 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
6022 @c distinction here.
6023 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
6024 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
6025 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
6026 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
6027 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
6028 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
6029 below.
6030 @end quotation
6031
6032 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
6033 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
6034 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
6035 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
6036 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
6037 called within the line.
6038
6039 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
6040 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
6041 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
6042 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
6043 was any debugging information about the routine.
6044
6045 @item step @var{count}
6046 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
6047 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
6048 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
6049
6050 @kindex next
6051 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
6052 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6053 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
6054 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
6055 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
6056 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
6057 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
6058 is abbreviated @code{n}.
6059
6060 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
6061
6062
6063 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
6064 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
6065 @c
6066 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
6067 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
6068 @c function are executed without stopping.
6069
6070 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
6071 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
6072 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
6073
6074 @kindex set step-mode
6075 @item set step-mode
6076 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
6077 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
6078 @itemx set step-mode on
6079 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
6080 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
6081 information rather than stepping over it.
6082
6083 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
6084 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
6085 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
6086
6087 @item set step-mode off
6088 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
6089 debug information. This is the default.
6090
6091 @item show step-mode
6092 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
6093 source line debug information.
6094
6095 @kindex finish
6096 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
6097 @item finish
6098 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
6099 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
6100 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
6101
6102 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
6103 ,Returning from a Function}).
6104
6105 @kindex set print finish
6106 @kindex show print finish
6107 @item set print finish @r{[}on|off@r{]}
6108 @itemx show print finish
6109 By default the @code{finish} command will show the value that is
6110 returned by the function. This can be disabled using @code{set print
6111 finish off}. When disabled, the value is still entered into the value
6112 history (@pxref{Value History}), but not displayed.
6113
6114 @kindex until
6115 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
6116 @cindex run until specified location
6117 @item until
6118 @itemx u
6119 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
6120 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
6121 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
6122 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
6123 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
6124 than the address of the jump.
6125
6126 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
6127 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
6128 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
6129 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
6130 through the next iteration.
6131
6132 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
6133 stack frame.
6134
6135 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
6136 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
6137 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
6138 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
6139 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
6140
6141 @smallexample
6142 (@value{GDBP}) f
6143 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
6144 206 expand_input();
6145 (@value{GDBP}) until
6146 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
6147 @end smallexample
6148
6149 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
6150 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
6151 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
6152 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
6153 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
6154 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
6155 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
6156
6157 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
6158 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
6159 argument.
6160
6161 @item until @var{location}
6162 @itemx u @var{location}
6163 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
6164 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
6165 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
6166 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
6167 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
6168 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
6169 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
6170 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
6171 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
6172 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
6173 invocations have returned.
6174
6175 @smallexample
6176 94 int factorial (int value)
6177 95 @{
6178 96 if (value > 1) @{
6179 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
6180 98 @}
6181 99 return (value);
6182 100 @}
6183 @end smallexample
6184
6185
6186 @kindex advance @var{location}
6187 @item advance @var{location}
6188 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
6189 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
6190 @ref{Specify Location}.
6191 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
6192 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
6193 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
6194 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
6195
6196
6197 @kindex stepi
6198 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
6199 @item stepi
6200 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
6201 @itemx si
6202 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
6203
6204 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
6205 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
6206 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
6207 Display,, Automatic Display}.
6208
6209 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
6210
6211 @need 750
6212 @kindex nexti
6213 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
6214 @item nexti
6215 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
6216 @itemx ni
6217 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
6218 proceed until the function returns.
6219
6220 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
6221
6222 @end table
6223
6224 @anchor{range stepping}
6225 @cindex range stepping
6226 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
6227 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
6228 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
6229 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
6230 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
6231 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
6232 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
6233 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
6234 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
6235 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
6236 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
6237 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
6238 if necessary:
6239
6240 @table @code
6241 @kindex set range-stepping
6242 @kindex show range-stepping
6243 @item set range-stepping
6244 @itemx show range-stepping
6245 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
6246
6247 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
6248 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
6249 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
6250 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
6251 default is @code{on}.
6252
6253 @end table
6254
6255 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
6256 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
6257 @cindex skipping over functions and files
6258
6259 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
6260 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
6261 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
6262 a particular file when stepping.
6263
6264 For example, consider the following C function:
6265
6266 @smallexample
6267 101 int func()
6268 102 @{
6269 103 foo(boring());
6270 104 bar(boring());
6271 105 @}
6272 @end smallexample
6273
6274 @noindent
6275 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
6276 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
6277 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
6278 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
6279
6280 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
6281 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
6282 is called from many places.
6283
6284 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
6285 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
6286 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
6287 @code{foo}.
6288
6289 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
6290 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
6291 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
6292
6293 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
6294 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
6295 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
6296 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
6297 the underlying system.
6298 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
6299 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
6300
6301 @table @code
6302 @kindex skip
6303 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
6304 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
6305 that specify what to skip.
6306 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
6307
6308 @table @code
6309 @item -file @var{file}
6310 @itemx -fi @var{file}
6311 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
6312
6313 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
6314 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
6315 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
6316 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
6317 over when stepping.
6318
6319 @smallexample
6320 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
6321 @end smallexample
6322
6323 @item -function @var{linespec}
6324 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
6325 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
6326 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
6327 @xref{Specify Location}.
6328
6329 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
6330 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
6331 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
6332 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
6333
6334 This form is useful for complex function names.
6335 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
6336 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
6337 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
6338 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
6339 regular expression makes this easier.
6340
6341 @smallexample
6342 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
6343 @end smallexample
6344
6345 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
6346 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
6347
6348 @smallexample
6349 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
6350 @end smallexample
6351 @end table
6352
6353 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
6354 will be skipped.
6355
6356 @kindex skip function
6357 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
6358 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
6359 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
6360 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
6361
6362 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
6363 will be skipped.
6364
6365 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
6366 @kbd{skip function file}.)
6367
6368 @kindex skip file
6369 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
6370 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
6371 will be skipped over when stepping.
6372
6373 @smallexample
6374 (gdb) skip file boring.c
6375 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
6376 @end smallexample
6377
6378 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
6379 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
6380 @end table
6381
6382 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
6383 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
6384
6385 @table @code
6386 @kindex info skip
6387 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6388 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
6389 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
6390 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
6391
6392 @table @emph
6393 @item Identifier
6394 A number identifying this skip.
6395 @item Enabled or Disabled
6396 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
6397 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
6398 @item Glob
6399 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
6400 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
6401 @item File
6402 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
6403 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
6404 @item RE
6405 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
6406 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
6407 @item Function
6408 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
6409 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
6410 @end table
6411
6412 @kindex skip delete
6413 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6414 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
6415 skips.
6416
6417 @kindex skip enable
6418 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6419 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
6420 skips.
6421
6422 @kindex skip disable
6423 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6424 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
6425 skips.
6426
6427 @kindex set debug skip
6428 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
6429 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
6430
6431 @kindex show debug skip
6432 @item show debug skip
6433 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
6434
6435 @end table
6436
6437 @node Signals
6438 @section Signals
6439 @cindex signals
6440
6441 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
6442 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
6443 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
6444 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
6445 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
6446 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
6447 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
6448 requested an alarm).
6449
6450 @cindex fatal signals
6451 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
6452 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
6453 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
6454 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
6455 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
6456 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
6457
6458 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
6459 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
6460 signal.
6461
6462 @cindex handling signals
6463 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
6464 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
6465 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
6466 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
6467 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
6468
6469 @table @code
6470 @kindex info signals
6471 @kindex info handle
6472 @item info signals
6473 @itemx info handle
6474 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
6475 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
6476 the defined types of signals.
6477
6478 @item info signals @var{sig}
6479 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
6480
6481 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
6482
6483 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
6484 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
6485 for details about this command.
6486
6487 @kindex handle
6488 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
6489 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
6490 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
6491 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
6492 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
6493 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
6494 say what change to make.
6495 @end table
6496
6497 @c @group
6498 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
6499 Their full names are:
6500
6501 @table @code
6502 @item nostop
6503 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
6504 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
6505
6506 @item stop
6507 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
6508 the @code{print} keyword as well.
6509
6510 @item print
6511 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
6512
6513 @item noprint
6514 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
6515 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
6516
6517 @item pass
6518 @itemx noignore
6519 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
6520 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
6521 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
6522
6523 @item nopass
6524 @itemx ignore
6525 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6526 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6527 @end table
6528 @c @end group
6529
6530 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6531 program until you
6532 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6533 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6534 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6535 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6536 program sees that signal when you continue.
6537
6538 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6539 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6540 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6541 erroneous signals.
6542
6543 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6544 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6545 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6546 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6547 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6548 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6549 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6550 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6551 Program a Signal}.
6552
6553 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6554 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6555
6556 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6557 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6558 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6559 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6560 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6561 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6562 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6563 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6564 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6565 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6566 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6567 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6568 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6569
6570 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6571
6572 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6573 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6574 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6575 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6576
6577 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6578 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6579 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6580 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6581
6582 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6583 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6584
6585 @smallexample
6586 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6587 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6588 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6589 (@value{GDBP}) c
6590 Continuing.
6591
6592 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6593 main () sigusr1.c:28
6594 28 p = 0;
6595 (@value{GDBP}) si
6596 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6597 9 @{
6598 @end smallexample
6599
6600 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6601 program to receive the signal first:
6602
6603 @smallexample
6604 (@value{GDBP}) n
6605 28 p = 0;
6606 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6607 (@value{GDBP}) si
6608 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6609 9 @{
6610 (@value{GDBP})
6611 @end smallexample
6612
6613 @cindex extra signal information
6614 @anchor{extra signal information}
6615
6616 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6617 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6618 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6619 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6620 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6621 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6622 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6623 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6624 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6625 system header.
6626
6627 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6628 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6629
6630 @smallexample
6631 @group
6632 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6633 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6634 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6635 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6636 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6637 type = struct @{
6638 int si_signo;
6639 int si_errno;
6640 int si_code;
6641 union @{
6642 int _pad[28];
6643 struct @{...@} _kill;
6644 struct @{...@} _timer;
6645 struct @{...@} _rt;
6646 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6647 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6648 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6649 @} _sifields;
6650 @}
6651 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6652 type = struct @{
6653 void *si_addr;
6654 @}
6655 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6656 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6657 @end group
6658 @end smallexample
6659
6660 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6661
6662 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6663 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6664 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6665 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6666 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6667 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6668 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6669 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6670 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6671 information is displayed.
6672
6673 The usual output of a segfault is:
6674 @smallexample
6675 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6676 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6677 68 value = *(p + len);
6678 @end smallexample
6679
6680 While a bound violation is presented as:
6681 @smallexample
6682 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6683 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6684 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6685 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6686 68 value = *(p + len);
6687 @end smallexample
6688
6689 @node Thread Stops
6690 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6691
6692 @cindex stopped threads
6693 @cindex threads, stopped
6694
6695 @cindex continuing threads
6696 @cindex threads, continuing
6697
6698 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6699 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6700 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6701 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6702 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6703 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6704 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6705 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6706 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6707
6708 @menu
6709 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6710 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6711 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6712 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6713 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6714 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6715 @end menu
6716
6717 @node All-Stop Mode
6718 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6719
6720 @cindex all-stop mode
6721
6722 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6723 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6724 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6725 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6726 underfoot.
6727
6728 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6729 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6730 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6731
6732 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6733 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6734 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6735 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6736 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6737 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6738 stops.
6739
6740 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6741 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6742 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6743 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6744
6745 @cindex automatic thread selection
6746 @cindex switching threads automatically
6747 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6748 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6749 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6750 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6751 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6752 thread.
6753
6754 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6755 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6756
6757 @table @code
6758 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6759 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6760 @cindex lock scheduler
6761 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6762 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6763 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6764 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6765 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6766 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6767 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6768 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6769 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6770 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6771 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6772 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6773 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6774 @code{on} in replay mode.
6775
6776 @item show scheduler-locking
6777 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6778 @end table
6779
6780 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6781 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6782 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6783 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6784 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6785 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6786 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6787 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6788 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6789 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6790 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6791 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6792 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6793 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6794
6795 @table @code
6796 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6797 @item set schedule-multiple
6798 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6799 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6800 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6801 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6802 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6803 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6804
6805 @item show schedule-multiple
6806 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6807 multiple processes.
6808 @end table
6809
6810 @node Non-Stop Mode
6811 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6812
6813 @cindex non-stop mode
6814
6815 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6816 @c with more details.
6817
6818 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6819 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6820 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6821 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6822 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6823 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6824
6825 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6826 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6827 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6828 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6829 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6830 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6831 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6832 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6833 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6834 independently and simultaneously.
6835
6836 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6837 or attach to your program:
6838
6839 @smallexample
6840 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6841 set pagination off
6842
6843 # Finally, turn it on!
6844 set non-stop on
6845 @end smallexample
6846
6847 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6848
6849 @table @code
6850 @kindex set non-stop
6851 @item set non-stop on
6852 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6853 @item set non-stop off
6854 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6855 @kindex show non-stop
6856 @item show non-stop
6857 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6858 @end table
6859
6860 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6861 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6862 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6863 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6864 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6865 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6866 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6867 default.
6868
6869 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6870 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6871 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6872
6873 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6874 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6875 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6876 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6877 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6878
6879 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6880 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6881 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6882 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6883 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6884
6885 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6886
6887 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6888 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6889 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6890 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6891 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6892 previously current thread.
6893
6894 @node Background Execution
6895 @subsection Background Execution
6896
6897 @cindex foreground execution
6898 @cindex background execution
6899 @cindex asynchronous execution
6900 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6901
6902 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6903 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6904 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6905 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6906 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6907 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6908
6909 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6910 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6911
6912 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6913 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6914 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6915 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6916 are:
6917
6918 @table @code
6919 @kindex run&
6920 @item run
6921 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6922
6923 @item attach
6924 @kindex attach&
6925 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6926
6927 @item step
6928 @kindex step&
6929 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6930
6931 @item stepi
6932 @kindex stepi&
6933 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6934
6935 @item next
6936 @kindex next&
6937 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6938
6939 @item nexti
6940 @kindex nexti&
6941 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6942
6943 @item continue
6944 @kindex continue&
6945 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6946
6947 @item finish
6948 @kindex finish&
6949 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6950
6951 @item until
6952 @kindex until&
6953 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6954
6955 @end table
6956
6957 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6958 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6959 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6960 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6961 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6962 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6963
6964 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6965 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6966
6967 @table @code
6968 @kindex interrupt
6969 @item interrupt
6970 @itemx interrupt -a
6971
6972 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6973 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6974 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6975 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6976 @end table
6977
6978 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6979 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6980
6981 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6982 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6983 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6984
6985 @table @code
6986 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6987 @cindex thread breakpoints
6988 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6989 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6990 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6991 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6992 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6993 specify some source line.
6994
6995 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6996 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6997 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6998 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6999 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
7000
7001 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
7002 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
7003 program.
7004
7005 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
7006 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
7007 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
7008
7009 @smallexample
7010 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
7011 @end smallexample
7012
7013 @end table
7014
7015 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
7016 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
7017 thread list. For example:
7018
7019 @smallexample
7020 (@value{GDBP}) c
7021 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
7022 @end smallexample
7023
7024 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
7025 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
7026 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
7027 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
7028 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
7029 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
7030 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
7031 command.
7032
7033 @node Interrupted System Calls
7034 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
7035
7036 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
7037 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
7038 @cindex premature return from system calls
7039 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
7040 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
7041 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
7042 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
7043 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
7044 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
7045 stop execution.
7046
7047 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
7048 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
7049 style anyways.
7050
7051 For example, do not write code like this:
7052
7053 @smallexample
7054 sleep (10);
7055 @end smallexample
7056
7057 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
7058 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
7059
7060 Instead, write this:
7061
7062 @smallexample
7063 int unslept = 10;
7064 while (unslept > 0)
7065 unslept = sleep (unslept);
7066 @end smallexample
7067
7068 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
7069 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
7070 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
7071 @value{GDBN}.
7072
7073 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
7074 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
7075 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
7076 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
7077
7078 @node Observer Mode
7079 @subsection Observer Mode
7080
7081 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
7082 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
7083 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
7084 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
7085 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
7086
7087 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
7088 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
7089 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
7090 mode.
7091
7092 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
7093 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
7094 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
7095 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
7096 stream will still not be able to be placed.
7097
7098 @table @code
7099
7100 @kindex observer
7101 @item set observer on
7102 @itemx set observer off
7103 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
7104 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
7105 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
7106 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
7107
7108 @item show observer
7109 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
7110
7111 @kindex may-write-registers
7112 @item set may-write-registers on
7113 @itemx set may-write-registers off
7114 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
7115 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
7116 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
7117
7118 @item show may-write-registers
7119 Show the current permission to write registers.
7120
7121 @kindex may-write-memory
7122 @item set may-write-memory on
7123 @itemx set may-write-memory off
7124 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
7125 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
7126 defaults to @code{on}.
7127
7128 @item show may-write-memory
7129 Show the current permission to write memory.
7130
7131 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
7132 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
7133 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
7134 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
7135 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
7136 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
7137
7138 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
7139 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
7140
7141 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
7142 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
7143 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
7144 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
7145 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
7146 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
7147 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
7148
7149 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
7150 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
7151
7152 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
7153 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
7154 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
7155 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
7156 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
7157 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
7158 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
7159
7160 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
7161 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
7162
7163 @kindex may-interrupt
7164 @item set may-interrupt on
7165 @itemx set may-interrupt off
7166 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
7167 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
7168 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
7169 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
7170
7171 @item show may-interrupt
7172 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
7173
7174 @end table
7175
7176 @node Reverse Execution
7177 @chapter Running programs backward
7178 @cindex reverse execution
7179 @cindex running programs backward
7180
7181 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
7182 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
7183 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
7184 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
7185
7186 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
7187 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
7188 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
7189 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
7190 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
7191 all target environments can support reverse execution.
7192
7193 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
7194 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
7195 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
7196 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
7197 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
7198 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
7199 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
7200 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
7201 prior values@footnote{
7202 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
7203 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
7204 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
7205
7206 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
7207 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
7208 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
7209 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
7210 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
7211 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
7212 consistent state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
7213 }.
7214
7215 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} has built-in support for reverse
7216 execution, activated with the @code{record} or @code{record btrace}
7217 commands. @xref{Process Record and Replay}. Some remote targets,
7218 typically full system emulators, support reverse execution directly
7219 without requiring any special command.
7220
7221 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
7222 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
7223
7224 @table @code
7225 @kindex reverse-continue
7226 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
7227 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
7228 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
7229 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
7230 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
7231 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
7232 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
7233
7234 @kindex reverse-step
7235 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
7236 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7237 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
7238 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
7239
7240 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
7241 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
7242 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
7243 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
7244 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
7245 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
7246
7247 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
7248 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
7249
7250 @kindex reverse-stepi
7251 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
7252 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7253 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
7254 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
7255 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
7256 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
7257 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
7258
7259 @kindex reverse-next
7260 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
7261 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7262 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
7263 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
7264 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
7265 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
7266 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
7267 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
7268 line of a function back to its return to its caller
7269 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
7270
7271 @kindex reverse-nexti
7272 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
7273 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7274 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
7275 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
7276 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
7277 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
7278 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
7279 frame) is reached.
7280
7281 @kindex reverse-finish
7282 @item reverse-finish
7283 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
7284 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
7285 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
7286 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
7287
7288 @kindex set exec-direction
7289 @item set exec-direction
7290 Set the direction of target execution.
7291 @item set exec-direction reverse
7292 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
7293 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
7294 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
7295 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
7296 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
7297 @item set exec-direction forward
7298 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
7299 This is the default.
7300 @end table
7301
7302
7303 @node Process Record and Replay
7304 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
7305 @cindex process record and replay
7306 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
7307
7308 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
7309 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
7310 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
7311
7312 @cindex replay mode
7313 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
7314 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
7315 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
7316 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
7317 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
7318 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
7319 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
7320 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
7321 execution log.
7322
7323 @cindex record mode
7324 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
7325 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
7326 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
7327 for future replay.
7328
7329 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
7330 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
7331 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
7332 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
7333 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
7334 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
7335
7336 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
7337 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
7338 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
7339 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
7340
7341 Currently, process record and replay is supported on ARM, Aarch64,
7342 Moxie, PowerPC, PowerPC64, S/390, and x86 (i386/amd64) running
7343 GNU/Linux. Process record and replay can be used both when native
7344 debugging, and when remote debugging via @code{gdbserver}.
7345
7346 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
7347 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
7348
7349 @table @code
7350 @kindex target record
7351 @kindex target record-full
7352 @kindex target record-btrace
7353 @kindex record
7354 @kindex record full
7355 @kindex record btrace
7356 @kindex record btrace bts
7357 @kindex record btrace pt
7358 @kindex record bts
7359 @kindex record pt
7360 @kindex rec
7361 @kindex rec full
7362 @kindex rec btrace
7363 @kindex rec btrace bts
7364 @kindex rec btrace pt
7365 @kindex rec bts
7366 @kindex rec pt
7367 @item record @var{method}
7368 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
7369 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
7370 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
7371 recording methods are available:
7372
7373 @table @code
7374 @item full
7375 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
7376 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
7377 execution.
7378
7379 @item btrace @var{format}
7380 Hardware-supported instruction recording, supported on Intel
7381 processors. This method does not record data. Further, the data is
7382 collected in a ring buffer so old data will be overwritten when the
7383 buffer is full. It allows limited reverse execution. Variables and
7384 registers are not available during reverse execution. In remote
7385 debugging, recording continues on disconnect. Recorded data can be
7386 inspected after reconnecting. The recording may be stopped using
7387 @code{record stop}.
7388
7389 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
7390 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
7391 formats are available:
7392
7393 @table @code
7394 @item bts
7395 @cindex branch trace store
7396 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
7397 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
7398 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
7399
7400 @item pt
7401 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
7402 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
7403 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
7404 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
7405
7406 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
7407 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
7408 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
7409
7410 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
7411 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
7412 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
7413 buffer-size with care.
7414 @end table
7415
7416 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
7417 @end table
7418
7419 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
7420 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
7421 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
7422 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
7423
7424 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
7425 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
7426 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
7427 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
7428 doesn't support displaced stepping.
7429
7430 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
7431 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
7432 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
7433 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
7434 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
7435 does not support these two modes.
7436
7437 @kindex record stop
7438 @kindex rec s
7439 @item record stop
7440 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
7441 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
7442 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
7443
7444 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
7445 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
7446 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
7447 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
7448 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
7449
7450 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
7451 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
7452 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
7453 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
7454 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
7455
7456 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
7457 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
7458
7459 @kindex record goto
7460 @item record goto
7461 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
7462 ways to specify the location to go to:
7463
7464 @table @code
7465 @item record goto begin
7466 @itemx record goto start
7467 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
7468
7469 @item record goto end
7470 Go to the end of the execution log.
7471
7472 @item record goto @var{n}
7473 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
7474 @end table
7475
7476 @kindex record save
7477 @item record save @var{filename}
7478 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
7479 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
7480 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
7481
7482 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7483
7484 @kindex record restore
7485 @item record restore @var{filename}
7486 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
7487 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
7488
7489 @kindex set record full
7490 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
7491 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
7492 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
7493 recording method. Default value is 200000.
7494
7495 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
7496 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
7497 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
7498 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
7499 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
7500 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
7501 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
7502 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
7503
7504 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
7505 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
7506 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
7507
7508 @kindex show record full
7509 @item show record full insn-number-max
7510 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
7511 recording method.
7512
7513 @item set record full stop-at-limit
7514 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
7515 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
7516 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
7517 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
7518 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
7519 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
7520 oldest one to be deleted.
7521
7522 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
7523 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
7524
7525 @item show record full stop-at-limit
7526 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
7527
7528 @item set record full memory-query
7529 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
7530 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
7531 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
7532 case.
7533
7534 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7535 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7536 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7537 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7538 results.
7539
7540 @item show record full memory-query
7541 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7542
7543 @kindex set record btrace
7544 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7545 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7546 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7547 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7548 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7549 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7550 You can use the following command for that:
7551
7552 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7553 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7554 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7555 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7556 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7557 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7558 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7559 position.
7560
7561 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7562 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7563 errata when decoding the trace.
7564
7565 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7566 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7567 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7568 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7569 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7570 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7571 which the trace was recorded.
7572
7573 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7574 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7575 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7576 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7577 disable the workarounds.
7578
7579 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7580 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{processor identifier}}. In addition,
7581 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7582 (default).
7583
7584 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7585 identifiers are currently supported:
7586
7587 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7588
7589 @item @code{intel}
7590 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7591
7592 @end multitable
7593
7594 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7595 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7596
7597 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7598 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7599 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7600
7601 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7602 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7603 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7604 supports.
7605
7606 @smallexample
7607 (gdb) info record
7608 Active record target: record-btrace
7609 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7610 Buffer size: 16kB.
7611 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7612 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7613 (gdb) info record
7614 Active record target: record-btrace
7615 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7616 Buffer size: 16kB.
7617 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7618 @end smallexample
7619
7620 @kindex show record btrace
7621 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7622 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7623
7624 @item show record btrace cpu
7625 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7626 workarounds.
7627
7628 @kindex set record btrace bts
7629 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7630 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7631 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7632 format. Default is 64KB.
7633
7634 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7635 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7636 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7637 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7638 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7639 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7640 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7641
7642 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7643 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7644
7645 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7646 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7647
7648 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7649 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7650 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7651
7652 @kindex set record btrace pt
7653 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7654 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7655 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7656 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7657
7658 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7659 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7660 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7661 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7662 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7663 actual buffer size for each thread.
7664
7665 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7666 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7667
7668 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7669 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7670
7671 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7672 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7673 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7674
7675 @kindex info record
7676 @item info record
7677 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7678 method:
7679
7680 @table @code
7681 @item full
7682 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7683 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7684
7685 @itemize @bullet
7686 @item
7687 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7688 @item
7689 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7690 @item
7691 Highest recorded instruction number.
7692 @item
7693 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7694 @item
7695 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7696 @item
7697 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7698 @end itemize
7699
7700 @item btrace
7701 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7702
7703 @itemize @bullet
7704 @item
7705 Recording format.
7706 @item
7707 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7708 @item
7709 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7710 instructions.
7711 @item
7712 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7713 @end itemize
7714
7715 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7716 @itemize @bullet
7717 @item
7718 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7719 @end itemize
7720
7721 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7722 @itemize @bullet
7723 @item
7724 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7725 @end itemize
7726 @end table
7727
7728 @kindex record delete
7729 @kindex rec del
7730 @item record delete
7731 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7732 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7733 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7734 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7735
7736 @kindex record instruction-history
7737 @kindex rec instruction-history
7738 @item record instruction-history
7739 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7740 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7741 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7742 are printed in execution order.
7743
7744 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7745 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7746 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7747
7748 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7749 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7750 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7751 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7752 @code{/p} modifier.
7753
7754 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7755 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7756 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7757
7758 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7759 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7760
7761 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7762 disassemble:
7763
7764 @table @code
7765 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7766 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7767 @var{insn}.
7768
7769 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7770 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7771 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7772 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7773 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7774 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7775
7776 @item record instruction-history
7777 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7778
7779 @item record instruction-history -
7780 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7781
7782 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7783 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7784 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7785 number @var{end} is included.
7786 @end table
7787
7788 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7789
7790 @kindex set record
7791 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7792 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7793 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7794 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7795 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7796
7797 @kindex show record
7798 @item show record instruction-history-size
7799 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7800 instruction-history} command.
7801
7802 @kindex record function-call-history
7803 @kindex rec function-call-history
7804 @item record function-call-history
7805 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7806 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7807 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7808 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7809 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7810 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7811 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7812 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7813 given together.
7814
7815 @smallexample
7816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7817 1 void foo (void)
7818 2 @{
7819 3 @}
7820 4
7821 5 void bar (void)
7822 6 @{
7823 7 ...
7824 8 foo ();
7825 9 ...
7826 10 @}
7827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7828 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7829 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7830 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7831 @end smallexample
7832
7833 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7834 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7835 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7836 to print:
7837
7838 @table @code
7839 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7840 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7841
7842 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7843 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7844 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7845 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7846 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7847
7848 @item record function-call-history
7849 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7850
7851 @item record function-call-history -
7852 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7853
7854 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7855 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7856 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7857 @end table
7858
7859 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7860
7861 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7862 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7863 Define how many lines to print in the
7864 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7865 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7866
7867 @item show record function-call-history-size
7868 Show how many lines to print in the
7869 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7870 @end table
7871
7872
7873 @node Stack
7874 @chapter Examining the Stack
7875
7876 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7877 stopped and how it got there.
7878
7879 @cindex call stack
7880 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7881 is generated.
7882 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7883 the arguments of the call,
7884 and the local variables of the function being called.
7885 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7886 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7887 stack}.
7888
7889 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7890 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7891
7892 @cindex selected frame
7893 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7894 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7895 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7896 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7897 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7898 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7899
7900 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7901 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7902 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7903
7904 @menu
7905 * Frames:: Stack frames
7906 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7907 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7908 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7909 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7910 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7911
7912 @end menu
7913
7914 @node Frames
7915 @section Stack Frames
7916
7917 @cindex frame, definition
7918 @cindex stack frame
7919 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7920 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7921 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7922 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7923 which the function is executing.
7924
7925 @cindex initial frame
7926 @cindex outermost frame
7927 @cindex innermost frame
7928 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7929 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7930 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7931 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7932 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7933 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7934 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7935 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7936
7937 @cindex frame pointer
7938 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7939 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7940 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7941 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7942 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7943 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7944
7945 @cindex frame level
7946 @cindex frame number
7947 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7948 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7949 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7950 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7951 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7952 describe this number.
7953
7954 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7955 @c underflow problems.
7956 @cindex frameless execution
7957 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7958 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7959 @smallexample
7960 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7961 @end smallexample
7962 generates functions without a frame.)
7963 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7964 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7965 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7966 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7967 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7968 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7969 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7970
7971 @node Backtrace
7972 @section Backtraces
7973
7974 @cindex traceback
7975 @cindex call stack traces
7976 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7977 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7978 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7979 stack.
7980
7981 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7982 @kindex backtrace
7983 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7984 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7985 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7986 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7987 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7988 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7989
7990 @table @code
7991 @item backtrace [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{qualifier}]@dots{} [@var{count}]
7992 @itemx bt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{qualifier}]@dots{} [@var{count}]
7993 Print the backtrace of the entire stack.
7994
7995 The optional @var{count} can be one of the following:
7996
7997 @table @code
7998 @item @var{n}
7999 @itemx @var{n}
8000 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
8001 number.
8002
8003 @item -@var{n}
8004 @itemx -@var{n}
8005 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
8006 number.
8007 @end table
8008
8009 Options:
8010
8011 @table @code
8012 @item -full
8013 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
8014 with the optional @var{count} to limit the number of frames shown.
8015
8016 @item -no-filters
8017 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
8018 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
8019 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
8020 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
8021 support.
8022
8023 @item -hide
8024 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
8025 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
8026 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{-hide}
8027 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
8028 @end table
8029
8030 The @code{backtrace} command also supports a number of options that
8031 allow overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set
8032 backtrace} and @code{set print} subcommands:
8033
8034 @table @code
8035 @item -past-main [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8036 Set whether backtraces should continue past @code{main}. Related setting:
8037 @ref{set backtrace past-main}.
8038
8039 @item -past-entry [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8040 Set whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a program.
8041 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-entry}.
8042
8043 @item -entry-values @code{no}|@code{only}|@code{preferred}|@code{if-needed}|@code{both}|@code{compact}|@code{default}
8044 Set printing of function arguments at function entry.
8045 Related setting: @ref{set print entry-values}.
8046
8047 @item -frame-arguments @code{all}|@code{scalars}|@code{none}
8048 Set printing of non-scalar frame arguments.
8049 Related setting: @ref{set print frame-arguments}.
8050
8051 @item -raw-frame-arguments [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8052 Set whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
8053 Related setting: @ref{set print raw-frame-arguments}.
8054
8055 @item -frame-info @code{auto}|@code{source-line}|@code{location}|@code{source-and-location}|@code{location-and-address}|@code{short-location}
8056 Set printing of frame information.
8057 Related setting: @ref{set print frame-info}.
8058 @end table
8059
8060 The optional @var{qualifier} is maintained for backward compatibility.
8061 It can be one of the following:
8062
8063 @table @code
8064 @item full
8065 Equivalent to the @code{-full} option.
8066
8067 @item no-filters
8068 Equivalent to the @code{-no-filters} option.
8069
8070 @item hide
8071 Equivalent to the @code{-hide} option.
8072 @end table
8073
8074 @end table
8075
8076 @kindex where
8077 @kindex info stack
8078 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
8079 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
8080
8081 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
8082 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
8083 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
8084 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
8085 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
8086 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
8087 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
8088 multi-threaded program.
8089
8090 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
8091 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
8092 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
8093 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
8094 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
8095 line number.
8096
8097 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
8098 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
8099
8100 @smallexample
8101 @group
8102 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
8103 at builtin.c:993
8104 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
8105 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
8106 at macro.c:71
8107 (More stack frames follow...)
8108 @end group
8109 @end smallexample
8110
8111 @noindent
8112 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
8113 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
8114 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
8115
8116 @noindent
8117 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
8118 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
8119 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
8120 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
8121 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
8122 The command @kbd{set print frame-info} (@pxref{Print Settings}) controls
8123 what frame information is printed.
8124
8125 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
8126 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
8127 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
8128 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
8129 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
8130 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
8131 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
8132 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
8133 such a backtrace might look like:
8134
8135 @smallexample
8136 @group
8137 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
8138 at builtin.c:993
8139 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
8140 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
8141 at macro.c:71
8142 (More stack frames follow...)
8143 @end group
8144 @end smallexample
8145
8146 @noindent
8147 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
8148 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
8149
8150 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
8151 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
8152 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
8153
8154 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
8155 @cindex program entry point
8156 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
8157 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
8158 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
8159 @code{main}@footnote{
8160 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
8161 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
8162 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
8163 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
8164 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
8165 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
8166
8167 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
8168 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
8169
8170 @table @code
8171 @item set backtrace past-main
8172 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
8173 @anchor{set backtrace past-main}
8174 @kindex set backtrace
8175 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
8176
8177 @item set backtrace past-main off
8178 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
8179 default.
8180
8181 @item show backtrace past-main
8182 @kindex show backtrace
8183 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
8184
8185 @item set backtrace past-entry
8186 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
8187 @anchor{set backtrace past-entry}
8188 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
8189 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
8190 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
8191
8192 @item set backtrace past-entry off
8193 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
8194 application. This is the default.
8195
8196 @item show backtrace past-entry
8197 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
8198
8199 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
8200 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
8201 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
8202 @anchor{set backtrace limit}
8203 @cindex backtrace limit
8204 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
8205 or zero means unlimited levels.
8206
8207 @item show backtrace limit
8208 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
8209 @end table
8210
8211 You can control how file names are displayed.
8212
8213 @table @code
8214 @item set filename-display
8215 @itemx set filename-display relative
8216 @cindex filename-display
8217 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
8218
8219 @item set filename-display basename
8220 Display only basename of a filename.
8221
8222 @item set filename-display absolute
8223 Display an absolute filename.
8224
8225 @item show filename-display
8226 Show the current way to display filenames.
8227 @end table
8228
8229 @node Selection
8230 @section Selecting a Frame
8231
8232 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
8233 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
8234 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
8235 of the stack frame just selected.
8236
8237 @table @code
8238 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
8239 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
8240 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8241 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8242 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
8243 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
8244
8245 @table @code
8246 @kindex frame level
8247 @item @var{num}
8248 @item level @var{num}
8249 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
8250 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
8251 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
8252 for @code{main}.
8253
8254 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
8255 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
8256 commands are equivalent:
8257
8258 @smallexample
8259 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
8260 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
8261 @end smallexample
8262
8263 @kindex frame address
8264 @item address @var{stack-address}
8265 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
8266 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
8267 @command{info frame}, for example:
8268
8269 @smallexample
8270 (gdb) info frame
8271 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
8272 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
8273 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
8274 source language c++.
8275 Arglist at unknown address.
8276 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
8277 @end smallexample
8278
8279 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
8280 indicated by the line:
8281
8282 @smallexample
8283 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
8284 @end smallexample
8285
8286 @kindex frame function
8287 @item function @var{function-name}
8288 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
8289 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
8290 most stack frame is selected.
8291
8292 @kindex frame view
8293 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
8294 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
8295 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
8296 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
8297
8298 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
8299 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
8300 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
8301 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
8302
8303 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
8304 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
8305 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
8306 for example @command{frame level 0}.
8307
8308 @end table
8309
8310 @kindex up
8311 @item up @var{n}
8312 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
8313 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
8314 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
8315
8316 @kindex down
8317 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
8318 @item down @var{n}
8319 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
8320 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
8321 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
8322 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
8323 @end table
8324
8325 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
8326 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
8327 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
8328 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
8329
8330 @need 1000
8331 For example:
8332
8333 @smallexample
8334 @group
8335 (@value{GDBP}) up
8336 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
8337 at env.c:10
8338 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
8339 @end group
8340 @end smallexample
8341
8342 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
8343 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
8344 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
8345 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
8346 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
8347 for details.
8348
8349 @table @code
8350 @kindex select-frame
8351 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8352 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
8353 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
8354 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
8355 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
8356 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
8357 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
8358
8359 @kindex down-silently
8360 @kindex up-silently
8361 @item up-silently @var{n}
8362 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
8363 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
8364 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
8365 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
8366 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
8367 distracting.
8368 @end table
8369
8370 @node Frame Info
8371 @section Information About a Frame
8372
8373 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
8374 stack frame.
8375
8376 @table @code
8377 @item frame
8378 @itemx f
8379 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
8380 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
8381 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
8382 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
8383 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
8384
8385 @kindex info frame
8386 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
8387 @item info frame
8388 @itemx info f
8389 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
8390 including:
8391
8392 @itemize @bullet
8393 @item
8394 the address of the frame
8395 @item
8396 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
8397 @item
8398 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
8399 @item
8400 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
8401 @item
8402 the address of the frame's arguments
8403 @item
8404 the address of the frame's local variables
8405 @item
8406 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
8407 @item
8408 which registers were saved in the frame
8409 @end itemize
8410
8411 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
8412 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
8413 the usual conventions.
8414
8415 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8416 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8417 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
8418 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
8419 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
8420 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
8421
8422 @kindex info args
8423 @item info args [-q]
8424 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
8425
8426 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
8427 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
8428 have been printed.
8429
8430 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
8431 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
8432 with the provided regexp(s).
8433
8434 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
8435 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
8436
8437 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
8438 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
8439 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
8440 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
8441 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
8442 of special characters or quotes.
8443
8444 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
8445 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
8446 @var{type_regexp}.
8447
8448 @item info locals [-q]
8449 @kindex info locals
8450 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
8451 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
8452 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
8453
8454 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
8455 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
8456 have been printed.
8457
8458 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
8459 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
8460 with the provided regexp(s).
8461
8462 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
8463 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
8464
8465 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
8466 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
8467 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
8468 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
8469 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
8470 of special characters or quotes.
8471
8472 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
8473 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
8474 @var{type_regexp}.
8475
8476 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
8477 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
8478 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
8479 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
8480 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
8481 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
8482 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
8483 @smallexample
8484 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
8485 @end smallexample
8486 @noindent
8487 or the equivalent shorter form
8488 @smallexample
8489 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
8490 @end smallexample
8491
8492 @end table
8493
8494 @node Frame Apply
8495 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
8496 @kindex frame apply
8497 @cindex apply command to several frames
8498 @table @code
8499 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
8500 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
8501 @var{command} to one or more frames.
8502
8503 @table @code
8504 @item @code{all}
8505 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
8506
8507 @item @var{count}
8508 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
8509 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
8510
8511 @item @var{-count}
8512 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
8513 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
8514
8515 @item @code{level}
8516 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
8517 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
8518 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
8519 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
8520 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
8521 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
8522
8523 @end table
8524
8525 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
8526 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
8527 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}.
8528 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
8529
8530 The @code{frame apply} command also supports a number of options that
8531 allow overriding relevant @code{set backtrace} settings:
8532
8533 @table @code
8534 @item -past-main [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8535 Whether backtraces should continue past @code{main}.
8536 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-main}.
8537
8538 @item -past-entry [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8539 Whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a program.
8540 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-entry}.
8541 @end table
8542
8543 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
8544 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
8545 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
8546 following options can be used to fine-tune these behaviors:
8547
8548 @table @code
8549 @item -c
8550 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
8551 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
8552 @code{frame apply} then continues.
8553 @item -s
8554 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
8555 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
8556 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
8557 are not printed.
8558 @item -q
8559 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
8560 information.
8561 @end table
8562
8563 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
8564 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
8565 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
8566 @code{#1 main} frame.
8567
8568 @smallexample
8569 @group
8570 (gdb) frame apply all p j
8571 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8572 No symbol "j" in current context.
8573 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
8574 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8575 No symbol "j" in current context.
8576 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8577 $1 = 5
8578 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
8579 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8580 $2 = 5
8581 (gdb)
8582 @end group
8583 @end smallexample
8584
8585 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
8586 information before the command output:
8587
8588 @smallexample
8589 @group
8590 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
8591 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8592 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8593 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8594 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8595 (gdb)
8596 @end group
8597 @end smallexample
8598
8599 If the flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8600 @smallexample
8601 @group
8602 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
8603 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8604 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8605 (gdb)
8606 @end group
8607 @end smallexample
8608
8609 @end table
8610
8611 @table @code
8612
8613 @kindex faas
8614 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8615 @item faas @var{command}
8616 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8617 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8618
8619 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8620 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8621 is, using:
8622 @smallexample
8623 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8624 @end smallexample
8625
8626 The @code{faas} command accepts the same options as the @code{frame
8627 apply} command. @xref{Frame Apply,,frame apply}.
8628
8629 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8630 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8631 @end table
8632
8633
8634 @node Frame Filter Management
8635 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8636 @cindex managing frame filters
8637
8638 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8639 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8640
8641 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8642 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8643
8644 @table @code
8645 @kindex info frame-filter
8646 @item info frame-filter
8647 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8648 their name, priority and enabled status.
8649
8650 @kindex disable frame-filter
8651 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8652 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8653 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8654 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8655 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8656 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8657 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8658 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8659 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8660 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8661 may be enabled again later.
8662
8663 @kindex enable frame-filter
8664 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8665 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8666 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8667 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8668 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8669 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8670 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8671 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8672 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8673
8674 Example:
8675
8676 @smallexample
8677 (gdb) info frame-filter
8678
8679 global frame-filters:
8680 Priority Enabled Name
8681 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8682 100 Yes Reverse
8683
8684 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8685 Priority Enabled Name
8686 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8687
8688 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8689 Priority Enabled Name
8690 999 Yes BuildProgramFilter
8691
8692 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8693 (gdb) info frame-filter
8694
8695 global frame-filters:
8696 Priority Enabled Name
8697 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8698 100 Yes Reverse
8699
8700 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8701 Priority Enabled Name
8702 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8703
8704 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8705 Priority Enabled Name
8706 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8707
8708 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8709 (gdb) info frame-filter
8710
8711 global frame-filters:
8712 Priority Enabled Name
8713 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8714 100 Yes Reverse
8715
8716 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8717 Priority Enabled Name
8718 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8719
8720 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8721 Priority Enabled Name
8722 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8723 @end smallexample
8724
8725 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8726 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8727 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8728 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8729 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8730 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8731 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8732
8733 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8734 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8735 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8736 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8737 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8738 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8739 dictionary resides.
8740
8741 Example:
8742
8743 @smallexample
8744 (gdb) info frame-filter
8745
8746 global frame-filters:
8747 Priority Enabled Name
8748 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8749 100 Yes Reverse
8750
8751 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8752 Priority Enabled Name
8753 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8754
8755 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8756 Priority Enabled Name
8757 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8758
8759 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8760 (gdb) info frame-filter
8761
8762 global frame-filters:
8763 Priority Enabled Name
8764 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8765 50 Yes Reverse
8766
8767 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8768 Priority Enabled Name
8769 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8770
8771 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8772 Priority Enabled Name
8773 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8774 @end smallexample
8775 @end table
8776
8777 @node Source
8778 @chapter Examining Source Files
8779
8780 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8781 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8782 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8783 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8784 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8785 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8786 source files by explicit command.
8787
8788 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8789 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8790 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8791
8792 @menu
8793 * List:: Printing source lines
8794 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8795 * Edit:: Editing source files
8796 * Search:: Searching source files
8797 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8798 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8799 @end menu
8800
8801 @node List
8802 @section Printing Source Lines
8803
8804 @kindex list
8805 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8806 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8807 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8808 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8809 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8810
8811 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8812
8813 @table @code
8814 @item list @var{linenum}
8815 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8816 current source file.
8817
8818 @item list @var{function}
8819 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8820 @var{function}.
8821
8822 @item list
8823 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8824 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8825 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8826 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8827 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8828
8829 @item list -
8830 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8831 @end table
8832
8833 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8834 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8835 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8836
8837 @table @code
8838 @kindex set listsize
8839 @item set listsize @var{count}
8840 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8841 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8842 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8843 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8844
8845 @kindex show listsize
8846 @item show listsize
8847 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8848 @end table
8849
8850 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8851 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8852 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8853 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8854 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8855
8856 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8857 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8858 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8859 to specify some source line.
8860
8861 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8862
8863 @table @code
8864 @item list @var{location}
8865 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8866
8867 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8868 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8869 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8870 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8871 the same source file as the first location.
8872
8873 @item list ,@var{last}
8874 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8875
8876 @item list @var{first},
8877 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8878
8879 @item list +
8880 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8881
8882 @item list -
8883 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8884
8885 @item list
8886 As described in the preceding table.
8887 @end table
8888
8889 @node Specify Location
8890 @section Specifying a Location
8891 @cindex specifying location
8892 @cindex location
8893 @cindex source location
8894
8895 @menu
8896 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8897 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8898 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8899 @end menu
8900
8901 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8902 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8903 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8904 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8905 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8906
8907 @node Linespec Locations
8908 @subsection Linespec Locations
8909 @cindex linespec locations
8910
8911 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8912 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8913 specifying a linespec:
8914
8915 @table @code
8916 @item @var{linenum}
8917 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8918
8919 @item -@var{offset}
8920 @itemx +@var{offset}
8921 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8922 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8923 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8924 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8925 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8926 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8927 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8928 linespec.
8929
8930 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8931 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8932 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8933 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8934 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8935 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8936 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8937
8938 @item @var{function}
8939 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8940 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8941
8942 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8943 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8944 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8945 means in all packages.
8946
8947 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8948 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8949 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8950
8951 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8952 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8953 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8954 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8955
8956 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8957
8958 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8959 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8960
8961 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8962 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8963 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8964 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8965 functions in different source files.
8966
8967 @item @var{label}
8968 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8969 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8970 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8971 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8972
8973 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8974 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8975 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8976 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8977 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8978 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8979
8980 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8981 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8982 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8983 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8984 each one of those probes.
8985 @end table
8986
8987 @node Explicit Locations
8988 @subsection Explicit Locations
8989 @cindex explicit locations
8990
8991 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8992 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8993
8994 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8995 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8996 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8997 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8998 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8999
9000 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
9001 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
9002 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
9003 the symbol table to know.
9004
9005 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
9006 following table:
9007
9008 @table @code
9009 @item -source @var{filename}
9010 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
9011 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
9012 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
9013 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
9014 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
9015
9016 @item -function @var{function}
9017 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
9018 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
9019 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
9020 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
9021
9022 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
9023 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
9024 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
9025 means in all packages.
9026
9027 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
9028 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
9029 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
9030 breakpoint on both symbols.
9031
9032 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
9033
9034 @item -qualified
9035
9036 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
9037 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
9038
9039 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
9040 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
9041 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
9042
9043 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
9044 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
9045 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
9046
9047 @item -label @var{label}
9048 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
9049 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
9050 selected stack frame.
9051
9052 @item -line @var{number}
9053 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
9054 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
9055 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
9056 relative to the current line.
9057 @end table
9058
9059 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
9060 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
9061
9062 @node Address Locations
9063 @subsection Address Locations
9064 @cindex address locations
9065
9066 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
9067 the generalized form *@var{address}.
9068
9069 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
9070 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
9071 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
9072 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
9073 source files.
9074
9075 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
9076 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
9077 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
9078 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
9079 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
9080 of @var{address}:
9081
9082 @table @code
9083 @item @var{expression}
9084 Any expression valid in the current working language.
9085
9086 @item @var{funcaddr}
9087 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
9088 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
9089 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
9090 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
9091 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
9092 (although the Pascal form also works).
9093
9094 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
9095 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
9096
9097 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
9098 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
9099 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
9100 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
9101 functions with identical names in different source files.
9102 @end table
9103
9104 @node Edit
9105 @section Editing Source Files
9106 @cindex editing source files
9107
9108 @kindex edit
9109 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
9110 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
9111 The editing program of your choice
9112 is invoked with the current line set to
9113 the active line in the program.
9114 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
9115 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
9116
9117 @table @code
9118 @item edit @var{location}
9119 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
9120 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
9121 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
9122 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
9123 command most commonly used:
9124
9125 @table @code
9126 @item edit @var{number}
9127 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
9128
9129 @item edit @var{function}
9130 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
9131 @end table
9132
9133 @end table
9134
9135 @subsection Choosing your Editor
9136 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
9137 @footnote{
9138 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
9139 following command-line syntax:
9140 @smallexample
9141 ex +@var{number} file
9142 @end smallexample
9143 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
9144 the file where to start editing.}.
9145 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
9146 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
9147 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
9148 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
9149 @smallexample
9150 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
9151 export EDITOR
9152 gdb @dots{}
9153 @end smallexample
9154 or in the @code{csh} shell,
9155 @smallexample
9156 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
9157 gdb @dots{}
9158 @end smallexample
9159
9160 @node Search
9161 @section Searching Source Files
9162 @cindex searching source files
9163
9164 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
9165 regular expression.
9166
9167 @table @code
9168 @kindex search
9169 @kindex forward-search
9170 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
9171 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
9172 @itemx search @var{regexp}
9173 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
9174 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
9175 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
9176 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
9177 @code{fo}.
9178
9179 @kindex reverse-search
9180 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
9181 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
9182 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
9183 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
9184 this command as @code{rev}.
9185 @end table
9186
9187 @node Source Path
9188 @section Specifying Source Directories
9189
9190 @cindex source path
9191 @cindex directories for source files
9192 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
9193 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
9194 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
9195 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
9196 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
9197 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
9198 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
9199
9200 For example, suppose an executable references the file
9201 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, does not record a compilation
9202 directory, and the @dfn{source path} is @file{/mnt/cross}.
9203 @value{GDBN} would look for the source file in the following
9204 locations:
9205
9206 @enumerate
9207
9208 @item @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9209 @item @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9210 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9211
9212 @end enumerate
9213
9214 If the source file is not present at any of the above locations then
9215 an error is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
9216 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
9217 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
9218 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
9219 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
9220 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
9221
9222 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
9223 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above,
9224 except that non-absolute file names are not looked up literally. If
9225 the @dfn{source path} is @file{/mnt/cross}, the source file is
9226 recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, and no compilation directory is
9227 recorded, then @value{GDBN} will search in the following locations:
9228
9229 @enumerate
9230
9231 @item @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}
9232 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9233
9234 @end enumerate
9235
9236 @kindex cdir
9237 @kindex cwd
9238 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
9239 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
9240 @cindex compilation directory
9241 @cindex current directory
9242 @cindex working directory
9243 @cindex directory, current
9244 @cindex directory, compilation
9245 The @dfn{source path} will always include two special entries
9246 @samp{$cdir} and @samp{$cwd}, these refer to the compilation directory
9247 (if one is recorded) and the current working directory respectively.
9248
9249 @samp{$cdir} causes @value{GDBN} to search within the compilation
9250 directory, if one is recorded in the debug information. If no
9251 compilation directory is recorded in the debug information then
9252 @samp{$cdir} is ignored.
9253
9254 @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former tracks the
9255 current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
9256 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
9257 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
9258
9259 If a compilation directory is recorded in the debug information, and
9260 @value{GDBN} has not found the source file after the first search
9261 using @dfn{source path}, then @value{GDBN} will combine the
9262 compilation directory and the filename, and then search for the source
9263 file again using the @dfn{source path}.
9264
9265 For example, if the executable records the source file as
9266 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, the compilation directory is
9267 recorded as @file{/project/build}, and the @dfn{source path} is
9268 @file{/mnt/cross:$cdir:$cwd} while the current working directory of
9269 the @value{GDBN} session is @file{/home/user}, then @value{GDBN} will
9270 search for the source file in the following locations:
9271
9272 @enumerate
9273
9274 @item @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9275 @item @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9276 @item @file{/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9277 @item @file{/home/user/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9278 @item @file{/mnt/cross/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9279 @item @file{/project/build/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9280 @item @file{/home/user/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9281 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9282 @item @file{/project/build/foo.c}
9283 @item @file{/home/user/foo.c}
9284
9285 @end enumerate
9286
9287 If the file name in the previous example had been recorded in the
9288 executable as a relative path rather than an absolute path, then the
9289 first look up would not have occurred, but all of the remaining steps
9290 would be similar.
9291
9292 When searching for source files on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where
9293 absolute paths start with a drive letter (e.g.
9294 @file{C:/project/foo.c}), @value{GDBN} will remove the drive letter
9295 from the file name before appending it to a search directory from
9296 @dfn{source path}; for instance if the executable references the
9297 source file @file{C:/project/foo.c} and @dfn{source path} is set to
9298 @file{D:/mnt/cross}, then @value{GDBN} will search in the following
9299 locations for the source file:
9300
9301 @enumerate
9302
9303 @item @file{C:/project/foo.c}
9304 @item @file{D:/mnt/cross/project/foo.c}
9305 @item @file{D:/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9306
9307 @end enumerate
9308
9309 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
9310 source files.
9311
9312 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
9313 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
9314 each line is in the file.
9315
9316 @kindex directory
9317 @kindex dir
9318 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{$cdir}
9319 and @samp{$cwd}, in that order.
9320 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
9321
9322 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
9323 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
9324
9325 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
9326 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
9327 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
9328 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
9329 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
9330 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
9331 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
9332 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
9333 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
9334 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
9335 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
9336 name to look up the sources.
9337
9338 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
9339 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
9340 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
9341 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
9342 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
9343 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
9344 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
9345 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
9346
9347 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
9348 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
9349 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
9350 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
9351 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
9352 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
9353 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
9354
9355 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
9356 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
9357 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
9358 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
9359 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
9360 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
9361 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
9362 command.
9363
9364 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
9365 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
9366 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
9367 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
9368 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
9369 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
9370 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
9371
9372 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
9373 @cindex default source path substitution
9374 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
9375 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
9376 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
9377 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
9378 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
9379 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
9380 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
9381 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
9382 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
9383 together.
9384
9385 @table @code
9386 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
9387 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
9388 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
9389 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
9390 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
9391 part of absolute file names) or
9392 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
9393 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
9394
9395 The special strings @samp{$cdir} (to refer to the compilation
9396 directory, if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} (to refer to the
9397 current working directory) can also be included in the list of
9398 directories @var{dirname}. Though these will already be in the source
9399 path they will be moved forward in the list so @value{GDBN} searches
9400 them sooner.
9401
9402 @item directory
9403 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
9404
9405 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
9406 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
9407
9408 @item set directories @var{path-list}
9409 @kindex set directories
9410 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
9411 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
9412
9413 @item show directories
9414 @kindex show directories
9415 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
9416
9417 @anchor{set substitute-path}
9418 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
9419 @kindex set substitute-path
9420 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
9421 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
9422 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
9423
9424 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
9425 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
9426
9427 @smallexample
9428 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
9429 @end smallexample
9430
9431 @noindent
9432 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
9433 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
9434 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
9435
9436 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
9437 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
9438 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
9439 the substitution.
9440
9441 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
9442
9443 @smallexample
9444 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
9445 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
9446 @end smallexample
9447
9448 @noindent
9449 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
9450 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
9451 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
9452 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
9453
9454
9455 @item unset substitute-path [path]
9456 @kindex unset substitute-path
9457 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
9458 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
9459 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
9460
9461 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
9462
9463 @item show substitute-path [path]
9464 @kindex show substitute-path
9465 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
9466 which would rewrite that path, if any.
9467
9468 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
9469 rules.
9470
9471 @end table
9472
9473 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
9474 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
9475 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
9476
9477 @enumerate
9478 @item
9479 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
9480
9481 @item
9482 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
9483 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
9484 directories in one command.
9485 @end enumerate
9486
9487 @node Machine Code
9488 @section Source and Machine Code
9489 @cindex source line and its code address
9490
9491 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
9492 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
9493 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
9494 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
9495 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
9496 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
9497 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
9498 well as hex.
9499
9500 @table @code
9501 @kindex info line
9502 @item info line
9503 @itemx info line @var{location}
9504 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
9505 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
9506 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
9507 information about the current source line is printed.
9508 @end table
9509
9510 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
9511 the object code for the first line of function
9512 @code{m4_changequote}:
9513
9514 @smallexample
9515 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
9516 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
9517 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
9518 @end smallexample
9519
9520 @noindent
9521 @cindex code address and its source line
9522 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
9523 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
9524 @smallexample
9525 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
9526 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
9527 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
9528 @end smallexample
9529
9530 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
9531 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
9532 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
9533 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
9534 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
9535 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
9536 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
9537 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9538 Variables}).
9539
9540 @cindex info line, repeated calls
9541 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
9542 specifying a location will display information about the next source
9543 line.
9544
9545 @table @code
9546 @kindex disassemble
9547 @cindex assembly instructions
9548 @cindex instructions, assembly
9549 @cindex machine instructions
9550 @cindex listing machine instructions
9551 @item disassemble
9552 @itemx disassemble /m
9553 @itemx disassemble /s
9554 @itemx disassemble /r
9555 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
9556 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
9557 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
9558 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
9559 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
9560 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
9561 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
9562 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
9563 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
9564 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
9565
9566 @table @code
9567 @item @var{start},@var{end}
9568 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
9569 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
9570 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
9571 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
9572 @end table
9573
9574 @noindent
9575 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
9576 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
9577
9578 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
9579 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
9580
9581 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
9582 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
9583 @end table
9584
9585 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
9586 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
9587
9588 @smallexample
9589 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
9590 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
9591 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
9592 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
9593 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
9594 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
9595 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
9596 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
9597 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
9598 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
9599 End of assembler dump.
9600 @end smallexample
9601
9602 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
9603 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
9604 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
9605
9606 @smallexample
9607 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
9608 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9609 5 @{
9610 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
9611 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
9612 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
9613 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
9614 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
9615
9616 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
9617 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
9618 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
9619
9620 7 return 0;
9621 8 @}
9622 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
9623 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
9624 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
9625
9626 End of assembler dump.
9627 @end smallexample
9628
9629 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
9630 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
9631 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
9632 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
9633 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
9634 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
9635 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
9636 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
9637 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
9638
9639 @file{foo.h}:
9640
9641 @smallexample
9642 int
9643 foo (int a)
9644 @{
9645 if (a < 0)
9646 return a * 2;
9647 if (a == 0)
9648 return 1;
9649 return a + 10;
9650 @}
9651 @end smallexample
9652
9653 @file{foo.c}:
9654
9655 @smallexample
9656 #include "foo.h"
9657 volatile int x, y;
9658 int
9659 main ()
9660 @{
9661 x = foo (y);
9662 return 0;
9663 @}
9664 @end smallexample
9665
9666 @smallexample
9667 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
9668 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9669 5 @{
9670
9671 6 x = foo (y);
9672 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9673 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9674
9675 7 return 0;
9676 8 @}
9677 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9678 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9679 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9680 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9681
9682 End of assembler dump.
9683 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
9684 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9685 foo.c:
9686 5 @{
9687 6 x = foo (y);
9688 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9689
9690 foo.h:
9691 4 if (a < 0)
9692 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
9693 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
9694
9695 6 if (a == 0)
9696 7 return 1;
9697 8 return a + 10;
9698 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
9699 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
9700 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
9701 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
9702
9703 foo.c:
9704 6 x = foo (y);
9705 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9706
9707 7 return 0;
9708 8 @}
9709 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9710 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9711
9712 foo.h:
9713 5 return a * 2;
9714 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9715 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9716 End of assembler dump.
9717 @end smallexample
9718
9719 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
9720
9721 @smallexample
9722 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
9723 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
9724 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
9725 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
9726 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
9727 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
9728 End of assembler dump.
9729 @end smallexample
9730
9731 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
9732 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
9733 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
9734 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
9735
9736 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
9737 mnemonics or other syntax.
9738
9739 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
9740 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9741 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9742 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9743 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9744
9745 @table @code
9746 @kindex set disassembler-options
9747 @cindex disassembler options
9748 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9749 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9750 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9751 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9752 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9753 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9754 The default value is the empty string.
9755
9756 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9757 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9758 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9759 and S/390.
9760
9761 @kindex show disassembler-options
9762 @item show disassembler-options
9763 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9764 @end table
9765
9766 @table @code
9767 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9768 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9769 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9770 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9771 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9772 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9773
9774 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9775 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9776 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9777 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9778
9779 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9780 @item show disassembly-flavor
9781 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9782 @end table
9783
9784 @table @code
9785 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9786 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9787 @item set disassemble-next-line
9788 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9789 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9790 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9791 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9792 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9793 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9794 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9795 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9796 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9797 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9798 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9799 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9800 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9801 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9802 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9803 instruction.
9804 @end table
9805
9806
9807 @node Data
9808 @chapter Examining Data
9809
9810 @cindex printing data
9811 @cindex examining data
9812 @kindex print
9813 @kindex inspect
9814 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9815 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9816 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9817 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9818 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9819 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9820
9821 @table @code
9822 @item print [[@var{options}] --] @var{expr}
9823 @itemx print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f} @var{expr}
9824 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9825 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9826 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9827 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9828 Formats}.
9829
9830 @anchor{print options}
9831 The @code{print} command supports a number of options that allow
9832 overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set print}
9833 subcommands:
9834
9835 @table @code
9836 @item -address [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9837 Set printing of addresses.
9838 Related setting: @ref{set print address}.
9839
9840 @item -array [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9841 Pretty formatting of arrays.
9842 Related setting: @ref{set print array}.
9843
9844 @item -array-indexes [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9845 Set printing of array indexes.
9846 Related setting: @ref{set print array-indexes}.
9847
9848 @item -elements @var{number-of-elements}|@code{unlimited}
9849 Set limit on string chars or array elements to print. The value
9850 @code{unlimited} causes there to be no limit. Related setting:
9851 @ref{set print elements}.
9852
9853 @item -max-depth @var{depth}|@code{unlimited}
9854 Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
9855 ellipsis. Related setting: @ref{set print max-depth}.
9856
9857 @item -null-stop [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9858 Set printing of char arrays to stop at first null char. Related
9859 setting: @ref{set print null-stop}.
9860
9861 @item -object [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9862 Set printing C@t{++} virtual function tables. Related setting:
9863 @ref{set print object}.
9864
9865 @item -pretty [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9866 Set pretty formatting of structures. Related setting: @ref{set print
9867 pretty}.
9868
9869 @item -raw-values [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9870 Set whether to print values in raw form, bypassing any
9871 pretty-printers for that value. Related setting: @ref{set print
9872 raw-values}.
9873
9874 @item -repeats @var{number-of-repeats}|@code{unlimited}
9875 Set threshold for repeated print elements. @code{unlimited} causes
9876 all elements to be individually printed. Related setting: @ref{set
9877 print repeats}.
9878
9879 @item -static-members [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9880 Set printing C@t{++} static members. Related setting: @ref{set print
9881 static-members}.
9882
9883 @item -symbol [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9884 Set printing of symbol names when printing pointers. Related setting:
9885 @ref{set print symbol}.
9886
9887 @item -union [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9888 Set printing of unions interior to structures. Related setting:
9889 @ref{set print union}.
9890
9891 @item -vtbl [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9892 Set printing of C++ virtual function tables. Related setting:
9893 @ref{set print vtbl}.
9894 @end table
9895
9896 Because the @code{print} command accepts arbitrary expressions which
9897 may look like options (including abbreviations), if you specify any
9898 command option, then you must use a double dash (@code{--}) to mark
9899 the end of option processing.
9900
9901 For example, this prints the value of the @code{-p} expression:
9902
9903 @smallexample
9904 (@value{GDBP}) print -p
9905 @end smallexample
9906
9907 While this repeats the last value in the value history (see below)
9908 with the @code{-pretty} option in effect:
9909
9910 @smallexample
9911 (@value{GDBP}) print -p --
9912 @end smallexample
9913
9914 Here is an example including both on option and an expression:
9915
9916 @smallexample
9917 @group
9918 (@value{GDBP}) print -pretty -- *myptr
9919 $1 = @{
9920 next = 0x0,
9921 flags = @{
9922 sweet = 1,
9923 sour = 1
9924 @},
9925 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9926 @}
9927 @end group
9928 @end smallexample
9929
9930 @item print [@var{options}]
9931 @itemx print [@var{options}] /@var{f}
9932 @cindex reprint the last value
9933 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9934 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9935 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9936 @end table
9937
9938 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9939 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9940 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9941
9942 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9943 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9944 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9945 Table}.
9946
9947 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9948 @kindex explore
9949 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9950 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9951 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9952 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9953 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9954 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9955 embedded in the higher level data types.
9956
9957 @table @code
9958 @item explore @var{arg}
9959 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9960 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9961 @end table
9962
9963 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9964 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9965 C program as
9966
9967 @smallexample
9968 struct SimpleStruct
9969 @{
9970 int i;
9971 double d;
9972 @};
9973
9974 struct ComplexStruct
9975 @{
9976 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9977 int arr[10];
9978 @};
9979 @end smallexample
9980
9981 @noindent
9982 followed by variable declarations as
9983
9984 @smallexample
9985 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9986 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9987 @end smallexample
9988
9989 @noindent
9990 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9991 @code{explore} command as follows.
9992
9993 @smallexample
9994 (gdb) explore cs
9995 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9996 the following fields:
9997
9998 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9999 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
10000
10001 Enter the field number of choice:
10002 @end smallexample
10003
10004 @noindent
10005 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
10006 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
10007 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
10008 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
10009 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
10010 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
10011 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
10012 field will be explored as if it were an array.
10013
10014 @smallexample
10015 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
10016 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
10017 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
10018 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
10019
10020 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
10021 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
10022
10023 Press enter to return to parent value:
10024 @end smallexample
10025
10026 @noindent
10027 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
10028 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
10029 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
10030 to explore.
10031
10032 @smallexample
10033 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
10034 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
10035
10036 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
10037
10038 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
10039
10040 Press enter to return to parent value:
10041 @end smallexample
10042
10043 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
10044 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
10045 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
10046 level data structure).
10047
10048 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
10049 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
10050 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
10051 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
10052 same example as above, your can explore the type
10053 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
10054 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
10055
10056 @smallexample
10057 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
10058 @end smallexample
10059
10060 @noindent
10061 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
10062 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
10063 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
10064 example.
10065
10066 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
10067 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
10068 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
10069 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
10070 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
10071
10072 @table @code
10073 @item explore value @var{expr}
10074 @cindex explore value
10075 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
10076 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
10077 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
10078 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
10079 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
10080
10081 @item explore type @var{arg}
10082 @cindex explore type
10083 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
10084 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
10085 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
10086 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
10087 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
10088 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
10089 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
10090 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
10091 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
10092 @end table
10093
10094 @menu
10095 * Expressions:: Expressions
10096 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
10097 * Variables:: Program variables
10098 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
10099 * Output Formats:: Output formats
10100 * Memory:: Examining memory
10101 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
10102 * Print Settings:: Print settings
10103 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
10104 * Value History:: Value history
10105 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
10106 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
10107 * Registers:: Registers
10108 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
10109 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
10110 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
10111 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
10112 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
10113 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
10114 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
10115 character set than GDB does
10116 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
10117 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
10118 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
10119 @end menu
10120
10121 @node Expressions
10122 @section Expressions
10123
10124 @cindex expressions
10125 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
10126 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
10127 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
10128 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
10129 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
10130 you compiled your program to include this information; see
10131 @ref{Compilation}.
10132
10133 @cindex arrays in expressions
10134 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
10135 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
10136 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
10137 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
10138 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
10139 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
10140
10141 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
10142 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
10143 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
10144 languages.
10145
10146 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
10147 expressions regardless of your programming language.
10148
10149 @cindex casts, in expressions
10150 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
10151 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
10152 at that address in memory.
10153 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
10154
10155 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
10156 to programming languages:
10157
10158 @table @code
10159 @item @@
10160 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
10161 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
10162
10163 @item ::
10164 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
10165 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
10166
10167 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
10168 @cindex type casting memory
10169 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
10170 @cindex casts, to view memory
10171 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
10172 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
10173 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
10174 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
10175 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
10176 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
10177 @end table
10178
10179 @node Ambiguous Expressions
10180 @section Ambiguous Expressions
10181 @cindex ambiguous expressions
10182
10183 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
10184 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
10185 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
10186 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
10187 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
10188 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
10189 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
10190
10191 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
10192 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
10193 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
10194 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
10195 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
10196 as well.
10197
10198 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
10199 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
10200 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
10201 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
10202 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
10203 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
10204 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
10205 choices.
10206
10207 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
10208 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
10209 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
10210
10211 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
10212 @smallexample
10213 @group
10214 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
10215 [0] cancel
10216 [1] all
10217 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
10218 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
10219 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
10220 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
10221 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
10222 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
10223 > 2 4 6
10224 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
10225 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
10226 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
10227 Multiple breakpoints were set.
10228 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
10229 breakpoints.
10230 (@value{GDBP})
10231 @end group
10232 @end smallexample
10233
10234 @table @code
10235 @kindex set multiple-symbols
10236 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
10237 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
10238
10239 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
10240 is ambiguous.
10241
10242 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
10243 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
10244 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
10245 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
10246 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
10247 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
10248 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
10249 in the use of the menu.
10250
10251 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
10252 when an ambiguity is detected.
10253
10254 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
10255 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
10256
10257 @kindex show multiple-symbols
10258 @item show multiple-symbols
10259 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
10260 @end table
10261
10262 @node Variables
10263 @section Program Variables
10264
10265 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
10266 in your program.
10267
10268 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
10269 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
10270
10271 @itemize @bullet
10272 @item
10273 global (or file-static)
10274 @end itemize
10275
10276 @noindent or
10277
10278 @itemize @bullet
10279 @item
10280 visible according to the scope rules of the
10281 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
10282 @end itemize
10283
10284 @noindent This means that in the function
10285
10286 @smallexample
10287 foo (a)
10288 int a;
10289 @{
10290 bar (a);
10291 @{
10292 int b = test ();
10293 bar (b);
10294 @}
10295 @}
10296 @end smallexample
10297
10298 @noindent
10299 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
10300 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
10301 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
10302 the block where @code{b} is declared.
10303
10304 @cindex variable name conflict
10305 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
10306 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
10307 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
10308 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
10309 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
10310 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
10311 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
10312
10313 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
10314 @ifnotinfo
10315 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
10316 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
10317 @end ifnotinfo
10318 @smallexample
10319 @var{file}::@var{variable}
10320 @var{function}::@var{variable}
10321 @end smallexample
10322
10323 @noindent
10324 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
10325 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
10326 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
10327 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
10328
10329 @smallexample
10330 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
10331 @end smallexample
10332
10333 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
10334 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
10335 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
10336 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
10337 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
10338
10339 @smallexample
10340 void
10341 foo (int a)
10342 @{
10343 if (a < 10)
10344 bar (a);
10345 else
10346 process (a); /* Stop here */
10347 @}
10348
10349 int
10350 bar (int a)
10351 @{
10352 foo (a + 5);
10353 @}
10354 @end smallexample
10355
10356 @noindent
10357 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
10358 here is what you might see
10359 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
10360
10361 @smallexample
10362 (@value{GDBP}) p a
10363 $1 = 10
10364 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
10365 $2 = 5
10366 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
10367 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
10368 (@value{GDBP}) p a
10369 $3 = 5
10370 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
10371 $4 = 0
10372 @end smallexample
10373
10374 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
10375 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
10376 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
10377 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
10378 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
10379
10380 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
10381 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
10382 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
10383 @code{some_global}.
10384
10385 @smallexample
10386 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
10387 $1 = 23
10388 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
10389 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
10390 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
10391 $2 = 27
10392 @end smallexample
10393
10394 @cindex wrong values
10395 @cindex variable values, wrong
10396 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
10397 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
10398 @quotation
10399 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
10400 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
10401 scope, and just before exit.
10402 @end quotation
10403 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
10404 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
10405 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
10406 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
10407 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
10408 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
10409 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
10410 variable definitions may be gone.
10411
10412 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
10413 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
10414 when compiling.
10415
10416 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
10417 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
10418 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
10419 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
10420 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
10421 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
10422 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
10423
10424 @smallexample
10425 No symbol "foo" in current context.
10426 @end smallexample
10427
10428 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
10429 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
10430 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
10431 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
10432 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
10433
10434 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
10435 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
10436 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
10437 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
10438
10439 @cindex no debug info variables
10440 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
10441 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
10442 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
10443 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
10444 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
10445 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
10446 example, in a C program:
10447
10448 @smallexample
10449 (@value{GDBP}) p var
10450 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
10451 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
10452 $1 = 3.14
10453 @end smallexample
10454
10455 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
10456 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
10457 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
10458 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
10459 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
10460
10461 @smallexample
10462 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
10463 29 i++;
10464 (gdb) next
10465 30 e (i);
10466 (gdb) print i
10467 $1 = 31
10468 (gdb) print i@@entry
10469 $2 = 30
10470 @end smallexample
10471
10472 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
10473 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
10474 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
10475 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
10476 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
10477 For program code
10478
10479 @smallexample
10480 char var0[] = "A";
10481 signed char var1[] = "A";
10482 @end smallexample
10483
10484 You get during debugging
10485 @smallexample
10486 (gdb) print var0
10487 $1 = "A"
10488 (gdb) print var1
10489 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
10490 @end smallexample
10491
10492 @node Arrays
10493 @section Artificial Arrays
10494
10495 @cindex artificial array
10496 @cindex arrays
10497 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
10498 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
10499 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
10500 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
10501 program.
10502
10503 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
10504 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
10505 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
10506 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
10507 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
10508 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
10509 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
10510 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
10511 example. If a program says
10512
10513 @smallexample
10514 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
10515 @end smallexample
10516
10517 @noindent
10518 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
10519
10520 @smallexample
10521 p *array@@len
10522 @end smallexample
10523
10524 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
10525 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
10526 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
10527 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
10528 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
10529
10530 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
10531 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
10532 The value need not be in memory:
10533 @smallexample
10534 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
10535 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
10536 @end smallexample
10537
10538 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
10539 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
10540 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
10541 @smallexample
10542 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
10543 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
10544 @end smallexample
10545
10546 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
10547 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
10548 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
10549 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
10550 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
10551 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
10552 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
10553 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
10554 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
10555 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
10556
10557 @smallexample
10558 set $i = 0
10559 p dtab[$i++]->fv
10560 @key{RET}
10561 @key{RET}
10562 @dots{}
10563 @end smallexample
10564
10565 @node Output Formats
10566 @section Output Formats
10567
10568 @cindex formatted output
10569 @cindex output formats
10570 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
10571 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
10572 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
10573 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
10574 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
10575
10576 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
10577 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
10578 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
10579 letters supported are:
10580
10581 @table @code
10582 @item x
10583 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
10584 hexadecimal.
10585
10586 @item d
10587 Print as integer in signed decimal.
10588
10589 @item u
10590 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
10591
10592 @item o
10593 Print as integer in octal.
10594
10595 @item t
10596 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
10597 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
10598 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
10599 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
10600
10601 @item a
10602 @cindex unknown address, locating
10603 @cindex locate address
10604 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
10605 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
10606 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
10607
10608 @smallexample
10609 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
10610 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
10611 @end smallexample
10612
10613 @noindent
10614 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
10615 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
10616
10617 @item c
10618 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
10619 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
10620 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
10621 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
10622
10623 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
10624 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
10625 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
10626 data.
10627
10628 @item f
10629 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
10630 using typical floating point syntax.
10631
10632 @item s
10633 @cindex printing strings
10634 @cindex printing byte arrays
10635 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
10636 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
10637 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
10638 natural types.
10639
10640 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
10641 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
10642 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
10643 array.
10644
10645 @item z
10646 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
10647 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
10648 to the size of the integer type.
10649
10650 @item r
10651 @cindex raw printing
10652 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
10653 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
10654 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
10655 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
10656 pretty-printer which might exist.
10657 @end table
10658
10659 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
10660
10661 @smallexample
10662 p/x $pc
10663 @end smallexample
10664
10665 @noindent
10666 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
10667 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
10668
10669 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
10670 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
10671 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
10672
10673 @node Memory
10674 @section Examining Memory
10675
10676 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
10677 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
10678
10679 @cindex examining memory
10680 @table @code
10681 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
10682 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
10683 @itemx x @var{addr}
10684 @itemx x
10685 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
10686 @end table
10687
10688 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
10689 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
10690 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
10691 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
10692 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
10693
10694 @table @r
10695 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
10696 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
10697 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
10698 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
10699 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
10700 @c 4.1.2.
10701
10702 @item @var{f}, the display format
10703 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
10704 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
10705 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
10706 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
10707 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
10708
10709 @item @var{u}, the unit size
10710 The unit size is any of
10711
10712 @table @code
10713 @item b
10714 Bytes.
10715 @item h
10716 Halfwords (two bytes).
10717 @item w
10718 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
10719 @item g
10720 Giant words (eight bytes).
10721 @end table
10722
10723 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
10724 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
10725 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
10726 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
10727 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
10728 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
10729 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
10730 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
10731 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
10732 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
10733 be altered.
10734
10735 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
10736 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
10737 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
10738 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
10739 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
10740 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
10741 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
10742 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
10743 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
10744 a value from memory).
10745 @end table
10746
10747 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
10748 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
10749 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
10750 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
10751 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
10752
10753 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
10754 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
10755 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
10756
10757 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
10758 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
10759 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
10760 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
10761 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
10762
10763 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
10764 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
10765 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
10766 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
10767 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
10768 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
10769 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
10770 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
10771 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
10772
10773 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
10774 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
10775 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
10776 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
10777 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
10778 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
10779
10780 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
10781 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
10782 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
10783 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
10784 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
10785 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
10786 for successive uses of @code{x}.
10787
10788 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
10789 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
10790
10791 @smallexample
10792 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
10793 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
10794 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
10795 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
10796 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
10797 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
10798 @end smallexample
10799
10800 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
10801 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
10802 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
10803 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
10804 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
10805 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
10806 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
10807 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
10808 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
10809
10810 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
10811 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
10812 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
10813
10814 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
10815 @cindex addressable memory unit
10816 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
10817 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
10818 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
10819 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
10820 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
10821 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
10822 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
10823 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
10824 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
10825
10826 @cindex remote memory comparison
10827 @cindex target memory comparison
10828 @cindex verify remote memory image
10829 @cindex verify target memory image
10830 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
10831 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
10832 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
10833 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
10834 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
10835 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
10836
10837 @table @code
10838 @kindex compare-sections
10839 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
10840 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10841 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10842 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10843 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10844 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10845
10846 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10847 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10848 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10849 @end table
10850
10851 @node Auto Display
10852 @section Automatic Display
10853 @cindex automatic display
10854 @cindex display of expressions
10855
10856 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10857 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10858 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10859 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10860 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10861 The automatic display looks like this:
10862
10863 @smallexample
10864 2: foo = 38
10865 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10866 @end smallexample
10867
10868 @noindent
10869 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10870 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10871 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10872 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10873 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10874 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10875
10876 @table @code
10877 @kindex display
10878 @item display @var{expr}
10879 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10880 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10881
10882 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10883
10884 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10885 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10886 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10887 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10888 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10889
10890 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10891 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10892 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10893 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10894 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10895 @end table
10896
10897 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10898 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10899 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10900
10901 @table @code
10902 @kindex delete display
10903 @kindex undisplay
10904 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10905 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10906 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10907 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10908 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10909 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10910 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10911
10912 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10913 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10914
10915 @kindex disable display
10916 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10917 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10918 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10919 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10920 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10921 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10922 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10923 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10924
10925 @kindex enable display
10926 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10927 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10928 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10929 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10930 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10931 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10932 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10933
10934 @item display
10935 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10936 done when your program stops.
10937
10938 @kindex info display
10939 @item info display
10940 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10941 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10942 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10943 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10944 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10945 @end table
10946
10947 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10948 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10949 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10950 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10951 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10952 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10953 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10954 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10955 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10956 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10957 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10958
10959 @node Print Settings
10960 @section Print Settings
10961
10962 @cindex format options
10963 @cindex print settings
10964 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10965 and symbols are printed.
10966
10967 @noindent
10968 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10969
10970 @table @code
10971 @kindex set print
10972 @anchor{set print address}
10973 @item set print address
10974 @itemx set print address on
10975 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10976 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10977 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10978 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10979 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10980 @code{set print address on}:
10981
10982 @smallexample
10983 @group
10984 (@value{GDBP}) f
10985 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10986 at input.c:530
10987 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10988 @end group
10989 @end smallexample
10990
10991 @item set print address off
10992 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10993 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10994
10995 @smallexample
10996 @group
10997 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10998 (@value{GDBP}) f
10999 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
11000 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
11001 @end group
11002 @end smallexample
11003
11004 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
11005 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
11006 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
11007 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
11008
11009 @kindex show print
11010 @item show print address
11011 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
11012 @end table
11013
11014 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
11015 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
11016 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
11017 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
11018 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
11019 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
11020 it prints a symbolic address:
11021
11022 @table @code
11023 @item set print symbol-filename on
11024 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
11025 @cindex symbol, source file and line
11026 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
11027 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
11028
11029 @item set print symbol-filename off
11030 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
11031 default.
11032
11033 @item show print symbol-filename
11034 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
11035 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
11036 @end table
11037
11038 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
11039 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
11040 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
11041
11042 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
11043 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
11044
11045 @table @code
11046 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
11047 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
11048 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
11049 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
11050 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
11051 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
11052 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
11053 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
11054
11055 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
11056 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
11057 symbolic address.
11058 @end table
11059
11060 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
11061 @cindex pointer, finding referent
11062 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
11063 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
11064 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
11065 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
11066 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
11067 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
11068
11069 @smallexample
11070 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
11071 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
11072 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
11073 @end smallexample
11074
11075 @quotation
11076 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
11077 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
11078 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
11079 @end quotation
11080
11081 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
11082 @samp{set print symbol on}:
11083
11084 @anchor{set print symbol}
11085 @table @code
11086 @item set print symbol on
11087 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
11088 one exists.
11089
11090 @item set print symbol off
11091 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
11092 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
11093 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
11094
11095 @item show print symbol
11096 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
11097 address.
11098 @end table
11099
11100 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
11101
11102 @table @code
11103 @anchor{set print array}
11104 @item set print array
11105 @itemx set print array on
11106 @cindex pretty print arrays
11107 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
11108 but uses more space. The default is off.
11109
11110 @item set print array off
11111 Return to compressed format for arrays.
11112
11113 @item show print array
11114 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
11115 arrays.
11116
11117 @cindex print array indexes
11118 @anchor{set print array-indexes}
11119 @item set print array-indexes
11120 @itemx set print array-indexes on
11121 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
11122 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
11123 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
11124
11125 @item set print array-indexes off
11126 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
11127
11128 @item show print array-indexes
11129 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
11130 arrays.
11131
11132 @anchor{set print elements}
11133 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
11134 @itemx set print elements unlimited
11135 @cindex number of array elements to print
11136 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
11137 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
11138 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
11139 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
11140 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
11141 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
11142 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
11143 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
11144
11145 @item show print elements
11146 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
11147 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
11148
11149 @anchor{set print frame-arguments}
11150 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
11151 @kindex set print frame-arguments
11152 @cindex printing frame argument values
11153 @cindex print all frame argument values
11154 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
11155 @cindex do not print frame arguments
11156 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
11157 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
11158 values are:
11159
11160 @table @code
11161 @item all
11162 The values of all arguments are printed.
11163
11164 @item scalars
11165 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
11166 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
11167 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
11168 only scalar arguments are shown:
11169
11170 @smallexample
11171 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
11172 at frame-args.c:23
11173 @end smallexample
11174
11175 @item none
11176 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
11177 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
11178
11179 @smallexample
11180 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
11181 at frame-args.c:23
11182 @end smallexample
11183
11184 @item presence
11185 Only the presence of arguments is indicated by @code{@dots{}}.
11186 The @code{@dots{}} are not printed for function without any arguments.
11187 None of the argument names and values are printed.
11188 In this case, the example above now becomes:
11189
11190 @smallexample
11191 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (@dots{}) at frame-args.c:23
11192 @end smallexample
11193
11194 @end table
11195
11196 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
11197 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
11198 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
11199 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
11200 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
11201 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
11202 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
11203 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
11204 to @code{scalars} (the default), @code{none} or @code{presence} avoids
11205 this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
11206
11207 @item show print frame-arguments
11208 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
11209
11210 @anchor{set print raw-frame-arguments}
11211 @item set print raw-frame-arguments on
11212 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
11213
11214 @item set print raw-frame-arguments off
11215 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
11216 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
11217 otherwise print the value in raw form.
11218 This is the default.
11219
11220 @item show print raw-frame-arguments
11221 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
11222
11223 @anchor{set print entry-values}
11224 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
11225 @kindex set print entry-values
11226 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
11227 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
11228 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
11229 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
11230 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
11231
11232 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
11233 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
11234 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
11235 @code{no} setting.
11236
11237 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11238 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
11239 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11240 this information.
11241
11242 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
11243
11244 @table @code
11245 @item no
11246 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
11247 point.
11248 @smallexample
11249 #0 equal (val=5)
11250 #0 different (val=6)
11251 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
11252 #0 born (val=10)
11253 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11254 @end smallexample
11255
11256 @item only
11257 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
11258 values are never printed.
11259 @smallexample
11260 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
11261 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
11262 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11263 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11264 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11265 @end smallexample
11266
11267 @item preferred
11268 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
11269 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
11270 value for such parameter.
11271 @smallexample
11272 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
11273 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
11274 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11275 #0 born (val=10)
11276 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11277 @end smallexample
11278
11279 @item if-needed
11280 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
11281 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
11282 parameter.
11283 @smallexample
11284 #0 equal (val=5)
11285 #0 different (val=6)
11286 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11287 #0 born (val=10)
11288 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11289 @end smallexample
11290
11291 @item both
11292 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
11293 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
11294 optimizations.
11295 @smallexample
11296 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
11297 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11298 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
11299 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11300 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11301 @end smallexample
11302
11303 @item compact
11304 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
11305 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
11306 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
11307 values are known and identical, print the shortened
11308 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
11309 @smallexample
11310 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
11311 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11312 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11313 #0 born (val=10)
11314 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11315 @end smallexample
11316
11317 @item default
11318 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
11319 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
11320 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
11321 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
11322 @smallexample
11323 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
11324 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11325 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
11326 #0 born (val=10)
11327 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11328 @end smallexample
11329 @end table
11330
11331 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
11332 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
11333
11334 @item show print entry-values
11335 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
11336 entry.
11337
11338 @anchor{set print frame-info}
11339 @item set print frame-info @var{value}
11340 @kindex set print frame-info
11341 @cindex printing frame information
11342 @cindex frame information, printing
11343 This command allows to control the information printed when
11344 the debugger prints a frame. See @ref{Frames}, @ref{Backtrace},
11345 for a general explanation about frames and frame information.
11346 Note that some other settings (such as @code{set print frame-arguments}
11347 and @code{set print address}) are also influencing if and how some frame
11348 information is displayed. In particular, the frame program counter is never
11349 printed if @code{set print address} is off.
11350
11351 The possible values for @code{set print frame-info} are:
11352 @table @code
11353 @item short-location
11354 Print the frame level, the program counter (if not at the
11355 beginning of the location source line), the function, the function
11356 arguments.
11357 @item location
11358 Same as @code{short-location} but also print the source file and source line
11359 number.
11360 @item location-and-address
11361 Same as @code{location} but print the program counter even if located at the
11362 beginning of the location source line.
11363 @item source-line
11364 Print the program counter (if not at the beginning of the location
11365 source line), the line number and the source line.
11366 @item source-and-location
11367 Print what @code{location} and @code{source-line} are printing.
11368 @item auto
11369 The information printed for a frame is decided automatically
11370 by the @value{GDBN} command that prints a frame.
11371 For example, @code{frame} prints the information printed by
11372 @code{source-and-location} while @code{stepi} will switch between
11373 @code{source-line} and @code{source-and-location} depending on the program
11374 counter.
11375 The default value is @code{auto}.
11376 @end table
11377
11378 @anchor{set print repeats}
11379 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
11380 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
11381 @cindex repeated array elements
11382 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
11383 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
11384 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
11385 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
11386 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
11387 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
11388 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
11389 is 10.
11390
11391 @item show print repeats
11392 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
11393 elements.
11394
11395 @anchor{set print max-depth}
11396 @item set print max-depth @var{depth}
11397 @item set print max-depth unlimited
11398 @cindex printing nested structures
11399 Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
11400 ellipsis, this can make visualising deeply nested structures easier.
11401
11402 For example, given this C code
11403
11404 @smallexample
11405 typedef struct s1 @{ int a; @} s1;
11406 typedef struct s2 @{ s1 b; @} s2;
11407 typedef struct s3 @{ s2 c; @} s3;
11408 typedef struct s4 @{ s3 d; @} s4;
11409
11410 s4 var = @{ @{ @{ @{ 3 @} @} @} @};
11411 @end smallexample
11412
11413 The following table shows how different values of @var{depth} will
11414 effect how @code{var} is printed by @value{GDBN}:
11415
11416 @multitable @columnfractions .3 .7
11417 @headitem @var{depth} setting @tab Result of @samp{p var}
11418 @item unlimited
11419 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
11420 @item @code{0}
11421 @tab @code{$1 = @{...@}}
11422 @item @code{1}
11423 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{...@}@}}
11424 @item @code{2}
11425 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}}
11426 @item @code{3}
11427 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}@}}
11428 @item @code{4}
11429 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
11430 @end multitable
11431
11432 To see the contents of structures that have been hidden the user can
11433 either increase the print max-depth, or they can print the elements of
11434 the structure that are visible, for example
11435
11436 @smallexample
11437 (gdb) set print max-depth 2
11438 (gdb) p var
11439 $1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}
11440 (gdb) p var.d
11441 $2 = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}
11442 (gdb) p var.d.c
11443 $3 = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}
11444 @end smallexample
11445
11446 The pattern used to replace nested structures varies based on
11447 language, for most languages @code{@{...@}} is used, but Fortran uses
11448 @code{(...)}.
11449
11450 @item show print max-depth
11451 Display the current threshold after which nested structures are
11452 replaces with ellipsis.
11453
11454 @anchor{set print null-stop}
11455 @item set print null-stop
11456 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
11457 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
11458 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
11459 contain only short strings.
11460 The default is off.
11461
11462 @item show print null-stop
11463 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
11464 @sc{null} character.
11465
11466 @anchor{set print pretty}
11467 @item set print pretty on
11468 @cindex print structures in indented form
11469 @cindex indentation in structure display
11470 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
11471 per line, like this:
11472
11473 @smallexample
11474 @group
11475 $1 = @{
11476 next = 0x0,
11477 flags = @{
11478 sweet = 1,
11479 sour = 1
11480 @},
11481 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
11482 @}
11483 @end group
11484 @end smallexample
11485
11486 @item set print pretty off
11487 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
11488
11489 @smallexample
11490 @group
11491 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
11492 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
11493 @end group
11494 @end smallexample
11495
11496 @noindent
11497 This is the default format.
11498
11499 @item show print pretty
11500 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
11501
11502 @anchor{set print raw-values}
11503 @item set print raw-values on
11504 Print values in raw form, without applying the pretty
11505 printers for the value.
11506
11507 @item set print raw-values off
11508 Print values in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
11509 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
11510 otherwise print the value in raw form.
11511
11512 The default setting is ``off''.
11513
11514 @item show print raw-values
11515 Show whether to print values in raw form.
11516
11517 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
11518 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
11519 @cindex octal escapes in strings
11520 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
11521 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
11522 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
11523 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
11524 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
11525
11526 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
11527 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
11528 international character sets, and is the default.
11529
11530 @item show print sevenbit-strings
11531 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
11532
11533 @anchor{set print union}
11534 @item set print union on
11535 @cindex unions in structures, printing
11536 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
11537 and other unions. This is the default setting.
11538
11539 @item set print union off
11540 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
11541 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
11542 instead.
11543
11544 @item show print union
11545 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
11546 structures and other unions.
11547
11548 For example, given the declarations
11549
11550 @smallexample
11551 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
11552 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
11553 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
11554 Bug_forms;
11555
11556 struct thing @{
11557 Species it;
11558 union @{
11559 Tree_forms tree;
11560 Bug_forms bug;
11561 @} form;
11562 @};
11563
11564 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
11565 @end smallexample
11566
11567 @noindent
11568 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
11569
11570 @smallexample
11571 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
11572 @end smallexample
11573
11574 @noindent
11575 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
11576
11577 @smallexample
11578 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
11579 @end smallexample
11580
11581 @noindent
11582 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
11583 and in Pascal.
11584 @end table
11585
11586 @need 1000
11587 @noindent
11588 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
11589
11590 @table @code
11591 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
11592 @item set print demangle
11593 @itemx set print demangle on
11594 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
11595 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
11596 linkage. The default is on.
11597
11598 @item show print demangle
11599 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
11600
11601 @item set print asm-demangle
11602 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
11603 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
11604 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
11605 The default is off.
11606
11607 @item show print asm-demangle
11608 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
11609 or demangled form.
11610
11611 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
11612 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
11613 @kindex set demangle-style
11614 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
11615 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to represent
11616 C@t{++} names. If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible
11617 formats. The default value is @var{auto}, which lets @value{GDBN} choose a
11618 decoding style by inspecting your program.
11619
11620 @item show demangle-style
11621 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
11622
11623 @anchor{set print object}
11624 @item set print object
11625 @itemx set print object on
11626 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
11627 @cindex display derived types
11628 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
11629 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
11630 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
11631 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
11632 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
11633 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
11634 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
11635
11636 @item set print object off
11637 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
11638 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
11639
11640 @item show print object
11641 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
11642
11643 @anchor{set print static-members}
11644 @item set print static-members
11645 @itemx set print static-members on
11646 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
11647 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
11648
11649 @item set print static-members off
11650 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
11651
11652 @item show print static-members
11653 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
11654
11655 @item set print pascal_static-members
11656 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
11657 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
11658 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
11659 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
11660
11661 @item set print pascal_static-members off
11662 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
11663
11664 @item show print pascal_static-members
11665 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
11666
11667 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
11668 @anchor{set print vtbl}
11669 @item set print vtbl
11670 @itemx set print vtbl on
11671 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
11672 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
11673 @cindex VTBL display
11674 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
11675 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
11676 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
11677
11678 @item set print vtbl off
11679 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
11680
11681 @item show print vtbl
11682 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
11683 @end table
11684
11685 @node Pretty Printing
11686 @section Pretty Printing
11687
11688 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
11689 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
11690 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
11691
11692 @menu
11693 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
11694 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
11695 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
11696 @end menu
11697
11698 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
11699 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
11700
11701 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
11702 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
11703 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
11704
11705 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
11706 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
11707 pretty-printers with their names.
11708 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
11709 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
11710 Each such subprinter has its own name.
11711 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
11712
11713 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
11714 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
11715 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
11716 do anything special.
11717
11718 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
11719
11720 @itemize @bullet
11721 @item
11722 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
11723 all inferiors.
11724
11725 @item
11726 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
11727 when debugging that program.
11728 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
11729
11730 @item
11731 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
11732 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
11733 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
11734 @end itemize
11735
11736 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
11737 pretty-printers are selected,
11738
11739 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
11740 for new types.
11741
11742 @node Pretty-Printer Example
11743 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
11744
11745 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
11746
11747 @smallexample
11748 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11749 $1 = @{
11750 static npos = 4294967295,
11751 _M_dataplus = @{
11752 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
11753 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
11754 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
11755 @},
11756 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
11757 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
11758 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
11759 @}
11760 @}
11761 @end smallexample
11762
11763 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
11764
11765 @smallexample
11766 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11767 $2 = "abcd"
11768 @end smallexample
11769
11770 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
11771 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
11772 @cindex pretty-printer commands
11773
11774 @table @code
11775 @kindex info pretty-printer
11776 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11777 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
11778 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
11779
11780 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
11781 whose pretty-printers to list.
11782 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
11783 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
11784 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
11785 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
11786 looks up a printer from these three objects.
11787
11788 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
11789 to list.
11790
11791 @kindex disable pretty-printer
11792 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11793 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
11794 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
11795
11796 @kindex enable pretty-printer
11797 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11798 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
11799 @end table
11800
11801 Example:
11802
11803 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
11804 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
11805 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
11806 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
11807
11808 @smallexample
11809 (gdb) info pretty-printer
11810 library1.so:
11811 foo
11812 library2.so:
11813 bar
11814 bar1
11815 bar2
11816 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11817 library2.so:
11818 bar
11819 bar1
11820 bar2
11821 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
11822 1 printer disabled
11823 2 of 3 printers enabled
11824 (gdb) info pretty-printer
11825 library1.so:
11826 foo [disabled]
11827 library2.so:
11828 bar
11829 bar1
11830 bar2
11831 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
11832 1 printer disabled
11833 1 of 3 printers enabled
11834 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11835 library1.so:
11836 foo [disabled]
11837 library2.so:
11838 bar
11839 bar1 [disabled]
11840 bar2
11841 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
11842 1 printer disabled
11843 0 of 3 printers enabled
11844 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11845 library1.so:
11846 foo [disabled]
11847 library2.so:
11848 bar [disabled]
11849 bar1 [disabled]
11850 bar2
11851 @end smallexample
11852
11853 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
11854 as can each individual subprinter.
11855
11856 Printing values and frame arguments is done by default using
11857 the enabled pretty printers.
11858
11859 The print option @code{-raw-values} and @value{GDBN} setting
11860 @code{set print raw-values} (@pxref{set print raw-values}) can be
11861 used to print values without applying the enabled pretty printers.
11862
11863 Similarly, the backtrace option @code{-raw-frame-arguments} and
11864 @value{GDBN} setting @code{set print raw-frame-arguments}
11865 (@pxref{set print raw-frame-arguments}) can be used to ignore the
11866 enabled pretty printers when printing frame argument values.
11867
11868 @node Value History
11869 @section Value History
11870
11871 @cindex value history
11872 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
11873 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
11874 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
11875 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
11876 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
11877 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
11878 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
11879 symbol table.
11880
11881 @cindex @code{$}
11882 @cindex @code{$$}
11883 @cindex history number
11884 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
11885 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
11886 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
11887 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
11888 history number.
11889
11890 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
11891 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
11892 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
11893 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
11894 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
11895 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
11896 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
11897
11898 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
11899 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
11900
11901 @smallexample
11902 p *$
11903 @end smallexample
11904
11905 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
11906 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
11907
11908 @smallexample
11909 p *$.next
11910 @end smallexample
11911
11912 @noindent
11913 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
11914 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
11915
11916 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
11917 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
11918
11919 @smallexample
11920 print x
11921 set x=5
11922 @end smallexample
11923
11924 @noindent
11925 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
11926 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
11927
11928 @table @code
11929 @kindex show values
11930 @item show values
11931 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
11932 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
11933 values} does not change the history.
11934
11935 @item show values @var{n}
11936 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
11937
11938 @item show values +
11939 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
11940 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
11941 @end table
11942
11943 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
11944 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
11945
11946 @node Convenience Vars
11947 @section Convenience Variables
11948
11949 @cindex convenience variables
11950 @cindex user-defined variables
11951 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
11952 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
11953 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
11954 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
11955 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
11956
11957 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
11958 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
11959 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11960 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
11961 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
11962
11963 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
11964 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
11965 For example:
11966
11967 @smallexample
11968 set $foo = *object_ptr
11969 @end smallexample
11970
11971 @noindent
11972 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11973 @code{object_ptr}.
11974
11975 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11976 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11977 value with another assignment at any time.
11978
11979 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11980 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11981 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11982 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11983
11984 @table @code
11985 @kindex show convenience
11986 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11987 @item show convenience
11988 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11989 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11990 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11991
11992 @kindex init-if-undefined
11993 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11994 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11995 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11996 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11997 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11998 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11999 override default values used in a command script.
12000
12001 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
12002 any side-effects do not occur.
12003 @end table
12004
12005 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
12006 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
12007 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
12008
12009 @smallexample
12010 set $i = 0
12011 print bar[$i++]->contents
12012 @end smallexample
12013
12014 @noindent
12015 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
12016
12017 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
12018 values likely to be useful.
12019
12020 @table @code
12021 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
12022 @item $_
12023 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
12024 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
12025 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
12026 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
12027 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
12028 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
12029 to the type of @code{$__}.
12030
12031 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
12032 @item $__
12033 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
12034 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
12035 to match the format in which the data was printed.
12036
12037 @item $_exitcode
12038 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
12039 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
12040 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
12041 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
12042
12043 @item $_exitsignal
12044 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
12045 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
12046 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
12047 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
12048
12049 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
12050 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
12051 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
12052 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
12053 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
12054
12055 @smallexample
12056 #include <signal.h>
12057
12058 int
12059 main (int argc, char *argv[])
12060 @{
12061 raise (SIGALRM);
12062 return 0;
12063 @}
12064 @end smallexample
12065
12066 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
12067 or signalled would be:
12068
12069 @smallexample
12070 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
12071 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
12072 End with a line saying just ``end''.
12073 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
12074 >echo The program has exited\n
12075 >else
12076 >echo The program has signalled\n
12077 >end
12078 >end
12079 (@value{GDBP}) run
12080 Starting program:
12081
12082 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
12083 The program no longer exists.
12084 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
12085 The program has signalled
12086 @end smallexample
12087
12088 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
12089 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
12090 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
12091 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
12092
12093 @smallexample
12094 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
12095 The program has exited
12096 @end smallexample
12097
12098 @item $_exception
12099 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
12100 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
12101
12102 @item $_ada_exception
12103 The variable @code{$_ada_exception} is set to the address of the
12104 exception being caught or thrown at an Ada exception-related
12105 catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
12106
12107 @item $_probe_argc
12108 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
12109 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12110
12111 @item $_sdata
12112 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
12113 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
12114 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
12115 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
12116 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
12117
12118 @item $_siginfo
12119 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
12120 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
12121 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
12122 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
12123 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
12124
12125 @item $_tlb
12126 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
12127 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
12128 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
12129 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
12130 @xref{General Query Packets}.
12131 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
12132
12133 @item $_inferior
12134 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors Connections and
12135 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors Connections and Programs}.
12136
12137 @item $_thread
12138 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
12139
12140 @item $_gthread
12141 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
12142
12143 @item $_gdb_major
12144 @itemx $_gdb_minor
12145 @vindex $_gdb_major@r{, convenience variable}
12146 @vindex $_gdb_minor@r{, convenience variable}
12147 The major and minor version numbers of the running @value{GDBN}.
12148 Development snapshots and pretest versions have their minor version
12149 incremented by one; thus, @value{GDBN} pretest 9.11.90 will produce
12150 the value 12 for @code{$_gdb_minor}. These variables allow you to
12151 write scripts that work with different versions of @value{GDBN}
12152 without errors caused by features unavailable in some of those
12153 versions.
12154
12155 @item $_shell_exitcode
12156 @itemx $_shell_exitsignal
12157 @vindex $_shell_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
12158 @vindex $_shell_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
12159 @cindex shell command, exit code
12160 @cindex shell command, exit signal
12161 @cindex exit status of shell commands
12162 @value{GDBN} commands such as @code{shell} and @code{|} are launching
12163 shell commands. When a launched command terminates, @value{GDBN}
12164 automatically maintains the variables @code{$_shell_exitcode}
12165 and @code{$_shell_exitsignal} according to the exit status of the last
12166 launched command. These variables are set and used similarly to
12167 the variables @code{$_exitcode} and @code{$_exitsignal}.
12168
12169 @end table
12170
12171 @node Convenience Funs
12172 @section Convenience Functions
12173
12174 @cindex convenience functions
12175 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
12176 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
12177 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
12178 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
12179 @value{GDBN}.
12180
12181 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
12182 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
12183
12184 @table @code
12185
12186 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
12187 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
12188 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
12189 returns zero.
12190
12191 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
12192 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
12193 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
12194 it is @code{void}:
12195
12196 @smallexample
12197 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
12198 $1 = void
12199 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
12200 $2 = 1
12201 (@value{GDBP}) run
12202 Starting program: ./a.out
12203 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
12204 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
12205 $3 = 0
12206 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
12207 $4 = 0
12208 @end smallexample
12209
12210 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
12211 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
12212 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
12213 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
12214 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
12215 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
12216 anymore.
12217
12218 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
12219 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
12220
12221 @smallexample
12222 void
12223 foo (void)
12224 @{
12225 @}
12226 @end smallexample
12227
12228 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
12229
12230 @smallexample
12231 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
12232 $1 = void
12233 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
12234 $2 = 1
12235 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
12236 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
12237 $3 = void
12238 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
12239 $4 = 1
12240 @end smallexample
12241
12242 @item $_gdb_setting_str (@var{setting})
12243 @findex $_gdb_setting_str@r{, convenience function}
12244 Return the value of the @value{GDBN} @var{setting} as a string.
12245 @var{setting} is any setting that can be used in a @code{set} or
12246 @code{show} command (@pxref{Controlling GDB}).
12247
12248 @smallexample
12249 (@value{GDBP}) show print frame-arguments
12250 Printing of non-scalar frame arguments is "scalars".
12251 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("print frame-arguments")
12252 $1 = "scalars"
12253 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("height")
12254 $2 = "30"
12255 (@value{GDBP})
12256 @end smallexample
12257
12258 @item $_gdb_setting (@var{setting})
12259 @findex $_gdb_setting@r{, convenience function}
12260 Return the value of the @value{GDBN} @var{setting}.
12261 The type of the returned value depends on the setting.
12262
12263 The value type for boolean and auto boolean settings is @code{int}.
12264 The boolean values @code{off} and @code{on} are converted to
12265 the integer values @code{0} and @code{1}. The value @code{auto} is
12266 converted to the value @code{-1}.
12267
12268 The value type for integer settings is either @code{unsigned int}
12269 or @code{int}, depending on the setting.
12270
12271 Some integer settings accept an @code{unlimited} value.
12272 Depending on the setting, the @code{set} command also accepts
12273 the value @code{0} or the value @code{@minus{}1} as a synonym for
12274 @code{unlimited}.
12275 For example, @code{set height unlimited} is equivalent to
12276 @code{set height 0}.
12277
12278 Some other settings that accept the @code{unlimited} value
12279 use the value @code{0} to literally mean zero.
12280 For example, @code{set history size 0} indicates to not
12281 record any @value{GDBN} commands in the command history.
12282 For such settings, @code{@minus{}1} is the synonym
12283 for @code{unlimited}.
12284
12285 See the documentation of the corresponding @code{set} command for
12286 the numerical value equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
12287
12288 The @code{$_gdb_setting} function converts the unlimited value
12289 to a @code{0} or a @code{@minus{}1} value according to what the
12290 @code{set} command uses.
12291
12292 @smallexample
12293 @group
12294 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("height")
12295 $1 = "30"
12296 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting("height")
12297 $2 = 30
12298 (@value{GDBP}) set height unlimited
12299 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("height")
12300 $3 = "unlimited"
12301 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting("height")
12302 $4 = 0
12303 @end group
12304 @group
12305 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("history size")
12306 $5 = "unlimited"
12307 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting("history size")
12308 $6 = -1
12309 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("disassemble-next-line")
12310 $7 = "auto"
12311 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting("disassemble-next-line")
12312 $8 = -1
12313 (@value{GDBP})
12314 @end group
12315 @end smallexample
12316
12317 Other setting types (enum, filename, optional filename, string, string noescape)
12318 are returned as string values.
12319
12320
12321 @item $_gdb_maint_setting_str (@var{setting})
12322 @findex $_gdb_maint_setting_str@r{, convenience function}
12323 Like the @code{$_gdb_setting_str} function, but works with
12324 @code{maintenance set} variables.
12325
12326 @item $_gdb_maint_setting (@var{setting})
12327 @findex $_gdb_maint_setting@r{, convenience function}
12328 Like the @code{$_gdb_setting} function, but works with
12329 @code{maintenance set} variables.
12330
12331 @end table
12332
12333 The following functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
12334 @code{Python} support.
12335
12336 @table @code
12337
12338 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
12339 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
12340 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
12341 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
12342 Otherwise it returns zero.
12343
12344 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
12345 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
12346 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
12347 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
12348 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
12349 regular expression support.
12350
12351 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
12352 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
12353 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
12354 Otherwise it returns zero.
12355
12356 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
12357 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
12358 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
12359
12360 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
12361 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
12362 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
12363 Otherwise it returns zero.
12364
12365 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
12366 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
12367 The default is 1.
12368
12369 Example:
12370
12371 @smallexample
12372 (gdb) backtrace
12373 #0 bottom_func ()
12374 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
12375 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
12376 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
12377 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
12378 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
12379 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
12380 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
12381 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
12382 $1 = 1
12383 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
12384 $1 = 1
12385 @end smallexample
12386
12387 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
12388 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
12389 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
12390 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
12391
12392 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
12393 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
12394 The default is 1.
12395
12396 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
12397 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
12398 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
12399 Otherwise it returns zero.
12400
12401 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
12402 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
12403 The default is 1.
12404
12405 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
12406 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
12407 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
12408 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
12409
12410 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
12411 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
12412 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
12413 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
12414
12415 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
12416 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
12417 The default is 1.
12418
12419 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
12420 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
12421 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
12422 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
12423
12424 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
12425 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
12426 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
12427
12428 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
12429 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
12430 an enumerated type:
12431
12432 @smallexample
12433 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
12434 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
12435 @end smallexample
12436
12437 @item $_cimag(@var{value})
12438 @itemx $_creal(@var{value})
12439 @findex $_cimag@r{, convenience function}
12440 @findex $_creal@r{, convenience function}
12441 Return the imaginary (@code{$_cimag}) or real (@code{$_creal}) part of
12442 the complex number @var{value}.
12443
12444 The type of the imaginary or real part depends on the type of the
12445 complex number, e.g., using @code{$_cimag} on a @code{float complex}
12446 will return an imaginary part of type @code{float}.
12447
12448 @end table
12449
12450 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
12451 convenience functions.
12452
12453 @table @code
12454 @item help function
12455 @kindex help function
12456 @cindex show all convenience functions
12457 Print a list of all convenience functions.
12458 @end table
12459
12460 @node Registers
12461 @section Registers
12462
12463 @cindex registers
12464 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
12465 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
12466 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
12467 your machine.
12468
12469 @table @code
12470 @kindex info registers
12471 @item info registers
12472 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
12473 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
12474
12475 @kindex info all-registers
12476 @cindex floating point registers
12477 @item info all-registers
12478 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
12479 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
12480
12481 @anchor{info_registers_reggroup}
12482 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
12483 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
12484 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggroup} can be any of those returned by
12485 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
12486
12487 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
12488 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
12489 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
12490 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
12491 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
12492 @end table
12493
12494 @anchor{standard registers}
12495 @cindex stack pointer register
12496 @cindex program counter register
12497 @cindex process status register
12498 @cindex frame pointer register
12499 @cindex standard registers
12500 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
12501 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
12502 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
12503 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
12504 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
12505 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
12506 register that contains the processor status. For example,
12507 you could print the program counter in hex with
12508
12509 @smallexample
12510 p/x $pc
12511 @end smallexample
12512
12513 @noindent
12514 or print the instruction to be executed next with
12515
12516 @smallexample
12517 x/i $pc
12518 @end smallexample
12519
12520 @noindent
12521 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
12522 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
12523 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
12524 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
12525 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
12526 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
12527 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
12528
12529 @smallexample
12530 set $sp += 4
12531 @end smallexample
12532
12533 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
12534 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
12535 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
12536 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
12537 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
12538 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
12539 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
12540
12541 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
12542 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
12543 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
12544 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
12545 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
12546 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
12547 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
12548
12549 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
12550 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
12551 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
12552 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
12553 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
12554 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
12555 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
12556 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
12557 prints the data in both formats.
12558
12559 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
12560 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
12561 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
12562 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
12563 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
12564 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
12565 registers in @code{struct} notation:
12566
12567 @smallexample
12568 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
12569 $1 = @{
12570 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
12571 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
12572 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
12573 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
12574 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
12575 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
12576 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
12577 @}
12578 @end smallexample
12579
12580 @noindent
12581 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
12582 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
12583 value to a @code{struct} member:
12584
12585 @smallexample
12586 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
12587 @end smallexample
12588
12589 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
12590 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
12591 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
12592 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
12593 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
12594 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
12595
12596 @cindex caller-saved registers
12597 @cindex call-clobbered registers
12598 @cindex volatile registers
12599 @cindex <not saved> values
12600 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
12601 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
12602 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
12603 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
12604 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
12605 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
12606 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
12607 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
12608 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
12609 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
12610 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
12611 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
12612 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
12613 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
12614 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
12615 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
12616 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
12617 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
12618 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
12619 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
12620 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
12621 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
12622 represent the value the register had just before the call.
12623
12624 @node Floating Point Hardware
12625 @section Floating Point Hardware
12626 @cindex floating point
12627
12628 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
12629 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
12630
12631 @table @code
12632 @kindex info float
12633 @item info float
12634 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
12635 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
12636 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
12637 the ARM and x86 machines.
12638 @end table
12639
12640 @node Vector Unit
12641 @section Vector Unit
12642 @cindex vector unit
12643
12644 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
12645 more information about the status of the vector unit.
12646
12647 @table @code
12648 @kindex info vector
12649 @item info vector
12650 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
12651 layout vary depending on the hardware.
12652 @end table
12653
12654 @node OS Information
12655 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
12656 @cindex OS information
12657
12658 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
12659 you debug your program.
12660
12661 @cindex auxiliary vector
12662 @cindex vector, auxiliary
12663 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
12664 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
12665 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
12666 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
12667 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
12668 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
12669 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
12670 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
12671 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
12672 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
12673 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
12674
12675 @table @code
12676 @kindex info auxv
12677 @item info auxv
12678 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
12679 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
12680 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
12681 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
12682 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
12683 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
12684 an unrecognized tag.
12685 @end table
12686
12687 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
12688 information and show it to you. The types of information available
12689 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
12690 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
12691 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
12692 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
12693 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
12694
12695 @table @code
12696 @kindex info os
12697 @item info os @var{infotype}
12698
12699 Display OS information of the requested type.
12700
12701 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
12702
12703 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
12704 @table @code
12705 @kindex info os cpus
12706 @item cpus
12707 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
12708 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
12709 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
12710 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
12711 kernel initialization.
12712
12713 @kindex info os files
12714 @item files
12715 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
12716 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
12717 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
12718 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
12719
12720 @kindex info os modules
12721 @item modules
12722 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
12723 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
12724 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
12725 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
12726 in memory.
12727
12728 @kindex info os msg
12729 @item msg
12730 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
12731 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
12732 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
12733 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
12734 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
12735 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
12736 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
12737 the message queue was last changed.
12738
12739 @kindex info os processes
12740 @item processes
12741 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
12742 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
12743 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
12744 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
12745 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
12746 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
12747
12748 @kindex info os procgroups
12749 @item procgroups
12750 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
12751 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
12752 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
12753 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
12754 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
12755 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
12756 and the process group leader is listed first.
12757
12758 @kindex info os semaphores
12759 @item semaphores
12760 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
12761 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
12762 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
12763 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
12764 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
12765
12766 @kindex info os shm
12767 @item shm
12768 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
12769 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
12770 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
12771 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
12772 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
12773 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
12774 attached to, detach from, and changed.
12775
12776 @kindex info os sockets
12777 @item sockets
12778 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
12779 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
12780 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
12781 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
12782 connection.
12783
12784 @kindex info os threads
12785 @item threads
12786 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
12787 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
12788 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
12789 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
12790 process is not listed.
12791 @end table
12792
12793 @item info os
12794 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
12795 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
12796 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
12797 types, this command will report an error.
12798 @end table
12799
12800 @node Memory Region Attributes
12801 @section Memory Region Attributes
12802 @cindex memory region attributes
12803
12804 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
12805 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
12806 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
12807 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
12808 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
12809 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
12810 user can override the fetched regions.
12811
12812 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
12813 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
12814 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
12815 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
12816 all memory.
12817
12818 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
12819 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
12820
12821 @table @code
12822 @kindex mem
12823 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
12824 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
12825 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
12826 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
12827 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
12828 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
12829
12830 @item mem auto
12831 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
12832 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
12833
12834 @kindex delete mem
12835 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12836 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
12837 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
12838
12839 @kindex disable mem
12840 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12841 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
12842 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
12843 It may be enabled again later.
12844
12845 @kindex enable mem
12846 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12847 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
12848
12849 @kindex info mem
12850 @item info mem
12851 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
12852 for each region:
12853
12854 @table @emph
12855 @item Memory Region Number
12856 @item Enabled or Disabled.
12857 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
12858 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
12859
12860 @item Lo Address
12861 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
12862
12863 @item Hi Address
12864 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
12865
12866 @item Attributes
12867 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
12868 @end table
12869 @end table
12870
12871
12872 @subsection Attributes
12873
12874 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
12875 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
12876 write accesses to a memory region.
12877
12878 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
12879 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
12880 etc.@: from accessing memory.
12881
12882 @table @code
12883 @item ro
12884 Memory is read only.
12885 @item wo
12886 Memory is write only.
12887 @item rw
12888 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
12889 @end table
12890
12891 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
12892 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
12893 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
12894 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
12895 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
12896
12897 @table @code
12898 @item 8
12899 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
12900 @item 16
12901 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
12902 @item 32
12903 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
12904 @item 64
12905 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
12906 @end table
12907
12908 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
12909 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
12910 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
12911 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
12912 @c
12913 @c @table @code
12914 @c @item hwbreak
12915 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
12916 @c @item swbreak (default)
12917 @c @end table
12918
12919 @subsubsection Data Cache
12920 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
12921 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
12922 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
12923 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
12924 registers.
12925
12926 @table @code
12927 @item cache
12928 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
12929 @item nocache
12930 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
12931 @end table
12932
12933 @subsection Memory Access Checking
12934 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
12935 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
12936 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
12937 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
12938
12939 @table @code
12940 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
12941 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
12942 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
12943 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
12944 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
12945 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
12946 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
12947 The default value is @code{on}.
12948 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
12949 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
12950 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
12951 @end table
12952
12953
12954 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
12955 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
12956 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
12957 @c
12958 @c @table @code
12959 @c @item verify
12960 @c @item noverify (default)
12961 @c @end table
12962
12963 @node Dump/Restore Files
12964 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
12965 @cindex dump/restore files
12966 @cindex append data to a file
12967 @cindex dump data to a file
12968 @cindex restore data from a file
12969
12970 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
12971 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
12972 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
12973 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
12974 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
12975 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
12976 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
12977
12978 @table @code
12979
12980 @kindex dump
12981 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
12982 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
12983 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
12984 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
12985
12986 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
12987 @table @code
12988 @item binary
12989 Raw binary form.
12990 @item ihex
12991 Intel hex format.
12992 @item srec
12993 Motorola S-record format.
12994 @item tekhex
12995 Tektronix Hex format.
12996 @item verilog
12997 Verilog Hex format.
12998 @end table
12999
13000 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
13001 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
13002 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
13003 form.
13004
13005 @kindex append
13006 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
13007 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
13008 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
13009 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
13010 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
13011
13012 @kindex restore
13013 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
13014 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
13015 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
13016 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
13017 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
13018
13019 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
13020 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
13021 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
13022 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
13023 from that location.
13024
13025 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
13026 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
13027 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
13028 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
13029
13030 @end table
13031
13032 @node Core File Generation
13033 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
13034 @cindex dump core from inferior
13035
13036 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
13037 image of a running process and its process status (register values
13038 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
13039 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
13040 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
13041 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
13042 the post-mortem debugging mode.
13043
13044 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
13045 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
13046 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
13047
13048 @table @code
13049 @kindex gcore
13050 @kindex generate-core-file
13051 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
13052 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
13053 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
13054 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
13055 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
13056 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
13057
13058 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
13059 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
13060
13061 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
13062 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
13063 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
13064 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
13065 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
13066
13067 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
13068 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
13069 @item set use-coredump-filter on
13070 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
13071 Enable or disable the use of the file
13072 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
13073 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
13074 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
13075 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
13076
13077 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
13078 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
13079 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
13080 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
13081 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
13082 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
13083 about the bits that can be set in the
13084 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
13085 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
13086
13087 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
13088 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
13089 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
13090 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
13091 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
13092 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
13093 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
13094 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
13095
13096 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
13097 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
13098 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
13099 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
13100 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
13101 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
13102 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
13103
13104 The default value is @code{off}.
13105 @end table
13106
13107 @node Character Sets
13108 @section Character Sets
13109 @cindex character sets
13110 @cindex charset
13111 @cindex translating between character sets
13112 @cindex host character set
13113 @cindex target character set
13114
13115 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
13116 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
13117 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
13118 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
13119 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
13120 @dfn{target character set}.
13121
13122 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
13123 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
13124 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
13125 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
13126 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
13127 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
13128 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
13129 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
13130 character and string literals in expressions.
13131
13132 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
13133 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
13134 target-charset} command, described below.
13135
13136 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
13137 support:
13138
13139 @table @code
13140 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
13141 @kindex set target-charset
13142 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
13143 list of supported target character sets, type
13144 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
13145
13146 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
13147 @kindex set host-charset
13148 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
13149
13150 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
13151 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
13152 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
13153 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
13154 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
13155
13156 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
13157 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
13158 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
13159
13160 @item set charset @var{charset}
13161 @kindex set charset
13162 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
13163 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
13164 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
13165 for both host and target.
13166
13167 @item show charset
13168 @kindex show charset
13169 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
13170
13171 @item show host-charset
13172 @kindex show host-charset
13173 Show the name of the current host character set.
13174
13175 @item show target-charset
13176 @kindex show target-charset
13177 Show the name of the current target character set.
13178
13179 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
13180 @kindex set target-wide-charset
13181 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
13182 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
13183 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
13184 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
13185
13186 @item show target-wide-charset
13187 @kindex show target-wide-charset
13188 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
13189 @end table
13190
13191 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
13192 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
13193 @file{charset-test.c}:
13194
13195 @smallexample
13196 #include <stdio.h>
13197
13198 char ascii_hello[]
13199 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
13200 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
13201 char ibm1047_hello[]
13202 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
13203 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
13204
13205 main ()
13206 @{
13207 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13208 @}
13209 @end smallexample
13210
13211 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
13212 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
13213 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
13214
13215 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
13216
13217 @smallexample
13218 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
13219 $ gdb -nw charset-test
13220 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
13221 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13222 @dots{}
13223 (@value{GDBP})
13224 @end smallexample
13225
13226 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
13227 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
13228 strings:
13229
13230 @smallexample
13231 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
13232 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
13233 (@value{GDBP})
13234 @end smallexample
13235
13236 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
13237 initial character set:
13238 @smallexample
13239 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
13240 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
13241 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
13242 (@value{GDBP})
13243 @end smallexample
13244
13245 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
13246 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
13247 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
13248 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
13249 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
13250
13251 @smallexample
13252 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
13253 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
13254 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
13255 $2 = 72 'H'
13256 (@value{GDBP})
13257 @end smallexample
13258
13259 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
13260 literals you use in expressions:
13261
13262 @smallexample
13263 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
13264 $3 = 43 '+'
13265 (@value{GDBP})
13266 @end smallexample
13267
13268 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
13269 character.
13270
13271 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
13272 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
13273 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
13274
13275 @smallexample
13276 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
13277 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
13278 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
13279 $5 = 200 '\310'
13280 (@value{GDBP})
13281 @end smallexample
13282
13283 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
13284 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
13285
13286 @smallexample
13287 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
13288 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
13289 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
13290 @end smallexample
13291
13292 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
13293 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
13294 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
13295 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
13296 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
13297
13298 @smallexample
13299 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
13300 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
13301 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
13302 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
13303 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
13304 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
13305 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
13306 $7 = 72 '\110'
13307 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
13308 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
13309 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
13310 $9 = 200 'H'
13311 (@value{GDBP})
13312 @end smallexample
13313
13314 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
13315 string literals you use in expressions:
13316
13317 @smallexample
13318 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
13319 $10 = 78 '+'
13320 (@value{GDBP})
13321 @end smallexample
13322
13323 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
13324 character.
13325
13326 @node Caching Target Data
13327 @section Caching Data of Targets
13328 @cindex caching data of targets
13329
13330 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
13331 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
13332 @xref{Inferiors Connections and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
13333 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
13334 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
13335 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
13336 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
13337 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
13338 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
13339 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
13340 is executing.
13341 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
13342 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
13343 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
13344 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
13345 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
13346 in the code segment.
13347 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
13348 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
13349
13350 @table @code
13351 @kindex set remotecache
13352 @item set remotecache on
13353 @itemx set remotecache off
13354 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
13355 with old scripts.
13356
13357 @kindex show remotecache
13358 @item show remotecache
13359 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
13360
13361 @kindex set stack-cache
13362 @item set stack-cache on
13363 @itemx set stack-cache off
13364 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
13365 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
13366
13367 @kindex show stack-cache
13368 @item show stack-cache
13369 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
13370
13371 @kindex set code-cache
13372 @item set code-cache on
13373 @itemx set code-cache off
13374 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
13375 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
13376 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
13377
13378 @kindex show code-cache
13379 @item show code-cache
13380 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
13381 accesses.
13382
13383 @kindex info dcache
13384 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
13385 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
13386 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
13387 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
13388 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
13389 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
13390
13391 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
13392 printed in hex.
13393
13394 @item set dcache size @var{size}
13395 @cindex dcache size
13396 @kindex set dcache size
13397 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
13398
13399 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
13400 @cindex dcache line-size
13401 @kindex set dcache line-size
13402 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
13403 Must be a power of 2.
13404
13405 @item show dcache size
13406 @kindex show dcache size
13407 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
13408
13409 @item show dcache line-size
13410 @kindex show dcache line-size
13411 Show default size of dcache lines.
13412
13413 @item maint flush dcache
13414 @cindex dcache, flushing
13415 @kindex maint flush dcache
13416 Flush the contents (if any) of the dcache. This maintainer command is
13417 useful when debugging the dcache implementation.
13418
13419 @end table
13420
13421 @node Searching Memory
13422 @section Search Memory
13423 @cindex searching memory
13424
13425 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
13426 @code{find} command.
13427
13428 @table @code
13429 @kindex find
13430 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
13431 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
13432 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
13433 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
13434 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
13435 @end table
13436
13437 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
13438 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
13439
13440 @table @r
13441 @item @var{s}, search query size
13442 The size of each search query value.
13443
13444 @table @code
13445 @item b
13446 bytes
13447 @item h
13448 halfwords (two bytes)
13449 @item w
13450 words (four bytes)
13451 @item g
13452 giant words (eight bytes)
13453 @end table
13454
13455 All values are interpreted in the current language.
13456 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
13457 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
13458 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
13459 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
13460
13461 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
13462 value's type in the current language.
13463 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
13464 pattern as a mixture of types.
13465 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
13466 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
13467 which is typically four bytes.
13468
13469 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
13470 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
13471 @end table
13472
13473 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
13474 (@code{"}).
13475 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
13476 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
13477
13478 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
13479 number of matches found.
13480
13481 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
13482 @samp{$_}.
13483 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
13484
13485 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
13486
13487 @smallexample
13488 void
13489 hello ()
13490 @{
13491 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
13492 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
13493 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
13494 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
13495 printf ("%s\n", hello);
13496 @}
13497 @end smallexample
13498
13499 @noindent
13500 you get during debugging:
13501
13502 @smallexample
13503 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
13504 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13505 1 pattern found
13506 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
13507 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13508 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13509 2 patterns found.
13510 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
13511 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13512 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13513 2 patterns found.
13514 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
13515 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13516 1 pattern found
13517 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
13518 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
13519 1 pattern found
13520 (gdb) print $numfound
13521 $1 = 1
13522 (gdb) print $_
13523 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
13524 @end smallexample
13525
13526 @node Value Sizes
13527 @section Value Sizes
13528
13529 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
13530 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
13531 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
13532 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
13533 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large amount of memory.
13534
13535 @table @code
13536 @kindex set max-value-size
13537 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
13538 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
13539 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
13540 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
13541 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
13542
13543 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
13544 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
13545
13546 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
13547 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
13548 currently 16 bytes.
13549
13550 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
13551 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
13552 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
13553 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
13554 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
13555 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
13556 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
13557 size is less than @var{bytes}.
13558
13559 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
13560
13561 @kindex show max-value-size
13562 @item show max-value-size
13563 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
13564 allocate for the contents of a value.
13565 @end table
13566
13567 @node Optimized Code
13568 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
13569 @cindex optimized code, debugging
13570 @cindex debugging optimized code
13571
13572 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
13573 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
13574 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
13575 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
13576 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
13577 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
13578 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
13579
13580 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
13581 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
13582 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
13583 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
13584
13585 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
13586 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
13587 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
13588 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
13589 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
13590 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
13591
13592 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
13593 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
13594 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
13595 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
13596 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
13597
13598 @menu
13599 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
13600 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
13601 @end menu
13602
13603 @node Inline Functions
13604 @section Inline Functions
13605 @cindex inline functions, debugging
13606
13607 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
13608 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
13609 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
13610 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
13611 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
13612 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
13613 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
13614 @code{info frame} command.
13615
13616 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
13617 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
13618 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
13619 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
13620 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
13621 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
13622 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
13623 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
13624 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
13625 local variables in the caller.
13626
13627 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
13628 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
13629 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
13630 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
13631 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
13632 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
13633 instructions are executed.
13634
13635 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
13636 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
13637 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
13638 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
13639
13640 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
13641 function calls are the same as normal calls:
13642
13643 @itemize @bullet
13644 @item
13645 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
13646 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
13647 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
13648 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
13649 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
13650 or inside the inlined function instead.
13651
13652 @item
13653 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
13654 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
13655 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
13656 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
13657
13658 @end itemize
13659
13660 @node Tail Call Frames
13661 @section Tail Call Frames
13662 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
13663
13664 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
13665 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
13666 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
13667 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
13668 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
13669
13670 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
13671 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
13672 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
13673 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
13674 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
13675 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
13676 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
13677
13678 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
13679 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
13680 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
13681 this information.
13682
13683 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
13684 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
13685
13686 @smallexample
13687 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
13688 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
13689 (gdb) info frame
13690 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
13691 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
13692 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
13693 source language c++.
13694 Arglist at unknown address.
13695 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
13696 @end smallexample
13697
13698 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
13699 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
13700 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
13701 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
13702 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
13703 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
13704
13705 @table @code
13706 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
13707 @item set debug entry-values
13708 @kindex set debug entry-values
13709 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
13710 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
13711 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
13712 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
13713 result.
13714
13715 @item show debug entry-values
13716 @kindex show debug entry-values
13717 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
13718 values at function entry and tail calls.
13719 @end table
13720
13721 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
13722 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
13723 reference by variable @code{x}):
13724
13725 @smallexample
13726 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
13727 void (*x) (void) = c;
13728 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
13729 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
13730 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
13731
13732 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
13733 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
13734 a () at t.c:3
13735 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
13736 (gdb) bt
13737 #0 a () at t.c:3
13738 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
13739 @end smallexample
13740
13741 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
13742
13743 @smallexample
13744 int i;
13745 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
13746 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
13747 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
13748 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
13749 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
13750 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
13751 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
13752 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
13753
13754 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
13755 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
13756 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
13757 (gdb) bt
13758 #0 f () at t.c:2
13759 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
13760 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
13761 @end smallexample
13762
13763 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
13764 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
13765
13766 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
13767 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
13768 @set ARROW @click{}
13769 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
13770 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
13771 @end ifset
13772 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
13773 @set ARROW ->
13774 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
13775 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
13776 @end ifclear
13777
13778 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
13779 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
13780 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
13781
13782 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
13783 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequence - that one is
13784 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
13785 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
13786 further @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
13787 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
13788
13789 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
13790 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
13791 also ambiguous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
13792 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
13793 omitted.
13794
13795 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
13796 entry may fail:
13797
13798 @smallexample
13799 int v;
13800 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
13801 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
13802 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
13803 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
13804 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
13805 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
13806
13807 (gdb) bt
13808 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
13809 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
13810 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
13811 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
13812 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
13813 @end smallexample
13814
13815 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
13816 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
13817 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify the @code{i} variable, therefore
13818 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
13819 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
13820
13821 @node Macros
13822 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
13823
13824 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
13825 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
13826 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
13827 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
13828 where it was defined.
13829
13830 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
13831 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
13832 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
13833 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
13834
13835 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
13836 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
13837 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
13838 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
13839 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
13840 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
13841 see @ref{List}.
13842
13843 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
13844 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
13845 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
13846
13847 @table @code
13848
13849 @kindex macro expand
13850 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
13851 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
13852 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
13853 @item macro expand @var{expression}
13854 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
13855 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
13856 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
13857 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
13858 it can be any string of tokens.
13859
13860 @kindex macro exp1
13861 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
13862 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
13863 @cindex expand macro once
13864 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
13865 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
13866 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
13867 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
13868 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
13869 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
13870 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
13871 can be any string of tokens.
13872
13873 @kindex info macro
13874 @cindex macro definition, showing
13875 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
13876 @cindex macros, from debug info
13877 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
13878 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
13879 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
13880 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
13881 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
13882 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
13883
13884 @kindex info macros
13885 @item info macros @var{location}
13886 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
13887 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
13888 command-line where those definitions were established.
13889
13890 @kindex macro define
13891 @cindex user-defined macros
13892 @cindex defining macros interactively
13893 @cindex macros, user-defined
13894 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
13895 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
13896 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
13897 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
13898 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
13899 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
13900 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
13901 @var{arglist}.
13902
13903 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
13904 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
13905 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
13906 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
13907 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
13908
13909 @kindex macro undef
13910 @item macro undef @var{macro}
13911 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
13912 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
13913 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
13914 in the program being debugged.
13915
13916 @kindex macro list
13917 @item macro list
13918 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
13919 @end table
13920
13921 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
13922 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
13923 show our source files:
13924
13925 @smallexample
13926 $ cat sample.c
13927 #include <stdio.h>
13928 #include "sample.h"
13929
13930 #define M 42
13931 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13932
13933 main ()
13934 @{
13935 #define N 28
13936 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13937 #undef N
13938 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13939 #define N 1729
13940 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
13941 @}
13942 $ cat sample.h
13943 #define Q <
13944 $
13945 @end smallexample
13946
13947 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
13948 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
13949 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
13950 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
13951 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
13952 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
13953 information.
13954
13955 @smallexample
13956 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
13957 $
13958 @end smallexample
13959
13960 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
13961
13962 @smallexample
13963 $ gdb -nw sample
13964 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
13965 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13966 GDB is free software, @dots{}
13967 (@value{GDBP})
13968 @end smallexample
13969
13970 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
13971 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
13972 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
13973
13974 @smallexample
13975 (@value{GDBP}) list main
13976 3
13977 4 #define M 42
13978 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13979 6
13980 7 main ()
13981 8 @{
13982 9 #define N 28
13983 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13984 11 #undef N
13985 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13986 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
13987 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
13988 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13989 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
13990 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
13991 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
13992 #define Q <
13993 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
13994 expands to: (42 + 1)
13995 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
13996 expands to: once (M + 1)
13997 (@value{GDBP})
13998 @end smallexample
13999
14000 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
14001 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
14002 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
14003 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
14004
14005 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
14006 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
14007
14008 @smallexample
14009 (@value{GDBP}) break main
14010 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
14011 (@value{GDBP}) run
14012 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
14013
14014 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
14015 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
14016 (@value{GDBP})
14017 @end smallexample
14018
14019 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
14020
14021 @smallexample
14022 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
14023 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
14024 #define N 28
14025 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
14026 expands to: 28 < 42
14027 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
14028 $1 = 1
14029 (@value{GDBP})
14030 @end smallexample
14031
14032 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
14033 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
14034 thereof) in force at each point:
14035
14036 @smallexample
14037 (@value{GDBP}) next
14038 Hello, world!
14039 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
14040 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
14041 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
14042 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
14043 (@value{GDBP}) next
14044 We're so creative.
14045 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
14046 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
14047 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
14048 #define N 1729
14049 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
14050 expands to: 1729 < 42
14051 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
14052 $2 = 0
14053 (@value{GDBP})
14054 @end smallexample
14055
14056 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
14057 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
14058 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
14059 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
14060
14061 @smallexample
14062 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
14063 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
14064 -D__STDC__=1
14065 (@value{GDBP})
14066 @end smallexample
14067
14068
14069 @node Tracepoints
14070 @chapter Tracepoints
14071 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
14072 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
14073
14074 @cindex tracepoints
14075 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
14076 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
14077 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
14078 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
14079 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
14080 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
14081 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
14082
14083 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
14084 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
14085 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
14086 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
14087 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
14088 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
14089 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
14090 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
14091 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
14092 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
14093 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
14094
14095 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
14096 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
14097 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
14098 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
14099 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
14100 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
14101 Packets}.
14102
14103 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
14104 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
14105 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
14106
14107 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
14108
14109 @menu
14110 * Set Tracepoints::
14111 * Analyze Collected Data::
14112 * Tracepoint Variables::
14113 * Trace Files::
14114 @end menu
14115
14116 @node Set Tracepoints
14117 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
14118
14119 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
14120 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
14121 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
14122 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
14123 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
14124 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
14125 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
14126
14127 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
14128 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
14129 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
14130 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
14131 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
14132 tracepoint was hit.
14133
14134 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
14135 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
14136 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
14137 either.
14138
14139 @cindex fast tracepoints
14140 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
14141 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
14142 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
14143
14144 @cindex static tracepoints
14145 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
14146 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
14147 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
14148 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
14149 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
14150 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
14151 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
14152 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
14153 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
14154 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
14155 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
14156 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
14157 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
14158 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
14159 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
14160 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
14161 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
14162 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
14163 static tracepoint marker.
14164
14165 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
14166 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
14167
14168 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
14169 conditions and actions.
14170
14171 @menu
14172 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
14173 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
14174 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
14175 * Tracepoint Conditions::
14176 * Trace State Variables::
14177 * Tracepoint Actions::
14178 * Listing Tracepoints::
14179 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
14180 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
14181 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
14182 @end menu
14183
14184 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
14185 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
14186
14187 @table @code
14188 @cindex set tracepoint
14189 @kindex trace
14190 @item trace @var{location}
14191 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
14192 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
14193 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
14194 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
14195 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
14196 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
14197 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
14198 in tracing}).
14199 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
14200 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
14201 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
14202 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
14203 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
14204 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
14205 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
14206 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
14207 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
14208 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
14209 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
14210 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
14211
14212 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
14213
14214 @smallexample
14215 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
14216
14217 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
14218
14219 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
14220
14221 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
14222
14223 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
14224 @end smallexample
14225
14226 @noindent
14227 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
14228
14229 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
14230 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
14231 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
14232 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
14233 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
14234 information on tracepoint conditions.
14235
14236 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
14237 @cindex set fast tracepoint
14238 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
14239 @kindex ftrace
14240 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
14241 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
14242 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
14243 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
14244 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
14245 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
14246 message.
14247
14248 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
14249 @code{trace}.
14250
14251 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
14252 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
14253 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
14254 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
14255 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
14256 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
14257 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
14258 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
14259
14260 @example
14261 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
14262 @end example
14263
14264 @noindent
14265 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
14266 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
14267
14268 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
14269 @cindex set static tracepoint
14270 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
14271 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
14272 @kindex strace
14273 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
14274 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
14275 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
14276 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
14277 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
14278
14279 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
14280 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
14281 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
14282 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
14283 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
14284 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
14285 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
14286 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
14287 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
14288 tracing engine:
14289
14290 @smallexample
14291 main ()
14292 @{
14293 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
14294 @}
14295 @end smallexample
14296
14297 @noindent
14298 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
14299 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
14300
14301 @smallexample
14302 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
14303 Cnt Enb ID Address What
14304 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
14305 Data: "str %s"
14306 [etc...]
14307 @end smallexample
14308
14309 @noindent
14310 so you may probe the marker above with:
14311
14312 @smallexample
14313 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
14314 @end smallexample
14315
14316 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
14317 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
14318 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
14319 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
14320 string. The user data is then the result of running that formatting
14321 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
14322 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
14323 the @samp{Data:} field.
14324
14325 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
14326 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
14327 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
14328
14329 @vindex $tpnum
14330 @cindex last tracepoint number
14331 @cindex recent tracepoint number
14332 @cindex tracepoint number
14333 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
14334 of the most recently set tracepoint.
14335
14336 @kindex delete tracepoint
14337 @cindex tracepoint deletion
14338 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
14339 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
14340 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
14341 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
14342
14343 Examples:
14344
14345 @smallexample
14346 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
14347
14348 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
14349 @end smallexample
14350
14351 @noindent
14352 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
14353 @end table
14354
14355 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
14356 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
14357
14358 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
14359
14360 @table @code
14361 @kindex disable tracepoint
14362 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
14363 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
14364 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
14365 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
14366 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
14367 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
14368 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
14369 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
14370 next trace experiment.
14371
14372 @kindex enable tracepoint
14373 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
14374 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
14375 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
14376 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
14377 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
14378 next time a trace experiment is run.
14379 @end table
14380
14381 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
14382 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
14383
14384 @table @code
14385 @kindex passcount
14386 @cindex tracepoint pass count
14387 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
14388 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
14389 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
14390 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
14391 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
14392 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
14393 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
14394 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
14395 user.
14396
14397 Examples:
14398
14399 @smallexample
14400 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
14401 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
14402
14403 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
14404 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
14405 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
14406 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
14407 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
14408 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
14409 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
14410 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
14411 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
14412 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
14413 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
14414 @end smallexample
14415 @end table
14416
14417 @node Tracepoint Conditions
14418 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
14419 @cindex conditional tracepoints
14420 @cindex tracepoint conditions
14421
14422 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
14423 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
14424 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
14425 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
14426 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
14427 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
14428 is true.
14429
14430 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
14431 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
14432 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
14433 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
14434 just as with breakpoints.
14435
14436 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
14437 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
14438 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
14439 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
14440 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
14441 accesses, and so forth.
14442
14443 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
14444 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
14445 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
14446 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
14447 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
14448 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
14449 search through.
14450
14451 @smallexample
14452 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
14453 @end smallexample
14454
14455 @node Trace State Variables
14456 @subsection Trace State Variables
14457 @cindex trace state variables
14458
14459 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
14460 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
14461 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
14462 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
14463 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
14464 integers.
14465
14466 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
14467 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
14468 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
14469 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
14470
14471 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
14472 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
14473 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
14474 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
14475 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
14476 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
14477 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
14478 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
14479 variable with the same name.
14480
14481 @table @code
14482
14483 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
14484 @kindex tvariable
14485 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
14486 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
14487 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
14488 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
14489 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
14490 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
14491 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
14492 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
14493 value. The default initial value is 0.
14494
14495 @item info tvariables
14496 @kindex info tvariables
14497 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
14498 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
14499 currently running.
14500
14501 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
14502 @kindex delete tvariable
14503 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
14504 are specified.
14505
14506 @end table
14507
14508 @node Tracepoint Actions
14509 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
14510
14511 @table @code
14512 @kindex actions
14513 @cindex tracepoint actions
14514 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
14515 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
14516 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
14517 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
14518 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
14519 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
14520 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
14521 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
14522 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
14523 @code{while-stepping}.
14524
14525 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
14526 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
14527 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
14528
14529 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
14530 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
14531 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
14532
14533 @smallexample
14534 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
14535
14536 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
14537
14538 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
14539 @end smallexample
14540
14541 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
14542 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
14543 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
14544 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
14545 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
14546 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
14547 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
14548 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
14549
14550 @smallexample
14551 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
14552 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14553 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
14554 > collect bar,baz
14555 > collect $regs
14556 > while-stepping 12
14557 > collect $pc, arr[i]
14558 > end
14559 end
14560 @end smallexample
14561
14562 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
14563 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14564 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
14565 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
14566 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
14567 special arguments are supported:
14568
14569 @table @code
14570 @item $regs
14571 Collect all registers.
14572
14573 @item $args
14574 Collect all function arguments.
14575
14576 @item $locals
14577 Collect all local variables.
14578
14579 @item $_ret
14580 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
14581 of a backtrace.
14582
14583 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
14584 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
14585 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
14586 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
14587 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
14588 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
14589
14590 @item $_probe_argc
14591 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
14592 tracepoint is located.
14593 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
14594
14595 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
14596 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
14597 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
14598 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
14599
14600 @item $_sdata
14601 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
14602 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
14603 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
14604 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
14605 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
14606 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
14607 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
14608 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
14609 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
14610
14611 @smallexample
14612 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
14613 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
14614 @end smallexample
14615
14616 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
14617 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
14618 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
14619 @value{GDBN}.
14620 @end table
14621
14622 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
14623 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
14624 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
14625
14626 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
14627 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
14628 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
14629 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
14630 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
14631 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
14632 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
14633 @samp{mystr}.
14634
14635 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
14636 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
14637
14638 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
14639 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14640 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
14641 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
14642 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
14643 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
14644 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
14645 action were used.
14646
14647 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
14648 @item while-stepping @var{n}
14649 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
14650 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
14651 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
14652 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
14653
14654 @smallexample
14655 > while-stepping 12
14656 > collect $regs, myglobal
14657 > end
14658 >
14659 @end smallexample
14660
14661 @noindent
14662 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
14663 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
14664 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
14665 @code{stepping}.
14666
14667 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14668 @kindex set default-collect
14669 @cindex default collection action
14670 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
14671 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
14672 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
14673 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
14674 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
14675 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
14676
14677 @item show default-collect
14678 @kindex show default-collect
14679 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
14680 tracepoint hit.
14681
14682 @end table
14683
14684 @node Listing Tracepoints
14685 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
14686
14687 @table @code
14688 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
14689 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
14690 @cindex information about tracepoints
14691 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
14692 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
14693 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
14694 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
14695 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
14696 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
14697
14698 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
14699 tracing:
14700
14701 @itemize @bullet
14702 @item
14703 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
14704
14705 @item
14706 the state about installed on target of each location
14707 @end itemize
14708
14709 @smallexample
14710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
14711 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
14712 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
14713 while-stepping 20
14714 collect globfoo, $regs
14715 end
14716 collect globfoo2
14717 end
14718 pass count 1200
14719 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
14720 collect $eip
14721 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
14722 installed on target
14723 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
14724 installed on target
14725 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
14726 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
14727 not installed on target
14728 (@value{GDBP})
14729 @end smallexample
14730
14731 @noindent
14732 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
14733 @end table
14734
14735 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
14736 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
14737
14738 @table @code
14739 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
14740 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
14741 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
14742 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
14743 program.
14744
14745 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
14746
14747 @table @emph
14748 @item Count
14749 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
14750 stable identifier.
14751 @item ID
14752 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
14753 @item Enabled or Disabled
14754 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
14755 that are not enabled.
14756 @item Address
14757 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
14758 @item What
14759 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
14760 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
14761 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
14762 will be left blank.
14763 @end table
14764
14765 @noindent
14766 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
14767
14768 @table @emph
14769 @item Data
14770 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
14771 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
14772 marker call.
14773 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
14774 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
14775 @end table
14776
14777 @smallexample
14778 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
14779 Cnt ID Enb Address What
14780 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
14781 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
14782 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
14783 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
14784 Data: str %s
14785 (@value{GDBP})
14786 @end smallexample
14787 @end table
14788
14789 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
14790 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
14791
14792 @table @code
14793 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
14794 @cindex start a new trace experiment
14795 @cindex collected data discarded
14796 @item tstart
14797 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
14798 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
14799 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
14800 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
14801 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
14802 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
14803 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
14804 information, and so forth.
14805
14806 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
14807 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
14808 @item tstop
14809 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
14810 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
14811 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
14812 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
14813 needs to be stopped quickly.
14814
14815 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
14816 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
14817 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
14818
14819 @kindex tstatus
14820 @cindex status of trace data collection
14821 @cindex trace experiment, status of
14822 @item tstatus
14823 This command displays the status of the current trace data
14824 collection.
14825 @end table
14826
14827 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
14828
14829 @smallexample
14830 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
14831 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14832 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
14833 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
14834 > while-stepping 11
14835 > collect $regs
14836 > end
14837 > end
14838 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14839 [time passes @dots{}]
14840 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
14841 @end smallexample
14842
14843 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
14844 @cindex disconnected tracing
14845 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
14846 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
14847 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
14848 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
14849 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
14850 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
14851 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
14852 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
14853
14854 @table @code
14855 @item set disconnected-tracing on
14856 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
14857 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
14858 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
14859 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
14860 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
14861 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
14862 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
14863
14864 @item show disconnected-tracing
14865 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
14866 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
14867
14868 @end table
14869
14870 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
14871 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
14872 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
14873 it will continue after reconnection.
14874
14875 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
14876 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
14877 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
14878 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
14879 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
14880 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
14881 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
14882 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
14883 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
14884 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
14885
14886 @cindex circular trace buffer
14887 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
14888 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
14889 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
14890 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
14891 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
14892 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
14893 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
14894 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
14895 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
14896 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
14897 the next run.
14898
14899 @table @code
14900 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
14901 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
14902 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
14903 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
14904 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
14905 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
14906 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
14907
14908 @item show circular-trace-buffer
14909 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
14910 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
14911 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
14912 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
14913 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
14914
14915 @end table
14916
14917 @table @code
14918 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
14919 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
14920 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
14921 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
14922 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
14923 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
14924 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
14925 likes. This is also the default.
14926
14927 @item show trace-buffer-size
14928 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
14929 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
14930 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
14931 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
14932 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
14933 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
14934 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
14935 @end table
14936
14937 @table @code
14938 @item set trace-user @var{text}
14939 @kindex set trace-user
14940
14941 @item show trace-user
14942 @kindex show trace-user
14943
14944 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
14945 @kindex set trace-notes
14946 Set the trace run's notes.
14947
14948 @item show trace-notes
14949 @kindex show trace-notes
14950 Show the trace run's notes.
14951
14952 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
14953 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
14954 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
14955 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
14956 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
14957
14958 @item show trace-stop-notes
14959 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
14960 Show the trace run's stop notes.
14961
14962 @end table
14963
14964 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
14965 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
14966
14967 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
14968 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
14969 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
14970 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
14971 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
14972 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
14973 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
14974 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
14975 mentioned here.
14976
14977 @itemize @bullet
14978
14979 @item
14980 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
14981 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
14982 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
14983 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
14984 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
14985 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
14986 cannot be collected either.
14987
14988 @item
14989 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
14990 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
14991 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
14992 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
14993 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
14994 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
14995 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
14996 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
14997 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
14998 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
14999
15000 @item
15001 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
15002 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
15003 in a misleading way.
15004
15005 @item
15006 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
15007 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
15008 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
15009 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
15010 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
15011 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
15012 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
15013 by @code{ptr}.
15014
15015 @item
15016 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
15017 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
15018 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
15019 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
15020 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
15021 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
15022 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
15023 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
15024 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
15025 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
15026 invalid address.
15027
15028 @item
15029 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
15030 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
15031 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
15032 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
15033 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
15034 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
15035 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
15036 it to zero.
15037
15038 @end itemize
15039
15040 @node Analyze Collected Data
15041 @section Using the Collected Data
15042
15043 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
15044 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
15045 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
15046 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
15047 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
15048 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
15049 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
15050 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
15051 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
15052 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
15053 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
15054 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
15055 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
15056 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
15057 the buffer will fail.
15058
15059 @menu
15060 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
15061 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
15062 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
15063 @end menu
15064
15065 @node tfind
15066 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
15067
15068 @kindex tfind
15069 @cindex select trace snapshot
15070 @cindex find trace snapshot
15071 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
15072 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
15073 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
15074 snapshot is selected.
15075
15076 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
15077
15078 @table @code
15079 @item tfind start
15080 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
15081 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
15082
15083 @item tfind none
15084 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
15085
15086 @item tfind end
15087 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
15088
15089 @item tfind
15090 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
15091 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
15092
15093 @item tfind -
15094 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
15095 retracing earlier steps.
15096
15097 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
15098 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
15099 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
15100 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
15101 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
15102
15103 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
15104 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
15105 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
15106 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
15107 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
15108
15109 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
15110 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
15111 addresses (exclusive).
15112
15113 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
15114 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
15115 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
15116
15117 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
15118 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
15119 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
15120 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
15121 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
15122 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
15123 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
15124 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
15125 @end table
15126
15127 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
15128 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
15129 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
15130 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
15131 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
15132 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
15133 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
15134 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
15135 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
15136 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
15137 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
15138 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
15139 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
15140 tracepoint as the current one.
15141
15142 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
15143 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
15144 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
15145 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
15146 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
15147
15148 @smallexample
15149 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
15150 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
15151 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
15152 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
15153 > tfind
15154 > end
15155
15156 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
15157 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
15158 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
15159 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
15160 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
15161 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
15162 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
15163 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
15164 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
15165 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
15166 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
15167 @end smallexample
15168
15169 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
15170 the buffer:
15171
15172 @smallexample
15173 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
15174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
15175 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
15176 > tfind line
15177 > end
15178
15179 Frame 0, X = 1
15180 Frame 7, X = 2
15181 Frame 13, X = 255
15182 @end smallexample
15183
15184 @node tdump
15185 @subsection @code{tdump}
15186 @kindex tdump
15187 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
15188 @cindex tracepoint data, display
15189
15190 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
15191 the current trace snapshot.
15192
15193 @smallexample
15194 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
15195 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
15196 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
15197 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
15198 > end
15199
15200 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
15201
15202 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
15203 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
15204 at gdb_test.c:444
15205 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
15206
15207 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
15208 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
15209 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
15210 d1 0x18 24
15211 d2 0x80 128
15212 d3 0x33 51
15213 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
15214 d5 0x22 34
15215 d6 0xe0 224
15216 d7 0x380035 3670069
15217 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
15218 a1 0x3000668 50333288
15219 a2 0x100 256
15220 a3 0x322000 3284992
15221 a4 0x3000698 50333336
15222 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
15223 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
15224 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
15225 ps 0x0 0
15226 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
15227 fpcontrol 0x0 0
15228 fpstatus 0x0 0
15229 fpiaddr 0x0 0
15230 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
15231 p1 = (void *) 0x11
15232 p2 = (void *) 0x22
15233 p3 = (void *) 0x33
15234 p4 = (void *) 0x44
15235 p5 = (void *) 0x55
15236 p6 = (void *) 0x66
15237 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
15238
15239 (@value{GDBP})
15240 @end smallexample
15241
15242 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
15243 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
15244 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
15245 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
15246
15247 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
15248 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
15249 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
15250 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
15251 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
15252 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
15253 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
15254 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
15255 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
15256 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
15257
15258 @node save tracepoints
15259 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
15260 @kindex save tracepoints
15261 @kindex save-tracepoints
15262 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
15263
15264 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
15265 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
15266 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
15267 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
15268 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
15269 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
15270
15271 @node Tracepoint Variables
15272 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
15273 @cindex tracepoint variables
15274 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
15275
15276 @table @code
15277 @vindex $trace_frame
15278 @item (int) $trace_frame
15279 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
15280 snapshot is selected.
15281
15282 @vindex $tracepoint
15283 @item (int) $tracepoint
15284 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
15285
15286 @vindex $trace_line
15287 @item (int) $trace_line
15288 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
15289
15290 @vindex $trace_file
15291 @item (char []) $trace_file
15292 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
15293
15294 @vindex $trace_func
15295 @item (char []) $trace_func
15296 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
15297 @end table
15298
15299 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
15300 use @code{output} instead.
15301
15302 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
15303 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
15304 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
15305 which are managed by the target.
15306
15307 @smallexample
15308 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
15309
15310 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
15311 > output $trace_file
15312 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
15313 > tfind
15314 > end
15315 @end smallexample
15316
15317 @node Trace Files
15318 @section Using Trace Files
15319 @cindex trace files
15320
15321 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
15322 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
15323 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
15324 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
15325 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
15326
15327 @table @code
15328
15329 @kindex tsave
15330 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
15331 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
15332 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
15333 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
15334 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
15335 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
15336 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
15337 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
15338 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
15339 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
15340 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
15341 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
15342 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
15343 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
15344 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
15345
15346 @kindex target tfile
15347 @kindex tfile
15348 @kindex target ctf
15349 @kindex ctf
15350 @item target tfile @var{filename}
15351 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
15352 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
15353 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
15354 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
15355 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
15356 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
15357 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
15358 the host.
15359
15360 @smallexample
15361 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
15362 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
15363 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
15364 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
15365 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
15366 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
15367 i = 0
15368 a = 0
15369 b = 1 '\001'
15370 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
15371 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
15372 (@value{GDBP}) p b
15373 $1 = 1
15374 @end smallexample
15375
15376 @end table
15377
15378 @node Overlays
15379 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
15380 @cindex overlays
15381
15382 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
15383 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
15384 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
15385 use overlays.
15386
15387 @menu
15388 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
15389 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
15390 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
15391 mapped by asking the inferior.
15392 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
15393 @end menu
15394
15395 @node How Overlays Work
15396 @section How Overlays Work
15397 @cindex mapped overlays
15398 @cindex unmapped overlays
15399 @cindex load address, overlay's
15400 @cindex mapped address
15401 @cindex overlay area
15402
15403 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
15404 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
15405 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
15406 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
15407 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
15408
15409 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
15410 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
15411 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
15412 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
15413 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
15414 largest overlay as well.
15415
15416 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
15417 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
15418 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
15419 there.
15420
15421 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
15422 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
15423 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
15424
15425 @smallexample
15426 @group
15427 Data Instruction Larger
15428 Address Space Address Space Address Space
15429 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
15430 | | | | | |
15431 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
15432 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
15433 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
15434 | and heap | | | | | |
15435 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
15436 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
15437 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
15438 | | | | | |
15439 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
15440 address | | | | | |
15441 | overlay | <-' | | |
15442 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
15443 | | <---. | | load address
15444 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
15445 | | | |
15446 +-----------+ | |
15447 +-----------+
15448 | |
15449 +-----------+
15450
15451 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
15452 @end group
15453 @end smallexample
15454
15455 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
15456 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
15457 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
15458 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
15459 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
15460 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
15461 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
15462 program and the overlay area.
15463
15464 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
15465 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
15466 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
15467 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
15468 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
15469 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
15470 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
15471
15472 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
15473 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
15474 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
15475
15476 @itemize @bullet
15477
15478 @item
15479 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
15480 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
15481 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
15482 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
15483
15484 @item
15485 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
15486 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
15487 your program's performance.
15488
15489 @item
15490 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
15491 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
15492 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
15493 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
15494 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
15495 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
15496 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
15497
15498 @item
15499 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
15500 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
15501 instruction and data spaces.
15502
15503 @end itemize
15504
15505 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
15506 improved in many ways:
15507
15508 @itemize @bullet
15509
15510 @item
15511 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
15512 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
15513 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
15514 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
15515 area in the usual way.
15516
15517 @item
15518 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
15519 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
15520
15521 @item
15522 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
15523 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
15524 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
15525 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
15526 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
15527 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
15528 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
15529
15530 @end itemize
15531
15532
15533 @node Overlay Commands
15534 @section Overlay Commands
15535
15536 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
15537 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
15538 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
15539 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
15540 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
15541 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
15542
15543 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
15544 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
15545
15546 @table @code
15547 @item overlay off
15548 @kindex overlay
15549 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
15550 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
15551 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
15552 overlay support is disabled.
15553
15554 @item overlay manual
15555 @cindex manual overlay debugging
15556 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
15557 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
15558 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
15559 commands described below.
15560
15561 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
15562 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
15563 @cindex map an overlay
15564 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
15565 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
15566 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
15567 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
15568 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
15569 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
15570
15571 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
15572 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
15573 @cindex unmap an overlay
15574 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
15575 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
15576 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
15577 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
15578
15579 @item overlay auto
15580 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
15581 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
15582 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
15583 Overlay Debugging}.
15584
15585 @item overlay load-target
15586 @itemx overlay load
15587 @cindex reloading the overlay table
15588 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
15589 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
15590 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
15591 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
15592 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
15593
15594 @item overlay list-overlays
15595 @itemx overlay list
15596 @cindex listing mapped overlays
15597 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
15598 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
15599
15600 @end table
15601
15602 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
15603 of the function the address falls in:
15604
15605 @smallexample
15606 (@value{GDBP}) print main
15607 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
15608 @end smallexample
15609 @noindent
15610 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
15611 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
15612 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
15613 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
15614
15615 @smallexample
15616 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
15617 No sections are mapped.
15618 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
15619 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
15620 @end smallexample
15621 @noindent
15622 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
15623 name normally:
15624
15625 @smallexample
15626 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
15627 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
15628 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
15629 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
15630 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
15631 @end smallexample
15632
15633 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
15634 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
15635 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
15636 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
15637 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
15638
15639 @itemize @bullet
15640 @item
15641 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
15642 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
15643 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
15644 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
15645 @item
15646 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
15647 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
15648 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
15649 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
15650 breakpoints properly.
15651 @end itemize
15652
15653
15654 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
15655 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
15656 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
15657
15658 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
15659 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
15660 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
15661 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
15662 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
15663 current state of the overlays.
15664
15665 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
15666 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
15667
15668 @table @asis
15669
15670 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
15671 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
15672
15673 @smallexample
15674 struct
15675 @{
15676 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
15677 unsigned long vma;
15678
15679 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
15680 unsigned long size;
15681
15682 /* The overlay's load address. */
15683 unsigned long lma;
15684
15685 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
15686 zero otherwise. */
15687 unsigned long mapped;
15688 @}
15689 @end smallexample
15690
15691 @item @code{_novlys}:
15692 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
15693 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
15694
15695 @end table
15696
15697 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
15698 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
15699 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
15700 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
15701 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
15702 currently mapped.
15703
15704 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
15705 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
15706 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
15707 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
15708 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
15709 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
15710 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
15711 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
15712 are not being executed.
15713
15714 @node Overlay Sample Program
15715 @section Overlay Sample Program
15716 @cindex overlay example program
15717
15718 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
15719 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
15720 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
15721 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
15722 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
15723 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
15724 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
15725
15726 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
15727 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
15728 suite. The program consists of the following files from
15729 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
15730
15731 @table @file
15732 @item overlays.c
15733 The main program file.
15734 @item ovlymgr.c
15735 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
15736 @item foo.c
15737 @itemx bar.c
15738 @itemx baz.c
15739 @itemx grbx.c
15740 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
15741 @item d10v.ld
15742 @itemx m32r.ld
15743 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
15744 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
15745 @end table
15746
15747 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
15748 cross-compiler like this:
15749
15750 @smallexample
15751 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
15752 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
15753 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
15754 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
15755 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
15756 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
15757 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
15758 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
15759 @end smallexample
15760
15761 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
15762 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
15763 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
15764
15765
15766 @node Languages
15767 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
15768 @cindex languages
15769
15770 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
15771 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
15772 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
15773 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
15774 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
15775 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
15776
15777 @cindex working language
15778 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
15779 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
15780 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
15781 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
15782 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
15783 language}.
15784
15785 @menu
15786 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
15787 * Show:: Displaying the language
15788 * Checks:: Type and range checks
15789 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
15790 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
15791 @end menu
15792
15793 @node Setting
15794 @section Switching Between Source Languages
15795
15796 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
15797 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
15798 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
15799 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
15800 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
15801 are printed, etc.
15802
15803 In addition to the working language, every source file that
15804 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
15805 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
15806 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
15807 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
15808 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
15809 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
15810 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
15811 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
15812 Displaying the Language}.
15813
15814 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
15815 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
15816 another language. In that case, make the
15817 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
15818 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
15819 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
15820
15821 @menu
15822 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
15823 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
15824 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
15825 @end menu
15826
15827 @node Filenames
15828 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
15829
15830 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
15831 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
15832
15833 @table @file
15834 @item .ada
15835 @itemx .ads
15836 @itemx .adb
15837 @itemx .a
15838 Ada source file.
15839
15840 @item .c
15841 C source file
15842
15843 @item .C
15844 @itemx .cc
15845 @itemx .cp
15846 @itemx .cpp
15847 @itemx .cxx
15848 @itemx .c++
15849 C@t{++} source file
15850
15851 @item .d
15852 D source file
15853
15854 @item .m
15855 Objective-C source file
15856
15857 @item .f
15858 @itemx .F
15859 Fortran source file
15860
15861 @item .mod
15862 Modula-2 source file
15863
15864 @item .s
15865 @itemx .S
15866 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
15867 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
15868 @end table
15869
15870 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
15871 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
15872
15873 @node Manually
15874 @subsection Setting the Working Language
15875
15876 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
15877 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
15878 your program.
15879
15880 @kindex set language
15881 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
15882 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
15883 a language, such as
15884 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
15885 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
15886
15887 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
15888 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
15889 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
15890 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
15891 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
15892 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
15893 command such as:
15894
15895 @smallexample
15896 print a = b + c
15897 @end smallexample
15898
15899 @noindent
15900 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
15901 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
15902 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
15903 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
15904
15905 @node Automatically
15906 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
15907
15908 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
15909 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
15910 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
15911 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
15912 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
15913 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
15914 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
15915 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
15916 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
15917
15918 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
15919 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
15920 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
15921 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
15922 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
15923
15924 @node Show
15925 @section Displaying the Language
15926
15927 The following commands help you find out which language is the
15928 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
15929
15930 @table @code
15931 @item show language
15932 @anchor{show language}
15933 @kindex show language
15934 Display the current working language. This is the
15935 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
15936 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
15937
15938 @item info frame
15939 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
15940 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
15941 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
15942 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
15943 information listed here.
15944
15945 @item info source
15946 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
15947 Display the source language of this source file.
15948 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
15949 information listed here.
15950 @end table
15951
15952 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
15953 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
15954 with a language explicitly:
15955
15956 @table @code
15957 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
15958 @kindex set extension-language
15959 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
15960 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
15961
15962 @item info extensions
15963 @kindex info extensions
15964 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
15965 @end table
15966
15967 @node Checks
15968 @section Type and Range Checking
15969
15970 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
15971 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
15972 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
15973 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
15974 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
15975 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
15976 errors when your program is running.
15977
15978 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
15979 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
15980 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
15981 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
15982
15983 @menu
15984 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
15985 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
15986 @end menu
15987
15988 @cindex type checking
15989 @cindex checks, type
15990 @node Type Checking
15991 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
15992
15993 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
15994 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
15995 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
15996 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
15997
15998 @smallexample
15999 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
16000
16001 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
16002 $1 = 2
16003 @exdent but
16004 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
16005 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
16006 @end smallexample
16007
16008 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
16009 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
16010
16011 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
16012 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
16013 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
16014 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
16015 expressions like the second example above.
16016
16017 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
16018 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
16019 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
16020 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
16021 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
16022 little sense to evaluate anyway.
16023
16024 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
16025
16026 @kindex set check type
16027 @kindex show check type
16028 @table @code
16029 @item set check type on
16030 @itemx set check type off
16031 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
16032 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
16033 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
16034
16035 @item show check type
16036 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
16037 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
16038 @end table
16039
16040 @cindex range checking
16041 @cindex checks, range
16042 @node Range Checking
16043 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
16044
16045 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
16046 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
16047 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
16048 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
16049 not exceed the bounds of the array.
16050
16051 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
16052 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
16053 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
16054 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
16055
16056 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
16057 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
16058 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
16059 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
16060 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
16061 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
16062
16063 @smallexample
16064 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
16065 @end smallexample
16066
16067 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
16068 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
16069 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
16070
16071 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
16072
16073 @kindex set check range
16074 @kindex show check range
16075 @table @code
16076 @item set check range auto
16077 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
16078 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
16079 each language.
16080
16081 @item set check range on
16082 @itemx set check range off
16083 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
16084 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
16085 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
16086 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
16087
16088 @item set check range warn
16089 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
16090 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
16091 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
16092 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
16093 systems).
16094
16095 @item show check range
16096 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
16097 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
16098 @end table
16099
16100 @node Supported Languages
16101 @section Supported Languages
16102
16103 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
16104 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
16105 @c This is false ...
16106 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
16107 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
16108 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
16109 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
16110 language.
16111
16112 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
16113 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
16114 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
16115 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
16116 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
16117 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
16118 language reference or tutorial.
16119
16120 @menu
16121 * C:: C and C@t{++}
16122 * D:: D
16123 * Go:: Go
16124 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
16125 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
16126 * Fortran:: Fortran
16127 * Pascal:: Pascal
16128 * Rust:: Rust
16129 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
16130 * Ada:: Ada
16131 @end menu
16132
16133 @node C
16134 @subsection C and C@t{++}
16135
16136 @cindex C and C@t{++}
16137 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
16138
16139 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
16140 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
16141 together.
16142
16143 @cindex C@t{++}
16144 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
16145 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
16146 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
16147 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
16148 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
16149 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
16150 compiler (@code{aCC}).
16151
16152 @menu
16153 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
16154 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
16155 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
16156 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
16157 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
16158 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
16159 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
16160 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
16161 @end menu
16162
16163 @node C Operators
16164 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
16165
16166 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
16167
16168 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16169 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16170 often defined on groups of types.
16171
16172 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
16173
16174 @itemize @bullet
16175
16176 @item
16177 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
16178 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
16179
16180 @item
16181 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
16182 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
16183
16184 @item
16185 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
16186
16187 @item
16188 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
16189
16190 @end itemize
16191
16192 @noindent
16193 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
16194 in order of increasing precedence:
16195
16196 @table @code
16197 @item ,
16198 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
16199 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
16200 expression being the last expression evaluated.
16201
16202 @item =
16203 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
16204 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
16205
16206 @item @var{op}=
16207 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
16208 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
16209 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
16210 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
16211 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
16212
16213 @item ?:
16214 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
16215 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
16216 should be of an integral type.
16217
16218 @item ||
16219 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
16220
16221 @item &&
16222 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
16223
16224 @item |
16225 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
16226
16227 @item ^
16228 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
16229
16230 @item &
16231 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
16232
16233 @item ==@r{, }!=
16234 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
16235 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
16236
16237 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
16238 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
16239 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
16240 and non-zero for true.
16241
16242 @item <<@r{, }>>
16243 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
16244
16245 @item @@
16246 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16247
16248 @item +@r{, }-
16249 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
16250 pointer types.
16251
16252 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
16253 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
16254 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
16255 integral types.
16256
16257 @item ++@r{, }--
16258 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
16259 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
16260 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
16261 operation takes place.
16262
16263 @item *
16264 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
16265 @code{++}.
16266
16267 @item &
16268 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
16269
16270 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
16271 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
16272 to examine the address
16273 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
16274 stored.
16275
16276 @item -
16277 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
16278 precedence as @code{++}.
16279
16280 @item !
16281 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
16282 @code{++}.
16283
16284 @item ~
16285 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
16286 @code{++}.
16287
16288
16289 @item .@r{, }->
16290 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
16291 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
16292 pointer based on the stored type information.
16293 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
16294
16295 @item .*@r{, }->*
16296 Dereferences of pointers to members.
16297
16298 @item []
16299 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
16300 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
16301
16302 @item ()
16303 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
16304
16305 @item ::
16306 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
16307 and @code{class} types.
16308
16309 @item ::
16310 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
16311 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
16312 above.
16313 @end table
16314
16315 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
16316 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
16317 predefined meaning.
16318
16319 @node C Constants
16320 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
16321
16322 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
16323
16324 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
16325 following ways:
16326
16327 @itemize @bullet
16328 @item
16329 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
16330 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
16331 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
16332 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
16333 @code{long} value.
16334
16335 @item
16336 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
16337 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
16338 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
16339 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
16340 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
16341 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
16342 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
16343 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
16344 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
16345 constant.
16346
16347 @item
16348 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
16349 integral equivalents.
16350
16351 @item
16352 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
16353 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
16354 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
16355 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
16356 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
16357 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
16358 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
16359 @samp{\n} for newline.
16360
16361 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
16362 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
16363 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
16364 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
16365
16366 @item
16367 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
16368 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
16369 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
16370 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
16371 characters.
16372
16373 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
16374 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
16375 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
16376
16377 @item
16378 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
16379 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
16380
16381 @item
16382 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
16383 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
16384 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
16385 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
16386 @end itemize
16387
16388 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
16389 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
16390
16391 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
16392 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
16393
16394 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
16395 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
16396 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
16397 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
16398 @quotation
16399 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
16400 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
16401 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
16402 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
16403 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
16404 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
16405 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
16406 code. @xref{Compilation}.
16407 @end quotation
16408
16409 @enumerate
16410
16411 @cindex member functions
16412 @item
16413 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
16414
16415 @smallexample
16416 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
16417 @end smallexample
16418
16419 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
16420 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
16421 @item
16422 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
16423 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
16424 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
16425 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
16426 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
16427
16428 @cindex call overloaded functions
16429 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
16430 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
16431 @item
16432 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
16433 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
16434 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
16435 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
16436 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
16437 default arguments.
16438
16439 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
16440 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
16441 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
16442 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
16443 number of function arguments.
16444
16445 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
16446 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
16447 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
16448
16449 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
16450 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
16451 @smallexample
16452 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
16453 @end smallexample
16454
16455 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
16456 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
16457
16458 @cindex reference declarations
16459 @item
16460 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
16461 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
16462 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
16463
16464 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
16465 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
16466 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
16467 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
16468 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
16469
16470 @item
16471 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
16472 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
16473 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
16474 necessary, for example in an expression like
16475 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
16476 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
16477 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
16478
16479 @item
16480 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
16481 specification.
16482 @end enumerate
16483
16484 @node C Defaults
16485 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
16486
16487 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
16488
16489 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
16490 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
16491 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16492 selects the working language.
16493
16494 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
16495 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
16496 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
16497 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
16498 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
16499 for further details.
16500
16501 @node C Checks
16502 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
16503
16504 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
16505
16506 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
16507 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
16508 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
16509 constants to pointers.
16510
16511 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
16512 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
16513 that is not itself an array.
16514
16515 @node Debugging C
16516 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
16517
16518 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
16519 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
16520 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
16521 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
16522
16523 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
16524 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
16525 ,Expressions}.
16526
16527 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
16528 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
16529
16530 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
16531
16532 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
16533 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
16534
16535 @table @code
16536 @cindex break in overloaded functions
16537 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
16538 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
16539 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
16540 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
16541 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
16542
16543 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
16544 @item rbreak @var{regex}
16545 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
16546 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
16547 classes.
16548 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16549
16550 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
16551 @item catch throw
16552 @itemx catch rethrow
16553 @itemx catch catch
16554 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
16555 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
16556
16557 @cindex inheritance
16558 @item ptype @var{typename}
16559 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
16560 @var{typename}.
16561 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
16562
16563 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
16564 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
16565 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
16566 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
16567 multiple inheritance is in use.
16568
16569 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
16570 @item demangle @var{name}
16571 Demangle @var{name}.
16572 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
16573
16574 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
16575 @item set print demangle
16576 @itemx show print demangle
16577 @itemx set print asm-demangle
16578 @itemx show print asm-demangle
16579 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
16580 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
16581 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16582
16583 @item set print object
16584 @itemx show print object
16585 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
16586 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16587
16588 @item set print vtbl
16589 @itemx show print vtbl
16590 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
16591 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16592 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
16593 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
16594
16595 @kindex set overload-resolution
16596 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
16597 @item set overload-resolution on
16598 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
16599 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
16600 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
16601 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
16602 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
16603 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
16604
16605 @item set overload-resolution off
16606 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
16607 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
16608 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
16609 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
16610 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
16611 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
16612 argument types.
16613
16614 @kindex show overload-resolution
16615 @item show overload-resolution
16616 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
16617
16618 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
16619 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
16620 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
16621 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
16622 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
16623 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
16624 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
16625
16626 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
16627
16628 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
16629 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
16630 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
16631 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
16632 for more detail.
16633
16634 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
16635 function that returns a std::string:
16636
16637 @smallexample
16638 std::string function(int);
16639 @end smallexample
16640
16641 @noindent
16642 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
16643 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
16644
16645 @smallexample
16646 function[abi:cxx11](int)
16647 @end smallexample
16648
16649 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
16650 tag. For example:
16651
16652 @smallexample
16653 (gdb) b function(int)
16654 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
16655 (gdb) info breakpoints
16656 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
16657 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
16658 at main.cc:10
16659 @end smallexample
16660
16661 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
16662 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
16663 name, like:
16664
16665 @smallexample
16666 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
16667 @end smallexample
16668 @end table
16669
16670 @node Decimal Floating Point
16671 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
16672 @cindex decimal floating point format
16673
16674 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
16675 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
16676 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
16677 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
16678
16679 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
16680 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
16681 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
16682 configured target.
16683
16684 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
16685 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
16686 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
16687
16688 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
16689 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
16690 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
16691
16692 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
16693 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
16694 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
16695
16696 @node D
16697 @subsection D
16698
16699 @cindex D
16700 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
16701 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
16702 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
16703
16704 @node Go
16705 @subsection Go
16706
16707 @cindex Go (programming language)
16708 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
16709 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
16710
16711 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
16712
16713 @table @code
16714 @cindex current Go package
16715 @item The current Go package
16716 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
16717 specifying global variables and functions.
16718
16719 For example, given the program:
16720
16721 @example
16722 package main
16723 var myglob = "Shall we?"
16724 func main () @{
16725 // ...
16726 @}
16727 @end example
16728
16729 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
16730
16731 @example
16732 (gdb) p myglob
16733 (gdb) p main.myglob
16734 @end example
16735
16736 @cindex builtin Go types
16737 @item Builtin Go types
16738 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
16739 as a string.
16740
16741 @cindex builtin Go functions
16742 @item Builtin Go functions
16743 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
16744 function and handles it internally.
16745
16746 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
16747 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
16748 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
16749 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
16750 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
16751 @end table
16752
16753 @node Objective-C
16754 @subsection Objective-C
16755
16756 @cindex Objective-C
16757 This section provides information about some commands and command
16758 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
16759 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
16760 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
16761
16762 @menu
16763 * Method Names in Commands::
16764 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
16765 @end menu
16766
16767 @node Method Names in Commands
16768 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
16769
16770 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
16771 names as line specifications:
16772
16773 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
16774 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
16775 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
16776 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
16777 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
16778 @itemize
16779 @item @code{clear}
16780 @item @code{break}
16781 @item @code{info line}
16782 @item @code{jump}
16783 @item @code{list}
16784 @end itemize
16785
16786 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
16787
16788 @smallexample
16789 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
16790 @end smallexample
16791
16792 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
16793 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
16794 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
16795 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
16796 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
16797 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
16798 debugged, enter:
16799
16800 @smallexample
16801 break -[Fruit create]
16802 @end smallexample
16803
16804 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
16805 enter:
16806
16807 @smallexample
16808 list +[NSText initialize]
16809 @end smallexample
16810
16811 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
16812 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
16813 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
16814 is also possible to specify just a method name:
16815
16816 @smallexample
16817 break create
16818 @end smallexample
16819
16820 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
16821 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
16822 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
16823 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
16824 none apply.
16825
16826 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
16827 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
16828
16829 @smallexample
16830 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
16831 @end smallexample
16832
16833 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
16834 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
16835 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
16836 @kindex print-object
16837 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
16838
16839 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
16840
16841 @smallexample
16842 print -[@var{object} hash]
16843 @end smallexample
16844
16845 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
16846 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
16847 @noindent
16848 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
16849 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
16850 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
16851 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
16852 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
16853 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
16854
16855 @node OpenCL C
16856 @subsection OpenCL C
16857
16858 @cindex OpenCL C
16859 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
16860
16861 @menu
16862 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
16863 * OpenCL C Expressions::
16864 * OpenCL C Operators::
16865 @end menu
16866
16867 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
16868 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
16869
16870 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
16871 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
16872 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
16873 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
16874 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
16875
16876 @node OpenCL C Expressions
16877 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
16878
16879 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
16880 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
16881 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
16882 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
16883
16884 @node OpenCL C Operators
16885 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
16886
16887 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
16888 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
16889 vector data types.
16890
16891 @node Fortran
16892 @subsection Fortran
16893 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
16894
16895 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
16896 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
16897
16898 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
16899 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
16900 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
16901 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
16902 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
16903 underscore.
16904
16905 @menu
16906 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
16907 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
16908 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
16909 @end menu
16910
16911 @node Fortran Operators
16912 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
16913
16914 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
16915
16916 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16917 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
16918 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
16919
16920 @table @code
16921 @item **
16922 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
16923 of the second one.
16924
16925 @item :
16926 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
16927 represent a section of array.
16928
16929 @item %
16930 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
16931 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
16932 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
16933 union type.
16934 @item ::
16935 The scope operator. Normally used to access variables in modules or
16936 to set breakpoints on subroutines nested in modules or in other
16937 subroutines (internal subroutines).
16938 @end table
16939
16940 @node Fortran Defaults
16941 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
16942
16943 @cindex Fortran Defaults
16944
16945 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
16946 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
16947 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
16948 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
16949
16950 @node Special Fortran Commands
16951 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
16952
16953 @cindex Special Fortran commands
16954
16955 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
16956 such as displaying common blocks.
16957
16958 @table @code
16959 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
16960 @kindex info common
16961 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
16962 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
16963 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
16964 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
16965 printed.
16966 @cindex arrays slices (Fortran)
16967 @kindex set fortran repack-array-slices
16968 @kindex show fortran repack-array-slices
16969 @item set fortran repack-array-slices [on|off]
16970 @item show fortran repack-array-slices
16971 When taking a slice from an array, a Fortran compiler can choose to
16972 either produce an array descriptor that describes the slice in place,
16973 or it may repack the slice, copying the elements of the slice into a
16974 new region of memory.
16975
16976 When this setting is on, then @value{GDBN} will also repack array
16977 slices in some situations. When this setting is off, then
16978 @value{GDBN} will create array descriptors for slices that reference
16979 the original data in place.
16980
16981 @value{GDBN} will never repack an array slice if the data for the
16982 slice is contiguous within the original array.
16983
16984 @value{GDBN} will always repack string slices if the data for the
16985 slice is non-contiguous within the original string as @value{GDBN}
16986 does not support printing non-contiguous strings.
16987
16988 The default for this setting is @code{off}.
16989 @end table
16990
16991 @node Pascal
16992 @subsection Pascal
16993
16994 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
16995 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
16996 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
16997 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
16998 syntax.
16999
17000 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
17001 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
17002 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
17003
17004 @node Rust
17005 @subsection Rust
17006
17007 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
17008 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
17009 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
17010 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
17011
17012 @itemize @bullet
17013 @item
17014 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
17015 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
17016 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
17017
17018 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
17019 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
17020 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
17021 @samp{B}.
17022
17023 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
17024 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
17025
17026 @item
17027 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
17028 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
17029 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
17030 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
17031 @samp{K::x::y}.
17032
17033 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
17034 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
17035 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
17036 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
17037 scope.
17038
17039 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
17040 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
17041
17042 @item
17043 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
17044 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
17045
17046 @item
17047 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
17048
17049 @item
17050 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
17051 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
17052 never be destroyed.
17053
17054 @item
17055 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
17056 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
17057 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
17058
17059 @item
17060 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
17061 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
17062 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
17063 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
17064 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
17065 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
17066 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
17067 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
17068
17069 @item
17070 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
17071 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
17072 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
17073 @itemize @bullet
17074
17075 @item
17076 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
17077
17078 @item
17079 Operator overloading is not implemented.
17080
17081 @item
17082 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
17083 type names.
17084
17085 @item
17086 The type @code{Self} is not available.
17087
17088 @item
17089 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
17090 available in the crate.
17091 @end itemize
17092 @end itemize
17093
17094 @node Modula-2
17095 @subsection Modula-2
17096
17097 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
17098
17099 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
17100 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
17101 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
17102 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
17103 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
17104 table.
17105
17106 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
17107 @menu
17108 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
17109 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
17110 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
17111 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
17112 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
17113 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
17114 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
17115 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
17116 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
17117 @end menu
17118
17119 @node M2 Operators
17120 @subsubsection Operators
17121 @cindex Modula-2 operators
17122
17123 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
17124 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
17125 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
17126 following definitions hold:
17127
17128 @itemize @bullet
17129
17130 @item
17131 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
17132 their subranges.
17133
17134 @item
17135 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
17136
17137 @item
17138 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
17139
17140 @item
17141 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
17142 @var{type}}.
17143
17144 @item
17145 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
17146
17147 @item
17148 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
17149
17150 @item
17151 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
17152 @end itemize
17153
17154 @noindent
17155 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
17156 increasing precedence:
17157
17158 @table @code
17159 @item ,
17160 Function argument or array index separator.
17161
17162 @item :=
17163 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
17164 @var{value}.
17165
17166 @item <@r{, }>
17167 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
17168 types.
17169
17170 @item <=@r{, }>=
17171 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
17172 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
17173 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
17174
17175 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
17176 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
17177 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
17178 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
17179 comment character.
17180
17181 @item IN
17182 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
17183 Same precedence as @code{<}.
17184
17185 @item OR
17186 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
17187
17188 @item AND@r{, }&
17189 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
17190
17191 @item @@
17192 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
17193
17194 @item +@r{, }-
17195 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
17196 and difference on set types.
17197
17198 @item *
17199 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
17200 on set types.
17201
17202 @item /
17203 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
17204 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
17205
17206 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
17207 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
17208 precedence as @code{*}.
17209
17210 @item -
17211 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
17212
17213 @item ^
17214 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
17215
17216 @item NOT
17217 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
17218 @code{^}.
17219
17220 @item .
17221 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
17222 precedence as @code{^}.
17223
17224 @item []
17225 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
17226
17227 @item ()
17228 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
17229 as @code{^}.
17230
17231 @item ::@r{, }.
17232 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
17233 @end table
17234
17235 @quotation
17236 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
17237 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
17238 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
17239 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
17240 @end quotation
17241
17242
17243 @node Built-In Func/Proc
17244 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
17245 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
17246
17247 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
17248 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
17249
17250 @table @var
17251
17252 @item a
17253 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
17254
17255 @item c
17256 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
17257
17258 @item i
17259 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
17260
17261 @item m
17262 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
17263 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
17264 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
17265
17266 @item n
17267 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
17268
17269 @item r
17270 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
17271
17272 @item t
17273 represents a type.
17274
17275 @item v
17276 represents a variable.
17277
17278 @item x
17279 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
17280 explanation of the function for details.
17281 @end table
17282
17283 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
17284
17285 @table @code
17286 @item ABS(@var{n})
17287 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
17288
17289 @item CAP(@var{c})
17290 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
17291 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
17292
17293 @item CHR(@var{i})
17294 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
17295
17296 @item DEC(@var{v})
17297 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
17298
17299 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
17300 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
17301 new value.
17302
17303 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
17304 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
17305 set.
17306
17307 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
17308 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
17309
17310 @item HIGH(@var{a})
17311 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
17312
17313 @item INC(@var{v})
17314 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
17315
17316 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
17317 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
17318 new value.
17319
17320 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
17321 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
17322 there. Returns the new set.
17323
17324 @item MAX(@var{t})
17325 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
17326
17327 @item MIN(@var{t})
17328 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
17329
17330 @item ODD(@var{i})
17331 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
17332
17333 @item ORD(@var{x})
17334 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
17335 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
17336 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
17337 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
17338
17339 @item SIZE(@var{x})
17340 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
17341 variable or a type.
17342
17343 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
17344 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
17345
17346 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
17347 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
17348 variable or a type.
17349
17350 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
17351 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
17352 @end table
17353
17354 @quotation
17355 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
17356 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
17357 an error.
17358 @end quotation
17359
17360 @cindex Modula-2 constants
17361 @node M2 Constants
17362 @subsubsection Constants
17363
17364 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
17365 ways:
17366
17367 @itemize @bullet
17368
17369 @item
17370 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
17371 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
17372 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
17373 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
17374
17375 @item
17376 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
17377 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
17378 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
17379 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
17380 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
17381 digits.
17382
17383 @item
17384 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
17385 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
17386 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
17387 followed by a @samp{C}.
17388
17389 @item
17390 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
17391 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
17392 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
17393 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
17394 sequences.
17395
17396 @item
17397 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
17398
17399 @item
17400 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
17401 @code{FALSE}.
17402
17403 @item
17404 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
17405
17406 @item
17407 Set constants are not yet supported.
17408 @end itemize
17409
17410 @node M2 Types
17411 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
17412 @cindex Modula-2 types
17413
17414 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
17415 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
17416 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
17417 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
17418 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
17419 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
17420
17421 The first example contains the following section of code:
17422
17423 @smallexample
17424 VAR
17425 s: SET OF CHAR ;
17426 r: [20..40] ;
17427 @end smallexample
17428
17429 @noindent
17430 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
17431 @code{r} and @code{s}.
17432
17433 @smallexample
17434 (@value{GDBP}) print s
17435 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
17436 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17437 SET OF CHAR
17438 (@value{GDBP}) print r
17439 21
17440 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
17441 [20..40]
17442 @end smallexample
17443
17444 @noindent
17445 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
17446
17447 @smallexample
17448 VAR
17449 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
17450 @end smallexample
17451
17452 @noindent
17453 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
17454
17455 @smallexample
17456 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17457 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
17458 @end smallexample
17459
17460 @noindent
17461 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
17462 expressions using the debugger.
17463
17464 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
17465 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
17466
17467 @smallexample
17468 VAR
17469 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
17470 @end smallexample
17471
17472 @smallexample
17473 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17474 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
17475 @end smallexample
17476
17477 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
17478 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
17479 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
17480 above.
17481
17482 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
17483
17484 @smallexample
17485 TYPE
17486 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
17487 t = [blue..yellow] ;
17488 VAR
17489 s: t ;
17490 BEGIN
17491 s := blue ;
17492 @end smallexample
17493
17494 @noindent
17495 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
17496 and value of a variable.
17497
17498 @smallexample
17499 (@value{GDBP}) print s
17500 $1 = blue
17501 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
17502 type = [blue..yellow]
17503 @end smallexample
17504
17505 @noindent
17506 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
17507 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
17508 their @code{C} counterparts.
17509
17510 @smallexample
17511 VAR
17512 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
17513 BEGIN
17514 s[1] := 1 ;
17515 @end smallexample
17516
17517 @smallexample
17518 (@value{GDBP}) print s
17519 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
17520 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17521 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
17522 @end smallexample
17523
17524 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
17525 pointer types as shown in this example:
17526
17527 @smallexample
17528 VAR
17529 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
17530 BEGIN
17531 NEW(s) ;
17532 s^[1] := 1 ;
17533 @end smallexample
17534
17535 @noindent
17536 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
17537
17538 @smallexample
17539 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17540 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
17541 @end smallexample
17542
17543 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
17544 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
17545 types:
17546
17547 @smallexample
17548 TYPE
17549 foo = RECORD
17550 f1: CARDINAL ;
17551 f2: CHAR ;
17552 f3: myarray ;
17553 END ;
17554
17555 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
17556 myrange = [-2..2] ;
17557 VAR
17558 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
17559 @end smallexample
17560
17561 @noindent
17562 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
17563 below.
17564
17565 @smallexample
17566 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17567 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
17568 f1 : CARDINAL;
17569 f2 : CHAR;
17570 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
17571 END
17572 @end smallexample
17573
17574 @node M2 Defaults
17575 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
17576 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
17577
17578 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
17579 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
17580 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
17581 selected the working language.
17582
17583 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
17584 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
17585 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
17586 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
17587
17588 @node Deviations
17589 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
17590 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
17591
17592 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
17593 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
17594
17595 @itemize @bullet
17596 @item
17597 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
17598 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
17599 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
17600 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
17601 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
17602 returned a pointer.)
17603
17604 @item
17605 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
17606 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
17607 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
17608 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
17609
17610 @item
17611 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
17612 argument.
17613
17614 @item
17615 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
17616 @end itemize
17617
17618 @node M2 Checks
17619 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
17620 @cindex Modula-2 checks
17621
17622 @quotation
17623 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
17624 range checking.
17625 @end quotation
17626 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
17627
17628 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
17629
17630 @itemize @bullet
17631 @item
17632 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
17633 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
17634
17635 @item
17636 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
17637 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
17638 @end itemize
17639
17640 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
17641 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
17642
17643 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
17644 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
17645
17646 @node M2 Scope
17647 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
17648 @cindex scope
17649 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
17650 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
17651 @ifinfo
17652 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
17653 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
17654 @end ifinfo
17655 @ifnotinfo
17656 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
17657 @end ifnotinfo
17658
17659 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
17660 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
17661 similar syntax:
17662
17663 @smallexample
17664
17665 @var{module} . @var{id}
17666 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
17667 @end smallexample
17668
17669 @noindent
17670 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
17671 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
17672 identifier within your program, except another module.
17673
17674 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
17675 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
17676 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
17677 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
17678
17679 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
17680 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
17681 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
17682 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
17683 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
17684 @var{module}.
17685
17686 @node GDB/M2
17687 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
17688
17689 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
17690 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
17691 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
17692 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
17693 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
17694 analogue in Modula-2.
17695
17696 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
17697 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
17698 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
17699 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
17700 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
17701 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
17702
17703 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
17704 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
17705 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
17706
17707 @node Ada
17708 @subsection Ada
17709 @cindex Ada
17710
17711 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
17712 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
17713 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
17714 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
17715 to be difficult.
17716
17717
17718 @cindex expressions in Ada
17719 @menu
17720 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
17721 and semantics supported by Ada mode
17722 in @value{GDBN}.
17723 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
17724 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
17725 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
17726 subprograms.
17727 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
17728 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
17729 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
17730 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17731 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
17732 Profile
17733 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
17734 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
17735 @end menu
17736
17737 @node Ada Mode Intro
17738 @subsubsection Introduction
17739 @cindex Ada mode, general
17740
17741 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
17742 syntax, with some extensions.
17743 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
17744
17745 @itemize @bullet
17746 @item
17747 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
17748 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
17749 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
17750 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
17751
17752 @item
17753 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
17754 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
17755
17756 @item
17757 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
17758 @end itemize
17759
17760 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
17761 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
17762 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
17763 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
17764 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
17765
17766 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
17767 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
17768 was translated from an Ada source file.
17769
17770 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
17771 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
17772 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
17773 middle (to allow based literals).
17774
17775 @node Omissions from Ada
17776 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
17777 @cindex Ada, omissions from
17778
17779 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
17780
17781 @itemize @bullet
17782 @item
17783 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
17784
17785 @itemize @minus
17786 @item
17787 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
17788 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
17789
17790 @item
17791 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
17792
17793 @item
17794 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
17795
17796 @item
17797 @t{'Tag}.
17798
17799 @item
17800 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
17801 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
17802
17803 @item
17804 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
17805 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
17806
17807 @item
17808 @t{'Address}.
17809 @end itemize
17810
17811 @item
17812 The names in
17813 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
17814 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
17815 not currently available.
17816
17817 @item
17818 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
17819 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
17820 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
17821 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
17822 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
17823 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
17824 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
17825 indeterminate values.
17826
17827 @item
17828 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
17829 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
17830 are not implemented.
17831
17832 @item
17833 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
17834 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
17835 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
17836 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
17837 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
17838
17839 @smallexample
17840 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
17841 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
17842 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
17843 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
17844 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
17845 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
17846 @end smallexample
17847
17848 Changing a
17849 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
17850 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
17851 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
17852 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
17853 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
17854 declared to have a type such as:
17855
17856 @smallexample
17857 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
17858 Id : Integer;
17859 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
17860 end record;
17861 @end smallexample
17862
17863 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
17864 assignments:
17865
17866 @smallexample
17867 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
17868 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
17869 @end smallexample
17870
17871 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
17872 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
17873 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
17874 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
17875 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
17876 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
17877 redundant component associations, although which component values are
17878 assigned in such cases is not defined.
17879
17880 @item
17881 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
17882
17883 @item
17884 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
17885 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
17886 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
17887 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
17888 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
17889 the proper resolution.
17890
17891 @item
17892 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
17893
17894 @item
17895 Entry calls are not implemented.
17896
17897 @item
17898 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
17899 formats are not supported.
17900
17901 @item
17902 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
17903
17904 @item
17905 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
17906 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
17907 context.
17908 Should your program
17909 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
17910 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
17911 @end itemize
17912
17913 @node Additions to Ada
17914 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
17915 @cindex Ada, deviations from
17916
17917 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
17918 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
17919
17920 @itemize @bullet
17921 @item
17922 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
17923 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
17924 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
17925 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
17926 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
17927 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
17928 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
17929 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
17930
17931 @item
17932 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
17933 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
17934 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
17935
17936 @item
17937 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
17938 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
17939
17940 @item
17941 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
17942 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
17943 @end itemize
17944
17945 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
17946 additions specific to Ada:
17947
17948 @itemize @bullet
17949 @item
17950 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
17951 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
17952
17953 @smallexample
17954 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
17955 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
17956 @end smallexample
17957
17958 @item
17959 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
17960 the value of its right-hand operand.
17961 This allows, for example,
17962 complex conditional breaks:
17963
17964 @smallexample
17965 (@value{GDBP}) break f
17966 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
17967 @end smallexample
17968
17969 @item
17970 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
17971 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
17972 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
17973 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
17974 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
17975 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
17976 in strings. For example,
17977 @smallexample
17978 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
17979 @end smallexample
17980 @noindent
17981 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
17982 after each period.
17983
17984 @item
17985 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
17986 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
17987 to write
17988
17989 @smallexample
17990 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
17991 @end smallexample
17992
17993 @item
17994 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
17995 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
17996 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
17997 of 3 might print as
17998
17999 @smallexample
18000 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
18001 @end smallexample
18002
18003 @noindent
18004 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
18005 clause.
18006
18007 @item
18008 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
18009 multi-character subsequence of
18010 their names (an exact match gets preference).
18011 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
18012 in place of @t{a'length}.
18013
18014 @item
18015 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
18016 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
18017 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
18018 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
18019 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
18020 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
18021 For example,
18022 @smallexample
18023 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
18024 @end smallexample
18025
18026 @item
18027 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
18028 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
18029 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
18030 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
18031 object.
18032
18033 @end itemize
18034
18035 @node Overloading support for Ada
18036 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
18037 @cindex overloading, Ada
18038
18039 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
18040 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
18041 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
18042 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
18043 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
18044 functions to procedures elsewhere.
18045
18046 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
18047 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
18048 use, for instance:
18049
18050 @smallexample
18051 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
18052 Multiple matches for f
18053 [0] cancel
18054 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
18055 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
18056 >
18057 @end smallexample
18058
18059 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
18060 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
18061 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
18062
18063 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
18064 case:
18065
18066 @table @code
18067
18068 @kindex set ada print-signatures
18069 @item set ada print-signatures
18070 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
18071 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
18072 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
18073
18074 @kindex show ada print-signatures
18075 @item show ada print-signatures
18076 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
18077 overloads selection menu.
18078 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
18079
18080 @end table
18081
18082 @node Stopping Before Main Program
18083 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
18084
18085 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
18086 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
18087 before reaching the main procedure.
18088 As defined in the Ada Reference
18089 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
18090 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
18091 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
18092 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
18093
18094 @node Ada Exceptions
18095 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
18096
18097 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
18098
18099 @table @code
18100 @kindex info exceptions
18101 @item info exceptions
18102 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
18103 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
18104 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
18105 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
18106 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
18107 @end table
18108
18109 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
18110 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
18111 argument.
18112
18113 @smallexample
18114 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
18115 All defined Ada exceptions:
18116 constraint_error: 0x613da0
18117 program_error: 0x613d20
18118 storage_error: 0x613ce0
18119 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
18120 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
18121 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
18122 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
18123 constraint_error: 0x613da0
18124 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
18125 @end smallexample
18126
18127 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
18128 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
18129
18130 @node Ada Tasks
18131 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
18132 @cindex Ada, tasking
18133
18134 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
18135 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
18136
18137 @table @code
18138 @kindex info tasks
18139 @item info tasks
18140 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
18141
18142
18143 @smallexample
18144 @iftex
18145 @leftskip=0.5cm
18146 @end iftex
18147 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
18148 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
18149 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
18150 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
18151 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
18152 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
18153
18154 @end smallexample
18155
18156 @noindent
18157 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
18158 task currently being inspected.
18159
18160 @table @asis
18161 @item ID
18162 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
18163
18164 @item TID
18165 The Ada task ID.
18166
18167 @item P-ID
18168 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
18169
18170 @item Pri
18171 The base priority of the task.
18172
18173 @item State
18174 Current state of the task.
18175
18176 @table @code
18177 @item Unactivated
18178 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
18179 executing.
18180
18181 @item Runnable
18182 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
18183 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
18184
18185 @item Terminated
18186 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
18187 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
18188 terminated themselves.
18189
18190 @item Child Activation Wait
18191 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
18192
18193 @item Accept Statement
18194 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
18195
18196 @item Waiting on entry call
18197 The task is waiting on an entry call.
18198
18199 @item Async Select Wait
18200 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
18201 select statement.
18202
18203 @item Delay Sleep
18204 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
18205 alternative open.
18206
18207 @item Child Termination Wait
18208 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
18209 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
18210 waiting on a terminate Phase.
18211
18212 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
18213 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
18214 finish terminating.
18215
18216 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
18217 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
18218 @end table
18219
18220 @item Name
18221 Name of the task in the program.
18222
18223 @end table
18224
18225 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
18226 @item info task @var{taskno}
18227 This command shows detailed informations on the specified task, as in
18228 the following example:
18229 @smallexample
18230 @iftex
18231 @leftskip=0.5cm
18232 @end iftex
18233 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
18234 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
18235 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
18236 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
18237 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
18238 Ada Task: 0x807c468
18239 Name: "task_1"
18240 Thread: 0
18241 LWP: 0x1fac
18242 Parent: 1 ("main_task")
18243 Base Priority: 15
18244 State: Runnable
18245 @end smallexample
18246
18247 @item task
18248 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
18249 @cindex current Ada task ID
18250 This command prints the ID and name of the current task.
18251
18252 @smallexample
18253 @iftex
18254 @leftskip=0.5cm
18255 @end iftex
18256 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
18257 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
18258 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
18259 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable some_task
18260 (@value{GDBP}) task
18261 [Current task is 2 "some_task"]
18262 @end smallexample
18263
18264 @item task @var{taskno}
18265 @cindex Ada task switching
18266 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
18267 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
18268 from the current task to the given task.
18269
18270 @smallexample
18271 @iftex
18272 @leftskip=0.5cm
18273 @end iftex
18274 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
18275 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
18276 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
18277 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable some_task
18278 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
18279 [Switching to task 1 "main_task"]
18280 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
18281 (@value{GDBP}) bt
18282 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
18283 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
18284 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
18285 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
18286 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
18287 @end smallexample
18288
18289 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
18290 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
18291 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
18292 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
18293 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
18294 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
18295 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
18296 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
18297 in @ref{Specify Location}.
18298
18299 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
18300 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
18301 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
18302 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
18303 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
18304
18305 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
18306 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
18307 program.
18308
18309 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
18310 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
18311 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
18312
18313 For example,
18314
18315 @smallexample
18316 @iftex
18317 @leftskip=0.5cm
18318 @end iftex
18319 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
18320 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
18321 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
18322 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
18323 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
18324 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
18325 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
18326 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
18327 (@value{GDBP}) cont
18328 Continuing.
18329 task # 1 running
18330 task # 2 running
18331
18332 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
18333 15 flush;
18334 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
18335 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
18336 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
18337 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
18338 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
18339 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
18340 @end smallexample
18341 @end table
18342
18343 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
18344 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
18345 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
18346
18347 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
18348 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
18349 the platform being used.
18350 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
18351 switching is not supported.
18352
18353 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
18354 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
18355 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
18356 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
18357 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
18358 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
18359
18360 @node Ravenscar Profile
18361 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
18362 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
18363
18364 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
18365 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
18366 requirements.
18367
18368 @table @code
18369 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
18370 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
18371 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
18372 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
18373 Profile. This is the default.
18374
18375 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
18376 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
18377 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
18378 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
18379 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
18380 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
18381 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
18382
18383 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
18384 @item show ravenscar task-switching
18385 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
18386 using the Ravenscar Profile.
18387
18388 @end table
18389
18390 @cindex Ravenscar thread
18391 When Ravenscar task-switching is enabled, Ravenscar tasks are
18392 announced by @value{GDBN} as if they were threads:
18393
18394 @smallexample
18395 (gdb) continue
18396 [New Ravenscar Thread 0x2b8f0]
18397 @end smallexample
18398
18399 Both Ravenscar tasks and the underlying CPU threads will show up in
18400 the output of @code{info threads}:
18401
18402 @smallexample
18403 (gdb) info threads
18404 Id Target Id Frame
18405 1 Thread 1 (CPU#0 [running]) simple () at simple.adb:10
18406 2 Thread 2 (CPU#1 [running]) 0x0000000000003d34 in __gnat_initialize_cpu_devices ()
18407 3 Thread 3 (CPU#2 [running]) 0x0000000000003d28 in __gnat_initialize_cpu_devices ()
18408 4 Thread 4 (CPU#3 [halted ]) 0x000000000000c6ec in system.task_primitives.operations.idle ()
18409 * 5 Ravenscar Thread 0x2b8f0 simple () at simple.adb:10
18410 6 Ravenscar Thread 0x2f150 0x000000000000c6ec in system.task_primitives.operations.idle ()
18411 @end smallexample
18412
18413 One known limitation of the Ravenscar support in @value{GDBN} is that
18414 it isn't currently possible to single-step through the runtime
18415 initialization sequence. If you need to debug this code, you should
18416 use @code{set ravenscar task-switching off}.
18417
18418 @node Ada Settings
18419 @subsubsection Ada Settings
18420 @cindex Ada settings
18421
18422 @table @code
18423 @kindex set varsize-limit
18424 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
18425 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
18426 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
18427 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
18428 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
18429 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
18430 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
18431
18432 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18433 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
18434 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
18435 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
18436 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
18437 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
18438 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
18439 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
18440 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
18441 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
18442 size is less than @var{size}.
18443
18444 @kindex show varsize-limit
18445 @item show varsize-limit
18446 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
18447 @end table
18448
18449 @node Ada Glitches
18450 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
18451 @cindex Ada, problems
18452
18453 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
18454 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
18455 @value{GDBN},
18456 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
18457 and the GNU Ada compiler.
18458
18459 @itemize @bullet
18460 @item
18461 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
18462 storage are invisible to the debugger.
18463
18464 @item
18465 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
18466 argument lists are treated as positional).
18467
18468 @item
18469 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
18470
18471 @item
18472 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
18473 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
18474 the host machine.
18475
18476 @item
18477 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
18478 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
18479 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
18480 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
18481 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
18482 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
18483 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
18484 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
18485 you can usually resolve the confusion
18486 by qualifying the problematic names with package
18487 @code{Standard} explicitly.
18488 @end itemize
18489
18490 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
18491 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
18492 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
18493 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
18494 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
18495 enabled.
18496
18497 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
18498 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
18499 @table @code
18500
18501 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
18502 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
18503 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
18504 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
18505 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
18506 This is the default.
18507
18508 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
18509 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
18510 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
18511 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
18512 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
18513 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
18514 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
18515
18516 @end table
18517
18518 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
18519 @cindex GNAT encoding
18520 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
18521 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
18522 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
18523 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
18524 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
18525 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
18526
18527 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
18528 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
18529 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
18530 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
18531 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
18532 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
18533 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
18534 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
18535
18536 @table @code
18537
18538 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
18539 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
18540 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
18541 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
18542
18543 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
18544 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
18545 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
18546
18547 @end table
18548
18549 @node Unsupported Languages
18550 @section Unsupported Languages
18551
18552 @cindex unsupported languages
18553 @cindex minimal language
18554 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
18555 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
18556 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
18557 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
18558 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
18559 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
18560
18561 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
18562 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
18563 language.
18564
18565 @node Symbols
18566 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
18567
18568 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
18569 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
18570 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
18571 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
18572 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
18573 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
18574 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18575
18576 @cindex symbol names
18577 @cindex names of symbols
18578 @cindex quoting names
18579 @anchor{quoting names}
18580 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
18581 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
18582 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
18583 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
18584 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
18585 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
18586 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
18587 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
18588
18589 @smallexample
18590 p 'foo.c'::x
18591 @end smallexample
18592
18593 @noindent
18594 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
18595
18596 @table @code
18597 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
18598 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
18599 @kindex set case-sensitive
18600 @item set case-sensitive on
18601 @itemx set case-sensitive off
18602 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
18603 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
18604 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
18605 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
18606 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
18607 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
18608 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
18609 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
18610 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
18611 case-insensitive matches.
18612
18613 @kindex show case-sensitive
18614 @item show case-sensitive
18615 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
18616 lookups.
18617
18618 @kindex set print type methods
18619 @item set print type methods
18620 @itemx set print type methods on
18621 @itemx set print type methods off
18622 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
18623 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
18624 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
18625 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
18626 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
18627 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
18628
18629 @kindex show print type methods
18630 @item show print type methods
18631 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
18632 classes.
18633
18634 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
18635 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
18636 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
18637 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
18638 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
18639 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
18640 types defined in classes.
18641
18642 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
18643 @item show print type nested-type-limit
18644 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
18645 printing classes.
18646
18647 @kindex set print type typedefs
18648 @item set print type typedefs
18649 @itemx set print type typedefs on
18650 @itemx set print type typedefs off
18651
18652 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
18653 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
18654 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
18655 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
18656 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
18657 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
18658 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
18659 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
18660 types.
18661
18662 @kindex show print type typedefs
18663 @item show print type typedefs
18664 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
18665 printing classes.
18666
18667 @kindex info address
18668 @cindex address of a symbol
18669 @item info address @var{symbol}
18670 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
18671 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
18672 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
18673 is always stored.
18674
18675 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
18676 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
18677 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
18678
18679 @kindex info symbol
18680 @cindex symbol from address
18681 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
18682 @item info symbol @var{addr}
18683 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
18684 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
18685 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
18686
18687 @smallexample
18688 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
18689 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
18690 @end smallexample
18691
18692 @noindent
18693 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
18694 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
18695
18696 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
18697 library containing the symbol is also printed:
18698
18699 @smallexample
18700 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
18701 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
18702 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
18703 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
18704 @end smallexample
18705
18706 @kindex demangle
18707 @cindex demangle
18708 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
18709 Demangle @var{name}.
18710 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
18711 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
18712
18713 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
18714 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
18715
18716 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
18717 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
18718
18719 @kindex whatis
18720 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
18721 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
18722 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
18723 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
18724
18725 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
18726 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
18727 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
18728
18729 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
18730 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
18731 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
18732 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
18733 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
18734 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
18735 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
18736 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
18737 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
18738
18739 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
18740 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
18741 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
18742 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
18743 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
18744 unroll it.
18745
18746 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
18747 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
18748 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
18749
18750 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
18751 Available flags are:
18752
18753 @table @code
18754 @item r
18755 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
18756 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
18757 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
18758
18759 @item m
18760 Do not print methods defined in the class.
18761
18762 @item M
18763 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
18764 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
18765
18766 @item t
18767 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
18768 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
18769 names are substituted when printing other types.
18770
18771 @item T
18772 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
18773 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
18774
18775 @item o
18776 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
18777 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
18778
18779 For example, given the following declarations:
18780
18781 @smallexample
18782 struct tuv
18783 @{
18784 int a1;
18785 char *a2;
18786 int a3;
18787 @};
18788
18789 struct xyz
18790 @{
18791 int f1;
18792 char f2;
18793 void *f3;
18794 struct tuv f4;
18795 @};
18796
18797 union qwe
18798 @{
18799 struct tuv fff1;
18800 struct xyz fff2;
18801 @};
18802
18803 struct tyu
18804 @{
18805 int a1 : 1;
18806 int a2 : 3;
18807 int a3 : 23;
18808 char a4 : 2;
18809 int64_t a5;
18810 int a6 : 5;
18811 int64_t a7 : 3;
18812 @};
18813 @end smallexample
18814
18815 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
18816
18817 @smallexample
18818 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
18819 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
18820 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
18821 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18822 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
18823 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
18824
18825 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18826 @}
18827 @end smallexample
18828
18829 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
18830 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
18831 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
18832 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
18833 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
18834 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
18835 its fields.
18836
18837 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
18838
18839 @smallexample
18840 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
18841 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
18842 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
18843 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
18844 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18845 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
18846 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
18847
18848 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18849 @} fff1;
18850 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
18851 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
18852 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
18853 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
18854 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
18855 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
18856 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
18857 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18858 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
18859 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
18860
18861 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18862 @} f4;
18863
18864 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
18865 @} fff2;
18866
18867 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
18868 @}
18869 @end smallexample
18870
18871 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
18872 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
18873 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
18874 of these structures' fields.
18875
18876 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
18877 bitfields:
18878
18879 @smallexample
18880 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
18881 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
18882 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
18883 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
18884 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
18885 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
18886 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
18887 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18888 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
18889 /* 16: 0 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
18890 /* 16: 5 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
18891 "/* XXX 7-byte padding */
18892
18893 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18894 @}
18895 @end smallexample
18896
18897 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include the
18898 first bit of the bitfield.
18899 @end table
18900
18901 @kindex ptype
18902 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
18903 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
18904 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
18905 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
18906
18907 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
18908 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
18909 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
18910 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
18911 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
18912 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
18913 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
18914 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
18915
18916 For example, for this variable declaration:
18917
18918 @smallexample
18919 typedef double real_t;
18920 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
18921 typedef struct complex complex_t;
18922 complex_t var;
18923 real_t *real_pointer_var;
18924 @end smallexample
18925
18926 @noindent
18927 the two commands give this output:
18928
18929 @smallexample
18930 @group
18931 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
18932 type = complex_t
18933 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
18934 type = struct complex @{
18935 real_t real;
18936 double imag;
18937 @}
18938 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
18939 type = struct complex
18940 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
18941 type = struct complex
18942 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
18943 type = struct complex @{
18944 real_t real;
18945 double imag;
18946 @}
18947 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
18948 type = real_t *
18949 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
18950 type = double *
18951 @end group
18952 @end smallexample
18953
18954 @noindent
18955 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
18956 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
18957
18958 @cindex incomplete type
18959 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
18960 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
18961 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
18962 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
18963 given these declarations:
18964
18965 @smallexample
18966 struct foo;
18967 struct foo *fooptr;
18968 @end smallexample
18969
18970 @noindent
18971 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
18972
18973 @smallexample
18974 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
18975 $1 = <incomplete type>
18976 @end smallexample
18977
18978 @noindent
18979 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
18980 completely specified.
18981
18982 @cindex unknown type
18983 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
18984 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
18985 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
18986 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
18987 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
18988 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
18989 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
18990 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
18991
18992 @smallexample
18993 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
18994 type = <data variable, no debug info>
18995 @end smallexample
18996
18997 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
18998 of such variables.
18999
19000 @kindex info types
19001 @item info types [-q] [@var{regexp}]
19002 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
19003 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
19004 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
19005 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
19006 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
19007 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
19008 name is @code{value}.
19009
19010 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
19011 to print the type description according to the
19012 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
19013 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
19014 language of the type, other values mean to use
19015 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
19016
19017 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
19018 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
19019 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
19020
19021 The output from @samp{into types} is proceeded with a header line
19022 describing what types are being listed. The optional flag @samp{-q},
19023 which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables printing this header
19024 information.
19025
19026 @kindex info type-printers
19027 @item info type-printers
19028 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
19029 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
19030 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
19031 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
19032 type printers.
19033
19034 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
19035
19036 @kindex enable type-printer
19037 @kindex disable type-printer
19038 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
19039 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
19040 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
19041
19042 @kindex info scope
19043 @cindex local variables
19044 @item info scope @var{location}
19045 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
19046 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
19047 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
19048 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
19049 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
19050
19051 @smallexample
19052 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
19053 Scope for command_line_handler:
19054 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
19055 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
19056 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
19057 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
19058 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
19059 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
19060 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
19061 @end smallexample
19062
19063 @noindent
19064 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
19065 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
19066 collect}.
19067
19068 @kindex info source
19069 @item info source
19070 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
19071 the function containing the current point of execution:
19072 @itemize @bullet
19073 @item
19074 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
19075 @item
19076 the directory it was compiled in,
19077 @item
19078 its length, in lines,
19079 @item
19080 which programming language it is written in,
19081 @item
19082 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
19083 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
19084 @item
19085 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
19086 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
19087 @item
19088 whether the debugging information includes information about
19089 preprocessor macros.
19090 @end itemize
19091
19092
19093 @kindex info sources
19094 @item info sources
19095 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
19096 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
19097 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
19098
19099 @item info sources [-dirname | -basename] [--] [@var{regexp}]
19100 Like @samp{info sources}, but only print the names of the files
19101 matching the provided @var{regexp}.
19102 By default, the @var{regexp} is used to match anywhere in the filename.
19103 If @code{-dirname}, only files having a dirname matching @var{regexp} are shown.
19104 If @code{-basename}, only files having a basename matching @var{regexp}
19105 are shown.
19106 The matching is case-sensitive, except on operating systems that
19107 have case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows).
19108
19109 @kindex info functions
19110 @item info functions [-q] [-n]
19111 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
19112 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
19113 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
19114 number.
19115
19116 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
19117 to print the function name and type according to the
19118 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
19119 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
19120 language of the function, other values mean to use
19121 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
19122
19123 The @samp{-n} flag excludes @dfn{non-debugging symbols} from the
19124 results. A non-debugging symbol is a symbol that comes from the
19125 executable's symbol table, not from the debug information (for
19126 example, DWARF) associated with the executable.
19127
19128 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
19129 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
19130 have been printed.
19131
19132 @item info functions [-q] [-n] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
19133 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
19134 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
19135
19136 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
19137 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
19138 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
19139 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
19140 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
19141 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
19142 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
19143
19144 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
19145 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
19146 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
19147 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
19148 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
19149 of special characters or quotes.
19150 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
19151 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
19152 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
19153 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
19154 int.
19155
19156 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
19157 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
19158 @var{type_regexp}.
19159
19160
19161 @kindex info variables
19162 @item info variables [-q] [-n]
19163 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
19164 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
19165 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
19166 their respective source line numbers.
19167
19168 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
19169 to print the variable name and type according to the
19170 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
19171 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
19172 language of the variable, other values mean to use
19173 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
19174
19175 The @samp{-n} flag excludes non-debugging symbols from the results.
19176
19177 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
19178 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
19179 have been printed.
19180
19181 @item info variables [-q] [-n] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
19182 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
19183 with the provided regexp(s).
19184
19185 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
19186 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
19187
19188 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
19189 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
19190 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
19191 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
19192 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
19193 of special characters or quotes.
19194
19195 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
19196 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
19197 @var{type_regexp}.
19198
19199 @kindex info modules
19200 @cindex modules
19201 @item info modules @r{[}-q@r{]} @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
19202 List all Fortran modules in the program, or all modules matching the
19203 optional regular expression @var{regexp}.
19204
19205 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
19206 printing header information and messages explaining why no modules
19207 have been printed.
19208
19209 @kindex info module
19210 @cindex Fortran modules, information about
19211 @cindex functions and variables by Fortran module
19212 @cindex module functions and variables
19213 @item info module functions @r{[}-q@r{]} @r{[}-m @var{module-regexp}@r{]} @r{[}-t @var{type-regexp}@r{]} @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
19214 @itemx info module variables @r{[}-q@r{]} @r{[}-m @var{module-regexp}@r{]} @r{[}-t @var{type-regexp}@r{]} @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
19215 List all functions or variables within all Fortran modules. The set
19216 of functions or variables listed can be limited by providing some or
19217 all of the optional regular expressions. If @var{module-regexp} is
19218 provided, then only Fortran modules matching @var{module-regexp} will
19219 be searched. Only functions or variables whose type matches the
19220 optional regular expression @var{type-regexp} will be listed. And
19221 only functions or variables whose name matches the optional regular
19222 expression @var{regexp} will be listed.
19223
19224 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
19225 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
19226 or variables have been printed.
19227
19228 @kindex info classes
19229 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
19230 @item info classes
19231 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
19232 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
19233 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
19234 expression.
19235
19236 @kindex info selectors
19237 @item info selectors
19238 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
19239 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
19240 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
19241 expression.
19242
19243 @ignore
19244 This was never implemented.
19245 @kindex info methods
19246 @item info methods
19247 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
19248 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
19249 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
19250 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
19251 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
19252 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
19253 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
19254 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
19255 @end ignore
19256
19257 @cindex opaque data types
19258 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
19259 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
19260 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
19261 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
19262 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
19263 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
19264 another source file. The default is on.
19265
19266 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
19267 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
19268
19269 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
19270 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
19271 is printed as follows:
19272 @smallexample
19273 @{<no data fields>@}
19274 @end smallexample
19275
19276 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
19277 @item show opaque-type-resolution
19278 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
19279
19280 @kindex set print symbol-loading
19281 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
19282 @item set print symbol-loading
19283 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
19284 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
19285 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
19286 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
19287 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
19288 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
19289 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
19290 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
19291 can be annoying.
19292 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
19293 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
19294 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
19295 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
19296
19297 @kindex show print symbol-loading
19298 @item show print symbol-loading
19299 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
19300 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
19301
19302 @kindex maint print symbols
19303 @cindex symbol dump
19304 @kindex maint print psymbols
19305 @cindex partial symbol dump
19306 @kindex maint print msymbols
19307 @cindex minimal symbol dump
19308 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19309 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19310 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19311 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19312 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19313 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
19314 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
19315 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
19316 that objfile.
19317 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
19318 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
19319 @code{main}.
19320 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
19321 source file.
19322
19323 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
19324 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
19325 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
19326 tables.
19327 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
19328 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
19329 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
19330 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
19331 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
19332 ``ELF symbols''.
19333
19334 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
19335 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
19336
19337 @kindex maint info symtabs
19338 @kindex maint info psymtabs
19339 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
19340 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
19341 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
19342 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
19343 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
19344 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
19345
19346 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
19347 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
19348 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
19349 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
19350 structure in more detail. For example:
19351
19352 @smallexample
19353 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
19354 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
19355 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
19356 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
19357 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
19358 readin no
19359 fullname (null)
19360 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
19361 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
19362 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
19363 dependencies (none)
19364 @}
19365 @}
19366 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
19367 (@value{GDBP})
19368 @end smallexample
19369 @noindent
19370 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
19371 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
19372 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
19373 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
19374 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
19375
19376 @smallexample
19377 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
19378 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
19379 line 1574.
19380 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
19381 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
19382 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
19383 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
19384 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
19385 dirname (null)
19386 fullname (null)
19387 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
19388 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
19389 debugformat DWARF 2
19390 @}
19391 @}
19392 (@value{GDBP})
19393 @end smallexample
19394
19395 @kindex maint info line-table
19396 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
19397 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
19398 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
19399
19400 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
19401 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
19402 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
19403
19404 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
19405 @cindex symbol cache size
19406 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
19407 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
19408 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
19409 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
19410 with different sizes.
19411
19412 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
19413 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
19414 Show the size of the symbol cache.
19415
19416 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
19417 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
19418 @item maint print symbol-cache
19419 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
19420 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
19421
19422 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
19423 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
19424 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
19425 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
19426 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
19427
19428 @kindex maint flush symbol-cache
19429 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
19430 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
19431 @item maint flush symbol-cache
19432 @itemx maint flush-symbol-cache
19433 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed. This
19434 command is useful when debugging the symbol cache. It is also useful
19435 when collecting performance data. The command @code{maint
19436 flush-symbol-cache} is deprecated in favor of @code{maint flush
19437 symbol-cache}..
19438
19439 @end table
19440
19441 @node Altering
19442 @chapter Altering Execution
19443
19444 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
19445 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
19446 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
19447 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
19448 program.
19449
19450 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
19451 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
19452 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
19453
19454 @menu
19455 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
19456 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
19457 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
19458 * Returning:: Returning from a function
19459 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
19460 * Patching:: Patching your program
19461 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
19462 @end menu
19463
19464 @node Assignment
19465 @section Assignment to Variables
19466
19467 @cindex assignment
19468 @cindex setting variables
19469 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
19470 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
19471
19472 @smallexample
19473 print x=4
19474 @end smallexample
19475
19476 @noindent
19477 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
19478 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
19479 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
19480 information on operators in supported languages.
19481
19482 @kindex set variable
19483 @cindex variables, setting
19484 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
19485 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
19486 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
19487 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
19488 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
19489
19490 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
19491 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
19492 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
19493 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
19494 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
19495 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
19496 command @code{set width}:
19497
19498 @smallexample
19499 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
19500 type = double
19501 (@value{GDBP}) p width
19502 $4 = 13
19503 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
19504 Invalid syntax in expression.
19505 @end smallexample
19506
19507 @noindent
19508 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
19509 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
19510
19511 @smallexample
19512 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
19513 @end smallexample
19514
19515 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
19516 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
19517 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
19518 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
19519 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
19520 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
19521
19522 @smallexample
19523 @group
19524 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
19525 type = double
19526 (@value{GDBP}) p g
19527 $1 = 1
19528 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
19529 (@value{GDBP}) p g
19530 $2 = 1
19531 (@value{GDBP}) r
19532 The program being debugged has been started already.
19533 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
19534 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
19535 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
19536 Invalid bfd target.
19537 (@value{GDBP}) show g
19538 The current BFD target is "=4".
19539 @end group
19540 @end smallexample
19541
19542 @noindent
19543 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
19544 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
19545 @code{g}, use
19546
19547 @smallexample
19548 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
19549 @end smallexample
19550
19551 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
19552 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
19553 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
19554 same length or shorter.
19555 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
19556 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
19557
19558 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
19559 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
19560 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
19561 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
19562 and representation in memory), and
19563
19564 @smallexample
19565 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
19566 @end smallexample
19567
19568 @noindent
19569 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
19570
19571 @node Jumping
19572 @section Continuing at a Different Address
19573
19574 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
19575 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
19576 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
19577
19578 @table @code
19579 @kindex jump
19580 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
19581 @item jump @var{location}
19582 @itemx j @var{location}
19583 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
19584 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
19585 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
19586 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
19587 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
19588
19589 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
19590 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
19591 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
19592 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
19593 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
19594 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
19595 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
19596 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
19597 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
19598 @end table
19599
19600 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
19601 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
19602 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
19603 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
19604 example,
19605
19606 @smallexample
19607 set $pc = 0x485
19608 @end smallexample
19609
19610 @noindent
19611 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
19612 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
19613 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
19614
19615 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
19616 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
19617 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
19618 detail.
19619
19620 @c @group
19621 @node Signaling
19622 @section Giving your Program a Signal
19623 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
19624
19625 @table @code
19626 @kindex signal
19627 @item signal @var{signal}
19628 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
19629 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
19630 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
19631 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
19632
19633 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
19634 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
19635 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
19636 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
19637 signal.
19638
19639 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
19640 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
19641 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
19642 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
19643 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
19644 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
19645 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
19646 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
19647
19648 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
19649 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
19650 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
19651 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
19652 passes the signal directly to your program.
19653
19654 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
19655 after executing the command.
19656
19657 @kindex queue-signal
19658 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
19659 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
19660 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
19661 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
19662 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
19663 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
19664 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
19665 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
19666 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
19667
19668 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
19669 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
19670 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
19671 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
19672 @code{continue} command.
19673
19674 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
19675 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
19676 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
19677 (@pxref{Signals}).
19678 @end table
19679 @c @end group
19680
19681 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
19682 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
19683
19684 @node Returning
19685 @section Returning from a Function
19686
19687 @table @code
19688 @cindex returning from a function
19689 @kindex return
19690 @item return
19691 @itemx return @var{expression}
19692 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
19693 command. If you give an
19694 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
19695 value.
19696 @end table
19697
19698 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
19699 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
19700 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
19701 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
19702
19703 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
19704 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
19705 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
19706 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
19707 of functions.
19708
19709 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
19710 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
19711 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
19712 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
19713 selected stack frame returns naturally.
19714
19715 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
19716 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
19717 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
19718 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
19719 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
19720 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
19721 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
19722 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
19723 assignment into the right register(s).
19724
19725 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
19726 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
19727 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
19728 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
19729 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
19730 into a @code{long long int}:
19731
19732 @smallexample
19733 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
19734 29 return 31;
19735 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
19736 Make func return now? (y or n) y
19737 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
19738 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
19739 (@value{GDBP})
19740 @end smallexample
19741
19742 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
19743 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
19744 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
19745 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
19746 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
19747 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
19748 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
19749 an appropriate cast explicitly:
19750
19751 @smallexample
19752 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
19753 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
19754 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
19755 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
19756 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
19757 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
19758 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
19759 (@value{GDBP})
19760 @end smallexample
19761
19762 @node Calling
19763 @section Calling Program Functions
19764
19765 @table @code
19766 @cindex calling functions
19767 @cindex inferior functions, calling
19768 @item print @var{expr}
19769 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
19770 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
19771 debugged.
19772
19773 @kindex call
19774 @item call @var{expr}
19775 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
19776 returned values.
19777
19778 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
19779 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
19780 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
19781 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
19782 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
19783 value history.
19784 @end table
19785
19786 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
19787 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
19788 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
19789 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
19790
19791 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
19792 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
19793 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
19794 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
19795 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
19796 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
19797 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
19798 in that case is controlled by the
19799 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
19800
19801 @table @code
19802 @item set unwindonsignal
19803 @kindex set unwindonsignal
19804 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
19805 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
19806 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
19807 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
19808 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
19809 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
19810 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
19811 received.
19812
19813 @item show unwindonsignal
19814 @kindex show unwindonsignal
19815 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
19816 @value{GDBN}.
19817
19818 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
19819 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
19820 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
19821 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
19822 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
19823 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
19824 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
19825 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
19826 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
19827 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
19828
19829 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
19830 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
19831 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
19832 @value{GDBN}.
19833
19834 @item set may-call-functions
19835 @kindex set may-call-functions
19836 @cindex disabling calling functions in the program
19837 @cindex calling functions in the program, disabling
19838 Set permission to call functions in the program.
19839 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to call functions in
19840 the program, such as with expressions in the @code{print} command. It
19841 defaults to @code{on}.
19842
19843 To call a function in the program, @value{GDBN} has to temporarily
19844 modify the state of the inferior. This has potentially undesired side
19845 effects. Also, having @value{GDBN} call nested functions is likely to
19846 be erroneous and may even crash the program being debugged. You can
19847 avoid such hazards by forbidding @value{GDBN} from calling functions
19848 in the program being debugged. If calling functions in the program
19849 is forbidden, GDB will throw an error when a command (such as printing
19850 an expression) starts a function call in the program.
19851
19852 @item show may-call-functions
19853 @kindex show may-call-functions
19854 Show permission to call functions in the program.
19855
19856 @end table
19857
19858 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
19859
19860 @cindex no debug info functions
19861 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
19862 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
19863 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
19864 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
19865 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
19866 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
19867
19868 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
19869 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
19870 declared return type. For example:
19871
19872 @smallexample
19873 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
19874 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
19875 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
19876 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
19877 @end smallexample
19878
19879 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
19880 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
19881 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
19882 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
19883
19884 @smallexample
19885 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
19886 @end smallexample
19887
19888 @noindent
19889 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
19890
19891 @smallexample
19892 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
19893 @end smallexample
19894
19895 @noindent
19896 these calls are equivalent:
19897
19898 @smallexample
19899 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
19900 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
19901 @end smallexample
19902
19903 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
19904 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
19905 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
19906 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
19907 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
19908 float parameters, and no debug info:
19909
19910 @smallexample
19911 float
19912 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
19913 float v1, v2;
19914 @{
19915 return v1 * v2;
19916 @}
19917 @end smallexample
19918
19919 @noindent
19920 you call it like this:
19921
19922 @smallexample
19923 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
19924 @end smallexample
19925
19926 @node Patching
19927 @section Patching Programs
19928
19929 @cindex patching binaries
19930 @cindex writing into executables
19931 @cindex writing into corefiles
19932
19933 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
19934 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
19935 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
19936 patching your program's binary.
19937
19938 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
19939 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
19940 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
19941 repairs.
19942
19943 @table @code
19944 @kindex set write
19945 @item set write on
19946 @itemx set write off
19947 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
19948 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
19949 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
19950
19951 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
19952 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
19953 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
19954
19955 @item show write
19956 @kindex show write
19957 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
19958 as well as reading.
19959 @end table
19960
19961 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
19962 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
19963 @cindex injecting code
19964 @cindex writing into executables
19965 @cindex compiling code
19966
19967 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
19968 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
19969 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
19970 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
19971
19972 @table @code
19973 @kindex compile code
19974 @item compile code @var{source-code}
19975 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
19976 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
19977 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
19978 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
19979 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
19980 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
19981 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
19982 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
19983 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
19984 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
19985 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
19986
19987 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
19988 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
19989 E.g.:
19990
19991 @smallexample
19992 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
19993 @end smallexample
19994
19995 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
19996 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
19997 from actual source code. E.g.:
19998
19999 @smallexample
20000 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
20001 @end smallexample
20002
20003 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
20004 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
20005 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
20006 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
20007 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
20008 editor.
20009
20010 @smallexample
20011 compile code
20012 >printf ("hello\n");
20013 >printf ("world\n");
20014 >end
20015 @end smallexample
20016
20017 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
20018 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
20019 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
20020 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
20021 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
20022 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
20023 inferior symbols otherwise.
20024
20025 @kindex compile file
20026 @item compile file @var{filename}
20027 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
20028 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
20029
20030 @smallexample
20031 compile file /home/user/example.c
20032 @end smallexample
20033 @end table
20034
20035 @table @code
20036 @item compile print [[@var{options}] --] @var{expr}
20037 @itemx compile print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f} @var{expr}
20038 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
20039 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
20040 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
20041 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
20042 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
20043 Formats}. The @code{compile print} command accepts the same options
20044 as the @code{print} command; see @ref{print options}.
20045
20046 @item compile print [[@var{options}] --]
20047 @itemx compile print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f}
20048 @cindex reprint the last value
20049 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
20050 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
20051 command without any text following the command. This will start the
20052 multiple-line editor.
20053 @end table
20054
20055 @noindent
20056 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
20057
20058 @table @code
20059 @anchor{set debug compile}
20060 @item set debug compile
20061 @cindex compile command debugging info
20062 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
20063 injecting the code. The default is off.
20064
20065 @item show debug compile
20066 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
20067 compiling and injecting the code.
20068
20069 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
20070 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
20071 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
20072 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
20073 The default is off.
20074
20075 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
20076 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
20077 C@t{++} type conversion.
20078 @end table
20079
20080 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
20081
20082 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
20083 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
20084 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
20085 injecting process.
20086
20087 @noindent
20088 The options used, in increasing precedence:
20089
20090 @table @asis
20091 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
20092 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
20093 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
20094 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
20095
20096 @item compilation options recorded in the target
20097 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
20098 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
20099 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
20100 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
20101 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
20102 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
20103 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
20104
20105 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
20106 @end table
20107
20108 @noindent
20109 You can override compilation options using the following command:
20110
20111 @table @code
20112 @item set compile-args
20113 @cindex compile command options override
20114 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
20115 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
20116 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
20117 compilation.
20118
20119 @item show compile-args
20120 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
20121 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
20122 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
20123 @end table
20124
20125 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
20126
20127 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
20128 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
20129 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
20130
20131 @table @asis
20132 @item C code examples and caveats
20133 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
20134 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
20135 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
20136 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
20137 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
20138
20139 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
20140 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
20141 much like any other normal debugging session.
20142
20143 @smallexample
20144 void function1 (void)
20145 @{
20146 int i = 42;
20147 printf ("function 1\n");
20148 @}
20149
20150 void function2 (void)
20151 @{
20152 int j = 12;
20153 function1 ();
20154 @}
20155
20156 int main(void)
20157 @{
20158 int k = 6;
20159 int *p;
20160 function2 ();
20161 return 0;
20162 @}
20163 @end smallexample
20164
20165 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
20166 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
20167 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
20168
20169 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
20170 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
20171 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
20172 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
20173 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
20174
20175 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
20176 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
20177 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
20178 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
20179 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
20180 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
20181 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
20182 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
20183 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
20184 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
20185
20186 @smallexample
20187 compile code k = 3;
20188 @end smallexample
20189
20190 @noindent
20191 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
20192 something else in the example program changes it, or another
20193 @code{compile} command changes it.
20194
20195 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
20196 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
20197 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
20198 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
20199 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
20200
20201 @smallexample
20202 compile code j = 3;
20203 @end smallexample
20204
20205 @noindent
20206 will result in a compilation error message.
20207
20208 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
20209 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
20210 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
20211
20212 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
20213 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
20214 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
20215 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
20216
20217 @smallexample
20218 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
20219 @end smallexample
20220
20221 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
20222 command has completed:
20223
20224 @smallexample
20225 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
20226 @end smallexample
20227
20228 @noindent
20229 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
20230 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
20231 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
20232 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
20233 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
20234
20235 @smallexample
20236 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
20237 @end smallexample
20238
20239 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
20240 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
20241 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
20242 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
20243 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
20244 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
20245 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
20246 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
20247
20248 @smallexample
20249 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
20250 @end smallexample
20251
20252 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
20253 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
20254 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
20255 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
20256 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
20257 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
20258 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
20259
20260 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
20261 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
20262 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
20263 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
20264 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
20265 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
20266
20267 @smallexample
20268 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
20269 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
20270 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
20271 Compilation failed.
20272 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
20273 42
20274 @end smallexample
20275
20276 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
20277 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
20278 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
20279 will print to the console.
20280 @end table
20281
20282 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
20283
20284 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
20285 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
20286 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
20287 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
20288 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
20289 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
20290 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
20291 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
20292
20293
20294 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
20295 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
20296 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
20297 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
20298 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
20299 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
20300 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
20301
20302 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
20303 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
20304 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
20305 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
20306 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
20307 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
20308 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
20309
20310 @table @code
20311 @item set compile-gcc
20312 @cindex compile command driver filename override
20313 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
20314 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
20315 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
20316 default.
20317
20318 @item show compile-gcc
20319 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
20320 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
20321 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
20322 @end table
20323
20324 @node GDB Files
20325 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
20326
20327 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
20328 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
20329 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
20330 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
20331
20332 @menu
20333 * Files:: Commands to specify files
20334 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
20335 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
20336 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
20337 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
20338 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
20339 * Data Files:: GDB data files
20340 @end menu
20341
20342 @node Files
20343 @section Commands to Specify Files
20344
20345 @cindex symbol table
20346 @cindex core dump file
20347
20348 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
20349 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
20350 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
20351 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
20352
20353 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
20354 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
20355 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
20356 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
20357 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
20358 new files are useful.
20359
20360 @table @code
20361 @cindex executable file
20362 @kindex file
20363 @item file @var{filename}
20364 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
20365 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
20366 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
20367 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
20368 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
20369 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
20370 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
20371 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
20372
20373 @cindex unlinked object files
20374 @cindex patching object files
20375 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
20376 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
20377 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
20378 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
20379 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
20380 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
20381 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
20382 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
20383
20384 @item file
20385 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
20386 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
20387
20388 @kindex exec-file
20389 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
20390 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
20391 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
20392 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
20393 discard information on the executable file.
20394
20395 @kindex symbol-file
20396 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
20397 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
20398 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
20399 table and program to run from the same file.
20400
20401 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
20402 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
20403 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
20404 enabled.
20405
20406 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
20407 program's symbol table.
20408
20409 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
20410 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
20411 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
20412 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
20413 @value{GDBN}.
20414
20415 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
20416 executing it once.
20417
20418 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
20419 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
20420 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
20421 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
20422 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
20423 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
20424 optimized code.
20425
20426 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
20427 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
20428 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
20429 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
20430 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
20431
20432 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
20433 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
20434 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
20435 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
20436 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
20437 Warnings and Messages}.)
20438
20439 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
20440 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
20441 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
20442 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
20443 in stabs format.
20444
20445 @kindex readnow
20446 @cindex reading symbols immediately
20447 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
20448 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
20449 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
20450 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
20451 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
20452 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
20453 entire symbol table available.
20454
20455 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
20456 @cindex never read symbols
20457 @cindex symbols, never read
20458 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
20459 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
20460 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
20461 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
20462 @xref{--readnever}.
20463
20464 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
20465 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
20466 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
20467 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
20468 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
20469 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
20470 @c files.
20471
20472 @kindex core-file
20473 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
20474 @itemx core
20475 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
20476 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
20477 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
20478 executable file itself for other parts.
20479
20480 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
20481 to be used.
20482
20483 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
20484 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
20485 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
20486 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
20487 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
20488
20489 @kindex add-symbol-file
20490 @cindex dynamic linking
20491 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
20492 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
20493 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
20494 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
20495 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
20496 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
20497 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
20498 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
20499 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
20500 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
20501 can be given as an expression.
20502
20503 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
20504 address of each section, except those for which the address was
20505 specified explicitly.
20506
20507 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
20508 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
20509 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
20510 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
20511
20512 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
20513
20514 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
20515 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
20516 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
20517 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
20518 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
20519 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
20520 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
20521 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
20522 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
20523
20524 @itemize @bullet
20525 @item
20526 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
20527 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
20528 @item
20529 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
20530 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
20531 @item
20532 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
20533 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20534 @end itemize
20535
20536 @noindent
20537 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
20538 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
20539 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
20540 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
20541 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
20542 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
20543 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
20544 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
20545 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
20546 way.
20547
20548 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
20549
20550 @kindex remove-symbol-file
20551 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
20552 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
20553 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
20554 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
20555 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
20556
20557 @smallexample
20558 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
20559 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
20560 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
20561 (y or n) y
20562 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...
20563 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
20564 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
20565 (gdb)
20566 @end smallexample
20567
20568
20569 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
20570
20571 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
20572 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
20573 @cindex load symbols from memory
20574 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
20575 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
20576 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
20577 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
20578 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
20579 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
20580 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
20581 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
20582 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
20583
20584 @kindex section
20585 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
20586 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
20587 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
20588 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
20589 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
20590 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
20591 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
20592 their addresses.
20593
20594 @kindex info files
20595 @kindex info target
20596 @item info files
20597 @itemx info target
20598 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
20599 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
20600 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
20601 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
20602 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
20603 current ones.
20604
20605 @kindex maint info sections
20606 @item maint info sections
20607 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
20608 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
20609 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
20610 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
20611 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
20612 may be arbitrarily combined):
20613
20614 @table @code
20615 @item ALLOBJ
20616 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
20617 @item @var{sections}
20618 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
20619 @item @var{section-flags}
20620 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
20621 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
20622 @table @code
20623 @item ALLOC
20624 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
20625 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
20626 @item LOAD
20627 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
20628 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
20629 @item RELOC
20630 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
20631 @item READONLY
20632 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
20633 @item CODE
20634 Section contains executable code only.
20635 @item DATA
20636 Section contains data only (no executable code).
20637 @item ROM
20638 Section will reside in ROM.
20639 @item CONSTRUCTOR
20640 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
20641 @item HAS_CONTENTS
20642 Section is not empty.
20643 @item NEVER_LOAD
20644 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
20645 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
20646 A notification to the linker that the section contains
20647 COFF shared library information.
20648 @item IS_COMMON
20649 Section contains common symbols.
20650 @end table
20651 @end table
20652 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
20653 @cindex read-only sections
20654 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
20655 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
20656 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
20657 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
20658 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
20659 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
20660 enhancement to debugging performance.
20661
20662 The default is off.
20663
20664 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
20665 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
20666 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
20667 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
20668
20669 @item show trust-readonly-sections
20670 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
20671 @end table
20672
20673 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
20674 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
20675 name and remembers it that way.
20676
20677 @cindex shared libraries
20678 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
20679 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
20680 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
20681 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
20682
20683 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
20684 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
20685
20686 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
20687 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
20688 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
20689 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
20690 debugging a core file).
20691
20692 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
20693 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
20694 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
20695
20696 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
20697 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
20698 particularly large or there are many of them.
20699
20700 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
20701 commands:
20702
20703 @table @code
20704 @kindex set auto-solib-add
20705 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
20706 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
20707 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
20708 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
20709 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
20710 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
20711 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
20712
20713 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
20714 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
20715 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
20716 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
20717 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
20718 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
20719 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
20720 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
20721 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
20722
20723 @kindex show auto-solib-add
20724 @item show auto-solib-add
20725 Display the current autoloading mode.
20726 @end table
20727
20728 @cindex load shared library
20729 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
20730 command:
20731
20732 @table @code
20733 @kindex info sharedlibrary
20734 @kindex info share
20735 @item info share @var{regex}
20736 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
20737 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
20738 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
20739 all shared libraries that are loaded.
20740
20741 @kindex info dll
20742 @item info dll @var{regex}
20743 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
20744
20745 @kindex sharedlibrary
20746 @kindex share
20747 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
20748 @itemx share @var{regex}
20749 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
20750 Unix regular expression.
20751 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
20752 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
20753 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
20754 loaded.
20755
20756 @item nosharedlibrary
20757 @kindex nosharedlibrary
20758 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
20759 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
20760 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
20761 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
20762 discarded.
20763 @end table
20764
20765 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
20766 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
20767 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
20768 Catchpoints}).
20769
20770 @value{GDBN} also supports the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
20771 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
20772 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
20773 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
20774
20775 @table @code
20776 @item set stop-on-solib-events
20777 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
20778 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
20779 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
20780 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
20781 shared library.
20782
20783 @item show stop-on-solib-events
20784 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
20785 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
20786 library events happen.
20787 @end table
20788
20789 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
20790 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
20791 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
20792 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
20793 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
20794 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
20795 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
20796 not.
20797
20798 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
20799 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
20800 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
20801 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
20802 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
20803
20804 @table @code
20805 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
20806 @cindex system root, alternate
20807 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
20808 @kindex set sysroot
20809 @item set sysroot @var{path}
20810 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
20811 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
20812 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
20813 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
20814 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
20815 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
20816 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
20817 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
20818 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
20819 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
20820 @var{path}.
20821
20822 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
20823 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
20824 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
20825 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
20826 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
20827 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
20828 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
20829 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
20830 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
20831 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
20832 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
20833 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
20834 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
20835 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
20836
20837 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
20838 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
20839 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
20840 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
20841 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
20842
20843 @smallexample
20844 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
20845 @end smallexample
20846
20847 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
20848 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
20849 system:
20850
20851 @smallexample
20852 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
20853 @end smallexample
20854
20855 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
20856 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
20857 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
20858 colons:
20859
20860 @smallexample
20861 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
20862 @end smallexample
20863
20864 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
20865 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
20866 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
20867 @samp{z}):
20868
20869 @smallexample
20870 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
20871 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
20872 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
20873 @end smallexample
20874
20875 @noindent
20876 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
20877 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
20878 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
20879
20880 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
20881 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
20882
20883 @smallexample
20884 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
20885 @end smallexample
20886
20887 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
20888 if you don't want or need to.
20889
20890 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
20891 sysroot}.
20892
20893 @cindex default system root
20894 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
20895 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
20896 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
20897 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20898 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
20899 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20900 location.
20901
20902 @kindex show sysroot
20903 @item show sysroot
20904 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
20905
20906 @kindex set solib-search-path
20907 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
20908 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20909 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
20910 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
20911 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
20912 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
20913 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
20914 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
20915 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
20916 of shared library symbols.
20917
20918 @kindex show solib-search-path
20919 @item show solib-search-path
20920 Display the current shared library search path.
20921
20922 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
20923 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
20924 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
20925 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
20926 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
20927
20928 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
20929 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
20930 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
20931 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
20932 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
20933 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
20934 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
20935 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
20936 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
20937 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
20938 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
20939 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
20940 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
20941 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
20942 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
20943 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
20944 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
20945 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
20946 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
20947 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
20948 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
20949 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
20950
20951 @table @code
20952 @item unix
20953 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
20954 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
20955 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
20956 the forward slash.
20957
20958 @item dos-based
20959 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
20960 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
20961 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
20962 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
20963 considered directory separators.
20964
20965 @item auto
20966 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
20967 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
20968 This is the default.
20969 @end table
20970 @end table
20971
20972 @cindex file name canonicalization
20973 @cindex base name differences
20974 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
20975 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
20976 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
20977 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
20978 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
20979 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
20980 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
20981 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
20982 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
20983 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
20984 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
20985 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
20986 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
20987 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
20988 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
20989
20990 @table @code
20991 @item set basenames-may-differ
20992 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
20993 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
20994
20995 @item show basenames-may-differ
20996 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
20997 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
20998 @end table
20999
21000 @node File Caching
21001 @section File Caching
21002 @cindex caching of opened files
21003 @cindex caching of bfd objects
21004
21005 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
21006 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
21007 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
21008 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
21009
21010 @table @code
21011 @kindex maint info bfds
21012 @item maint info bfds
21013 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
21014 @value{GDBN}.
21015
21016 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
21017 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
21018 @kindex bfd caching
21019 @item maint set bfd-sharing
21020 @item maint show bfd-sharing
21021 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
21022 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
21023 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
21024 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
21025 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
21026 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
21027 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
21028
21029 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
21030 @kindex bfd caching
21031 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
21032 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
21033
21034 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
21035 @kindex bfd caching
21036 @item show debug bfd-cache
21037 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
21038 @end table
21039
21040 @node Separate Debug Files
21041 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
21042 @cindex separate debugging information files
21043 @cindex debugging information in separate files
21044 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
21045 @cindex debugging information directory, global
21046 @cindex global debugging information directories
21047 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
21048 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
21049
21050 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
21051 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
21052 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
21053 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
21054 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
21055 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
21056 install only when they need to debug a problem.
21057
21058 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
21059 file:
21060
21061 @itemize @bullet
21062 @item
21063 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
21064 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
21065 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
21066 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
21067 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
21068 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
21069 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
21070 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
21071
21072 @item
21073 @anchor{build ID}
21074 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
21075 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
21076 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
21077 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
21078 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
21079 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
21080 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
21081 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
21082 below.
21083 @end itemize
21084
21085 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
21086 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
21087
21088 @itemize @bullet
21089 @item
21090 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
21091 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
21092 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the
21093 global debug directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to
21094 the leading directories of the executable's absolute file name. (On
21095 MS-Windows/MS-DOS, the drive letter of the executable's leading
21096 directories is converted to a one-letter subdirectory, i.e.@:
21097 @file{d:/usr/bin/} is converted to @file{/d/usr/bin/}, because Windows
21098 filesystems disallow colons in file names.)
21099
21100 @item
21101 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
21102 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
21103 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
21104 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
21105 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
21106 hex characters, not 10.)
21107 @end itemize
21108
21109 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
21110 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
21111 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
21112 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
21113 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
21114 debug information files, in the indicated order:
21115
21116 @itemize @minus
21117 @item
21118 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
21119 @item
21120 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
21121 @item
21122 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
21123 @item
21124 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
21125 @end itemize
21126
21127 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
21128 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
21129 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
21130 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
21131 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
21132
21133 @table @code
21134
21135 @kindex set debug-file-directory
21136 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
21137 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
21138 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
21139 concatenating them by a path separator.
21140
21141 @kindex show debug-file-directory
21142 @item show debug-file-directory
21143 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
21144 information files.
21145
21146 @end table
21147
21148 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
21149 @cindex debug link sections
21150 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
21151 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
21152
21153 @itemize
21154 @item
21155 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
21156 a zero byte,
21157 @item
21158 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
21159 boundary within the section, and
21160 @item
21161 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
21162 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
21163 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
21164 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
21165 @end itemize
21166
21167 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
21168 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
21169 described above.
21170
21171 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
21172 @cindex build ID sections
21173 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
21174 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
21175 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
21176 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
21177 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
21178 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
21179 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
21180 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
21181 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
21182
21183 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
21184 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
21185 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
21186 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
21187 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
21188 in an ordinary executable.
21189
21190 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
21191 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
21192 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
21193 following commands:
21194
21195 @smallexample
21196 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
21197 @kbd{strip -g foo}
21198 @end smallexample
21199
21200 @noindent
21201 These commands remove the debugging
21202 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
21203 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
21204 two files:
21205
21206 @itemize @bullet
21207 @item
21208 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
21209 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
21210
21211 @smallexample
21212 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
21213 @end smallexample
21214
21215 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
21216 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
21217 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
21218 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
21219
21220 @item
21221 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
21222 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
21223 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
21224 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
21225 @end itemize
21226
21227 @noindent
21228
21229 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
21230 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
21231 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
21232
21233 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
21234 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
21235 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
21236 @c different ways!
21237 @ifhtml
21238 @display
21239 @html
21240 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
21241 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
21242 @end html
21243 @end display
21244 @end ifhtml
21245 @ifnothtml
21246 @display
21247 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
21248 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
21249 @end display
21250 @end ifnothtml
21251
21252 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
21253 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
21254 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
21255 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
21256 CRC.
21257
21258 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
21259 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
21260 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
21261 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
21262 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
21263
21264 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
21265 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
21266 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
21267 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
21268 @code{0xffffffff}.
21269
21270 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
21271 @smallexample
21272 unsigned long
21273 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
21274 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
21275 @{
21276 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
21277 @{
21278 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
21279 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
21280 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
21281 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
21282 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
21283 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
21284 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
21285 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
21286 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
21287 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
21288 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
21289 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
21290 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
21291 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
21292 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
21293 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
21294 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
21295 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
21296 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
21297 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
21298 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
21299 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
21300 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
21301 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
21302 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
21303 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
21304 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
21305 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
21306 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
21307 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
21308 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
21309 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
21310 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
21311 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
21312 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
21313 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
21314 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
21315 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
21316 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
21317 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
21318 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
21319 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
21320 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
21321 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
21322 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
21323 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
21324 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
21325 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
21326 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
21327 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
21328 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
21329 0x2d02ef8d
21330 @};
21331 unsigned char *end;
21332
21333 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
21334 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
21335 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
21336 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
21337 @}
21338 @end smallexample
21339
21340 @noindent
21341 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
21342
21343 @node MiniDebugInfo
21344 @section Debugging information in a special section
21345 @cindex separate debug sections
21346 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
21347
21348 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
21349 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
21350 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
21351 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
21352
21353 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
21354 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
21355 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
21356 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
21357 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
21358 debugging information might be included in the section.
21359
21360 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
21361 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
21362 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
21363
21364 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
21365 standard utilities:
21366
21367 @smallexample
21368 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
21369 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
21370 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
21371 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
21372
21373 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
21374 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
21375 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
21376 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
21377 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
21378 | sort > funcsyms
21379
21380 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
21381 # table.
21382 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
21383
21384 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
21385 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
21386
21387 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
21388 # removing some unnecessary sections.
21389 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
21390 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
21391
21392 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
21393 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
21394
21395 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
21396 # original binary.
21397 xz mini_debuginfo
21398 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
21399 @end smallexample
21400
21401 @node Index Files
21402 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
21403 @cindex index files
21404 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
21405
21406 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
21407 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
21408 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
21409 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
21410 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
21411 startup.
21412
21413 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
21414 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
21415 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
21416
21417 @smallexample
21418 $ gdb-add-index symfile
21419 @end smallexample
21420
21421 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
21422
21423 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
21424 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
21425
21426 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
21427 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
21428 using @command{objcopy}.
21429
21430 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
21431
21432 @table @code
21433 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
21434 @kindex save gdb-index
21435 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
21436 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
21437 default creates it produces a single file
21438 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
21439 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
21440 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
21441 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
21442 given @var{directory}.
21443 @end table
21444
21445 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
21446 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
21447
21448 @smallexample
21449 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
21450 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
21451 @end smallexample
21452
21453 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
21454
21455 @smallexample
21456 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
21457 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
21458 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
21459 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
21460 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
21461 @end smallexample
21462
21463 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
21464 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
21465 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
21466 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
21467 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
21468 The default is @code{off}.
21469 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
21470 @xref{Index Section Format}.
21471
21472 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
21473 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
21474
21475 @smallexample
21476 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
21477 @end smallexample
21478
21479 Instead you must do, for example,
21480
21481 @smallexample
21482 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
21483 @end smallexample
21484
21485 Indices only work when using DWARF debugging information, not stabs.
21486
21487 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
21488
21489 @cindex automatic symbol index cache
21490 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
21491 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
21492 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
21493 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
21494
21495 @table @code
21496
21497 @kindex set index-cache
21498 @item set index-cache on
21499 @itemx set index-cache off
21500 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
21501
21502 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
21503 @kindex show index-cache
21504 @itemx show index-cache directory
21505 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
21506
21507 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
21508 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
21509 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
21510 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
21511 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
21512 differ according to local convention.
21513
21514 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
21515 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
21516
21517 @item show index-cache stats
21518 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
21519
21520 @end table
21521
21522 @node Symbol Errors
21523 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
21524
21525 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
21526 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
21527 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
21528 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
21529 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
21530 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
21531 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
21532 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
21533 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
21534 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
21535 Messages}).
21536
21537 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
21538
21539 @table @code
21540 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
21541
21542 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
21543 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
21544 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
21545 in its outer scope blocks.
21546
21547 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
21548 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
21549 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
21550 function.
21551
21552 @item block at @var{address} out of order
21553
21554 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
21555 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
21556 do so.
21557
21558 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
21559 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
21560 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
21561 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
21562 Messages}.)
21563
21564 @item bad block start address patched
21565
21566 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
21567 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
21568 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
21569
21570 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
21571 starting on the previous source line.
21572
21573 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
21574
21575 @cindex foo
21576 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
21577 larger than the size of the string table.
21578
21579 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
21580 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
21581 with this name.
21582
21583 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
21584
21585 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
21586 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
21587 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
21588
21589 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
21590 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
21591 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
21592 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
21593 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
21594 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
21595
21596 @item stub type has NULL name
21597
21598 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
21599
21600 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
21601 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
21602 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
21603 it.
21604
21605 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
21606
21607 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
21608
21609 @end table
21610
21611 @node Data Files
21612 @section GDB Data Files
21613
21614 @cindex prefix for data files
21615 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
21616 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
21617
21618 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
21619 is currently using.
21620
21621 @table @code
21622 @kindex set data-directory
21623 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
21624 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
21625 to @var{directory}.
21626
21627 @kindex show data-directory
21628 @item show data-directory
21629 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
21630 @end table
21631
21632 @cindex default data directory
21633 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
21634 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
21635 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
21636 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
21637 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
21638 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
21639 location.
21640
21641 The data directory may also be specified with the
21642 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
21643 @xref{Mode Options}.
21644
21645 @node Targets
21646 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
21647
21648 @cindex debugging target
21649 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
21650
21651 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
21652 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
21653 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
21654 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
21655 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
21656 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
21657 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
21658 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
21659
21660 @cindex target architecture
21661 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
21662 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
21663 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
21664 command.
21665
21666 @table @code
21667 @kindex set architecture
21668 @kindex show architecture
21669 @item set architecture @var{arch}
21670 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
21671 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
21672 supported architectures.
21673
21674 @item show architecture
21675 Show the current target architecture.
21676
21677 @item set processor
21678 @itemx processor
21679 @kindex set processor
21680 @kindex show processor
21681 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
21682 and @code{show architecture}.
21683 @end table
21684
21685 @menu
21686 * Active Targets:: Active targets
21687 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
21688 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
21689 @end menu
21690
21691 @node Active Targets
21692 @section Active Targets
21693
21694 @cindex stacking targets
21695 @cindex active targets
21696 @cindex multiple targets
21697
21698 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
21699 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
21700 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
21701 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
21702 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
21703 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
21704 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
21705 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
21706 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
21707
21708 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
21709 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
21710 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
21711 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
21712
21713 @node Target Commands
21714 @section Commands for Managing Targets
21715
21716 @table @code
21717 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
21718 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
21719 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
21720 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
21721 protocol of the target machine.
21722
21723 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
21724 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
21725 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
21726
21727 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
21728 after executing the command.
21729
21730 @kindex help target
21731 @item help target
21732 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
21733 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
21734 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
21735
21736 @item help target @var{name}
21737 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
21738 select it.
21739
21740 @kindex set gnutarget
21741 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
21742 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
21743 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
21744 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
21745 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
21746 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
21747
21748 @quotation
21749 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
21750 you must know the actual BFD name.
21751 @end quotation
21752
21753 @noindent
21754 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
21755
21756 @kindex show gnutarget
21757 @item show gnutarget
21758 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
21759 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
21760 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
21761 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
21762 @end table
21763
21764 @cindex common targets
21765 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
21766 configuration):
21767
21768 @table @code
21769 @kindex target
21770 @item target exec @var{program}
21771 @cindex executable file target
21772 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
21773 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
21774
21775 @item target core @var{filename}
21776 @cindex core dump file target
21777 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
21778 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
21779
21780 @item target remote @var{medium}
21781 @cindex remote target
21782 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
21783 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
21784 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
21785
21786 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
21787 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
21788
21789 @smallexample
21790 target remote /dev/ttya
21791 @end smallexample
21792
21793 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
21794 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
21795 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
21796 clobbered by the download.
21797
21798 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21799 @cindex built-in simulator target
21800 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
21801 In general,
21802 @smallexample
21803 target sim
21804 load
21805 run
21806 @end smallexample
21807 @noindent
21808 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
21809 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
21810 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
21811 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
21812 Processors}.
21813
21814 @item target native
21815 @cindex native target
21816 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
21817 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
21818 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
21819 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
21820
21821 @end table
21822
21823 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
21824 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
21825
21826 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
21827 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
21828 various aspects of this process.
21829
21830 @table @code
21831
21832 @item set hash
21833 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
21834 @cindex hash mark while downloading
21835 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
21836 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
21837 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
21838 monitor.
21839
21840 @item show hash
21841 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
21842 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
21843
21844 @item set debug monitor
21845 @kindex set debug monitor
21846 @cindex display remote monitor communications
21847 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
21848 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
21849
21850 @item show debug monitor
21851 @kindex show debug monitor
21852 Show the current status of displaying communications between
21853 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
21854 @end table
21855
21856 @table @code
21857
21858 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
21859 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
21860 @anchor{load}
21861 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
21862 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
21863 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
21864 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
21865 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
21866 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
21867
21868 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
21869 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
21870 target is @dots{}}''
21871
21872 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
21873 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
21874 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
21875 specifies a fixed address.
21876 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
21877
21878 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
21879 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
21880 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
21881
21882 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
21883 load programs into flash memory.
21884
21885 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
21886 @end table
21887
21888 @table @code
21889
21890 @kindex flash-erase
21891 @item flash-erase
21892 @anchor{flash-erase}
21893
21894 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
21895
21896 @end table
21897
21898 @node Byte Order
21899 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
21900
21901 @cindex choosing target byte order
21902 @cindex target byte order
21903
21904 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
21905 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
21906 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
21907 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
21908 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
21909 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
21910
21911 @table @code
21912 @kindex set endian
21913 @item set endian big
21914 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
21915
21916 @item set endian little
21917 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
21918
21919 @item set endian auto
21920 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
21921 executable.
21922
21923 @item show endian
21924 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
21925
21926 @end table
21927
21928 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
21929 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
21930 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
21931 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
21932 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
21933 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
21934 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
21935 and @code{big} otherwise.
21936
21937 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
21938 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
21939 target system.
21940
21941
21942 @node Remote Debugging
21943 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
21944 @cindex remote debugging
21945
21946 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
21947 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
21948 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
21949 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
21950 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
21951
21952 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
21953 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
21954 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
21955 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
21956 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
21957 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
21958
21959 Other remote targets may be available in your
21960 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
21961
21962 @menu
21963 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
21964 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
21965 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
21966 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
21967 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
21968 @end menu
21969
21970 @node Connecting
21971 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
21972 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
21973 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
21974 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
21975 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
21976 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
21977 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
21978
21979 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
21980 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
21981 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
21982 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
21983
21984 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
21985
21986 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
21987 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
21988 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
21989 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
21990
21991 @table @asis
21992
21993 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
21994 @item Result of detach or program exit
21995 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
21996 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
21997 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
21998
21999 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
22000 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
22001 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
22002 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
22003
22004 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
22005 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
22006 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
22007 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
22008
22009 @item Specifying the program to debug
22010 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
22011 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
22012 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
22013 target.
22014
22015 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
22016 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
22017 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
22018
22019 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
22020 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
22021 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
22022 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
22023
22024 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
22025 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
22026 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
22027 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
22028 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
22029 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
22030 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
22031 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
22032 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
22033
22034 @item The @code{run} command
22035 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
22036 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
22037 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
22038 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
22039 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
22040
22041 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
22042 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
22043 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
22044 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
22045 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
22046
22047 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
22048 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
22049 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
22050 @code{target remote} mode.
22051
22052 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
22053 @item Attaching
22054 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
22055 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
22056 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
22057
22058 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
22059 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
22060 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
22061 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
22062 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
22063
22064 Some remote targets allow @value{GDBN} to determine the executable file running
22065 in the process the debugger is attaching to. In such a case, @value{GDBN}
22066 uses the value of @code{exec-file-mismatch} to handle a possible mismatch
22067 between the executable file name running in the process and the name of the
22068 current exec-file loaded by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set exec-file-mismatch}).
22069
22070 @end table
22071
22072 @anchor{Host and target files}
22073 @subsection Host and Target Files
22074 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
22075 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
22076
22077 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
22078 information for your program running on the target. This requires
22079 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
22080 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
22081 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
22082
22083 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
22084 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
22085 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
22086 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
22087 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
22088
22089 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
22090 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
22091 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
22092 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
22093 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
22094 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
22095 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
22096 target libraries.
22097
22098 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
22099 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
22100 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
22101 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
22102 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
22103 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
22104 programs.
22105
22106 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
22107 @cindex remote connection commands
22108 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
22109 local Unix domain socket, or
22110 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
22111 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
22112 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
22113 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
22114 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
22115 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
22116
22117 @table @code
22118
22119 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
22120 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
22121 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
22122 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
22123 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
22124
22125 @smallexample
22126 target remote /dev/ttyb
22127 @end smallexample
22128
22129 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
22130 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
22131 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
22132 @code{target} command.
22133
22134 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
22135 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
22136 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
22137 @cindex Unix domain socket
22138 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
22139 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
22140
22141 @smallexample
22142 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
22143 @end smallexample
22144
22145 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
22146 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
22147 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
22148 of connection.
22149 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
22150 Unix domain sockets.
22151
22152 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
22153 @itemx target remote @code{[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
22154 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22155 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
22156 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22157 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22158 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
22159 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
22160 @itemx target extended-remote @code{[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
22161 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22162 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
22163 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22164 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22165 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
22166 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
22167 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
22168 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
22169 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
22170 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
22171 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
22172 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
22173 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
22174
22175 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
22176 @code{manyfarms}:
22177
22178 @smallexample
22179 target remote manyfarms:2828
22180 @end smallexample
22181
22182 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
22183 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
22184 square bracket syntax:
22185
22186 @smallexample
22187 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
22188 @end smallexample
22189
22190 @noindent
22191 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
22192
22193 @smallexample
22194 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
22195 @end smallexample
22196
22197 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
22198 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
22199 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
22200 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
22201 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
22202 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
22203
22204 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
22205 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
22206 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
22207 port 1234 on your local machine:
22208
22209 @smallexample
22210 target remote :1234
22211 @end smallexample
22212 @noindent
22213
22214 Note that the colon is still required here.
22215
22216 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22217 @itemx target remote @code{udp:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
22218 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22219 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
22220 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22221 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22222 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
22223 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22224 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
22225 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
22226 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
22227 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
22228 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
22229
22230 @smallexample
22231 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
22232 @end smallexample
22233
22234 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
22235 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
22236 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
22237 cause havoc with your debugging session.
22238
22239 @item target remote | @var{command}
22240 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
22241 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
22242 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
22243 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
22244 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
22245 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
22246 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
22247 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
22248 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
22249
22250 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
22251 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
22252 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
22253
22254 @end table
22255
22256 @cindex interrupting remote programs
22257 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
22258 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
22259 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
22260 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
22261 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
22262 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
22263
22264 @smallexample
22265 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
22266 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
22267 @end smallexample
22268
22269 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
22270 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
22271 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
22272 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
22273
22274 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
22275 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
22276
22277 @table @code
22278 @kindex detach (remote)
22279 @item detach
22280 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
22281 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
22282 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
22283 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
22284 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
22285 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
22286 still connected to the target.
22287
22288 @kindex disconnect
22289 @item disconnect
22290 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
22291 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
22292 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
22293 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
22294 another target.
22295
22296 @cindex send command to remote monitor
22297 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
22298 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
22299 @kindex monitor
22300 @item monitor @var{cmd}
22301 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
22302 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
22303 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
22304 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
22305 and implement.
22306 @end table
22307
22308 @node File Transfer
22309 @section Sending files to a remote system
22310 @cindex remote target, file transfer
22311 @cindex file transfer
22312 @cindex sending files to remote systems
22313
22314 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
22315 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
22316 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
22317 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
22318 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
22319 the only way to upload or download files.
22320
22321 Not all remote targets support these commands.
22322
22323 @table @code
22324 @kindex remote put
22325 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
22326 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
22327 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
22328
22329 @kindex remote get
22330 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
22331 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
22332 on the host system.
22333
22334 @kindex remote delete
22335 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
22336 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
22337
22338 @end table
22339
22340 @node Server
22341 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
22342
22343 @kindex gdbserver
22344 @cindex remote connection without stubs
22345 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
22346 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
22347 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
22348 linking in the usual debugging stub.
22349
22350 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
22351 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
22352 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
22353 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
22354 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
22355 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
22356 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
22357 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
22358 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
22359 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
22360 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
22361 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
22362 choice for debugging.
22363
22364 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
22365 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
22366 protocol.
22367
22368 @quotation
22369 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
22370 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
22371 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
22372 target system with the same privileges as the user running
22373 @code{gdbserver}.
22374 @end quotation
22375
22376 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
22377 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
22378 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
22379 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
22380
22381 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
22382 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
22383 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
22384 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
22385 system does all the symbol handling.
22386
22387 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
22388 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
22389 syntax is:
22390
22391 @smallexample
22392 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
22393 @end smallexample
22394
22395 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
22396 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
22397 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
22398 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
22399 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
22400 @file{/dev/com1}:
22401
22402 @smallexample
22403 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
22404 @end smallexample
22405
22406 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
22407 with it.
22408
22409 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
22410
22411 @smallexample
22412 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
22413 @end smallexample
22414
22415 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
22416 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
22417 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
22418 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
22419 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
22420 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
22421 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
22422 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
22423 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
22424 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
22425 @code{target remote} command.
22426
22427 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
22428 with ssh:
22429
22430 @smallexample
22431 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
22432 @end smallexample
22433
22434 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
22435 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
22436 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
22437 You could elide it if you want to.
22438
22439 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
22440 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
22441 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
22442 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
22443
22444 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
22445 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
22446 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
22447 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
22448
22449 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
22450 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
22451
22452 @smallexample
22453 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
22454 @end smallexample
22455
22456 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
22457 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
22458
22459 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
22460 @value{GDBN} attach command
22461 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
22462
22463 @pindex pidof
22464 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
22465 @code{pidof} utility:
22466
22467 @smallexample
22468 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
22469 @end smallexample
22470
22471 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
22472 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
22473 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
22474
22475 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
22476
22477 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
22478 port.
22479
22480 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
22481 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
22482 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
22483 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
22484 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
22485 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
22486 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
22487 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
22488
22489 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
22490 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
22491 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
22492
22493 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
22494 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
22495 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
22496 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
22497 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
22498 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
22499 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
22500 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
22501 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
22502 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
22503 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
22504 instance closes its port after the first connection.
22505
22506 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
22507 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
22508
22509 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
22510 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
22511 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
22512 program. For more information,
22513 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
22514
22515 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
22516 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
22517 status information about the debugging process.
22518 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
22519 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
22520 remote protocol debug output.
22521 @cindex @option{--debug-file}, @code{gdbserver} option
22522 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, send all debug output to a single file
22523 The @option{--debug-file=@var{filename}} option tells @code{gdbserver} to
22524 write any debug output to the given @var{filename}. These options are intended
22525 for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
22526
22527 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
22528 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
22529 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
22530 Possible options are:
22531
22532 @table @code
22533 @item none
22534 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
22535 @item all
22536 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
22537 @item timestamps
22538 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
22539 @end table
22540
22541 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
22542 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
22543
22544 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
22545 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
22546 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
22547 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
22548 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
22549
22550 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
22551 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
22552 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
22553 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
22554
22555 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
22556 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
22557 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
22558 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
22559
22560 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
22561 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
22562 environment:
22563
22564 @smallexample
22565 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
22566 @end smallexample
22567
22568 @cindex @option{--selftest}
22569 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
22570
22571 @smallexample
22572 $ gdbserver --selftest
22573 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
22574 @end smallexample
22575
22576 These tests are disabled in release.
22577 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
22578
22579 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
22580 @itemize
22581
22582 @item
22583 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
22584
22585 @item
22586 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
22587 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
22588 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
22589 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
22590 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
22591 @code{--with-sysroot}).
22592
22593 @item
22594 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22595 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
22596 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
22597 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
22598 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
22599 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
22600 program is already on the target.
22601
22602 @end itemize
22603
22604 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
22605 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
22606 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
22607
22608 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
22609 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
22610 Here are the available commands.
22611
22612 @table @code
22613 @item monitor help
22614 List the available monitor commands.
22615
22616 @item monitor set debug 0
22617 @itemx monitor set debug 1
22618 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
22619
22620 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
22621 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
22622 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
22623 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
22624
22625 @item monitor set debug-file filename
22626 @itemx monitor set debug-file
22627 Send any debug output to the given file, or to stderr.
22628
22629 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
22630 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
22631 Possible options are:
22632
22633 @table @code
22634 @item none
22635 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
22636 @item all
22637 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
22638 @item timestamps
22639 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
22640 @end table
22641
22642 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
22643 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
22644
22645 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
22646 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
22647 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
22648 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
22649 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
22650 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
22651
22652 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
22653 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
22654
22655 @item monitor exit
22656 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
22657 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
22658 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
22659 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
22660 of a multi-process mode debug session.
22661
22662 @end table
22663
22664 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
22665 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
22666
22667 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
22668 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
22669
22670 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
22671 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
22672 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
22673 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
22674 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
22675 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
22676 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
22677 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
22678 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
22679 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
22680 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
22681 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
22682
22683 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
22684
22685 @table @code
22686 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
22687
22688 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
22689 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
22690 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
22691
22692 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
22693
22694 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
22695 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
22696 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
22697 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
22698 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
22699 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
22700
22701 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
22702
22703 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
22704 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
22705 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
22706 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
22707 command for that. For example:
22708
22709 @smallexample
22710 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
22711 @end smallexample
22712
22713 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
22714 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
22715 @end table
22716
22717 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
22718 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
22719 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
22720 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
22721 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
22722 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
22723 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
22724 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
22725 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
22726 @code{gdbserver} like so:
22727
22728 @smallexample
22729 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
22730 @end smallexample
22731
22732 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
22733
22734 @smallexample
22735 $ gdb myprogram
22736 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
22737 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
22738 (@value{GDBP}) b main
22739 (@value{GDBP}) continue
22740 @end smallexample
22741
22742 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
22743 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
22744 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
22745 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
22746 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
22747 tracing.
22748
22749 @node Remote Configuration
22750 @section Remote Configuration
22751
22752 @kindex set remote
22753 @kindex show remote
22754 This section documents the configuration options available when
22755 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
22756 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
22757 system-call-allowed}.
22758
22759 @table @code
22760 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
22761 @cindex address size for remote targets
22762 @cindex bits in remote address
22763 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
22764 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
22765 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
22766 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
22767
22768 @item show remoteaddresssize
22769 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
22770
22771 @item set serial baud @var{n}
22772 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
22773 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
22774 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
22775 remote targets.
22776
22777 @item show serial baud
22778 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
22779
22780 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
22781 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
22782 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
22783
22784 @item show serial parity
22785 Show the current parity of the serial port.
22786
22787 @item set remotebreak
22788 @cindex interrupt remote programs
22789 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
22790 @anchor{set remotebreak}
22791 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
22792 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
22793 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
22794 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
22795 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
22796
22797 @item show remotebreak
22798 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
22799 interrupt the remote program.
22800
22801 @item set remoteflow on
22802 @itemx set remoteflow off
22803 @kindex set remoteflow
22804 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
22805 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
22806
22807 @item show remoteflow
22808 @kindex show remoteflow
22809 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
22810
22811 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
22812 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
22813 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
22814 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
22815 @code{ascii}.
22816
22817 @item show remotelogbase
22818 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
22819 protocol.
22820
22821 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
22822 @cindex record serial communications on file
22823 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
22824 default is not to record at all.
22825
22826 @item show remotelogfile
22827 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
22828 serial communications.
22829
22830 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
22831 @cindex timeout for serial communications
22832 @cindex remote timeout
22833 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
22834 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
22835
22836 @item show remotetimeout
22837 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
22838 responses.
22839
22840 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
22841 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
22842 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
22843 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
22844 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
22845 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
22846 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
22847 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
22848 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
22849 watchpoints or breakpoints.
22850
22851 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
22852 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
22853 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
22854 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
22855
22856 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
22857 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
22858 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
22859 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
22860 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
22861 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
22862 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
22863 length.
22864
22865 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
22866 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
22867 a remote hardware watchpoint.
22868
22869 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
22870 @itemx show remote exec-file
22871 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
22872 @cindex executable file, for remote target
22873 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
22874 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
22875 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
22876 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
22877
22878 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
22879 @cindex interrupt remote programs
22880 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
22881 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
22882 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
22883 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
22884 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
22885 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
22886 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
22887 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
22888
22889 @item show interrupt-sequence
22890 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
22891 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
22892 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
22893 also known as Magic SysRq g.
22894
22895 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
22896 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
22897 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
22898 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
22899 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
22900 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
22901
22902 @item show interrupt-on-connect
22903 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
22904 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
22905
22906 @kindex set tcp
22907 @kindex show tcp
22908 @item set tcp auto-retry on
22909 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
22910 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
22911 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
22912 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
22913 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
22914 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
22915 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
22916 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
22917
22918 @item set tcp auto-retry off
22919 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
22920
22921 @item show tcp auto-retry
22922 Show the current auto-retry setting.
22923
22924 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
22925 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
22926 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
22927 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
22928 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
22929 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
22930 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
22931 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
22932 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
22933 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
22934 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
22935
22936 @item show tcp connect-timeout
22937 Show the current connection timeout setting.
22938 @end table
22939
22940 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
22941 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
22942 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
22943 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
22944 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
22945 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
22946 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
22947 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
22948 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
22949
22950 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
22951 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
22952 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
22953 @value{GDBN} developers.
22954
22955 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
22956 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
22957 are:
22958
22959 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
22960 @item Command Name
22961 @tab Remote Packet
22962 @tab Related Features
22963
22964 @item @code{fetch-register}
22965 @tab @code{p}
22966 @tab @code{info registers}
22967
22968 @item @code{set-register}
22969 @tab @code{P}
22970 @tab @code{set}
22971
22972 @item @code{binary-download}
22973 @tab @code{X}
22974 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
22975
22976 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
22977 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
22978 @tab @code{info auxv}
22979
22980 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
22981 @tab @code{qSymbol}
22982 @tab Detecting multiple threads
22983
22984 @item @code{attach}
22985 @tab @code{vAttach}
22986 @tab @code{attach}
22987
22988 @item @code{verbose-resume}
22989 @tab @code{vCont}
22990 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
22991
22992 @item @code{run}
22993 @tab @code{vRun}
22994 @tab @code{run}
22995
22996 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
22997 @tab @code{Z0}
22998 @tab @code{break}
22999
23000 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
23001 @tab @code{Z1}
23002 @tab @code{hbreak}
23003
23004 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
23005 @tab @code{Z2}
23006 @tab @code{watch}
23007
23008 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
23009 @tab @code{Z3}
23010 @tab @code{rwatch}
23011
23012 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
23013 @tab @code{Z4}
23014 @tab @code{awatch}
23015
23016 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
23017 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
23018 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
23019
23020 @item @code{target-features}
23021 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
23022 @tab @code{set architecture}
23023
23024 @item @code{library-info}
23025 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
23026 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
23027
23028 @item @code{memory-map}
23029 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23030 @tab @code{info mem}
23031
23032 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
23033 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
23034 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
23035
23036 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
23037 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
23038 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
23039
23040 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
23041 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
23042 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
23043
23044 @item @code{threads}
23045 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
23046 @tab @code{info threads}
23047
23048 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
23049 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
23050 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
23051
23052 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
23053 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
23054 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
23055
23056 @item @code{search-memory}
23057 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
23058 @tab @code{find}
23059
23060 @item @code{supported-packets}
23061 @tab @code{qSupported}
23062 @tab Remote communications parameters
23063
23064 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
23065 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
23066 @tab @code{catch syscall}
23067
23068 @item @code{pass-signals}
23069 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
23070 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
23071
23072 @item @code{program-signals}
23073 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
23074 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
23075
23076 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
23077 @tab @code{vFile:close}
23078 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
23079
23080 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
23081 @tab @code{vFile:open}
23082 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
23083
23084 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
23085 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
23086 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
23087
23088 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
23089 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
23090 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
23091
23092 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
23093 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
23094 @tab @code{remote delete}
23095
23096 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
23097 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
23098 @tab Host I/O
23099
23100 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
23101 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
23102 @tab Host I/O
23103
23104 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
23105 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
23106 @tab Host I/O
23107
23108 @item @code{noack-packet}
23109 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
23110 @tab Packet acknowledgment
23111
23112 @item @code{osdata}
23113 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
23114 @tab @code{info os}
23115
23116 @item @code{query-attached}
23117 @tab @code{qAttached}
23118 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
23119
23120 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
23121 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
23122 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
23123
23124 @item @code{trace-status}
23125 @tab @code{qTStatus}
23126 @tab @code{tstatus}
23127
23128 @item @code{traceframe-info}
23129 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
23130 @tab Traceframe info
23131
23132 @item @code{install-in-trace}
23133 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
23134 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
23135
23136 @item @code{disable-randomization}
23137 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
23138 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
23139
23140 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
23141 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
23142 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
23143
23144 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
23145 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
23146 @tab @code{set environment}
23147
23148 @item @code{environment-unset}
23149 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
23150 @tab @code{unset environment}
23151
23152 @item @code{environment-reset}
23153 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
23154 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
23155
23156 @item @code{set-working-dir}
23157 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
23158 @tab @code{set cwd}
23159
23160 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
23161 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
23162 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
23163
23164 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
23165 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
23166 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
23167
23168 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
23169 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
23170 @tab @code{break}
23171
23172 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
23173 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
23174 @tab @code{hbreak}
23175
23176 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
23177 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
23178 @tab @code{fork}
23179
23180 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
23181 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
23182 @tab @code{vfork}
23183
23184 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
23185 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
23186 @tab @code{exec}
23187
23188 @item @code{thread-events}
23189 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
23190 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
23191
23192 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
23193 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
23194 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
23195
23196 @end multitable
23197
23198 @node Remote Stub
23199 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
23200
23201 @cindex debugging stub, example
23202 @cindex remote stub, example
23203 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
23204 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
23205 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
23206 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
23207 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
23208 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
23209 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
23210 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
23211
23212 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
23213 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
23214 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
23215 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
23216 program, you need:
23217
23218 @enumerate
23219 @item
23220 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
23221 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
23222 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
23223
23224 @item
23225 A C subroutine library to support your program's
23226 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
23227
23228 @item
23229 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
23230 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
23231 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
23232 documentation.
23233 @end enumerate
23234
23235 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
23236 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
23237 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
23238
23239 @table @emph
23240 @item On the host,
23241 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
23242 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
23243 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
23244
23245 @item On the target,
23246 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
23247 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
23248 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
23249
23250 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
23251 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
23252 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
23253 @end table
23254
23255 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
23256 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
23257 @sc{sparc} boards.
23258
23259 @cindex remote serial stub list
23260 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
23261
23262 @table @code
23263
23264 @item i386-stub.c
23265 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
23266 @cindex Intel
23267 @cindex i386
23268 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
23269
23270 @item m68k-stub.c
23271 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
23272 @cindex Motorola 680x0
23273 @cindex m680x0
23274 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
23275
23276 @item sh-stub.c
23277 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
23278 @cindex Renesas
23279 @cindex SH
23280 For Renesas SH architectures.
23281
23282 @item sparc-stub.c
23283 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
23284 @cindex Sparc
23285 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
23286
23287 @item sparcl-stub.c
23288 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
23289 @cindex Fujitsu
23290 @cindex SparcLite
23291 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
23292
23293 @end table
23294
23295 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
23296 recently added stubs.
23297
23298 @menu
23299 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
23300 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
23301 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
23302 @end menu
23303
23304 @node Stub Contents
23305 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
23306
23307 @cindex remote serial stub
23308 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
23309 subroutines:
23310
23311 @table @code
23312 @item set_debug_traps
23313 @findex set_debug_traps
23314 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
23315 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
23316 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
23317 program's startup code.
23318
23319 @item handle_exception
23320 @findex handle_exception
23321 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
23322 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
23323 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
23324 run when a trap is triggered.
23325
23326 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
23327 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
23328 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
23329 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
23330 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
23331 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
23332 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
23333 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
23334 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
23335 machine.
23336
23337 @item breakpoint
23338 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
23339 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
23340 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
23341 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
23342 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
23343 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
23344 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
23345 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
23346 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
23347 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
23348 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
23349
23350 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
23351 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
23352 start of your debugging session.
23353 @end table
23354
23355 @node Bootstrapping
23356 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
23357
23358 @cindex remote stub, support routines
23359 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
23360 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
23361 debugging target machine.
23362
23363 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
23364 serial port.
23365
23366 @table @code
23367 @item int getDebugChar()
23368 @findex getDebugChar
23369 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
23370 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
23371 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
23372
23373 @item void putDebugChar(int)
23374 @findex putDebugChar
23375 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
23376 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
23377 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
23378 @end table
23379
23380 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
23381 @cindex interrupting remote targets
23382 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
23383 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
23384 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
23385 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
23386 remote system to stop.
23387
23388 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
23389 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
23390 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
23391 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
23392
23393 Other routines you need to supply are:
23394
23395 @table @code
23396 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
23397 @findex exceptionHandler
23398 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
23399 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
23400 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
23401 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
23402 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
23403 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
23404 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
23405 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
23406 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
23407 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
23408 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
23409 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
23410 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
23411
23412 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
23413 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
23414 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
23415 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
23416 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
23417
23418 @item void flush_i_cache()
23419 @findex flush_i_cache
23420 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
23421 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
23422 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
23423
23424 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
23425 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
23426 @end table
23427
23428 @noindent
23429 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
23430
23431 @table @code
23432 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
23433 @findex memset
23434 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
23435 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
23436 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
23437 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
23438 @end table
23439
23440 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
23441 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
23442 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
23443 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
23444
23445
23446 @node Debug Session
23447 @subsection Putting it All Together
23448
23449 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
23450 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
23451 steps.
23452
23453 @enumerate
23454 @item
23455 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
23456 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
23457 @display
23458 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
23459 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
23460 @end display
23461
23462 @item
23463 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
23464 procedure is called:
23465
23466 @smallexample
23467 set_debug_traps();
23468 breakpoint();
23469 @end smallexample
23470
23471 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
23472 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
23473 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
23474 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
23475 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
23476 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
23477 progress.
23478
23479 @item
23480 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
23481 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
23482
23483 @smallexample
23484 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
23485 @end smallexample
23486
23487 @noindent
23488 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
23489 function in your program, that function is called when
23490 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
23491 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
23492 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
23493
23494 @item
23495 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
23496 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
23497
23498 @item
23499 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
23500 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
23501
23502 @item
23503 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
23504 @c document that. FIXME.
23505 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
23506 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
23507
23508 @item
23509 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
23510 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
23511
23512 @end enumerate
23513
23514 @node Configurations
23515 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
23516
23517 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
23518 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
23519 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
23520
23521 There are three major categories of configurations: native
23522 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
23523 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
23524 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
23525 are quite different from each other.
23526
23527 @menu
23528 * Native::
23529 * Embedded OS::
23530 * Embedded Processors::
23531 * Architectures::
23532 @end menu
23533
23534 @node Native
23535 @section Native
23536
23537 This section describes details specific to particular native
23538 configurations.
23539
23540 @menu
23541 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
23542 * Process Information:: Process information
23543 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
23544 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
23545 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
23546 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
23547 * FreeBSD:: Features specific to FreeBSD
23548 @end menu
23549
23550 @node BSD libkvm Interface
23551 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
23552
23553 @cindex libkvm
23554 @cindex kernel memory image
23555 @cindex kernel crash dump
23556
23557 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
23558 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
23559 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
23560 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
23561 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
23562 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
23563 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
23564 @code{kvm} target:
23565
23566 @smallexample
23567 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
23568 @end smallexample
23569
23570 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
23571 argument:
23572
23573 @smallexample
23574 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
23575 @end smallexample
23576
23577 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
23578 available:
23579
23580 @table @code
23581 @kindex kvm
23582 @item kvm pcb
23583 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
23584
23585 @item kvm proc
23586 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
23587 modern FreeBSD systems.
23588 @end table
23589
23590 @node Process Information
23591 @subsection Process Information
23592 @cindex /proc
23593 @cindex examine process image
23594 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
23595
23596 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
23597 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
23598 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
23599 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
23600 to report information about the process running your program, or about
23601 any process running on your system.
23602
23603 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
23604 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
23605 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
23606 systems.
23607
23608 On FreeBSD and NetBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query
23609 process information.
23610
23611 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
23612 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
23613 information available from a live process. Process information is
23614 currently available from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
23615 systems.
23616
23617 @table @code
23618 @kindex info proc
23619 @cindex process ID
23620 @item info proc
23621 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
23622 Summarize available information about a process. If a
23623 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
23624 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
23625 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
23626 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
23627 executable file's absolute file name.
23628
23629 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
23630 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
23631 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
23632 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
23633 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
23634 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
23635
23636 @item info proc cmdline
23637 @cindex info proc cmdline
23638 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
23639 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
23640
23641 @item info proc cwd
23642 @cindex info proc cwd
23643 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
23644 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
23645
23646 @item info proc exe
23647 @cindex info proc exe
23648 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
23649 on @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
23650
23651 @item info proc files
23652 @cindex info proc files
23653 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
23654 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
23655 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
23656 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
23657 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
23658 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
23659 FreeBSD.
23660
23661 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
23662 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
23663
23664 @smallexample
23665 (gdb) info proc files 22136
23666 process 22136
23667 Open files:
23668
23669 FD Type Offset Flags Name
23670 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
23671 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
23672 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
23673 root dir - r-------- /
23674 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23675 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23676 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23677 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
23678 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
23679 @end smallexample
23680
23681 @item info proc mappings
23682 @cindex memory address space mappings
23683 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
23684 Solaris, FreeBSD and NetBSD systems, each memory range includes information
23685 on whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
23686 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD systems, each memory range
23687 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
23688
23689 @item info proc stat
23690 @itemx info proc status
23691 @cindex process detailed status information
23692 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
23693 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
23694 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
23695 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
23696 on @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
23697
23698 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
23699 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
23700
23701 For FreeBSD and NetBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for
23702 @code{info proc status}.
23703
23704 @item info proc all
23705 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
23706 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
23707
23708 @ignore
23709 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
23710 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
23711 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
23712 @kindex info proc times
23713 @item info proc times
23714 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
23715 its children.
23716
23717 @kindex info proc id
23718 @item info proc id
23719 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
23720 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
23721 @end ignore
23722
23723 @item set procfs-trace
23724 @kindex set procfs-trace
23725 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
23726 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
23727
23728 @item show procfs-trace
23729 @kindex show procfs-trace
23730 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
23731
23732 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
23733 @kindex set procfs-file
23734 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
23735 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
23736 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
23737 standard output.
23738
23739 @item show procfs-file
23740 @kindex show procfs-file
23741 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
23742
23743 @item proc-trace-entry
23744 @itemx proc-trace-exit
23745 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
23746 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
23747 @kindex proc-trace-entry
23748 @kindex proc-trace-exit
23749 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
23750 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
23751 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
23752 from the @code{syscall} interface.
23753
23754 @item info pidlist
23755 @kindex info pidlist
23756 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
23757 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
23758 processes and all the threads within each process.
23759
23760 @item info meminfo
23761 @kindex info meminfo
23762 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
23763 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
23764 @end table
23765
23766 @node DJGPP Native
23767 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
23768 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
23769 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
23770 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
23771
23772 @cindex DPMI
23773 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
23774 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
23775 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
23776 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
23777
23778 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
23779 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
23780 subsection describes those commands.
23781
23782 @table @code
23783 @kindex info dos
23784 @item info dos
23785 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
23786 information about the target system and important OS structures.
23787
23788 @kindex sysinfo
23789 @cindex MS-DOS system info
23790 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
23791 @item info dos sysinfo
23792 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
23793 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
23794 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
23795
23796 @cindex GDT
23797 @cindex LDT
23798 @cindex IDT
23799 @cindex segment descriptor tables
23800 @cindex descriptor tables display
23801 @item info dos gdt
23802 @itemx info dos ldt
23803 @itemx info dos idt
23804 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
23805 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
23806 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
23807 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
23808 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
23809 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
23810 rights.
23811
23812 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
23813 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
23814 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
23815 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
23816 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
23817
23818 @cindex garbled pointers
23819 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
23820 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
23821 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
23822 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
23823 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
23824 debugged program's data segment:
23825
23826 @smallexample
23827 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
23828 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
23829 @end smallexample
23830
23831 @noindent
23832 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
23833 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
23834
23835 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
23836 @item info dos pde
23837 @itemx info dos pte
23838 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
23839 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
23840 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
23841 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
23842 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
23843 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
23844 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
23845 that is currently in use.
23846
23847 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
23848 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
23849 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
23850 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
23851 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
23852 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
23853 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
23854
23855 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
23856 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
23857 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
23858 controller.
23859
23860 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
23861
23862 @cindex physical address from linear address
23863 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
23864 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
23865 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
23866 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
23867 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
23868 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
23869 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
23870
23871 @smallexample
23872 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
23873 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
23874 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
23875 @end smallexample
23876
23877 @noindent
23878 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
23879 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
23880 attributes of that page.
23881
23882 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
23883 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
23884 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
23885 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
23886 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
23887 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
23888
23889 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
23890 transfer buffer:
23891
23892 @smallexample
23893 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
23894 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
23895 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
23896 @end smallexample
23897
23898 @noindent
23899 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
23900 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
23901 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
23902 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
23903 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
23904
23905 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
23906 @end table
23907
23908 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
23909 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
23910 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
23911 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
23912
23913 @table @code
23914 @kindex set com1base
23915 @kindex set com1irq
23916 @kindex set com2base
23917 @kindex set com2irq
23918 @kindex set com3base
23919 @kindex set com3irq
23920 @kindex set com4base
23921 @kindex set com4irq
23922 @item set com1base @var{addr}
23923 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
23924 port.
23925
23926 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
23927 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
23928 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
23929
23930 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
23931 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
23932 other 3 COM ports.
23933
23934 @kindex show com1base
23935 @kindex show com1irq
23936 @kindex show com2base
23937 @kindex show com2irq
23938 @kindex show com3base
23939 @kindex show com3irq
23940 @kindex show com4base
23941 @kindex show com4irq
23942 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
23943 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
23944 lines used by the COM ports.
23945
23946 @item info serial
23947 @kindex info serial
23948 @cindex DOS serial port status
23949 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
23950 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
23951 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
23952 counts of various errors encountered so far.
23953 @end table
23954
23955
23956 @node Cygwin Native
23957 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
23958 @cindex MS Windows debugging
23959 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
23960 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
23961
23962 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
23963 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
23964
23965 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
23966 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
23967 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
23968 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
23969 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
23970 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
23971 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
23972 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
23973
23974 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
23975 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
23976 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
23977
23978 @table @code
23979 @kindex info w32
23980 @item info w32
23981 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
23982 information about the target system and important OS structures.
23983
23984 @item info w32 selector
23985 This command displays information returned by
23986 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
23987 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
23988 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
23989 Without argument, this command displays information
23990 about the six segment registers.
23991
23992 @item info w32 thread-information-block
23993 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
23994 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
23995 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
23996
23997 @kindex signal-event
23998 @item signal-event @var{id}
23999 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
24000 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
24001
24002 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
24003 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
24004 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
24005 (for x86_64 versions):
24006
24007 @itemize @minus
24008 @item
24009 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
24010 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
24011 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
24012
24013 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
24014 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
24015 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
24016 to attach.
24017
24018 @item
24019 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
24020 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
24021 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
24022 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
24023 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
24024 @end itemize
24025
24026 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
24027 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
24028 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
24029 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
24030 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
24031 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
24032 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
24033 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
24034 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
24035 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
24036 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
24037
24038 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
24039 @item show cygwin-exceptions
24040 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
24041 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
24042
24043 @kindex set new-console
24044 @item set new-console @var{mode}
24045 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
24046 be started in a new console on next start.
24047 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
24048 be started in the same console as the debugger.
24049
24050 @kindex show new-console
24051 @item show new-console
24052 Displays whether a new console is used
24053 when the debuggee is started.
24054
24055 @kindex set new-group
24056 @item set new-group @var{mode}
24057 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
24058 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
24059 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
24060 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
24061
24062 @kindex show new-group
24063 @item show new-group
24064 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
24065
24066 @kindex set debugevents
24067 @item set debugevents
24068 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
24069 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
24070 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
24071 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
24072 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
24073
24074 @kindex set debugexec
24075 @item set debugexec
24076 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
24077 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
24078
24079 @kindex set debugexceptions
24080 @item set debugexceptions
24081 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
24082 debuggee seen by the debugger.
24083
24084 @kindex set debugmemory
24085 @item set debugmemory
24086 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
24087 and writes by the debugger.
24088
24089 @kindex set shell
24090 @item set shell
24091 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
24092 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
24093
24094 @kindex show shell
24095 @item show shell
24096 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
24097
24098 @end table
24099
24100 @menu
24101 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
24102 @end menu
24103
24104 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
24105 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
24106 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
24107 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
24108
24109 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
24110 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
24111 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
24112 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
24113 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
24114 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
24115 ``minimal symbols''.
24116
24117 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
24118 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
24119 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
24120 program run once to completion.
24121
24122 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
24123
24124 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
24125 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
24126 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
24127 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
24128 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
24129 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
24130 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
24131 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
24132 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
24133
24134 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
24135 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
24136 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
24137 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
24138 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
24139 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
24140
24141 @smallexample
24142 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
24143 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
24144
24145 Non-debugging symbols:
24146 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
24147 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
24148 @end smallexample
24149
24150 @smallexample
24151 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
24152 All functions matching regular expression "!":
24153
24154 Non-debugging symbols:
24155 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
24156 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
24157 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
24158 [etc...]
24159 @end smallexample
24160
24161 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
24162
24163 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
24164 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
24165 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
24166 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
24167 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
24168 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
24169 a function within a DLL without a running program.
24170
24171 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
24172 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
24173 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
24174 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
24175 problem:
24176
24177 @smallexample
24178 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
24179 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
24180 @end smallexample
24181
24182 @smallexample
24183 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
24184 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
24185 @end smallexample
24186
24187 And two possible solutions:
24188
24189 @smallexample
24190 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
24191 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
24192 @end smallexample
24193
24194 @smallexample
24195 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
24196 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
24197 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
24198 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
24199 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
24200 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
24201 @end smallexample
24202
24203 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
24204 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
24205 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
24206 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
24207 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
24208
24209 @smallexample
24210 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
24211 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
24212 @end smallexample
24213
24214 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
24215 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
24216 safe.
24217
24218 @node Hurd Native
24219 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
24220 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
24221
24222 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
24223 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
24224
24225 @table @code
24226 @item set signals
24227 @itemx set sigs
24228 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
24229 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
24230 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
24231 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
24232 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
24233 @code{signals}.
24234
24235 @item show signals
24236 @itemx show sigs
24237 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
24238 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
24239 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
24240
24241 @item set signal-thread
24242 @itemx set sigthread
24243 @kindex set signal-thread
24244 @kindex set sigthread
24245 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
24246 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
24247 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
24248 signal-thread}.
24249
24250 @item show signal-thread
24251 @itemx show sigthread
24252 @kindex show signal-thread
24253 @kindex show sigthread
24254 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
24255 delivered a signal.
24256
24257 @item set stopped
24258 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
24259 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
24260 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
24261 continued by delivering a signal to it.
24262
24263 @item show stopped
24264 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
24265 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
24266 stopped.
24267
24268 @item set exceptions
24269 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
24270 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
24271 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
24272 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
24273 trapping on.
24274
24275 @item show exceptions
24276 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
24277 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
24278
24279 @item set task pause
24280 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
24281 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
24282 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
24283 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
24284 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
24285 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
24286 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
24287 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
24288 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
24289
24290 @item show task pause
24291 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
24292 Show the current state of task suspension.
24293
24294 @item set task detach-suspend-count
24295 @cindex task suspend count
24296 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
24297 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
24298 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
24299
24300 @item show task detach-suspend-count
24301 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
24302
24303 @item set task exception-port
24304 @itemx set task excp
24305 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
24306 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
24307 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
24308 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
24309
24310 @item set noninvasive
24311 @cindex noninvasive task options
24312 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
24313 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
24314 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
24315 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
24316
24317 @item info send-rights
24318 @itemx info receive-rights
24319 @itemx info port-rights
24320 @itemx info port-sets
24321 @itemx info dead-names
24322 @itemx info ports
24323 @itemx info psets
24324 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
24325 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
24326 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
24327 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
24328 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
24329 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
24330 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
24331 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
24332 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
24333
24334 @item set thread pause
24335 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
24336 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
24337 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
24338 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
24339 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
24340 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
24341 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
24342 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
24343 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
24344 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
24345 only the current thread.
24346
24347 @item show thread pause
24348 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
24349 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
24350
24351 @item set thread run
24352 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
24353
24354 @item show thread run
24355 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
24356
24357 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
24358 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
24359 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
24360 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
24361 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
24362 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
24363 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
24364
24365 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
24366 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
24367 detaching.
24368
24369 @item set thread exception-port
24370 @itemx set thread excp
24371 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
24372 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
24373 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
24374
24375 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
24376 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
24377 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
24378 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
24379
24380 @item set thread default
24381 @itemx show thread default
24382 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
24383 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
24384 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
24385 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
24386 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
24387 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
24388 the non-default commands.
24389 @end table
24390
24391 @node Darwin
24392 @subsection Darwin
24393 @cindex Darwin
24394
24395 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
24396
24397 @table @code
24398 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
24399 @kindex set debug darwin
24400 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
24401 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
24402
24403 @item show debug darwin
24404 @kindex show debug darwin
24405 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
24406
24407 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
24408 @kindex set debug mach-o
24409 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
24410 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
24411 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
24412 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
24413 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
24414 usage.
24415
24416 @item show debug mach-o
24417 @kindex show debug mach-o
24418 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
24419
24420 @item set mach-exceptions on
24421 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
24422 @kindex set mach-exceptions
24423 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
24424 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
24425 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
24426 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
24427
24428 @item show mach-exceptions
24429 @kindex show mach-exceptions
24430 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
24431 @end table
24432
24433 @node FreeBSD
24434 @subsection FreeBSD
24435 @cindex FreeBSD
24436
24437 When the ABI of a system call is changed in the FreeBSD kernel, this
24438 is implemented by leaving a compatibility system call using the old
24439 ABI at the existing number and allocating a new system call number for
24440 the version using the new ABI. As a convenience, when a system call
24441 is caught by name (@pxref{catch syscall}), compatibility system calls
24442 are also caught.
24443
24444 For example, FreeBSD 12 introduced a new variant of the @code{kevent}
24445 system call and catching the @code{kevent} system call by name catches
24446 both variants:
24447
24448 @smallexample
24449 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall kevent
24450 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'freebsd11_kevent' [363] 'kevent' [560])
24451 (@value{GDBP})
24452 @end smallexample
24453
24454
24455 @node Embedded OS
24456 @section Embedded Operating Systems
24457
24458 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
24459 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
24460 architectures.
24461
24462 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
24463 various real-time operating systems.
24464
24465 @node Embedded Processors
24466 @section Embedded Processors
24467
24468 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
24469 configurations.
24470
24471 @cindex send command to simulator
24472 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
24473 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
24474
24475 @table @code
24476 @item sim @var{command}
24477 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
24478 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
24479 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
24480 acceptable commands.
24481 @end table
24482
24483
24484 @menu
24485 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
24486 * ARM:: ARM
24487 * BPF:: eBPF
24488 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
24489 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
24490 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
24491 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
24492 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
24493 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
24494 * CRIS:: CRIS
24495 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
24496 @end menu
24497
24498 @node ARC
24499 @subsection Synopsys ARC
24500 @cindex Synopsys ARC
24501 @cindex ARC specific commands
24502 @cindex ARC600
24503 @cindex ARC700
24504 @cindex ARC EM
24505 @cindex ARC HS
24506
24507 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
24508
24509 @table @code
24510 @item set debug arc
24511 @kindex set debug arc
24512 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
24513 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
24514
24515 @item show debug arc
24516 @kindex show debug arc
24517 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
24518
24519 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
24520 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
24521 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
24522
24523 @end table
24524
24525 @node ARM
24526 @subsection ARM
24527
24528 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
24529
24530 @table @code
24531 @item set arm disassembler
24532 @kindex set arm
24533 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
24534 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
24535
24536 @item show arm disassembler
24537 @kindex show arm
24538 Show the current disassembly style.
24539
24540 @item set arm apcs32
24541 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
24542 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
24543
24544 @item show arm apcs32
24545 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
24546
24547 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
24548 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
24549 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
24550
24551 @table @code
24552 @item auto
24553 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
24554 @item softfpa
24555 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
24556 processors.
24557 @item fpa
24558 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
24559 @item softvfp
24560 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
24561 @item vfp
24562 VFP co-processor.
24563 @end table
24564
24565 @item show arm fpu
24566 Show the current type of the FPU.
24567
24568 @item set arm abi
24569 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
24570
24571 @item show arm abi
24572 Show the currently used ABI.
24573
24574 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
24575 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
24576 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
24577 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
24578 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
24579 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
24580 register).
24581
24582 @item show arm fallback-mode
24583 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
24584
24585 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
24586 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
24587 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
24588 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
24589 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
24590
24591 @item show arm force-mode
24592 Show the current forced instruction mode.
24593
24594 @item set debug arm
24595 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
24596 target support subsystem.
24597
24598 @item show debug arm
24599 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
24600 @end table
24601
24602 @table @code
24603 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
24604 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
24605
24606 @table @code
24607 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
24608 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
24609 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
24610 The default value is @code{all}.
24611
24612 @table @code
24613 @item none
24614 @item demon
24615 @item angel
24616 @item redboot
24617 @item all
24618 @end table
24619 @end table
24620 @end table
24621
24622 @node BPF
24623 @subsection BPF
24624
24625 @table @code
24626 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
24627 The @value{GDBN} BPF simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
24628
24629 @table @code
24630 @item --skb-data-offset=@var{offset}
24631 Tell the simulator the offset, measured in bytes, of the
24632 @code{skb_data} field in the kernel @code{struct sk_buff} structure.
24633 This offset is used by some BPF specific-purpose load/store
24634 instructions. Defaults to 0.
24635 @end table
24636 @end table
24637
24638 @node M68K
24639 @subsection M68k
24640
24641 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
24642
24643 @node MicroBlaze
24644 @subsection MicroBlaze
24645 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
24646 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
24647
24648 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
24649 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
24650 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
24651 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
24652 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
24653 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
24654 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
24655 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
24656 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
24657 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
24658 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
24659
24660 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
24661
24662 @table @code
24663 @item target remote :1234
24664 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
24665 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
24666
24667 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
24668 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
24669 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
24670
24671 @item load
24672 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
24673
24674 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
24675 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
24676
24677 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
24678 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
24679 @end table
24680
24681 @node MIPS Embedded
24682 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
24683
24684 @noindent
24685 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
24686
24687 @table @code
24688 @item set mipsfpu double
24689 @itemx set mipsfpu single
24690 @itemx set mipsfpu none
24691 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
24692 @itemx show mipsfpu
24693 @kindex set mipsfpu
24694 @kindex show mipsfpu
24695 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
24696 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
24697 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
24698 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
24699 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
24700 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
24701 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
24702 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
24703 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
24704 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
24705 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
24706 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
24707 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
24708
24709 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
24710 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
24711 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
24712
24713 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
24714 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
24715 @end table
24716
24717 @node OpenRISC 1000
24718 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
24719 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
24720
24721 @noindent
24722 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
24723 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
24724 FPGA's.
24725
24726 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
24727 a target:
24728
24729 @table @code
24730
24731 @kindex target sim
24732 @item target sim
24733
24734 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
24735 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
24736 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
24737 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
24738
24739 Example: @code{target sim}
24740
24741 @item set debug or1k
24742 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
24743 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
24744
24745 @item show debug or1k
24746 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
24747 @end table
24748
24749 @node PowerPC Embedded
24750 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
24751
24752 @cindex DVC register
24753 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
24754 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
24755
24756 @smallexample
24757 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{address|variable} \
24758 if @var{address|variable} == @var{constant expression}
24759 @end smallexample
24760
24761 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
24762 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
24763 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
24764 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
24765 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
24766 or newer.
24767
24768 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
24769 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
24770 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
24771 watching variables of scalar types.
24772
24773 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
24774 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
24775
24776 @smallexample
24777 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
24778 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
24779 @end smallexample
24780
24781 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
24782 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
24783
24784 @cindex ranged breakpoint
24785 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
24786 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
24787 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
24788 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
24789 use the @code{break-range} command.
24790
24791 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
24792
24793 @table @code
24794 @kindex break-range
24795 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
24796 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
24797 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
24798 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
24799 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
24800 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
24801 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
24802 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
24803 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
24804
24805 @kindex set powerpc
24806 @item set powerpc soft-float
24807 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
24808 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
24809 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
24810 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
24811
24812 @item set powerpc vector-abi
24813 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
24814 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
24815 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
24816 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
24817 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
24818 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
24819 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
24820
24821 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
24822 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
24823 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
24824 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
24825 address of its first byte.
24826
24827 @end table
24828
24829 @node AVR
24830 @subsection Atmel AVR
24831 @cindex AVR
24832
24833 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
24834 following AVR-specific commands:
24835
24836 @table @code
24837 @item info io_registers
24838 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
24839 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
24840 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
24841 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
24842 @end table
24843
24844 @node CRIS
24845 @subsection CRIS
24846 @cindex CRIS
24847
24848 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
24849 following CRIS-specific commands:
24850
24851 @table @code
24852 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
24853 @cindex CRIS version
24854 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
24855 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
24856 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
24857
24858 @item show cris-version
24859 Show the current CRIS version.
24860
24861 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
24862 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
24863 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
24864 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
24865 @code{R59}.
24866
24867 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
24868 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
24869
24870 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
24871 @cindex CRIS mode
24872 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
24873 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
24874 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
24875
24876 @item show cris-mode
24877 Show the current CRIS mode.
24878 @end table
24879
24880 @node Super-H
24881 @subsection Renesas Super-H
24882 @cindex Super-H
24883
24884 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
24885 commands:
24886
24887 @table @code
24888 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
24889 @kindex set sh calling-convention
24890 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
24891 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
24892 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
24893 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
24894 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
24895 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
24896 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
24897 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
24898 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
24899 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
24900
24901 @item show sh calling-convention
24902 @kindex show sh calling-convention
24903 Show the current calling convention setting.
24904
24905 @end table
24906
24907
24908 @node Architectures
24909 @section Architectures
24910
24911 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
24912 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
24913
24914 @menu
24915 * AArch64::
24916 * i386::
24917 * Alpha::
24918 * MIPS::
24919 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
24920 * PowerPC::
24921 * Nios II::
24922 * Sparc64::
24923 * S12Z::
24924 @end menu
24925
24926 @node AArch64
24927 @subsection AArch64
24928 @cindex AArch64 support
24929
24930 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
24931 following special commands:
24932
24933 @table @code
24934 @item set debug aarch64
24935 @kindex set debug aarch64
24936 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
24937 messages are to be displayed.
24938
24939 @item show debug aarch64
24940 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
24941
24942 @end table
24943
24944 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
24945 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
24946
24947 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
24948 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
24949 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
24950 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
24951 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
24952 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
24953
24954 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
24955 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
24956 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
24957 target process.
24958
24959 @subsubsection AArch64 Pointer Authentication.
24960 @cindex AArch64 Pointer Authentication.
24961
24962 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, and the program is
24963 using the v8.3-A feature Pointer Authentication (PAC), then whenever the link
24964 register @code{$lr} is pointing to an PAC function its value will be masked.
24965 When GDB prints a backtrace, any addresses that required unmasking will be
24966 postfixed with the marker [PAC]. When using the MI, this is printed as part
24967 of the @code{addr_flags} field.
24968
24969 @node i386
24970 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
24971
24972 @table @code
24973 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
24974 @kindex set struct-convention
24975 @cindex struct return convention
24976 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
24977 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
24978 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
24979 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
24980 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
24981 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
24982 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
24983 be returned in a register.
24984
24985 @item show struct-convention
24986 @kindex show struct-convention
24987 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
24988 from functions.
24989 @end table
24990
24991
24992 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
24993 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
24994
24995 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
24996 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
24997 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
24998 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
24999 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
25000 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
25001 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
25002
25003 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
25004 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
25005 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
25006 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
25007 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
25008 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
25009
25010 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
25011 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
25012 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
25013
25014 @smallexample
25015 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
25016 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
25017 @end smallexample
25018
25019 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
25020 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
25021 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
25022 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
25023 the pointer.
25024
25025 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
25026 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
25027 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
25028 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
25029 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
25030
25031 @table @code
25032 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
25033 @kindex show mpx bound
25034 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
25035
25036 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
25037 @kindex set mpx bound
25038 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
25039 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
25040 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
25041 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
25042 @end table
25043
25044 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
25045 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
25046 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
25047 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
25048
25049 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
25050 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
25051 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
25052 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
25053 function.
25054
25055 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
25056 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
25057 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
25058 continuing the execution. For example:
25059
25060 @smallexample
25061 $ break *upper
25062 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
25063 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
25064 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
25065 $ print $bnd0
25066 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
25067 @end smallexample
25068
25069 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
25070 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
25071 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
25072
25073 @node Alpha
25074 @subsection Alpha
25075
25076 See the following section.
25077
25078 @node MIPS
25079 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
25080
25081 @cindex stack on Alpha
25082 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
25083 @cindex Alpha stack
25084 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
25085 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
25086 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
25087 find the beginning of a function.
25088
25089 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
25090 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
25091 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
25092 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
25093 commands:
25094
25095 @table @code
25096 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
25097 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
25098 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
25099 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
25100 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
25101 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
25102 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
25103 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
25104
25105 @item show heuristic-fence-post
25106 Display the current limit.
25107 @end table
25108
25109 @noindent
25110 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
25111 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
25112
25113 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
25114 programs:
25115
25116 @table @code
25117 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
25118 @kindex set mips abi
25119 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
25120 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
25121 values of @var{arg} are:
25122
25123 @table @samp
25124 @item auto
25125 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
25126 default).
25127 @item o32
25128 @item o64
25129 @item n32
25130 @item n64
25131 @item eabi32
25132 @item eabi64
25133 @end table
25134
25135 @item show mips abi
25136 @kindex show mips abi
25137 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
25138
25139 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
25140 @kindex set mips compression
25141 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
25142 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
25143 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
25144 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
25145 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
25146 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
25147 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
25148 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
25149 provided by the executable.
25150
25151 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
25152 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
25153 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
25154 identified as such.
25155
25156 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
25157 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
25158 implicitly from an executable.
25159
25160 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
25161 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
25162 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
25163 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
25164 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
25165
25166 @item show mips compression
25167 @kindex show mips compression
25168 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
25169 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
25170
25171 @item set mipsfpu
25172 @itemx show mipsfpu
25173 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
25174
25175 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
25176 @kindex set mips mask-address
25177 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
25178 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
25179 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
25180 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
25181 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
25182
25183 @item show mips mask-address
25184 @kindex show mips mask-address
25185 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
25186 not.
25187
25188 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
25189 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
25190 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
25191 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
25192 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
25193 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
25194
25195 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
25196 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
25197 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
25198
25199 @item set debug mips
25200 @kindex set debug mips
25201 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
25202 target code in @value{GDBN}.
25203
25204 @item show debug mips
25205 @kindex show debug mips
25206 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
25207 @end table
25208
25209
25210 @node HPPA
25211 @subsection HPPA
25212 @cindex HPPA support
25213
25214 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
25215 following special commands:
25216
25217 @table @code
25218 @item set debug hppa
25219 @kindex set debug hppa
25220 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
25221 messages are to be displayed.
25222
25223 @item show debug hppa
25224 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
25225
25226 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
25227 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
25228 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
25229 given @var{address}.
25230
25231 @end table
25232
25233
25234 @node PowerPC
25235 @subsection PowerPC
25236 @cindex PowerPC architecture
25237
25238 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
25239 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
25240 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
25241 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
25242 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
25243
25244 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
25245 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
25246 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
25247
25248 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
25249 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
25250
25251 @node Nios II
25252 @subsection Nios II
25253 @cindex Nios II architecture
25254
25255 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
25256 it provides the following special commands:
25257
25258 @table @code
25259
25260 @item set debug nios2
25261 @kindex set debug nios2
25262 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
25263 target code in @value{GDBN}.
25264
25265 @item show debug nios2
25266 @kindex show debug nios2
25267 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
25268 @end table
25269
25270 @node Sparc64
25271 @subsection Sparc64
25272 @cindex Sparc64 support
25273 @cindex Application Data Integrity
25274 @subsubsection ADI Support
25275
25276 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
25277 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
25278 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
25279 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
25280 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
25281 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
25282 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
25283 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
25284 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
25285 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
25286 signal.
25287
25288 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
25289 ADI-enabled.
25290
25291 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
25292 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
25293
25294
25295 @table @code
25296 @kindex adi examine
25297 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
25298
25299 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
25300 cacheline.
25301
25302 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
25303 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
25304 block size, to display.
25305
25306 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
25307 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
25308
25309 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
25310
25311 @smallexample
25312 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
25313 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
25314 @end smallexample
25315
25316 @kindex adi assign
25317 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
25318
25319 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
25320 to an address.
25321
25322 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
25323 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
25324 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
25325
25326 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
25327 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
25328
25329 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
25330
25331 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
25332 variable "shmaddr":
25333
25334 @smallexample
25335 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
25336 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
25337 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
25338 @end smallexample
25339
25340 @end table
25341
25342 @node S12Z
25343 @subsection S12Z
25344 @cindex S12Z support
25345
25346 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
25347 it provides the following special command:
25348
25349 @table @code
25350 @item maint info bdccsr
25351 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
25352 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
25353 BDCCSR register.
25354 @end table
25355
25356
25357 @node Controlling GDB
25358 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
25359
25360 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
25361 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
25362 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
25363 described here.
25364
25365 @menu
25366 * Prompt:: Prompt
25367 * Editing:: Command editing
25368 * Command History:: Command history
25369 * Screen Size:: Screen size
25370 * Output Styling:: Output styling
25371 * Numbers:: Numbers
25372 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
25373 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
25374 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
25375 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
25376 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
25377 @end menu
25378
25379 @node Prompt
25380 @section Prompt
25381
25382 @cindex prompt
25383
25384 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
25385 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
25386 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
25387 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
25388 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
25389 which one you are talking to.
25390
25391 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
25392 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
25393 or a prompt that does not.
25394
25395 @table @code
25396 @kindex set prompt
25397 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
25398 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
25399
25400 @kindex show prompt
25401 @item show prompt
25402 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
25403 @end table
25404
25405 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
25406 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
25407 are:
25408
25409 @table @code
25410 @kindex set extended-prompt
25411 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
25412 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
25413 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
25414 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
25415 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
25416 is displayed.
25417
25418 For example:
25419
25420 @smallexample
25421 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
25422 @end smallexample
25423
25424 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
25425 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
25426
25427 @kindex show extended-prompt
25428 @item show extended-prompt
25429 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
25430 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
25431 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
25432 @end table
25433
25434 @node Editing
25435 @section Command Editing
25436 @cindex readline
25437 @cindex command line editing
25438
25439 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
25440 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
25441 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
25442 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
25443 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
25444 debugging sessions.
25445
25446 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
25447 command @code{set}.
25448
25449 @table @code
25450 @kindex set editing
25451 @cindex editing
25452 @item set editing
25453 @itemx set editing on
25454 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
25455
25456 @item set editing off
25457 Disable command line editing.
25458
25459 @kindex show editing
25460 @item show editing
25461 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
25462 @end table
25463
25464 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25465 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
25466 @end ifset
25467 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25468 @xref{Command Line Editing},
25469 @end ifclear
25470 for more details about the Readline
25471 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
25472 encouraged to read that chapter.
25473
25474 @cindex Readline application name
25475 @value{GDBN} sets the Readline application name to @samp{gdb}. This
25476 is useful for conditions in @file{.inputrc}.
25477
25478 @cindex operate-and-get-next
25479 @value{GDBN} defines a bindable Readline command,
25480 @code{operate-and-get-next}. This is bound to @kbd{C-o} by default.
25481 This command accepts the current line for execution and fetches the
25482 next line relative to the current line from the history for editing.
25483 Any argument is ignored.
25484
25485 @node Command History
25486 @section Command History
25487 @cindex command history
25488
25489 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
25490 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
25491 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
25492 history facility.
25493
25494 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
25495 package, to provide the history facility.
25496 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25497 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
25498 @end ifset
25499 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25500 @xref{Using History Interactively},
25501 @end ifclear
25502 for the detailed description of the History library.
25503
25504 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
25505 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
25506 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
25507 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
25508 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
25509 pressed on a line by itself.
25510
25511 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
25512 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
25513 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
25514 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
25515
25516 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
25517 history.
25518
25519 @table @code
25520 @cindex history substitution
25521 @cindex history file
25522 @kindex set history filename
25523 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
25524 @item set history filename @r{[}@var{fname}@r{]}
25525 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
25526 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
25527 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
25528 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
25529 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
25530 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
25531 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
25532 is not set.
25533
25534 The @code{GDBHISTFILE} environment variable is read after processing
25535 any @value{GDBN} initialization files (@pxref{Startup}) and after
25536 processing any commands passed using command line options (for
25537 example, @code{-ex}).
25538
25539 If the @var{fname} argument is not given, or if the @code{GDBHISTFILE}
25540 is the empty string then @value{GDBN} will neither try to load an
25541 existing history file, nor will it try to save the history on exit.
25542
25543 @cindex save command history
25544 @kindex set history save
25545 @item set history save
25546 @itemx set history save on
25547 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
25548 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is
25549 disabled. The command history will be recorded when @value{GDBN}
25550 exits. If @code{set history filename} is set to the empty string then
25551 history saving is disabled, even when @code{set history save} is
25552 @code{on}.
25553
25554 @item set history save off
25555 Don't record the command history into the file specified by @code{set
25556 history filename} when @value{GDBN} exits.
25557
25558 @cindex history size
25559 @kindex set history size
25560 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
25561 @item set history size @var{size}
25562 @itemx set history size unlimited
25563 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
25564 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
25565 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
25566 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
25567 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
25568 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
25569
25570 The @code{GDBHISTSIZE} environment variable is read after processing
25571 any @value{GDBN} initialization files (@pxref{Startup}) and after
25572 processing any commands passed using command line options (for
25573 example, @code{-ex}).
25574
25575 @cindex remove duplicate history
25576 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
25577 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
25578 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
25579 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
25580 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
25581 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
25582 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
25583 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
25584 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
25585
25586 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
25587 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
25588
25589 @end table
25590
25591 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
25592 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25593 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
25594 @end ifset
25595 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25596 @xref{Event Designators},
25597 @end ifclear
25598 for more details.
25599
25600 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
25601 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
25602 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
25603 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
25604 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
25605 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
25606 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
25607 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
25608
25609 The commands to control history expansion are:
25610
25611 @table @code
25612 @item set history expansion on
25613 @itemx set history expansion
25614 @kindex set history expansion
25615 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
25616
25617 @item set history expansion off
25618 Disable history expansion.
25619
25620 @c @group
25621 @kindex show history
25622 @item show history
25623 @itemx show history filename
25624 @itemx show history save
25625 @itemx show history size
25626 @itemx show history expansion
25627 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
25628 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
25629 @c @end group
25630 @end table
25631
25632 @table @code
25633 @kindex show commands
25634 @cindex show last commands
25635 @cindex display command history
25636 @item show commands
25637 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
25638
25639 @item show commands @var{n}
25640 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
25641
25642 @item show commands +
25643 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
25644 @end table
25645
25646 @node Screen Size
25647 @section Screen Size
25648 @cindex size of screen
25649 @cindex screen size
25650 @cindex pagination
25651 @cindex page size
25652 @cindex pauses in output
25653
25654 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
25655 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
25656 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
25657 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
25658 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
25659 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
25660 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
25661 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
25662 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
25663 following line.
25664
25665 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
25666 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
25667 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
25668 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
25669 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
25670 width} commands:
25671
25672 @table @code
25673 @kindex set height
25674 @kindex set width
25675 @kindex show width
25676 @kindex show height
25677 @item set height @var{lpp}
25678 @itemx set height unlimited
25679 @itemx show height
25680 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
25681 @itemx set width unlimited
25682 @itemx show width
25683 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
25684 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
25685 commands display the current settings.
25686
25687 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
25688 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
25689 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
25690 buffer.
25691
25692 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
25693 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
25694
25695 @item set pagination on
25696 @itemx set pagination off
25697 @kindex set pagination
25698 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
25699 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
25700 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
25701 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
25702
25703 @item show pagination
25704 @kindex show pagination
25705 Show the current pagination mode.
25706 @end table
25707
25708 @node Output Styling
25709 @section Output Styling
25710 @cindex styling
25711 @cindex colors
25712
25713 @kindex set style
25714 @kindex show style
25715 @value{GDBN} can style its output on a capable terminal. This is
25716 enabled by default on most systems, but disabled by default when in
25717 batch mode (@pxref{Mode Options}). Various style settings are available;
25718 and styles can also be disabled entirely.
25719
25720 @table @code
25721 @item set style enabled @samp{on|off}
25722 Enable or disable all styling. The default is host-dependent, with
25723 most hosts defaulting to @samp{on}.
25724
25725 @item show style enabled
25726 Show the current state of styling.
25727
25728 @item set style sources @samp{on|off}
25729 Enable or disable source code styling. This affects whether source
25730 code, such as the output of the @code{list} command, is styled. Note
25731 that source styling only works if styling in general is enabled, and
25732 if @value{GDBN} was linked with the GNU Source Highlight library. The
25733 default is @samp{on}.
25734
25735 @item show style sources
25736 Show the current state of source code styling.
25737 @end table
25738
25739 Subcommands of @code{set style} control specific forms of styling.
25740 These subcommands all follow the same pattern: each style-able object
25741 can be styled with a foreground color, a background color, and an
25742 intensity.
25743
25744 For example, the style of file names can be controlled using the
25745 @code{set style filename} group of commands:
25746
25747 @table @code
25748 @item set style filename background @var{color}
25749 Set the background to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
25750 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
25751 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
25752 and@samp{white}.
25753
25754 @item set style filename foreground @var{color}
25755 Set the foreground to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
25756 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
25757 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
25758 and@samp{white}.
25759
25760 @item set style filename intensity @var{value}
25761 Set the intensity to @var{value}. Valid intensities are @samp{normal}
25762 (the default), @samp{bold}, and @samp{dim}.
25763 @end table
25764
25765 The @code{show style} command and its subcommands are styling
25766 a style name in their output using its own style.
25767 So, use @command{show style} to see the complete list of styles,
25768 their characteristics and the visual aspect of each style.
25769
25770 The style-able objects are:
25771 @table @code
25772 @item filename
25773 Control the styling of file names. By default, this style's
25774 foreground color is green.
25775
25776 @item function
25777 Control the styling of function names. These are managed with the
25778 @code{set style function} family of commands. By default, this
25779 style's foreground color is yellow.
25780
25781 @item variable
25782 Control the styling of variable names. These are managed with the
25783 @code{set style variable} family of commands. By default, this style's
25784 foreground color is cyan.
25785
25786 @item address
25787 Control the styling of addresses. These are managed with the
25788 @code{set style address} family of commands. By default, this style's
25789 foreground color is blue.
25790
25791 @item title
25792 Control the styling of titles. These are managed with the
25793 @code{set style title} family of commands. By default, this style's
25794 intensity is bold. Commands are using the title style to improve
25795 the readability of large output. For example, the commands
25796 @command{apropos} and @command{help} are using the title style
25797 for the command names.
25798
25799 @item highlight
25800 Control the styling of highlightings. These are managed with the
25801 @code{set style highlight} family of commands. By default, this style's
25802 foreground color is red. Commands are using the highlight style to draw
25803 the user attention to some specific parts of their output. For example,
25804 the command @command{apropos -v REGEXP} uses the highlight style to
25805 mark the documentation parts matching @var{regexp}.
25806
25807 @item tui-border
25808 Control the styling of the TUI border. Note that, unlike other
25809 styling options, only the color of the border can be controlled via
25810 @code{set style}. This was done for compatibility reasons, as TUI
25811 controls to set the border's intensity predated the addition of
25812 general styling to @value{GDBN}. @xref{TUI Configuration}.
25813
25814 @item tui-active-border
25815 Control the styling of the active TUI border; that is, the TUI window
25816 that has the focus.
25817
25818 @end table
25819
25820 @node Numbers
25821 @section Numbers
25822 @cindex number representation
25823 @cindex entering numbers
25824
25825 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
25826 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
25827 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
25828 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
25829 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
25830 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
25831 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
25832 both input and output with the commands described below.
25833
25834 @table @code
25835 @kindex set input-radix
25836 @item set input-radix @var{base}
25837 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
25838 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
25839 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
25840 example, any of
25841
25842 @smallexample
25843 set input-radix 012
25844 set input-radix 10.
25845 set input-radix 0xa
25846 @end smallexample
25847
25848 @noindent
25849 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
25850 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
25851 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
25852 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
25853 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
25854 change the radix.
25855
25856 @kindex set output-radix
25857 @item set output-radix @var{base}
25858 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
25859 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
25860 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
25861
25862 @kindex show input-radix
25863 @item show input-radix
25864 Display the current default base for numeric input.
25865
25866 @kindex show output-radix
25867 @item show output-radix
25868 Display the current default base for numeric display.
25869
25870 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
25871 @itemx show radix
25872 @kindex set radix
25873 @kindex show radix
25874 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
25875 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
25876 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
25877 default value of 10.
25878
25879 @end table
25880
25881 @node ABI
25882 @section Configuring the Current ABI
25883
25884 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
25885 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
25886 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
25887 current ABI.
25888
25889 @cindex OS ABI
25890 @kindex set osabi
25891 @kindex show osabi
25892 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
25893
25894 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
25895 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
25896 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
25897 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
25898 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
25899 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
25900 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
25901 platform provides.
25902
25903 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
25904 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
25905 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
25906 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
25907
25908 @table @code
25909 @item show osabi
25910 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
25911
25912 @item set osabi
25913 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
25914
25915 @item set osabi @var{abi}
25916 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
25917 @end table
25918
25919 @cindex float promotion
25920
25921 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
25922 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
25923 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
25924 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
25925 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
25926 @code{double} and then passed.
25927
25928 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
25929 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
25930 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
25931
25932 @table @code
25933 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
25934 @item set coerce-float-to-double
25935 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
25936 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
25937 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
25938
25939 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
25940 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
25941 functions.
25942
25943 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
25944 @item show coerce-float-to-double
25945 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
25946 @end table
25947
25948 @kindex set cp-abi
25949 @kindex show cp-abi
25950 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
25951 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
25952 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
25953 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
25954 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
25955 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
25956 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
25957 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
25958 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
25959 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
25960 ``auto''.
25961
25962 @table @code
25963 @item show cp-abi
25964 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
25965
25966 @item set cp-abi
25967 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
25968
25969 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
25970 @itemx set cp-abi auto
25971 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
25972 @end table
25973
25974 @node Auto-loading
25975 @section Automatically loading associated files
25976 @cindex auto-loading
25977
25978 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
25979 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
25980 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
25981 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
25982 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
25983 sources).
25984
25985 @menu
25986 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
25987 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
25988
25989 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
25990 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
25991 @end menu
25992
25993 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
25994 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
25995 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25996
25997 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
25998 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
25999 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26000
26001 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
26002 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
26003
26004 @table @code
26005 @anchor{set auto-load off}
26006 @kindex set auto-load off
26007 @item set auto-load off
26008 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
26009 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
26010 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
26011 @smallexample
26012 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
26013 @end smallexample
26014
26015 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
26016 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
26017 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
26018 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
26019 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
26020 @code{set auto-load no}.
26021
26022 @anchor{show auto-load}
26023 @kindex show auto-load
26024 @item show auto-load
26025 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
26026 or disabled.
26027
26028 @smallexample
26029 (gdb) show auto-load
26030 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
26031 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
26032 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
26033 is on.
26034 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
26035 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
26036 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
26037 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
26038 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
26039 @end smallexample
26040
26041 @anchor{info auto-load}
26042 @kindex info auto-load
26043 @item info auto-load
26044 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
26045 not.
26046
26047 @smallexample
26048 (gdb) info auto-load
26049 gdb-scripts:
26050 Loaded Script
26051 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
26052 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
26053 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
26054 loaded.
26055 python-scripts:
26056 Loaded Script
26057 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
26058 @end smallexample
26059 @end table
26060
26061 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
26062
26063 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
26064 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
26065 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
26066 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
26067 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
26068 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
26069 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
26070 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
26071 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
26072 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
26073 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
26074 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
26075 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
26076 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
26077 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
26078 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
26079 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
26080 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
26081 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
26082 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
26083 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
26084 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
26085 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
26086 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
26087 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
26088 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
26089 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26090 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
26091 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26092 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
26093 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
26094 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
26095 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
26096 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
26097 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
26098 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
26099 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
26100 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
26101 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
26102 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
26103 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
26104 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
26105 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
26106 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
26107 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
26108 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
26109 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
26110 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
26111 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
26112 @end multitable
26113
26114 @node Init File in the Current Directory
26115 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
26116 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
26117
26118 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
26119 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
26120 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
26121
26122 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
26123 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26124
26125 @table @code
26126 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
26127 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
26128 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
26129 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
26130 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
26131
26132 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
26133 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
26134 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
26135 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
26136 current directory is enabled or disabled.
26137
26138 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
26139 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
26140 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
26141 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
26142 current directory have been auto-loaded.
26143 @end table
26144
26145 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
26146 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
26147 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
26148
26149 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
26150
26151 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
26152 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
26153
26154 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
26155 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
26156 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
26157 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
26158 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
26159 library.
26160
26161 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
26162 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26163
26164 @table @code
26165 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
26166 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
26167 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
26168 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
26169
26170 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
26171 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
26172 @item show auto-load libthread-db
26173 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
26174 enabled or disabled.
26175
26176 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
26177 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
26178 @item info auto-load libthread-db
26179 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
26180 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
26181 @end table
26182
26183 @node Auto-loading safe path
26184 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
26185 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
26186
26187 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
26188 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
26189 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
26190 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
26191 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
26192
26193 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
26194 get loaded:
26195
26196 @smallexample
26197 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
26198 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...
26199 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
26200 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
26201 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
26202 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
26203 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
26204 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
26205 @end smallexample
26206
26207 @noindent
26208 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
26209 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
26210
26211 @smallexample
26212 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
26213 @end smallexample
26214
26215 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
26216
26217 @table @code
26218 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
26219 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
26220 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26221 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
26222 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
26223 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
26224 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
26225 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
26226 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
26227 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
26228
26229 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26230 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26231 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26232
26233 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
26234 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
26235 @item show auto-load safe-path
26236 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
26237 scripts.
26238
26239 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
26240 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
26241 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
26242 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
26243 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
26244 by the host platform path separator in use.
26245 @end table
26246
26247 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
26248 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
26249 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
26250 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
26251 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
26252
26253 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
26254 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
26255 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
26256 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
26257 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
26258 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
26259 init file in the current directory
26260 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
26261
26262 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
26263 example, you could use one of the following ways:
26264
26265 @table @asis
26266 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
26267 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
26268 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
26269 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
26270
26271 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
26272 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
26273 @value{GDBN} session.
26274
26275 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
26276 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
26277 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
26278 from trusted sources.
26279
26280 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
26281 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
26282 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
26283 trusted sources.
26284 @end table
26285
26286 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
26287 also suppresses any such warning messages:
26288
26289 @table @asis
26290 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
26291 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
26292
26293 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
26294 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
26295 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
26296 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
26297 @end table
26298
26299 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
26300 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
26301 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
26302 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
26303 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
26304 recommended to be entered.
26305
26306 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
26307 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
26308 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
26309
26310 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
26311 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
26312 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
26313 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
26314 be printed.
26315
26316 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
26317 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
26318 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
26319
26320 @smallexample
26321 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
26322 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
26323 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
26324 for objfile "/tmp/true".
26325 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
26326 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
26327 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
26328 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
26329 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
26330 @end smallexample
26331
26332 @table @code
26333 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
26334 @kindex set debug auto-load
26335 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
26336 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
26337
26338 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
26339 @kindex show debug auto-load
26340 @item show debug auto-load
26341 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
26342 on or off.
26343 @end table
26344
26345 @node Messages/Warnings
26346 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
26347
26348 @cindex verbose operation
26349 @cindex optional warnings
26350 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
26351 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
26352 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
26353 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
26354
26355 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
26356 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
26357 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26358
26359 @table @code
26360 @kindex set verbose
26361 @item set verbose on
26362 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
26363
26364 @item set verbose off
26365 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
26366
26367 @kindex show verbose
26368 @item show verbose
26369 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
26370 @end table
26371
26372 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
26373 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
26374 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
26375 Symbol Files}).
26376
26377 @table @code
26378
26379 @kindex set complaints
26380 @item set complaints @var{limit}
26381 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
26382 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
26383 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
26384 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
26385
26386 @kindex show complaints
26387 @item show complaints
26388 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
26389
26390 @end table
26391
26392 @anchor{confirmation requests}
26393 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
26394 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
26395 you try to run a program which is already running:
26396
26397 @smallexample
26398 (@value{GDBP}) run
26399 The program being debugged has been started already.
26400 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
26401 @end smallexample
26402
26403 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
26404 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
26405
26406 @table @code
26407
26408 @kindex set confirm
26409 @cindex flinching
26410 @cindex confirmation
26411 @cindex stupid questions
26412 @item set confirm off
26413 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
26414 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
26415 automatically disables confirmation requests.
26416
26417 @item set confirm on
26418 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
26419
26420 @kindex show confirm
26421 @item show confirm
26422 Displays state of confirmation requests.
26423
26424 @end table
26425
26426 @cindex command tracing
26427 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
26428 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
26429 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
26430 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
26431
26432 @table @code
26433 @kindex set trace-commands
26434 @cindex command scripts, debugging
26435 @item set trace-commands on
26436 Enable command tracing.
26437 @item set trace-commands off
26438 Disable command tracing.
26439 @item show trace-commands
26440 Display the current state of command tracing.
26441 @end table
26442
26443 @node Debugging Output
26444 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
26445 @cindex optional debugging messages
26446
26447 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
26448 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
26449 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
26450 section documents those commands.
26451
26452 @table @code
26453 @kindex set exec-done-display
26454 @item set exec-done-display
26455 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
26456 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
26457 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
26458 @kindex show exec-done-display
26459 @item show exec-done-display
26460 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
26461 notification.
26462
26463 @kindex set debug
26464 @cindex ARM AArch64
26465 @item set debug aarch64
26466 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
26467 The default is off.
26468 @kindex show debug
26469 @item show debug aarch64
26470 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
26471 ARM AArch64.
26472
26473 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
26474 @cindex architecture debugging info
26475 @item set debug arch
26476 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
26477 @item show debug arch
26478 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
26479
26480 @item set debug aix-solib
26481 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
26482 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
26483 support module. The default is off.
26484 @item show debug aix-solib
26485 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
26486
26487 @item set debug aix-thread
26488 @cindex AIX threads
26489 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
26490 module.
26491 @item show debug aix-thread
26492 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
26493
26494 @item set debug check-physname
26495 @cindex physname
26496 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
26497 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
26498 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
26499 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
26500 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
26501 both ways and display any discrepancies.
26502 @item show debug check-physname
26503 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
26504
26505 @item set debug coff-pe-read
26506 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
26507 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
26508 exported symbols. The default is off.
26509 @item show debug coff-pe-read
26510 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
26511 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
26512
26513 @item set debug dwarf-die
26514 @cindex DWARF DIEs
26515 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
26516 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
26517 A value of zero turns off the display.
26518 @item show debug dwarf-die
26519 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
26520
26521 @item set debug dwarf-line
26522 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
26523 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
26524 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
26525 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26526 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26527 @item show debug dwarf-line
26528 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
26529
26530 @item set debug dwarf-read
26531 @cindex DWARF Reading
26532 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
26533 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
26534 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26535 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26536 @item show debug dwarf-read
26537 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
26538
26539 @item set debug displaced
26540 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
26541 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
26542 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
26543 @item show debug displaced
26544 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
26545 related to displaced stepping.
26546
26547 @item set debug event
26548 @cindex event debugging info
26549 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
26550 default is off.
26551 @item show debug event
26552 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
26553 info.
26554
26555 @item set debug event-loop
26556 @cindex event-loop debugging
26557 Controls output of debugging info about the event loop. The possible
26558 values are @samp{off}, @samp{all} (shows all debugging info) and
26559 @samp{all-except-ui} (shows all debugging info except those about
26560 UI-related events).
26561 @item show debug event-loop
26562 Shows the current state of displaying debugging info about the event
26563 loop.
26564
26565 @item set debug expression
26566 @cindex expression debugging info
26567 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
26568 expression parsing. The default is off.
26569 @item show debug expression
26570 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
26571 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
26572
26573 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
26574 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
26575 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
26576 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
26577 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
26578
26579 @item set debug fbsd-nat
26580 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
26581 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
26582 @item show debug fbsd-nat
26583 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
26584
26585 @item set debug fortran-array-slicing
26586 @cindex fortran array slicing debugging info
26587 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} Fortran array slicing
26588 debugging info. The default is off.
26589
26590 @item show debug fortran-array-slicing
26591 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} Fortran array
26592 slicing debugging info.
26593
26594 @item set debug frame
26595 @cindex frame debugging info
26596 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
26597 default is off.
26598 @item show debug frame
26599 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
26600 info.
26601
26602 @item set debug gnu-nat
26603 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
26604 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
26605 @item show debug gnu-nat
26606 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
26607
26608 @item set debug infrun
26609 @cindex inferior debugging info
26610 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
26611 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
26612 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
26613 @item show debug infrun
26614 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
26615
26616 @item set debug jit
26617 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
26618 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
26619 @item show debug jit
26620 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
26621
26622 @item set debug lin-lwp
26623 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
26624 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
26625 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
26626 @item show debug lin-lwp
26627 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
26628
26629 @item set debug linux-namespaces
26630 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
26631 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
26632 @item show debug linux-namespaces
26633 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
26634
26635 @item set debug mach-o
26636 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
26637 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
26638 processing. The default is off.
26639 @item show debug mach-o
26640 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
26641 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
26642
26643 @item set debug notification
26644 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
26645 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
26646 The default is off.
26647 @item show debug notification
26648 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
26649
26650 @item set debug observer
26651 @cindex observer debugging info
26652 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
26653 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
26654 @item show debug observer
26655 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
26656
26657 @item set debug overload
26658 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
26659 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
26660 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
26661 is off.
26662 @item show debug overload
26663 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
26664 debugging info.
26665
26666 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
26667 @cindex debug expression parser
26668 @item set debug parser
26669 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
26670 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
26671 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
26672 details. The default is off.
26673 @item show debug parser
26674 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
26675
26676 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
26677 @cindex serial connections, debugging
26678 @cindex debug remote protocol
26679 @cindex remote protocol debugging
26680 @cindex display remote packets
26681 @item set debug remote
26682 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
26683 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
26684 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
26685 @item show debug remote
26686 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
26687
26688 @item set debug remote-packet-max-chars
26689 Sets the maximum number of characters to display for each remote packet when
26690 @code{set debug remote} is on. This is useful to prevent @value{GDBN} from
26691 displaying lengthy remote packets and polluting the console.
26692
26693 The default value is @code{512}, which means @value{GDBN} will truncate each
26694 remote packet after 512 bytes.
26695
26696 Setting this option to @code{unlimited} will disable truncation and will output
26697 the full length of the remote packets.
26698 @item show debug remote-packet-max-chars
26699 Displays the number of bytes to output for remote packet debugging.
26700
26701 @item set debug separate-debug-file
26702 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
26703 @item show debug separate-debug-file
26704 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
26705
26706 @item set debug serial
26707 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
26708 default is off.
26709 @item show debug serial
26710 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
26711 info.
26712
26713 @item set debug solib-frv
26714 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
26715 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
26716 @item show debug solib-frv
26717 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
26718 messages.
26719
26720 @item set debug symbol-lookup
26721 @cindex symbol lookup
26722 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
26723 The default is 0 (off).
26724 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26725 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26726 @item show debug symbol-lookup
26727 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
26728
26729 @item set debug symfile
26730 @cindex symbol file functions
26731 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
26732 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
26733 @item show debug symfile
26734 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
26735
26736 @item set debug symtab-create
26737 @cindex symbol table creation
26738 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
26739 The default is 0 (off).
26740 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26741 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26742 @item show debug symtab-create
26743 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
26744
26745 @item set debug target
26746 @cindex target debugging info
26747 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
26748 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
26749 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
26750 value of large memory transfers.
26751 @item show debug target
26752 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
26753 info.
26754
26755 @item set debug timestamp
26756 @cindex timestamping debugging info
26757 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
26758 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
26759 message.
26760 @item show debug timestamp
26761 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
26762 debugging info.
26763
26764 @item set debug varobj
26765 @cindex variable object debugging info
26766 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
26767 info. The default is off.
26768 @item show debug varobj
26769 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
26770 debugging info.
26771
26772 @item set debug xml
26773 @cindex XML parser debugging
26774 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
26775 @item show debug xml
26776 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
26777 @end table
26778
26779 @node Other Misc Settings
26780 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
26781 @cindex miscellaneous settings
26782
26783 @table @code
26784 @kindex set interactive-mode
26785 @item set interactive-mode
26786 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
26787 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
26788 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
26789 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
26790 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
26791 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
26792 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
26793 is, non-interactively otherwise.
26794
26795 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
26796 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
26797 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
26798 inside a cygwin window.
26799
26800 @kindex show interactive-mode
26801 @item show interactive-mode
26802 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
26803 @end table
26804
26805 @node Extending GDB
26806 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
26807 @cindex extending GDB
26808
26809 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
26810 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
26811 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
26812 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
26813 being debugged.
26814
26815 @menu
26816 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
26817 * Aliases:: Command Aliases
26818 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
26819 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
26820 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
26821 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
26822 @end menu
26823
26824 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
26825 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
26826 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
26827 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
26828 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
26829 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
26830
26831 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
26832 setting:
26833
26834 @table @code
26835 @kindex set script-extension
26836 @kindex show script-extension
26837 @item set script-extension off
26838 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
26839
26840 @item set script-extension soft
26841 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
26842 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
26843 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
26844 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
26845
26846 @item set script-extension strict
26847 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
26848 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
26849 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
26850
26851 @item show script-extension
26852 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
26853
26854 @end table
26855
26856 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR
26857 This setting is not used for files in the system-wide gdbinit directory.
26858 Files in that directory must have an extension matching their language,
26859 or have a @file{.gdb} extension to be interpreted as regular @value{GDBN}
26860 commands. @xref{Startup}.
26861 @end ifset
26862
26863 @node Sequences
26864 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
26865
26866 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
26867 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
26868 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
26869 files.
26870
26871 @menu
26872 * Define:: How to define your own commands
26873 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
26874 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
26875 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
26876 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
26877 @end menu
26878
26879 @node Define
26880 @subsection User-defined Commands
26881
26882 @cindex user-defined command
26883 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
26884 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
26885 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
26886 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
26887 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
26888 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
26889
26890 @smallexample
26891 define adder
26892 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
26893 end
26894 @end smallexample
26895
26896 @noindent
26897 To execute the command use:
26898
26899 @smallexample
26900 adder 1 2 3
26901 @end smallexample
26902
26903 @noindent
26904 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
26905 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
26906 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
26907 functions calls.
26908
26909 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
26910 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
26911 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
26912 been passed.
26913
26914 @smallexample
26915 define adder
26916 if $argc == 2
26917 print $arg0 + $arg1
26918 end
26919 if $argc == 3
26920 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
26921 end
26922 end
26923 @end smallexample
26924
26925 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
26926 to process a variable number of arguments:
26927
26928 @smallexample
26929 define adder
26930 set $i = 0
26931 set $sum = 0
26932 while $i < $argc
26933 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
26934 set $i = $i + 1
26935 end
26936 print $sum
26937 end
26938 @end smallexample
26939
26940 @table @code
26941
26942 @kindex define
26943 @item define @var{commandname}
26944 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
26945 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
26946 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
26947 numbers, dashes, dots, and underscores. It may also start with any
26948 predefined or user-defined prefix command.
26949 For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
26950 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
26951
26952 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
26953 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
26954 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
26955
26956 @kindex document
26957 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
26958 @item document @var{commandname}
26959 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
26960 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
26961 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
26962 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
26963 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
26964 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
26965
26966 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
26967 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
26968 does not change the documentation.
26969
26970 @kindex define-prefix
26971 @item define-prefix @var{commandname}
26972 Define or mark the command @var{commandname} as a user-defined prefix
26973 command. Once marked, @var{commandname} can be used as prefix command
26974 by the @code{define} command.
26975 Note that @code{define-prefix} can be used with a not yet defined
26976 @var{commandname}. In such a case, @var{commandname} is defined as
26977 an empty user-defined command.
26978 In case you redefine a command that was marked as a user-defined
26979 prefix command, the subcommands of the redefined command are kept
26980 (and @value{GDBN} indicates so to the user).
26981
26982 Example:
26983 @example
26984 (gdb) define-prefix abc
26985 (gdb) define-prefix abc def
26986 (gdb) define abc def
26987 Type commands for definition of "abc def".
26988 End with a line saying just "end".
26989 >echo command initial def\n
26990 >end
26991 (gdb) define abc def ghi
26992 Type commands for definition of "abc def ghi".
26993 End with a line saying just "end".
26994 >echo command ghi\n
26995 >end
26996 (gdb) define abc def
26997 Keeping subcommands of prefix command "def".
26998 Redefine command "def"? (y or n) y
26999 Type commands for definition of "abc def".
27000 End with a line saying just "end".
27001 >echo command def\n
27002 >end
27003 (gdb) abc def ghi
27004 command ghi
27005 (gdb) abc def
27006 command def
27007 (gdb)
27008 @end example
27009
27010 @kindex dont-repeat
27011 @cindex don't repeat command
27012 @item dont-repeat
27013 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
27014 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
27015 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
27016
27017 @kindex help user-defined
27018 @item help user-defined
27019 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
27020 COMMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
27021 included (if any).
27022
27023 @kindex show user
27024 @item show user
27025 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
27026 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
27027 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
27028 definitions for all user-defined commands.
27029 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
27030
27031 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
27032 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
27033 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
27034 @item show max-user-call-depth
27035 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
27036 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
27037 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
27038 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
27039 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
27040 @end table
27041
27042 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
27043 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
27044
27045 When user-defined commands are executed, the
27046 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
27047 stops execution of the user-defined command.
27048
27049 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
27050 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
27051 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
27052 messages when used in a user-defined command.
27053
27054 @node Hooks
27055 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
27056 @cindex command hooks
27057 @cindex hooks, for commands
27058 @cindex hooks, pre-command
27059
27060 @kindex hook
27061 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
27062 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
27063 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
27064 before that command.
27065
27066 @cindex hooks, post-command
27067 @kindex hookpost
27068 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
27069 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
27070 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
27071 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
27072 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
27073
27074 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
27075 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
27076
27077 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
27078 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
27079
27080 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
27081 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
27082 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
27083 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
27084 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
27085
27086 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
27087 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
27088 you could define:
27089
27090 @smallexample
27091 define hook-stop
27092 handle SIGALRM nopass
27093 end
27094
27095 define hook-run
27096 handle SIGALRM pass
27097 end
27098
27099 define hook-continue
27100 handle SIGALRM pass
27101 end
27102 @end smallexample
27103
27104 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
27105 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
27106 you could define:
27107
27108 @smallexample
27109 define hook-echo
27110 echo <<<---
27111 end
27112
27113 define hookpost-echo
27114 echo --->>>\n
27115 end
27116
27117 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
27118 <<<---Hello World--->>>
27119 (@value{GDBP})
27120
27121 @end smallexample
27122
27123 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
27124 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
27125 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
27126 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
27127 @c or not?
27128 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
27129 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
27130 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
27131
27132 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
27133 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
27134 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
27135
27136 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
27137 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
27138
27139 @node Command Files
27140 @subsection Command Files
27141
27142 @cindex command files
27143 @cindex scripting commands
27144 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
27145 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
27146 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
27147 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
27148 terminal.
27149
27150 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
27151 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
27152 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
27153 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
27154 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
27155
27156 @table @code
27157 @kindex source
27158 @cindex execute commands from a file
27159 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
27160 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
27161 @end table
27162
27163 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
27164 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
27165 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
27166 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
27167 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
27168
27169 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
27170 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
27171 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
27172 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
27173 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
27174 is not relevant to scripts.
27175
27176 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
27177 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
27178 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
27179 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
27180 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
27181 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
27182 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
27183 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
27184 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
27185 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
27186 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
27187 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
27188 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
27189 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
27190
27191 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
27192 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
27193 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
27194
27195 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
27196 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
27197 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
27198 when called from command files.
27199
27200 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
27201 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
27202 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
27203 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
27204 the next command.
27205
27206 @smallexample
27207 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
27208 @end smallexample
27209
27210 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
27211 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
27212 would be directed to @file{log}.
27213
27214 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
27215 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
27216 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
27217 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
27218 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
27219 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
27220 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
27221 conditionally, etc.
27222
27223 @table @code
27224 @kindex if
27225 @kindex else
27226 @item if
27227 @itemx else
27228 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
27229 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
27230 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
27231 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
27232 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
27233 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
27234 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
27235
27236 @kindex while
27237 @item while
27238 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
27239 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
27240 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
27241 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
27242 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
27243 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
27244
27245 @kindex loop_break
27246 @item loop_break
27247 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
27248 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
27249 line.
27250
27251 @kindex loop_continue
27252 @item loop_continue
27253 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
27254 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
27255 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
27256 the controlling expression.
27257
27258 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
27259 @item end
27260 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
27261 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
27262 @end table
27263
27264
27265 @node Output
27266 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
27267
27268 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
27269 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
27270 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
27271 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
27272 want.
27273
27274 @table @code
27275 @kindex echo
27276 @item echo @var{text}
27277 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
27278 @c because it is not in ANSI.
27279 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
27280 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
27281 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
27282 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
27283 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
27284 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
27285 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
27286 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
27287 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
27288
27289 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
27290 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
27291
27292 @smallexample
27293 echo This is some text\n\
27294 which is continued\n\
27295 onto several lines.\n
27296 @end smallexample
27297
27298 produces the same output as
27299
27300 @smallexample
27301 echo This is some text\n
27302 echo which is continued\n
27303 echo onto several lines.\n
27304 @end smallexample
27305
27306 @kindex output
27307 @item output @var{expression}
27308 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
27309 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
27310 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
27311 on expressions.
27312
27313 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
27314 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
27315 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
27316 Formats}, for more information.
27317
27318 @kindex printf
27319 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
27320 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
27321 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
27322 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
27323 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
27324 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
27325 executing the code below:
27326
27327 @smallexample
27328 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
27329 @end smallexample
27330
27331 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
27332 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
27333 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
27334 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
27335 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
27336 printed.
27337
27338 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
27339
27340 @smallexample
27341 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
27342 @end smallexample
27343
27344 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
27345 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
27346 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
27347
27348 @itemize @bullet
27349 @item
27350 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
27351
27352 @item
27353 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
27354 width.
27355
27356 @item
27357 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
27358 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
27359
27360 @item
27361 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
27362 supported.
27363
27364 @item
27365 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
27366
27367 @item
27368 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
27369 @end itemize
27370
27371 @noindent
27372 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
27373 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
27374 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
27375 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
27376
27377 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
27378 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
27379 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
27380 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
27381 supported.
27382
27383 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
27384 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
27385 together with a floating point specifier.
27386 letters:
27387
27388 @itemize @bullet
27389 @item
27390 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
27391
27392 @item
27393 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
27394
27395 @item
27396 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
27397 @end itemize
27398
27399 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
27400 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
27401 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
27402
27403 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
27404 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
27405
27406 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
27407 @smallexample
27408 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
27409 @end smallexample
27410
27411 @anchor{eval}
27412 @kindex eval
27413 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
27414 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
27415 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
27416
27417 @end table
27418
27419 @node Auto-loading sequences
27420 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
27421 @cindex native script auto-loading
27422
27423 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
27424 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
27425 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
27426 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
27427
27428 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
27429 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
27430
27431 @table @code
27432 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
27433 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
27434 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
27435 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
27436
27437 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
27438 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
27439 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
27440 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
27441 disabled.
27442
27443 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
27444 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
27445 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
27446 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
27447 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
27448 auto-loaded.
27449 @end table
27450
27451 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
27452 matching names are printed.
27453
27454 @node Aliases
27455 @section Command Aliases
27456 @cindex aliases for commands
27457
27458 Aliases allow you to define alternate spellings for existing commands.
27459 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python
27460 (@pxref{Python}) has a long name, it is handy to have an abbreviated
27461 version of it that involves less typing.
27462
27463 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
27464 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
27465 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
27466
27467 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
27468 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
27469 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
27470
27471 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
27472
27473 @table @code
27474
27475 @kindex alias
27476 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{alias} = @var{command} [@var{default-args}]
27477
27478 @end table
27479
27480 @var{alias} specifies the name of the new alias. Each word of
27481 @var{alias} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and underscores.
27482
27483 @var{command} specifies the name of an existing command
27484 that is being aliased.
27485
27486 @var{command} can also be the name of an existing alias. In this
27487 case, @var{command} cannot be an alias that has default arguments.
27488
27489 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
27490 of the command. Abbreviations are not used in command completion.
27491
27492 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
27493 and is useful when @var{alias} begins with a dash.
27494
27495 You can specify @var{default-args} for your alias. These
27496 @var{default-args} will be automatically added before the alias
27497 arguments typed explicitly on the command line.
27498
27499 For example, the below defines an alias @code{btfullall} that shows all local
27500 variables and all frame arguments:
27501 @smallexample
27502 (@value{GDBP}) alias btfullall = backtrace -full -frame-arguments all
27503 @end smallexample
27504
27505 For more information about @var{default-args}, see @ref{Command
27506 aliases default args, ,Default Arguments}.
27507
27508 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation of a
27509 command so that there is less to type. Suppose you were tired of
27510 typing @samp{disas}, the current shortest unambiguous abbreviation of
27511 the @samp{disassemble} command and you wanted an even shorter version
27512 named @samp{di}. The following will accomplish this.
27513
27514 @smallexample
27515 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
27516 @end smallexample
27517
27518 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands. With a
27519 user-defined command, you also need to write documentation for it with
27520 the @samp{document} command. An alias automatically picks up the
27521 documentation of the existing command.
27522
27523 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
27524 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
27525 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
27526 of a command.
27527
27528 @smallexample
27529 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
27530 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
27531 (gdb) set p elms 20
27532 (gdb) show p elms
27533 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
27534 @end smallexample
27535
27536 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
27537 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
27538 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
27539
27540 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{command} and
27541 @var{alias}, just as they are normally.
27542
27543 @smallexample
27544 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
27545 @end smallexample
27546
27547 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
27548 alias for a more complex command.
27549 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
27550
27551 @smallexample
27552 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
27553 (gdb) spe 20
27554 @end smallexample
27555
27556 @menu
27557 * Command aliases default args:: Default arguments for aliases
27558 @end menu
27559
27560 @node Command aliases default args
27561 @subsection Default Arguments
27562 @cindex aliases for commands, default arguments
27563
27564 You can tell @value{GDBN} to always prepend some default arguments to
27565 the list of arguments provided explicitly by the user when using a
27566 user-defined alias.
27567
27568 If you repeatedly use the same arguments or options for a command, you
27569 can define an alias for this command and tell @value{GDBN} to
27570 automatically prepend these arguments or options to the list of
27571 arguments you type explicitly when using the alias@footnote{@value{GDBN}
27572 could easily accept default arguments for pre-defined commands and aliases,
27573 but it was deemed this would be confusing, and so is not allowed.}.
27574
27575 For example, if you often use the command @code{thread apply all}
27576 specifying to work on the threads in ascending order and to continue in case it
27577 encounters an error, you can tell @value{GDBN} to automatically preprend
27578 the @code{-ascending} and @code{-c} options by using:
27579
27580 @smallexample
27581 (@value{GDBP}) alias thread apply asc-all = thread apply all -ascending -c
27582 @end smallexample
27583
27584 Once you have defined this alias with its default args, any time you type
27585 the @code{thread apply asc-all} followed by @code{some arguments},
27586 @value{GDBN} will execute @code{thread apply all -ascending -c some arguments}.
27587
27588 To have even less to type, you can also define a one word alias:
27589 @smallexample
27590 (@value{GDBP}) alias t_a_c = thread apply all -ascending -c
27591 @end smallexample
27592
27593 As usual, unambiguous abbreviations can be used for @var{alias}
27594 and @var{default-args}.
27595
27596 The different aliases of a command do not share their default args.
27597 For example, you define a new alias @code{bt_ALL} showing all possible
27598 information and another alias @code{bt_SMALL} showing very limited information
27599 using:
27600 @smallexample
27601 (@value{GDBP}) alias bt_ALL = backtrace -entry-values both -frame-arg all \
27602 -past-main -past-entry -full
27603 (@value{GDBP}) alias bt_SMALL = backtrace -entry-values no -frame-arg none \
27604 -past-main off -past-entry off
27605 @end smallexample
27606
27607 (For more on using the @code{alias} command, see @ref{Aliases}.)
27608
27609 Default args are not limited to the arguments and options of @var{command},
27610 but can specify nested commands if @var{command} accepts such a nested command
27611 as argument.
27612 For example, the below defines @code{faalocalsoftype} that lists the
27613 frames having locals of a certain type, together with the matching
27614 local vars:
27615 @smallexample
27616 (@value{GDBP}) alias faalocalsoftype = frame apply all info locals -q -t
27617 (@value{GDBP}) faalocalsoftype int
27618 #1 0x55554f5e in sleeper_or_burner (v=0xdf50) at sleepers.c:86
27619 i = 0
27620 ret = 21845
27621 @end smallexample
27622
27623 This is also very useful to define an alias for a set of nested @code{with}
27624 commands to have a particular combination of temporary settings. For example,
27625 the below defines the alias @code{pp10} that pretty prints an expression
27626 argument, with a maximum of 10 elements if the expression is a string or
27627 an array:
27628 @smallexample
27629 (@value{GDBP}) alias pp10 = with print pretty -- with print elements 10 -- print
27630 @end smallexample
27631 This defines the alias @code{pp10} as being a sequence of 3 commands.
27632 The first part @code{with print pretty --} temporarily activates the setting
27633 @code{set print pretty}, then launches the command that follows the separator
27634 @code{--}.
27635 The command following the first part is also a @code{with} command that
27636 temporarily changes the setting @code{set print elements} to 10, then
27637 launches the command that follows the second separator @code{--}.
27638 The third part @code{print} is the command the @code{pp10} alias will launch,
27639 using the temporary values of the settings and the arguments explicitly given
27640 by the user.
27641 For more information about the @code{with} command usage,
27642 see @ref{Command Settings}.
27643
27644 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
27645 @include python.texi
27646
27647 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
27648 @include guile.texi
27649
27650 @node Auto-loading extensions
27651 @section Auto-loading extensions
27652 @cindex auto-loading extensions
27653
27654 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
27655 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
27656 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
27657 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
27658 section of modern file formats like ELF.
27659
27660 @menu
27661 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
27662 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27663 * Which flavor to choose?::
27664 @end menu
27665
27666 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
27667 debugging commands and features.
27668
27669 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
27670 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
27671 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
27672 for more information.
27673 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
27674 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
27675
27676 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
27677 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27678
27679 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
27680 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
27681 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
27682 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
27683 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
27684
27685 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
27686 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
27687 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
27688 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
27689
27690 @table @code
27691 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
27692 GDB's own command language
27693 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
27694 Python
27695 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
27696 Guile
27697 @end table
27698
27699 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
27700 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
27701 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
27702 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
27703 script in the specified extension language.
27704
27705 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
27706 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
27707 (On MS-Windows/MS-DOS, the drive letter of the executable's leading
27708 directories is converted to a one-letter subdirectory, i.e.@:
27709 @file{d:/usr/bin/} is converted to @file{/d/usr/bin/}, because Windows
27710 filesystems disallow colons in file names.)
27711
27712 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
27713 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27714
27715 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
27716 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
27717 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
27718 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
27719 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
27720 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
27721
27722 @table @code
27723 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
27724 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
27725 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
27726 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
27727 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
27728 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
27729
27730 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
27731 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
27732
27733 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
27734 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
27735 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
27736 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
27737
27738 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
27739 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
27740 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
27741 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
27742 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
27743 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
27744 platform.
27745
27746 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
27747 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
27748 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
27749
27750 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
27751 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
27752 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
27753 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
27754
27755 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
27756 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
27757 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
27758 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
27759 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
27760 @end table
27761
27762 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
27763 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
27764 @var{objfile} is opened.
27765 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
27766 is evaluated more than once.
27767
27768 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
27769 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27770 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27771
27772 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
27773 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
27774 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
27775 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
27776 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
27777 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
27778 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
27779
27780 The following entries are supported:
27781
27782 @table @code
27783 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
27784 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
27785 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
27786 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
27787 @end table
27788
27789 @subsubsection Script File Entries
27790
27791 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
27792 in the current directory and then along the source search path
27793 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
27794 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
27795 directory is not relevant to scripts.
27796
27797 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
27798 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
27799
27800 @example
27801 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
27802 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
27803 asm("\
27804 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
27805 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
27806 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
27807 .popsection \n\
27808 ");
27809 @end example
27810
27811 @noindent
27812 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
27813 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
27814
27815 @example
27816 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
27817 @end example
27818
27819 The script name may include directories if desired.
27820
27821 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
27822 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27823
27824 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
27825 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
27826 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
27827 will remove duplicates.
27828
27829 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
27830
27831 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
27832 itself instead of loading it from a file.
27833 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
27834 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
27835 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
27836 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
27837 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
27838 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
27839 on its name.
27840
27841 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
27842 testsuite.
27843
27844 @example
27845 #include "symcat.h"
27846 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
27847 asm(
27848 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
27849 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
27850 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
27851 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
27852 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
27853 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
27854 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
27855 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
27856 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
27857 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
27858 ".byte 0\n"
27859 ".popsection\n"
27860 );
27861 @end example
27862
27863 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
27864 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27865 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
27866 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
27867
27868 @node Which flavor to choose?
27869 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
27870
27871 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
27872 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
27873
27874 @noindent
27875 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
27876
27877 @itemize @bullet
27878 @item
27879 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
27880
27881 @item
27882 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
27883
27884 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
27885 in the source search path.
27886 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
27887 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
27888
27889 @item
27890 Doesn't require source code additions.
27891 @end itemize
27892
27893 @noindent
27894 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
27895
27896 @itemize @bullet
27897 @item
27898 Works with static linking.
27899
27900 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
27901 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
27902 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
27903 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
27904 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
27905
27906 @item
27907 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
27908
27909 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
27910 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
27911
27912 @item
27913 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
27914
27915 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
27916 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
27917 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
27918 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
27919 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
27920 top of the source tree to the source search path.
27921 @end itemize
27922
27923 @node Multiple Extension Languages
27924 @section Multiple Extension Languages
27925
27926 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
27927 and generally do not interfere with each other.
27928 There are some things to be aware of, however.
27929
27930 @subsection Python comes first
27931
27932 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
27933 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
27934 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
27935 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
27936 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
27937 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
27938 pretty-printed form of a value).
27939 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
27940 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
27941 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
27942
27943 @node Interpreters
27944 @chapter Command Interpreters
27945 @cindex command interpreters
27946
27947 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
27948 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
27949 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
27950
27951 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
27952 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
27953 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
27954 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
27955
27956 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
27957 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
27958 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
27959 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
27960
27961 @table @code
27962 @item console
27963 @cindex console interpreter
27964 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
27965 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
27966 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
27967
27968 @item mi
27969 @cindex mi interpreter
27970 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi3}). Used primarily
27971 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
27972 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
27973 Interface}.
27974
27975 @item mi3
27976 @cindex mi3 interpreter
27977 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 9.1.
27978
27979 @item mi2
27980 @cindex mi2 interpreter
27981 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 6.0.
27982
27983 @item mi1
27984 @cindex mi1 interpreter
27985 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 5.1.
27986
27987 @end table
27988
27989 @cindex invoke another interpreter
27990
27991 @kindex interpreter-exec
27992 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
27993 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
27994 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
27995
27996 @smallexample
27997 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
27998 @end smallexample
27999
28000 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
28001 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
28002
28003 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
28004 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
28005 permanently.
28006
28007 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
28008
28009 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
28010 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
28011 device (usually a tty).
28012
28013 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
28014 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
28015 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
28016 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
28017 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
28018 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
28019 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
28020 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
28021 the separate MI interpreter.
28022
28023 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
28024 @code{new-ui} command:
28025
28026 @kindex new-ui
28027 @cindex new user interface
28028 @smallexample
28029 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
28030 @end smallexample
28031
28032 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
28033 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
28034 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
28035 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
28036 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
28037 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
28038
28039 @smallexample
28040 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
28041 @end smallexample
28042
28043 @noindent
28044 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
28045
28046 @node TUI
28047 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
28048 @cindex TUI
28049 @cindex Text User Interface
28050
28051 @menu
28052 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
28053 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
28054 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
28055 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
28056 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
28057 @end menu
28058
28059 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
28060 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
28061 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
28062 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
28063 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
28064 is available.
28065
28066 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
28067 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
28068 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
28069 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
28070 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
28071 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
28072
28073 @node TUI Overview
28074 @section TUI Overview
28075
28076 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
28077
28078 @table @emph
28079 @item command
28080 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
28081 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
28082 managed using readline.
28083
28084 @item source
28085 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
28086 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
28087
28088 @item assembly
28089 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
28090
28091 @item register
28092 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
28093 when their values change.
28094 @end table
28095
28096 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
28097 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
28098 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
28099 indicates the breakpoint type:
28100
28101 @table @code
28102 @item B
28103 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
28104
28105 @item b
28106 Breakpoint which was never hit.
28107
28108 @item H
28109 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
28110
28111 @item h
28112 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
28113 @end table
28114
28115 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
28116
28117 @table @code
28118 @item +
28119 Breakpoint is enabled.
28120
28121 @item -
28122 Breakpoint is disabled.
28123 @end table
28124
28125 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
28126 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
28127 changes.
28128
28129 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
28130 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
28131 layouts:
28132
28133 @itemize @bullet
28134 @item
28135 source only,
28136
28137 @item
28138 assembly only,
28139
28140 @item
28141 source and assembly,
28142
28143 @item
28144 source and registers, or
28145
28146 @item
28147 assembly and registers.
28148 @end itemize
28149
28150 These are the standard layouts, but other layouts can be defined.
28151
28152 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
28153
28154 @table @emph
28155 @item target
28156 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
28157 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
28158
28159 @item process
28160 Gives the current process or thread number.
28161 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
28162
28163 @item function
28164 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
28165 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
28166 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
28167 the string @code{??} is displayed.
28168
28169 @item line
28170 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
28171 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
28172
28173 @item pc
28174 Indicates the current program counter address.
28175 @end table
28176
28177 @node TUI Keys
28178 @section TUI Key Bindings
28179 @cindex TUI key bindings
28180
28181 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
28182 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
28183 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
28184 @end ifset
28185 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
28186 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
28187 @end ifclear
28188 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
28189 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
28190
28191 @table @kbd
28192 @kindex C-x C-a
28193 @item C-x C-a
28194 @kindex C-x a
28195 @itemx C-x a
28196 @kindex C-x A
28197 @itemx C-x A
28198 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
28199 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
28200 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
28201 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
28202 The screen is then refreshed.
28203
28204 This key binding uses the bindable Readline function
28205 @code{tui-switch-mode}.
28206
28207 @kindex C-x 1
28208 @item C-x 1
28209 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
28210 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
28211 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
28212
28213 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
28214
28215 This key binding uses the bindable Readline function
28216 @code{tui-delete-other-windows}.
28217
28218 @kindex C-x 2
28219 @item C-x 2
28220 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
28221 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
28222 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
28223 previous layout and the new one.
28224
28225 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
28226
28227 This key binding uses the bindable Readline function
28228 @code{tui-change-windows}.
28229
28230 @kindex C-x o
28231 @item C-x o
28232 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
28233 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
28234 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
28235
28236 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
28237
28238 This key binding uses the bindable Readline function
28239 @code{tui-other-window}.
28240
28241 @kindex C-x s
28242 @item C-x s
28243 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
28244 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
28245
28246 This key binding uses the bindable Readline function
28247 @code{next-keymap}.
28248 @end table
28249
28250 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
28251
28252 @table @asis
28253 @kindex PgUp
28254 @item @key{PgUp}
28255 Scroll the active window one page up.
28256
28257 @kindex PgDn
28258 @item @key{PgDn}
28259 Scroll the active window one page down.
28260
28261 @kindex Up
28262 @item @key{Up}
28263 Scroll the active window one line up.
28264
28265 @kindex Down
28266 @item @key{Down}
28267 Scroll the active window one line down.
28268
28269 @kindex Left
28270 @item @key{Left}
28271 Scroll the active window one column left.
28272
28273 @kindex Right
28274 @item @key{Right}
28275 Scroll the active window one column right.
28276
28277 @kindex C-L
28278 @item @kbd{C-L}
28279 Refresh the screen.
28280 @end table
28281
28282 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
28283 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
28284 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
28285 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
28286 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
28287
28288 @node TUI Single Key Mode
28289 @section TUI Single Key Mode
28290 @cindex TUI single key mode
28291
28292 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
28293 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
28294 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
28295
28296 @table @kbd
28297 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28298 @item c
28299 continue
28300
28301 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28302 @item d
28303 down
28304
28305 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28306 @item f
28307 finish
28308
28309 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28310 @item n
28311 next
28312
28313 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28314 @item o
28315 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
28316
28317 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28318 @item q
28319 exit the SingleKey mode.
28320
28321 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28322 @item r
28323 run
28324
28325 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28326 @item s
28327 step
28328
28329 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28330 @item i
28331 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
28332
28333 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28334 @item u
28335 up
28336
28337 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28338 @item v
28339 info locals
28340
28341 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28342 @item w
28343 where
28344 @end table
28345
28346 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
28347 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
28348 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
28349 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
28350 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
28351 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
28352
28353 @cindex SingleKey keymap name
28354 If @value{GDBN} was built with Readline 8.0 or later, the TUI
28355 SingleKey keymap will be named @samp{SingleKey}. This can be used in
28356 @file{.inputrc} to add additional bindings to this keymap.
28357
28358 @node TUI Commands
28359 @section TUI-specific Commands
28360 @cindex TUI commands
28361
28362 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
28363 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
28364 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
28365 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
28366
28367 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
28368 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
28369 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
28370 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
28371 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
28372
28373 @table @code
28374 @item tui enable
28375 @kindex tui enable
28376 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
28377 TUI mode has previously been used in the current debugging session,
28378 otherwise a default layout is used.
28379
28380 @item tui disable
28381 @kindex tui disable
28382 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
28383
28384 @item info win
28385 @kindex info win
28386 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
28387
28388 @item tui new-layout @var{name} @var{window} @var{weight} @r{[}@var{window} @var{weight}@dots{}@r{]}
28389 @kindex tui new-layout
28390 Create a new TUI layout. The new layout will be named @var{name}, and
28391 can be accessed using the @code{layout} command (see below).
28392
28393 Each @var{window} parameter is either the name of a window to display,
28394 or a window description. The windows will be displayed from top to
28395 bottom in the order listed.
28396
28397 The names of the windows are the same as the ones given to the
28398 @code{focus} command (see below); additional, the @code{status}
28399 window can be specified. Note that, because it is of fixed height,
28400 the weight assigned to the status window is of no importance. It is
28401 conventional to use @samp{0} here.
28402
28403 A window description looks a bit like an invocation of @code{tui
28404 new-layout}, and is of the form
28405 @{@r{[}@code{-horizontal}@r{]}@var{window} @var{weight} @r{[}@var{window} @var{weight}@dots{}@r{]}@}.
28406
28407 This specifies a sub-layout. If @code{-horizontal} is given, the
28408 windows in this description will be arranged side-by-side, rather than
28409 top-to-bottom.
28410
28411 Each @var{weight} is an integer. It is the weight of this window
28412 relative to all the other windows in the layout. These numbers are
28413 used to calculate how much of the screen is given to each window.
28414
28415 For example:
28416
28417 @example
28418 (gdb) tui new-layout example src 1 regs 1 status 0 cmd 1
28419 @end example
28420
28421 Here, the new layout is called @samp{example}. It shows the source
28422 and register windows, followed by the status window, and then finally
28423 the command window. The non-status windows all have the same weight,
28424 so the terminal will be split into three roughly equal sections.
28425
28426 Here is a more complex example, showing a horizontal layout:
28427
28428 @example
28429 (gdb) tui new-layout example @{-horizontal src 1 asm 1@} 2 status 0 cmd 1
28430 @end example
28431
28432 This will result in side-by-side source and assembly windows; with the
28433 status and command window being beneath these, filling the entire
28434 width of the terminal. Because they have weight 2, the source and
28435 assembly windows will be twice the height of the command window.
28436
28437 @item layout @var{name}
28438 @kindex layout
28439 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. The @var{name} parameter
28440 controls which layout is shown. It can be either one of the built-in
28441 layout names, or the name of a layout defined by the user using
28442 @code{tui new-layout}.
28443
28444 The built-in layouts are as follows:
28445
28446 @table @code
28447 @item next
28448 Display the next layout.
28449
28450 @item prev
28451 Display the previous layout.
28452
28453 @item src
28454 Display the source and command windows.
28455
28456 @item asm
28457 Display the assembly and command windows.
28458
28459 @item split
28460 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
28461
28462 @item regs
28463 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
28464 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
28465 register, assembler, and command windows.
28466 @end table
28467
28468 @item focus @var{name}
28469 @kindex focus
28470 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
28471 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
28472
28473 @table @code
28474 @item next
28475 Make the next window active for scrolling.
28476
28477 @item prev
28478 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
28479
28480 @item src
28481 Make the source window active for scrolling.
28482
28483 @item asm
28484 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
28485
28486 @item regs
28487 Make the register window active for scrolling.
28488
28489 @item cmd
28490 Make the command window active for scrolling.
28491 @end table
28492
28493 @item refresh
28494 @kindex refresh
28495 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
28496
28497 @item tui reg @var{group}
28498 @kindex tui reg
28499 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
28500 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
28501 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
28502 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
28503 following groups are available on most targets:
28504 @table @code
28505 @item next
28506 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
28507 through all of the available register groups.
28508
28509 @item prev
28510 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
28511 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
28512 @var{next}.
28513
28514 @item general
28515 Display the general registers.
28516 @item float
28517 Display the floating point registers.
28518 @item system
28519 Display the system registers.
28520 @item vector
28521 Display the vector registers.
28522 @item all
28523 Display all registers.
28524 @end table
28525
28526 @item update
28527 @kindex update
28528 Update the source window and the current execution point.
28529
28530 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
28531 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
28532 @kindex winheight
28533 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
28534 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
28535 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
28536 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
28537 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
28538 @end table
28539
28540 @node TUI Configuration
28541 @section TUI Configuration Variables
28542 @cindex TUI configuration variables
28543
28544 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
28545
28546 @table @code
28547 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
28548 @kindex set tui border-kind
28549 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
28550 The possible values are the following:
28551 @table @code
28552 @item space
28553 Use a space character to draw the border.
28554
28555 @item ascii
28556 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
28557
28558 @item acs
28559 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
28560 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
28561 @end table
28562
28563 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
28564 @kindex set tui border-mode
28565 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
28566 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
28567 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
28568 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
28569 @table @code
28570 @item normal
28571 Use normal attributes to display the border.
28572
28573 @item standout
28574 Use standout mode.
28575
28576 @item reverse
28577 Use reverse video mode.
28578
28579 @item half
28580 Use half bright mode.
28581
28582 @item half-standout
28583 Use half bright and standout mode.
28584
28585 @item bold
28586 Use extra bright or bold mode.
28587
28588 @item bold-standout
28589 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
28590 @end table
28591
28592 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
28593 @kindex set tui tab-width
28594 @kindex tabset
28595 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
28596 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
28597 assembly windows.
28598
28599 @item set tui compact-source @r{[}on@r{|}off@r{]}
28600 @kindex set tui compact-source
28601 Set whether the TUI source window is displayed in ``compact'' form.
28602 The default display uses more space for line numbers and starts the
28603 source text at the next tab stop; the compact display uses only as
28604 much space as is needed for the line numbers in the current file, and
28605 only a single space to separate the line numbers from the source.
28606 @end table
28607
28608 Note that the colors of the TUI borders can be controlled using the
28609 appropriate @code{set style} commands. @xref{Output Styling}.
28610
28611 @node Emacs
28612 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
28613
28614 @cindex Emacs
28615 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
28616 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
28617 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
28618 @value{GDBN}.
28619
28620 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
28621 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
28622 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
28623 created Emacs buffer.
28624 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
28625
28626 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
28627 things:
28628
28629 @itemize @bullet
28630 @item
28631 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
28632 the GUD buffer.
28633
28634 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
28635 and output done by the program you are debugging.
28636
28637 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
28638 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
28639 in this way.
28640
28641 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
28642 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
28643 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
28644 stop.
28645
28646 @item
28647 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
28648
28649 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
28650 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
28651 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
28652 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
28653 and the source.
28654
28655 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
28656 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
28657 @end itemize
28658
28659 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
28660 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
28661 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
28662 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
28663
28664 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
28665 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
28666 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
28667 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
28668 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
28669 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
28670 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
28671 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
28672 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
28673
28674 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
28675 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
28676 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
28677 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
28678
28679 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
28680 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
28681 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
28682 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
28683 one you want.
28684
28685 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
28686 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
28687
28688 @table @kbd
28689 @item C-h m
28690 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
28691
28692 @item C-c C-s
28693 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
28694 update the display window to show the current file and location.
28695
28696 @item C-c C-n
28697 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
28698 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
28699 to show the current file and location.
28700
28701 @item C-c C-i
28702 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
28703 display window accordingly.
28704
28705 @item C-c C-f
28706 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
28707 @code{finish} command.
28708
28709 @item C-c C-r
28710 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
28711 command.
28712
28713 @item C-c <
28714 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
28715 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
28716 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
28717
28718 @item C-c >
28719 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
28720 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
28721 @end table
28722
28723 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
28724 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
28725
28726 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
28727 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
28728 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
28729 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
28730 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
28731 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
28732 speedbar displays watch expressions.
28733
28734 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
28735 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
28736 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
28737 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
28738 frame.
28739
28740 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
28741 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
28742 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
28743 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
28744 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
28745 to correspond properly with the code.
28746
28747 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
28748 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
28749 Emacs Manual}).
28750
28751 @node GDB/MI
28752 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
28753
28754 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
28755
28756 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
28757 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
28758 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
28759 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
28760 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
28761 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
28762
28763 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
28764 in the form of a reference manual.
28765
28766 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
28767 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
28768 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
28769
28770 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
28771
28772 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
28773 This chapter uses the following notation:
28774
28775 @itemize @bullet
28776 @item
28777 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
28778
28779 @item
28780 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
28781 it may or may not be given.
28782
28783 @item
28784 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
28785 may repeat zero or more times.
28786
28787 @item
28788 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
28789 may repeat one or more times.
28790
28791 @item
28792 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
28793 @end itemize
28794
28795 @ignore
28796 @heading Dependencies
28797 @end ignore
28798
28799 @menu
28800 * GDB/MI General Design::
28801 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
28802 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
28803 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
28804 * GDB/MI Output Records::
28805 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
28806 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
28807 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
28808 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28809 * GDB/MI Program Context::
28810 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
28811 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
28812 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
28813 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
28814 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
28815 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
28816 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
28817 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
28818 * GDB/MI File Commands::
28819 @ignore
28820 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
28821 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
28822 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
28823 @end ignore
28824 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
28825 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
28826 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
28827 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
28828 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
28829 @end menu
28830
28831 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28832 @node GDB/MI General Design
28833 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
28834 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
28835
28836 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
28837 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
28838 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
28839 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
28840 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
28841 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
28842 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
28843 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
28844 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
28845 a command and reported as part of that command response.
28846
28847 The important examples of notifications are:
28848 @itemize @bullet
28849
28850 @item
28851 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
28852 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
28853 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
28854 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
28855 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
28856 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
28857 command itself was successfully executed.
28858
28859 @item
28860 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
28861 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
28862 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
28863 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
28864 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
28865 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
28866
28867 @item
28868 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
28869 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
28870 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
28871 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
28872 orthogonal frontend design.
28873
28874 @end itemize
28875
28876 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
28877 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
28878 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
28879 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
28880 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
28881 the user interface.
28882
28883
28884 @menu
28885 * Context management::
28886 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
28887 * Thread groups::
28888 @end menu
28889
28890 @node Context management
28891 @subsection Context management
28892
28893 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
28894
28895 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
28896 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
28897 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
28898 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
28899 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
28900 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
28901 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
28902 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
28903 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
28904
28905 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
28906 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
28907 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
28908 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
28909 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
28910 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
28911 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
28912 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
28913 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
28914 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
28915 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
28916
28917 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
28918 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
28919 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
28920 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
28921 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
28922 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
28923 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
28924 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
28925 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
28926 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
28927
28928 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
28929 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
28930 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
28931 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
28932 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
28933 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
28934 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
28935 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
28936 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
28937 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
28938 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
28939 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
28940 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
28941 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
28942 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
28943 @samp{--frame} options.
28944
28945 @subsubsection Language
28946
28947 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
28948 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
28949 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
28950 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
28951 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
28952 For instance:
28953
28954 @smallexample
28955 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
28956 ^done,value="4"
28957 (gdb)
28958 @end smallexample
28959
28960 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
28961 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
28962 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
28963
28964 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
28965 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
28966
28967 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
28968 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
28969 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
28970 specify a preference for asynchronous execution using the
28971 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
28972 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
28973 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
28974 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
28975 @code{-list-target-features} command.
28976
28977 @table @code
28978 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
28979 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
28980 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
28981
28982 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
28983 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
28984 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
28985
28986 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
28987 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
28988 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
28989 MI commands even while the target is running.
28990
28991 @item -gdb-show mi-async
28992 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
28993 @end table
28994
28995 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
28996 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
28997 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
28998 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
28999 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
29000 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
29001
29002 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
29003 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
29004 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
29005 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
29006 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
29007 are running.
29008
29009 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
29010 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
29011 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
29012 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
29013 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
29014 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
29015 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
29016 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
29017 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
29018 @samp{--thread} option).
29019
29020 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
29021 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
29022 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
29023 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
29024
29025 @node Thread groups
29026 @subsection Thread groups
29027 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
29028 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
29029 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
29030 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
29031 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
29032
29033 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
29034 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
29035 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
29036 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
29037 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
29038 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
29039 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
29040 into processes.
29041
29042 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
29043 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
29044 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
29045 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
29046 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
29047 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
29048 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
29049 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
29050 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
29051 the members of specific thread group.
29052
29053 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
29054 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
29055 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
29056 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
29057 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
29058 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
29059 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
29060 after attaching to that thread group.
29061
29062 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors Connections and
29063 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
29064 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
29065 such thread groups.
29066
29067 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29068 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
29069 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
29070
29071 @menu
29072 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
29073 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
29074 @end menu
29075
29076 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
29077 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
29078
29079 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
29080 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
29081 @table @code
29082 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
29083 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
29084
29085 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
29086 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
29087 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
29088
29089 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
29090 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
29091 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
29092
29093 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
29094 "any sequence of digits"
29095
29096 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
29097 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
29098
29099 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
29100 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
29101
29102 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
29103 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
29104
29105 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
29106 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
29107 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
29108
29109 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
29110 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
29111
29112 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
29113 @code{CR | CR-LF}
29114 @end table
29115
29116 @noindent
29117 Notes:
29118
29119 @itemize @bullet
29120 @item
29121 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
29122 output is described below.
29123
29124 @item
29125 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
29126 finishes.
29127
29128 @item
29129 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
29130 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
29131 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
29132 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
29133 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
29134 @end itemize
29135
29136 Pragmatics:
29137
29138 @itemize @bullet
29139 @item
29140 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
29141
29142 @item
29143 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
29144 @end itemize
29145
29146 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
29147 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
29148
29149 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
29150 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
29151 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
29152 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
29153 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
29154 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
29155
29156 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
29157 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
29158 @var{token}.
29159
29160 @table @code
29161 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
29162 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
29163
29164 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
29165 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
29166
29167 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
29168 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
29169
29170 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
29171 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
29172
29173 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
29174 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
29175
29176 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
29177 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
29178
29179 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
29180 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
29181
29182 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
29183 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
29184
29185 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
29186 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
29187
29188 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
29189 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
29190 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
29191
29192 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
29193 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
29194
29195 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
29196 @code{ @var{string} }
29197
29198 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
29199 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
29200
29201 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
29202 @code{@var{c-string}}
29203
29204 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
29205 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
29206
29207 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
29208 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
29209 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
29210
29211 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
29212 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
29213
29214 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
29215 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
29216
29217 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
29218 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
29219
29220 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
29221 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
29222
29223 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
29224 @code{CR | CR-LF}
29225
29226 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
29227 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
29228 @end table
29229
29230 @noindent
29231 Notes:
29232
29233 @itemize @bullet
29234 @item
29235 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
29236
29237 @item
29238 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
29239 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
29240 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
29241 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
29242 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
29243 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
29244 prior command.
29245
29246 @item
29247 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29248 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
29249 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
29250 prefixed by @samp{+}.
29251
29252 @item
29253 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29254 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
29255 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
29256 @samp{*}.
29257
29258 @item
29259 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29260 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
29261 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
29262 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
29263
29264 @item
29265 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29266 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
29267 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
29268 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
29269
29270 @item
29271 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29272 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
29273 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
29274
29275 @item
29276 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29277 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
29278 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
29279 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
29280
29281 @item
29282 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29283 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
29284 @var{values}.
29285
29286
29287 @end itemize
29288
29289 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
29290 details about the various output records.
29291
29292 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29293 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
29294 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
29295
29296 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
29297 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
29298
29299 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
29300 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
29301 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
29302 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
29303 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
29304 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
29305
29306 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
29307 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
29308 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
29309
29310 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29311 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
29312 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
29313 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
29314
29315 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
29316 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
29317
29318 Since @sc{gdb/mi} is used by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}, changes
29319 to the MI interface may break existing usage. This section describes how the
29320 protocol changes and how to request previous version of the protocol when it
29321 does.
29322
29323 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
29324 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
29325 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
29326 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
29327
29328 @itemize @bullet
29329 @item
29330 New MI commands may be added.
29331
29332 @item
29333 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
29334
29335 @item
29336 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
29337 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
29338
29339 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
29340 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
29341
29342 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
29343 @c resolve inconsistencies.
29344 @end itemize
29345
29346 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
29347 will be increased by one. The new versions of the MI protocol are not compatible
29348 with the old versions. Old versions of MI remain available, allowing front ends
29349 to keep using them until they are modified to use the latest MI version.
29350
29351 Since @code{--interpreter=mi} always points to the latest MI version, it is
29352 recommended that front ends request a specific version of MI when launching
29353 @value{GDBN} (e.g. @code{--interpreter=mi2}) to make sure they get an
29354 interpreter with the MI version they expect.
29355
29356 The following table gives a summary of the released versions of the MI
29357 interface: the version number, the version of GDB in which it first appeared
29358 and the breaking changes compared to the previous version.
29359
29360 @multitable @columnfractions .05 .05 .9
29361 @headitem MI version @tab GDB version @tab Breaking changes
29362
29363 @item
29364 @center 1
29365 @tab
29366 @center 5.1
29367 @tab
29368 None
29369
29370 @item
29371 @center 2
29372 @tab
29373 @center 6.0
29374 @tab
29375
29376 @itemize
29377 @item
29378 The @code{-environment-pwd}, @code{-environment-directory} and
29379 @code{-environment-path} commands now returns values using the MI output
29380 syntax, rather than CLI output syntax.
29381
29382 @item
29383 @code{-var-list-children}'s @code{children} result field is now a list, rather
29384 than a tuple.
29385
29386 @item
29387 @code{-var-update}'s @code{changelist} result field is now a list, rather than
29388 a tuple.
29389 @end itemize
29390
29391 @item
29392 @center 3
29393 @tab
29394 @center 9.1
29395 @tab
29396
29397 @itemize
29398 @item
29399 The output of information about multi-location breakpoints has changed in the
29400 responses to the @code{-break-insert} and @code{-break-info} commands, as well
29401 as in the @code{=breakpoint-created} and @code{=breakpoint-modified} events.
29402 The multiple locations are now placed in a @code{locations} field, whose value
29403 is a list.
29404 @end itemize
29405
29406 @end multitable
29407
29408 If your front end cannot yet migrate to a more recent version of the
29409 MI protocol, you can nevertheless selectively enable specific features
29410 available in those recent MI versions, using the following commands:
29411
29412 @table @code
29413
29414 @item -fix-multi-location-breakpoint-output
29415 Use the output for multi-location breakpoints which was introduced by
29416 MI 3, even when using MI versions 2 or 1. This command has no
29417 effect when using MI version 3 or later.
29418
29419 @end table
29420
29421 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
29422 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
29423 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
29424 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
29425 @cindex mailing lists
29426
29427 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29428 @node GDB/MI Output Records
29429 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
29430
29431 @menu
29432 * GDB/MI Result Records::
29433 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
29434 * GDB/MI Async Records::
29435 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
29436 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
29437 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
29438 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
29439 @end menu
29440
29441 @node GDB/MI Result Records
29442 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
29443
29444 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
29445 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
29446 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
29447 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
29448
29449 @table @code
29450 @findex ^done
29451 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
29452 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
29453 values.
29454
29455 @item "^running"
29456 @findex ^running
29457 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
29458 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
29459 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
29460 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
29461 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
29462 which threads are resumed.
29463
29464 @item "^connected"
29465 @findex ^connected
29466 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
29467
29468 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
29469 @findex ^error
29470 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
29471 the corresponding error message.
29472
29473 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
29474 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
29475 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
29476
29477 @table @samp
29478 @item "undefined-command"
29479 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
29480 @end table
29481
29482 @item "^exit"
29483 @findex ^exit
29484 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
29485
29486 @end table
29487
29488 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
29489 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
29490
29491 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
29492 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
29493 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
29494 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
29495 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
29496
29497 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
29498 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
29499 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
29500 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
29501 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
29502
29503 @table @code
29504 @item "~" @var{string-output}
29505 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
29506 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
29507
29508 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
29509 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
29510 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
29511 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
29512
29513 @item "&" @var{string-output}
29514 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
29515 internals.
29516 @end table
29517
29518 @node GDB/MI Async Records
29519 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
29520
29521 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
29522 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
29523 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
29524 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
29525 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
29526 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
29527
29528 The following is the list of possible async records:
29529
29530 @table @code
29531
29532 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
29533 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
29534 thread ID of the thread that is now running, and it can be
29535 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
29536 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
29537 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
29538 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
29539 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
29540 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
29541 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
29542 it run freely.
29543
29544 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
29545 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
29546 following values:
29547
29548 @table @code
29549 @item breakpoint-hit
29550 A breakpoint was reached.
29551 @item watchpoint-trigger
29552 A watchpoint was triggered.
29553 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
29554 A read watchpoint was triggered.
29555 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
29556 An access watchpoint was triggered.
29557 @item function-finished
29558 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
29559 @item location-reached
29560 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
29561 @item watchpoint-scope
29562 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
29563 @item end-stepping-range
29564 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
29565 similar CLI command was accomplished.
29566 @item exited-signalled
29567 The inferior exited because of a signal.
29568 @item exited
29569 The inferior exited.
29570 @item exited-normally
29571 The inferior exited normally.
29572 @item signal-received
29573 A signal was received by the inferior.
29574 @item solib-event
29575 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
29576 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
29577 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
29578 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
29579 @item fork
29580 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
29581 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29582 @item vfork
29583 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
29584 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29585 @item syscall-entry
29586 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
29587 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29588 @item syscall-return
29589 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
29590 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29591 @item exec
29592 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
29593 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29594 @end table
29595
29596 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
29597 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
29598 Depending on whether all-stop
29599 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
29600 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
29601 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
29602 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
29603 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
29604 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
29605 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
29606 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
29607 if such information is not available.
29608
29609 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
29610 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
29611 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
29612 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
29613 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
29614 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
29615 cannot be used in any way.
29616
29617 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
29618 A thread group became associated with a running program,
29619 either because the program was just started or the thread group
29620 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
29621 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
29622 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
29623
29624 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
29625 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
29626 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
29627 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
29628 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
29629 only when the inferior exited with some code.
29630
29631 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
29632 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
29633 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
29634 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
29635 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
29636
29637 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
29638 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
29639 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
29640 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
29641 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
29642 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
29643 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
29644 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
29645 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
29646
29647 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
29648 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
29649
29650 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
29651 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
29652 that thread.
29653
29654 @item =library-loaded,...
29655 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
29656 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
29657 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
29658 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
29659 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
29660 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
29661 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
29662 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
29663 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
29664 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
29665 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
29666 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
29667 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
29668 to this library.
29669
29670 @item =library-unloaded,...
29671 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
29672 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
29673 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
29674 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
29675 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
29676 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
29677 thread groups.
29678
29679 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
29680 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
29681 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
29682 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
29683 frame is @var{tpnum}.
29684
29685 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
29686 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
29687 initial value @var{initial}.
29688
29689 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
29690 @itemx =tsv-deleted
29691 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
29692 trace state variables are deleted.
29693
29694 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
29695 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
29696 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
29697 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
29698 value of trace state variable is known.
29699
29700 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
29701 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
29702 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
29703 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
29704 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
29705 user.
29706
29707 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
29708 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
29709 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
29710
29711 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
29712 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
29713
29714 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
29715 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
29716 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
29717 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
29718 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
29719
29720 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
29721 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
29722 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
29723 for existing method and format values.
29724
29725 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
29726 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
29727 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
29728 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
29729 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
29730 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
29731
29732 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
29733 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
29734 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
29735 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
29736 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
29737 executable code.
29738 @end table
29739
29740 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
29741 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
29742
29743 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
29744 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
29745 following fields:
29746
29747 @table @code
29748 @item number
29749 The breakpoint number.
29750
29751 @item type
29752 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
29753 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
29754
29755 @item catch-type
29756 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
29757 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
29758
29759 @item disp
29760 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
29761 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
29762 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
29763
29764 @item enabled
29765 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
29766 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
29767 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
29768
29769 @item addr
29770 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
29771 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
29772 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
29773 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
29774 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
29775
29776 @item addr_flags
29777 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
29778 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
29779 particular CPU.
29780
29781 @item func
29782 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
29783 If not known, this field is not present.
29784
29785 @item filename
29786 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
29787 If not known, this field is not present.
29788
29789 @item fullname
29790 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
29791 known. If not known, this field is not present.
29792
29793 @item line
29794 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
29795 If not known, this field is not present.
29796
29797 @item at
29798 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
29799 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
29800 by a symbol name.
29801
29802 @item pending
29803 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
29804 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
29805
29806 @item evaluated-by
29807 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
29808 @samp{target}.
29809
29810 @item thread
29811 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
29812 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
29813
29814 @item task
29815 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
29816 field will hold the task identifier.
29817
29818 @item cond
29819 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
29820
29821 @item ignore
29822 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
29823
29824 @item enable
29825 The enable count of the breakpoint.
29826
29827 @item traceframe-usage
29828 FIXME.
29829
29830 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
29831 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
29832
29833 @item mask
29834 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
29835
29836 @item pass
29837 A tracepoint's pass count.
29838
29839 @item original-location
29840 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
29841 This field is optional.
29842
29843 @item times
29844 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
29845
29846 @item installed
29847 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
29848 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
29849 is not.
29850
29851 @item what
29852 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
29853
29854 @item locations
29855 This field is present if the breakpoint has multiple locations. It is also
29856 exceptionally present if the breakpoint is enabled and has a single, disabled
29857 location.
29858
29859 The value is a list of locations. The format of a location is described below.
29860
29861 @end table
29862
29863 A location in a multi-location breakpoint is represented as a tuple with the
29864 following fields:
29865
29866 @table @code
29867
29868 @item number
29869 The location number as a dotted pair, like @samp{1.2}. The first digit is the
29870 number of the parent breakpoint. The second digit is the number of the
29871 location within that breakpoint.
29872
29873 @item enabled
29874 This indicates whether the location is enabled, in which case the
29875 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
29876 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
29877
29878 @item addr
29879 The address of this location as an hexidecimal number.
29880
29881 @item addr_flags
29882 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
29883 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
29884 particular CPU.
29885
29886 @item func
29887 If known, the function in which the location appears.
29888 If not known, this field is not present.
29889
29890 @item file
29891 The name of the source file which contains this location, if known.
29892 If not known, this field is not present.
29893
29894 @item fullname
29895 The full file name of the source file which contains this location, if
29896 known. If not known, this field is not present.
29897
29898 @item line
29899 The line number at which this location appears, if known.
29900 If not known, this field is not present.
29901
29902 @item thread-groups
29903 The thread groups this location is in.
29904
29905 @end table
29906
29907 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
29908 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
29909
29910 @smallexample
29911 -> -break-insert main
29912 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29913 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29914 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
29915 times="0"@}
29916 <- (gdb)
29917 @end smallexample
29918
29919 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
29920 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
29921
29922 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
29923 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
29924 fields:
29925
29926 @table @code
29927 @item level
29928 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
29929 zero. This field is always present.
29930
29931 @item func
29932 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
29933 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
29934
29935 @item addr
29936 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
29937
29938 @item addr_flags
29939 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
29940 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
29941 particular CPU.
29942
29943 @item file
29944 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
29945 address. This field may be absent.
29946
29947 @item line
29948 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
29949 may be absent.
29950
29951 @item from
29952 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
29953 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
29954
29955 @end table
29956
29957 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
29958 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
29959
29960 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
29961 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
29962 stated otherwise.
29963
29964 @table @code
29965 @item id
29966 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
29967
29968 @item target-id
29969 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
29970
29971 @item details
29972 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
29973 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
29974 frontend. This field is optional.
29975
29976 @item name
29977 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
29978 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
29979 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
29980 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
29981 field is omitted.
29982
29983 @item state
29984 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
29985 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
29986
29987 @item frame
29988 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
29989 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
29990 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
29991
29992 @item core
29993 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
29994 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
29995 @end table
29996
29997 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
29998 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
29999
30000 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
30001 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
30002 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
30003 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
30004 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
30005 the @code{exception-message} field.
30006
30007 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30008 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
30009 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
30010 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
30011
30012 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
30013 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
30014 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
30015 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
30016
30017 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
30018 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
30019
30020 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
30021
30022 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
30023 information of the breakpoint.
30024
30025 @smallexample
30026 -> -break-insert main
30027 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30028 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
30029 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
30030 times="0"@}
30031 <- (gdb)
30032 @end smallexample
30033
30034 @subheading Program Execution
30035
30036 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
30037 reason that execution stopped.
30038
30039 @smallexample
30040 -> -exec-run
30041 <- ^running
30042 <- (gdb)
30043 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
30044 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
30045 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
30046 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
30047 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30048 <- (gdb)
30049 -> -exec-continue
30050 <- ^running
30051 <- (gdb)
30052 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
30053 <- (gdb)
30054 @end smallexample
30055
30056 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
30057
30058 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
30059
30060 @smallexample
30061 -> (gdb)
30062 <- -gdb-exit
30063 <- ^exit
30064 @end smallexample
30065
30066 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
30067 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
30068 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
30069 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
30070 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
30071 fails to exit in reasonable time.
30072
30073 @subheading A Bad Command
30074
30075 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
30076
30077 @smallexample
30078 -> -rubbish
30079 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
30080 <- (gdb)
30081 @end smallexample
30082
30083
30084 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30085 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
30086 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
30087
30088 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
30089 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
30090
30091 @subheading Motivation
30092
30093 The motivation for this collection of commands.
30094
30095 @subheading Introduction
30096
30097 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
30098
30099 @subheading Commands
30100
30101 For each command in the block, the following is described:
30102
30103 @subsubheading Synopsis
30104
30105 @smallexample
30106 -command @var{args}@dots{}
30107 @end smallexample
30108
30109 @subsubheading Result
30110
30111 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30112
30113 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
30114
30115 @subsubheading Example
30116
30117 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
30118 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
30119
30120
30121 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30122 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
30123 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
30124
30125 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
30126 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
30127 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
30128 breakpoints.
30129
30130 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
30131 @findex -break-after
30132
30133 @subsubheading Synopsis
30134
30135 @smallexample
30136 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
30137 @end smallexample
30138
30139 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
30140 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
30141 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
30142 @samp{-break-list} command below.
30143
30144 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30145
30146 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
30147
30148 @subsubheading Example
30149
30150 @smallexample
30151 (gdb)
30152 -break-insert main
30153 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30154 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
30155 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
30156 times="0"@}
30157 (gdb)
30158 -break-after 1 3
30159 ~
30160 ^done
30161 (gdb)
30162 -break-list
30163 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30164 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30165 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30166 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30167 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30168 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30169 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30170 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30171 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
30172 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
30173 (gdb)
30174 @end smallexample
30175
30176 @ignore
30177 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
30178 @findex -break-catch
30179 @end ignore
30180
30181 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
30182 @findex -break-commands
30183
30184 @subsubheading Synopsis
30185
30186 @smallexample
30187 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
30188 @end smallexample
30189
30190 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
30191 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
30192 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
30193 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
30194 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
30195 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
30196
30197 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30198
30199 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
30200
30201 @subsubheading Example
30202
30203 @smallexample
30204 (gdb)
30205 -break-insert main
30206 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30207 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
30208 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
30209 times="0"@}
30210 (gdb)
30211 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
30212 ^done
30213 (gdb)
30214 @end smallexample
30215
30216 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
30217 @findex -break-condition
30218
30219 @subsubheading Synopsis
30220
30221 @smallexample
30222 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
30223 @end smallexample
30224
30225 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
30226 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
30227 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
30228 command below).
30229
30230 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30231
30232 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
30233
30234 @subsubheading Example
30235
30236 @smallexample
30237 (gdb)
30238 -break-condition 1 1
30239 ^done
30240 (gdb)
30241 -break-list
30242 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30243 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30244 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30245 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30246 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30247 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30248 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30249 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30250 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
30251 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
30252 (gdb)
30253 @end smallexample
30254
30255 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
30256 @findex -break-delete
30257
30258 @subsubheading Synopsis
30259
30260 @smallexample
30261 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
30262 @end smallexample
30263
30264 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
30265 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
30266
30267 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30268
30269 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
30270
30271 @subsubheading Example
30272
30273 @smallexample
30274 (gdb)
30275 -break-delete 1
30276 ^done
30277 (gdb)
30278 -break-list
30279 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
30280 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30281 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30282 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30283 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30284 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30285 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30286 body=[]@}
30287 (gdb)
30288 @end smallexample
30289
30290 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
30291 @findex -break-disable
30292
30293 @subsubheading Synopsis
30294
30295 @smallexample
30296 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
30297 @end smallexample
30298
30299 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
30300 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
30301
30302 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30303
30304 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
30305
30306 @subsubheading Example
30307
30308 @smallexample
30309 (gdb)
30310 -break-disable 2
30311 ^done
30312 (gdb)
30313 -break-list
30314 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30315 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30316 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30317 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30318 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30319 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30320 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30321 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
30322 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
30323 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
30324 (gdb)
30325 @end smallexample
30326
30327 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
30328 @findex -break-enable
30329
30330 @subsubheading Synopsis
30331
30332 @smallexample
30333 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
30334 @end smallexample
30335
30336 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
30337
30338 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30339
30340 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
30341
30342 @subsubheading Example
30343
30344 @smallexample
30345 (gdb)
30346 -break-enable 2
30347 ^done
30348 (gdb)
30349 -break-list
30350 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30351 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30352 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30353 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30354 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30355 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30356 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30357 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30358 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
30359 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
30360 (gdb)
30361 @end smallexample
30362
30363 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
30364 @findex -break-info
30365
30366 @subsubheading Synopsis
30367
30368 @smallexample
30369 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
30370 @end smallexample
30371
30372 @c REDUNDANT???
30373 Get information about a single breakpoint.
30374
30375 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
30376 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
30377 table.
30378
30379 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30380
30381 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
30382
30383 @subsubheading Example
30384 N.A.
30385
30386 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
30387 @findex -break-insert
30388 @anchor{-break-insert}
30389
30390 @subsubheading Synopsis
30391
30392 @smallexample
30393 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ] [ --qualified ]
30394 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
30395 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
30396 @end smallexample
30397
30398 @noindent
30399 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
30400
30401 @table @var
30402 @item linespec location
30403 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
30404
30405 @item explicit location
30406 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
30407 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
30408 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
30409
30410 @table @samp
30411 @item --source @var{filename}
30412 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
30413 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
30414
30415 @item --function @var{function}
30416 The name of a function or method.
30417
30418 @item --label @var{label}
30419 The name of a label.
30420
30421 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
30422 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
30423 @end table
30424
30425 @item address location
30426 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
30427 @end table
30428
30429 @noindent
30430 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
30431
30432 @table @samp
30433 @item -t
30434 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
30435 @item -h
30436 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
30437 @item -f
30438 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
30439 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
30440 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
30441 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
30442 cannot be parsed.
30443 @item -d
30444 Create a disabled breakpoint.
30445 @item -a
30446 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
30447 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
30448 @item -c @var{condition}
30449 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30450 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
30451 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
30452 @item -p @var{thread-id}
30453 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
30454 @var{thread-id}.
30455 @item --qualified
30456 This option makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified as
30457 a complete fully-qualified name.
30458 @end table
30459
30460 @subsubheading Result
30461
30462 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
30463 resulting breakpoint.
30464
30465 Note: this format is open to change.
30466 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
30467
30468 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30469
30470 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
30471 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
30472
30473 @subsubheading Example
30474
30475 @smallexample
30476 (gdb)
30477 -break-insert main
30478 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
30479 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
30480 times="0"@}
30481 (gdb)
30482 -break-insert -t foo
30483 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
30484 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
30485 times="0"@}
30486 (gdb)
30487 -break-list
30488 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
30489 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30490 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30491 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30492 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30493 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30494 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30495 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30496 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
30497 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
30498 times="0"@},
30499 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
30500 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
30501 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
30502 times="0"@}]@}
30503 (gdb)
30504 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
30505 @c ~int foo(int, int);
30506 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
30507 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
30508 @c times="0"@}
30509 @c (gdb)
30510 @end smallexample
30511
30512 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
30513 @findex -dprintf-insert
30514
30515 @subsubheading Synopsis
30516
30517 @smallexample
30518 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ --qualified ]
30519 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
30520 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
30521 [ @var{argument} ]
30522 @end smallexample
30523
30524 @noindent
30525 If supplied, @var{location} and @code{--qualified} may be specified
30526 the same way as for the @code{-break-insert} command.
30527 @xref{-break-insert}.
30528
30529 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
30530
30531 @table @samp
30532 @item -t
30533 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
30534 @item -f
30535 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
30536 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
30537 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
30538 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
30539 cannot be parsed.
30540 @item -d
30541 Create a disabled breakpoint.
30542 @item -c @var{condition}
30543 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30544 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
30545 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
30546 to @var{ignore-count}.
30547 @item -p @var{thread-id}
30548 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
30549 @var{thread-id}.
30550 @end table
30551
30552 @subsubheading Result
30553
30554 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
30555 resulting breakpoint.
30556
30557 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
30558
30559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30560
30561 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
30562
30563 @subsubheading Example
30564
30565 @smallexample
30566 (gdb)
30567 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
30568 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30569 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
30570 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
30571 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
30572 original-location="foo"@}
30573 (gdb)
30574 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
30575 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30576 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
30577 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
30578 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
30579 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
30580 (gdb)
30581 @end smallexample
30582
30583 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
30584 @findex -break-list
30585
30586 @subsubheading Synopsis
30587
30588 @smallexample
30589 -break-list
30590 @end smallexample
30591
30592 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
30593
30594 @table @samp
30595 @item Number
30596 number of the breakpoint
30597 @item Type
30598 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
30599 @item Disposition
30600 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
30601 or @samp{nokeep}
30602 @item Enabled
30603 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
30604 @item Address
30605 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
30606 @item What
30607 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
30608 name, line number
30609 @item Thread-groups
30610 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
30611 @item Times
30612 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
30613 @end table
30614
30615 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
30616 @code{body} field is an empty list.
30617
30618 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30619
30620 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
30621
30622 @subsubheading Example
30623
30624 @smallexample
30625 (gdb)
30626 -break-list
30627 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
30628 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30629 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30630 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30631 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30632 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30633 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30634 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30635 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
30636 times="0"@},
30637 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30638 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
30639 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
30640 (gdb)
30641 @end smallexample
30642
30643 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
30644
30645 @smallexample
30646 (gdb)
30647 -break-list
30648 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
30649 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30650 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30651 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30652 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30653 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30654 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30655 body=[]@}
30656 (gdb)
30657 @end smallexample
30658
30659 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
30660 @findex -break-passcount
30661
30662 @subsubheading Synopsis
30663
30664 @smallexample
30665 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
30666 @end smallexample
30667
30668 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
30669 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
30670 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
30671 command @samp{passcount}.
30672
30673 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
30674 @findex -break-watch
30675
30676 @subsubheading Synopsis
30677
30678 @smallexample
30679 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
30680 @end smallexample
30681
30682 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
30683 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
30684 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
30685 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
30686 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
30687 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
30688 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
30689 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
30690
30691 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
30692 breakpoints inserted.
30693
30694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30695
30696 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
30697 @samp{rwatch}.
30698
30699 @subsubheading Example
30700
30701 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
30702
30703 @smallexample
30704 (gdb)
30705 -break-watch x
30706 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
30707 (gdb)
30708 -exec-continue
30709 ^running
30710 (gdb)
30711 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
30712 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
30713 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
30714 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30715 (gdb)
30716 @end smallexample
30717
30718 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
30719 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
30720 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
30721
30722 @smallexample
30723 (gdb)
30724 -break-watch C
30725 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
30726 (gdb)
30727 -exec-continue
30728 ^running
30729 (gdb)
30730 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
30731 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
30732 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30733 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30734 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
30735 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30736 (gdb)
30737 -exec-continue
30738 ^running
30739 (gdb)
30740 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
30741 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
30742 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30743 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30744 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
30745 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30746 (gdb)
30747 @end smallexample
30748
30749 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
30750 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
30751 deleted.
30752
30753 @smallexample
30754 (gdb)
30755 -break-watch C
30756 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
30757 (gdb)
30758 -break-list
30759 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
30760 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30761 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30762 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30763 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30764 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30765 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30766 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30767 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30768 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30769 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
30770 times="1"@},
30771 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
30772 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
30773 (gdb)
30774 -exec-continue
30775 ^running
30776 (gdb)
30777 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
30778 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
30779 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30780 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30781 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
30782 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30783 (gdb)
30784 -break-list
30785 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
30786 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30787 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30788 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30789 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30790 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30791 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30792 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30793 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30794 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30795 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
30796 times="1"@},
30797 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
30798 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
30799 (gdb)
30800 -exec-continue
30801 ^running
30802 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
30803 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
30804 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30805 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30806 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
30807 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30808 (gdb)
30809 -break-list
30810 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30811 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30812 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30813 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30814 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30815 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30816 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30817 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30818 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30819 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30820 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30821 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
30822 (gdb)
30823 @end smallexample
30824
30825
30826 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30827 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30828 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
30829
30830 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
30831 catchpoints.
30832
30833 @menu
30834 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30835 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30836 * C++ Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30837 @end menu
30838
30839 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30840 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30841
30842 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
30843 @findex -catch-load
30844
30845 @subsubheading Synopsis
30846
30847 @smallexample
30848 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30849 @end smallexample
30850
30851 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
30852 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30853 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
30854 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30855 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
30856
30857
30858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30859
30860 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
30861
30862 @subsubheading Example
30863
30864 @smallexample
30865 -catch-load -t foo.so
30866 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
30867 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
30868 (gdb)
30869 @end smallexample
30870
30871
30872 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
30873 @findex -catch-unload
30874
30875 @subsubheading Synopsis
30876
30877 @smallexample
30878 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30879 @end smallexample
30880
30881 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
30882 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30883 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
30884 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30885 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
30886
30887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30888
30889 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
30890
30891 @subsubheading Example
30892
30893 @smallexample
30894 -catch-unload -d bar.so
30895 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
30896 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
30897 (gdb)
30898 @end smallexample
30899
30900 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30901 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30902
30903 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
30904 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
30905
30906 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
30907 @findex -catch-assert
30908
30909 @subsubheading Synopsis
30910
30911 @smallexample
30912 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
30913 @end smallexample
30914
30915 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
30916
30917 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30918
30919 @table @samp
30920 @item -c @var{condition}
30921 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30922 @item -d
30923 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30924 @item -t
30925 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30926 @end table
30927
30928 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30929
30930 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
30931
30932 @subsubheading Example
30933
30934 @smallexample
30935 -catch-assert
30936 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30937 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
30938 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
30939 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
30940 (gdb)
30941 @end smallexample
30942
30943 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
30944 @findex -catch-exception
30945
30946 @subsubheading Synopsis
30947
30948 @smallexample
30949 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
30950 [ -t ] [ -u ]
30951 @end smallexample
30952
30953 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
30954 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
30955 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
30956 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
30957 catchpoints.
30958
30959 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30960
30961 @table @samp
30962 @item -c @var{condition}
30963 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30964 @item -d
30965 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30966 @item -e @var{exception-name}
30967 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
30968 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
30969 @item -t
30970 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30971 @item -u
30972 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
30973 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
30974 @end table
30975
30976 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30977
30978 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
30979 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
30980
30981 @subsubheading Example
30982
30983 @smallexample
30984 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
30985 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30986 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
30987 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
30988 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
30989 (gdb)
30990 @end smallexample
30991
30992 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
30993 @findex -catch-handlers
30994
30995 @subsubheading Synopsis
30996
30997 @smallexample
30998 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
30999 [ -t ]
31000 @end smallexample
31001
31002 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
31003 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
31004 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
31005 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
31006 catchpoints.
31007
31008 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
31009
31010 @table @samp
31011 @item -c @var{condition}
31012 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
31013 @item -d
31014 Create a disabled catchpoint.
31015 @item -e @var{exception-name}
31016 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
31017 @item -t
31018 Create a temporary catchpoint.
31019 @end table
31020
31021 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31022
31023 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
31024
31025 @subsubheading Example
31026
31027 @smallexample
31028 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
31029 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
31030 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
31031 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
31032 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
31033 (gdb)
31034 @end smallexample
31035
31036 @node C++ Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
31037 @subsection C@t{++} Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
31038
31039 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
31040 that stop the execution when C@t{++} exceptions are being throw, rethrown,
31041 or caught.
31042
31043 @subheading The @code{-catch-throw} Command
31044 @findex -catch-throw
31045
31046 @subsubheading Synopsis
31047
31048 @smallexample
31049 -catch-throw [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
31050 @end smallexample
31051
31052 Stop when the debuggee throws a C@t{++} exception. If @var{regexp} is
31053 given, then only exceptions whose type matches the regular expression
31054 will be caught.
31055
31056 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
31057 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after stopping once for
31058 the event.
31059
31060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31061
31062 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch throw}
31063 and @samp{tcatch throw} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
31064
31065 @subsubheading Example
31066
31067 @smallexample
31068 -catch-throw -r exception_type
31069 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31070 what="exception throw",catch-type="throw",
31071 thread-groups=["i1"],
31072 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
31073 (gdb)
31074 -exec-run
31075 ^running
31076 (gdb)
31077 ~"\n"
31078 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception thrown), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
31079 in __cxa_throw () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
31080 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
31081 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_throw",
31082 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
31083 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
31084 (gdb)
31085 @end smallexample
31086
31087 @subheading The @code{-catch-rethrow} Command
31088 @findex -catch-rethrow
31089
31090 @subsubheading Synopsis
31091
31092 @smallexample
31093 -catch-rethrow [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
31094 @end smallexample
31095
31096 Stop when a C@t{++} exception is re-thrown. If @var{regexp} is given,
31097 then only exceptions whose type matches the regular expression will be
31098 caught.
31099
31100 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
31101 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after the first event is
31102 caught.
31103
31104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31105
31106 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch rethrow}
31107 and @samp{tcatch rethrow} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
31108
31109 @subsubheading Example
31110
31111 @smallexample
31112 -catch-rethrow -r exception_type
31113 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31114 what="exception rethrow",catch-type="rethrow",
31115 thread-groups=["i1"],
31116 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
31117 (gdb)
31118 -exec-run
31119 ^running
31120 (gdb)
31121 ~"\n"
31122 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception rethrown), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
31123 in __cxa_rethrow () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
31124 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
31125 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_rethrow",
31126 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
31127 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
31128 (gdb)
31129 @end smallexample
31130
31131 @subheading The @code{-catch-catch} Command
31132 @findex -catch-catch
31133
31134 @subsubheading Synopsis
31135
31136 @smallexample
31137 -catch-catch [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
31138 @end smallexample
31139
31140 Stop when the debuggee catches a C@t{++} exception. If @var{regexp}
31141 is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the regular
31142 expression will be caught.
31143
31144 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
31145 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after the first event is
31146 caught.
31147
31148 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31149
31150 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch catch}
31151 and @samp{tcatch catch} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
31152
31153 @subsubheading Example
31154
31155 @smallexample
31156 -catch-catch -r exception_type
31157 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31158 what="exception catch",catch-type="catch",
31159 thread-groups=["i1"],
31160 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
31161 (gdb)
31162 -exec-run
31163 ^running
31164 (gdb)
31165 ~"\n"
31166 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception caught), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
31167 in __cxa_begin_catch () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
31168 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
31169 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_begin_catch",
31170 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
31171 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
31172 (gdb)
31173 @end smallexample
31174
31175 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31176 @node GDB/MI Program Context
31177 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
31178
31179 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
31180 @findex -exec-arguments
31181
31182
31183 @subsubheading Synopsis
31184
31185 @smallexample
31186 -exec-arguments @var{args}
31187 @end smallexample
31188
31189 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
31190 @samp{-exec-run}.
31191
31192 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31193
31194 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
31195
31196 @subsubheading Example
31197
31198 @smallexample
31199 (gdb)
31200 -exec-arguments -v word
31201 ^done
31202 (gdb)
31203 @end smallexample
31204
31205
31206 @ignore
31207 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
31208 @findex -exec-show-arguments
31209
31210 @subsubheading Synopsis
31211
31212 @smallexample
31213 -exec-show-arguments
31214 @end smallexample
31215
31216 Print the arguments of the program.
31217
31218 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31219
31220 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
31221
31222 @subsubheading Example
31223 N.A.
31224 @end ignore
31225
31226
31227 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
31228 @findex -environment-cd
31229
31230 @subsubheading Synopsis
31231
31232 @smallexample
31233 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
31234 @end smallexample
31235
31236 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
31237
31238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31239
31240 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
31241
31242 @subsubheading Example
31243
31244 @smallexample
31245 (gdb)
31246 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
31247 ^done
31248 (gdb)
31249 @end smallexample
31250
31251
31252 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
31253 @findex -environment-directory
31254
31255 @subsubheading Synopsis
31256
31257 @smallexample
31258 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
31259 @end smallexample
31260
31261 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
31262 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
31263 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
31264 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
31265 occurs as normal.
31266 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
31267 multiple directories in a single command
31268 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
31269 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
31270 If blanks are needed as
31271 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
31272 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
31273 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
31274 character must not be used
31275 in any directory name.
31276 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
31277
31278 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31279
31280 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
31281
31282 @subsubheading Example
31283
31284 @smallexample
31285 (gdb)
31286 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
31287 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
31288 (gdb)
31289 -environment-directory ""
31290 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
31291 (gdb)
31292 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
31293 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
31294 (gdb)
31295 -environment-directory -r
31296 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
31297 (gdb)
31298 @end smallexample
31299
31300
31301 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
31302 @findex -environment-path
31303
31304 @subsubheading Synopsis
31305
31306 @smallexample
31307 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
31308 @end smallexample
31309
31310 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
31311 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
31312 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
31313 supplied in addition to the
31314 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
31315 occurs as normal.
31316 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
31317 multiple directories in a single command
31318 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
31319 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
31320 If blanks are needed as
31321 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
31322 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
31323 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
31324 character must not be used
31325 in any directory name.
31326 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
31327
31328
31329 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31330
31331 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
31332
31333 @subsubheading Example
31334
31335 @smallexample
31336 (gdb)
31337 -environment-path
31338 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
31339 (gdb)
31340 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
31341 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
31342 (gdb)
31343 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
31344 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
31345 (gdb)
31346 @end smallexample
31347
31348
31349 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
31350 @findex -environment-pwd
31351
31352 @subsubheading Synopsis
31353
31354 @smallexample
31355 -environment-pwd
31356 @end smallexample
31357
31358 Show the current working directory.
31359
31360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31361
31362 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
31363
31364 @subsubheading Example
31365
31366 @smallexample
31367 (gdb)
31368 -environment-pwd
31369 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
31370 (gdb)
31371 @end smallexample
31372
31373 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31374 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
31375 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
31376
31377
31378 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
31379 @findex -thread-info
31380
31381 @subsubheading Synopsis
31382
31383 @smallexample
31384 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
31385 @end smallexample
31386
31387 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
31388 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
31389 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
31390 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
31391 current thread.
31392
31393 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31394
31395 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
31396 about all threads.
31397
31398 @subsubheading Result
31399
31400 The result contains the following attributes:
31401
31402 @table @samp
31403 @item threads
31404 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
31405 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
31406
31407 @item current-thread-id
31408 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
31409 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
31410 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
31411 the command.
31412
31413 @end table
31414
31415 @subsubheading Example
31416
31417 @smallexample
31418 -thread-info
31419 ^done,threads=[
31420 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31421 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
31422 args=[]@},state="running"@},
31423 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31424 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
31425 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31426 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31427 state="running"@}],
31428 current-thread-id="1"
31429 (gdb)
31430 @end smallexample
31431
31432 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
31433 @findex -thread-list-ids
31434
31435 @subsubheading Synopsis
31436
31437 @smallexample
31438 -thread-list-ids
31439 @end smallexample
31440
31441 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
31442 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
31443 threads.
31444
31445 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
31446 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
31447
31448 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31449
31450 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
31451
31452 @subsubheading Example
31453
31454 @smallexample
31455 (gdb)
31456 -thread-list-ids
31457 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
31458 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
31459 (gdb)
31460 @end smallexample
31461
31462
31463 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
31464 @findex -thread-select
31465
31466 @subsubheading Synopsis
31467
31468 @smallexample
31469 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
31470 @end smallexample
31471
31472 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
31473 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
31474 topmost frame for that thread.
31475
31476 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
31477 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
31478
31479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31480
31481 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
31482
31483 @subsubheading Example
31484
31485 @smallexample
31486 (gdb)
31487 -exec-next
31488 ^running
31489 (gdb)
31490 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
31491 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
31492 (gdb)
31493 -thread-list-ids
31494 ^done,
31495 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
31496 number-of-threads="3"
31497 (gdb)
31498 -thread-select 3
31499 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
31500 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
31501 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
31502 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31503 (gdb)
31504 @end smallexample
31505
31506 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31507 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
31508 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
31509
31510 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
31511 @findex -ada-task-info
31512
31513 @subsubheading Synopsis
31514
31515 @smallexample
31516 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
31517 @end smallexample
31518
31519 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
31520 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
31521
31522 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31523
31524 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
31525 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
31526
31527 @subsubheading Result
31528
31529 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
31530 defined for each Ada task:
31531
31532 @table @samp
31533 @item current
31534 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
31535
31536 @item id
31537 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
31538
31539 @item task-id
31540 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
31541
31542 @item thread-id
31543 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
31544 task.
31545
31546 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
31547 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
31548 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
31549
31550 @item parent-id
31551 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
31552 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
31553
31554 @item priority
31555 The base priority of the task.
31556
31557 @item state
31558 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
31559 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
31560
31561 @item name
31562 The name of the task.
31563
31564 @end table
31565
31566 @subsubheading Example
31567
31568 @smallexample
31569 -ada-task-info
31570 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
31571 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
31572 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
31573 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
31574 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
31575 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
31576 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
31577 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
31578 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
31579 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
31580 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
31581 (gdb)
31582 @end smallexample
31583
31584 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31585 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
31586 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
31587
31588 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
31589 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
31590 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
31591 other cases.
31592
31593 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
31594 @findex -exec-continue
31595
31596 @subsubheading Synopsis
31597
31598 @smallexample
31599 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
31600 @end smallexample
31601
31602 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
31603 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
31604 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
31605 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
31606 @itemize @bullet
31607 @item
31608 breakpoints or watchpoints
31609 @item
31610 signals or exceptions
31611 @item
31612 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
31613 @item
31614 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
31615 @end itemize
31616 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
31617 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
31618 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
31619 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
31620 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
31621 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
31622
31623 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31624
31625 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
31626
31627 @subsubheading Example
31628
31629 @smallexample
31630 -exec-continue
31631 ^running
31632 (gdb)
31633 @@Hello world
31634 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
31635 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
31636 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31637 (gdb)
31638 @end smallexample
31639
31640
31641 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
31642 @findex -exec-finish
31643
31644 @subsubheading Synopsis
31645
31646 @smallexample
31647 -exec-finish [--reverse]
31648 @end smallexample
31649
31650 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
31651 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
31652 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
31653 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
31654 function was called.
31655
31656 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31657
31658 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
31659
31660 @subsubheading Example
31661
31662 Function returning @code{void}.
31663
31664 @smallexample
31665 -exec-finish
31666 ^running
31667 (gdb)
31668 @@hello from foo
31669 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
31670 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31671 (gdb)
31672 @end smallexample
31673
31674 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
31675 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
31676 value itself.
31677
31678 @smallexample
31679 -exec-finish
31680 ^running
31681 (gdb)
31682 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
31683 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
31684 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31685 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31686 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
31687 (gdb)
31688 @end smallexample
31689
31690
31691 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
31692 @findex -exec-interrupt
31693
31694 @subsubheading Synopsis
31695
31696 @smallexample
31697 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
31698 @end smallexample
31699
31700 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
31701 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
31702 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
31703 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
31704 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
31705
31706 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
31707 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
31708 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
31709 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
31710
31711 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
31712 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
31713 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
31714 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
31715
31716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31717
31718 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
31719
31720 @subsubheading Example
31721
31722 @smallexample
31723 (gdb)
31724 111-exec-continue
31725 111^running
31726
31727 (gdb)
31728 222-exec-interrupt
31729 222^done
31730 (gdb)
31731 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
31732 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31733 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31734 (gdb)
31735
31736 (gdb)
31737 -exec-interrupt
31738 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
31739 (gdb)
31740 @end smallexample
31741
31742 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
31743 @findex -exec-jump
31744
31745 @subsubheading Synopsis
31746
31747 @smallexample
31748 -exec-jump @var{location}
31749 @end smallexample
31750
31751 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
31752 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
31753 different forms of @var{location}.
31754
31755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31756
31757 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
31758
31759 @subsubheading Example
31760
31761 @smallexample
31762 -exec-jump foo.c:10
31763 *running,thread-id="all"
31764 ^running
31765 @end smallexample
31766
31767
31768 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
31769 @findex -exec-next
31770
31771 @subsubheading Synopsis
31772
31773 @smallexample
31774 -exec-next [--reverse]
31775 @end smallexample
31776
31777 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
31778 of the next source line is reached.
31779
31780 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
31781 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
31782 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
31783 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
31784 source line where the function was called.
31785
31786
31787 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31788
31789 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
31790
31791 @subsubheading Example
31792
31793 @smallexample
31794 -exec-next
31795 ^running
31796 (gdb)
31797 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
31798 (gdb)
31799 @end smallexample
31800
31801
31802 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
31803 @findex -exec-next-instruction
31804
31805 @subsubheading Synopsis
31806
31807 @smallexample
31808 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
31809 @end smallexample
31810
31811 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
31812 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
31813 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
31814 printed as well.
31815
31816 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
31817 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
31818 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
31819 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
31820 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
31821
31822 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31823
31824 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
31825
31826 @subsubheading Example
31827
31828 @smallexample
31829 (gdb)
31830 -exec-next-instruction
31831 ^running
31832
31833 (gdb)
31834 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31835 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
31836 (gdb)
31837 @end smallexample
31838
31839
31840 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
31841 @findex -exec-return
31842
31843 @subsubheading Synopsis
31844
31845 @smallexample
31846 -exec-return
31847 @end smallexample
31848
31849 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
31850 Displays the new current frame.
31851
31852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31853
31854 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
31855
31856 @subsubheading Example
31857
31858 @smallexample
31859 (gdb)
31860 200-break-insert callee4
31861 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
31862 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
31863 (gdb)
31864 000-exec-run
31865 000^running
31866 (gdb)
31867 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
31868 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
31869 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31870 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
31871 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31872 (gdb)
31873 205-break-delete
31874 205^done
31875 (gdb)
31876 111-exec-return
31877 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
31878 args=[@{name="strarg",
31879 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
31880 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31881 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
31882 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31883 (gdb)
31884 @end smallexample
31885
31886
31887 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
31888 @findex -exec-run
31889
31890 @subsubheading Synopsis
31891
31892 @smallexample
31893 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
31894 @end smallexample
31895
31896 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
31897 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
31898 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
31899 the program has exited exceptionally.
31900
31901 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
31902 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
31903 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
31904 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
31905 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
31906
31907 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
31908 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
31909 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
31910 (@pxref{Starting}).
31911
31912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31913
31914 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
31915
31916 @subsubheading Examples
31917
31918 @smallexample
31919 (gdb)
31920 -break-insert main
31921 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
31922 (gdb)
31923 -exec-run
31924 ^running
31925 (gdb)
31926 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
31927 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
31928 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31929 (gdb)
31930 @end smallexample
31931
31932 @noindent
31933 Program exited normally:
31934
31935 @smallexample
31936 (gdb)
31937 -exec-run
31938 ^running
31939 (gdb)
31940 x = 55
31941 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
31942 (gdb)
31943 @end smallexample
31944
31945 @noindent
31946 Program exited exceptionally:
31947
31948 @smallexample
31949 (gdb)
31950 -exec-run
31951 ^running
31952 (gdb)
31953 x = 55
31954 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
31955 (gdb)
31956 @end smallexample
31957
31958 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
31959 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
31960
31961 @smallexample
31962 (gdb)
31963 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
31964 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
31965 @end smallexample
31966
31967
31968 @c @subheading -exec-signal
31969
31970
31971 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
31972 @findex -exec-step
31973
31974 @subsubheading Synopsis
31975
31976 @smallexample
31977 -exec-step [--reverse]
31978 @end smallexample
31979
31980 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
31981 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
31982 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
31983 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
31984 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
31985 previously executed source line.
31986
31987 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31988
31989 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
31990
31991 @subsubheading Example
31992
31993 Stepping into a function:
31994
31995 @smallexample
31996 -exec-step
31997 ^running
31998 (gdb)
31999 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
32000 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
32001 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
32002 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
32003 (gdb)
32004 @end smallexample
32005
32006 Regular stepping:
32007
32008 @smallexample
32009 -exec-step
32010 ^running
32011 (gdb)
32012 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
32013 (gdb)
32014 @end smallexample
32015
32016
32017 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
32018 @findex -exec-step-instruction
32019
32020 @subsubheading Synopsis
32021
32022 @smallexample
32023 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
32024 @end smallexample
32025
32026 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
32027 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
32028 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
32029 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
32030 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
32031 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
32032 as well.
32033
32034 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32035
32036 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
32037
32038 @subsubheading Example
32039
32040 @smallexample
32041 (gdb)
32042 -exec-step-instruction
32043 ^running
32044
32045 (gdb)
32046 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
32047 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
32048 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
32049 (gdb)
32050 -exec-step-instruction
32051 ^running
32052
32053 (gdb)
32054 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
32055 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
32056 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
32057 (gdb)
32058 @end smallexample
32059
32060
32061 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
32062 @findex -exec-until
32063
32064 @subsubheading Synopsis
32065
32066 @smallexample
32067 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
32068 @end smallexample
32069
32070 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
32071 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
32072 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
32073 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
32074
32075 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32076
32077 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
32078
32079 @subsubheading Example
32080
32081 @smallexample
32082 (gdb)
32083 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
32084 ^running
32085 (gdb)
32086 x = 55
32087 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
32088 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
32089 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
32090 (gdb)
32091 @end smallexample
32092
32093 @ignore
32094 @subheading -file-clear
32095 Is this going away????
32096 @end ignore
32097
32098 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32099 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
32100 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
32101
32102 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
32103 @findex -enable-frame-filters
32104
32105 @smallexample
32106 -enable-frame-filters
32107 @end smallexample
32108
32109 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
32110 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
32111 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
32112 request that this functionality be enabled.
32113
32114 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
32115
32116 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
32117 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
32118
32119 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
32120 @findex -stack-info-frame
32121
32122 @subsubheading Synopsis
32123
32124 @smallexample
32125 -stack-info-frame
32126 @end smallexample
32127
32128 Get info on the selected frame.
32129
32130 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32131
32132 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
32133 (without arguments).
32134
32135 @subsubheading Example
32136
32137 @smallexample
32138 (gdb)
32139 -stack-info-frame
32140 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
32141 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32142 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
32143 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
32144 (gdb)
32145 @end smallexample
32146
32147 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
32148 @findex -stack-info-depth
32149
32150 @subsubheading Synopsis
32151
32152 @smallexample
32153 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
32154 @end smallexample
32155
32156 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
32157 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
32158
32159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32160
32161 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32162
32163 @subsubheading Example
32164
32165 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
32166
32167 @smallexample
32168 (gdb)
32169 -stack-info-depth
32170 ^done,depth="12"
32171 (gdb)
32172 -stack-info-depth 4
32173 ^done,depth="4"
32174 (gdb)
32175 -stack-info-depth 12
32176 ^done,depth="12"
32177 (gdb)
32178 -stack-info-depth 11
32179 ^done,depth="11"
32180 (gdb)
32181 -stack-info-depth 13
32182 ^done,depth="12"
32183 (gdb)
32184 @end smallexample
32185
32186 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
32187 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
32188 @findex -stack-list-arguments
32189
32190 @subsubheading Synopsis
32191
32192 @smallexample
32193 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
32194 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
32195 @end smallexample
32196
32197 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
32198 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
32199 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
32200 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
32201 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
32202 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
32203 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
32204 which case only existing frames will be returned.
32205
32206 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
32207 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
32208 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
32209 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
32210 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
32211 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
32212
32213 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
32214 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
32215 are still displayed, however.
32216
32217 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
32218 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
32219
32220 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32221
32222 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
32223 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
32224 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
32225
32226 @subsubheading Example
32227
32228 @smallexample
32229 (gdb)
32230 -stack-list-frames
32231 ^done,
32232 stack=[
32233 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
32234 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32235 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
32236 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32237 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
32238 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32239 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
32240 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32241 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
32242 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32243 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
32244 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32245 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
32246 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32247 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
32248 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32249 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
32250 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32251 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
32252 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
32253 (gdb)
32254 -stack-list-arguments 0
32255 ^done,
32256 stack-args=[
32257 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
32258 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
32259 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
32260 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
32261 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
32262 (gdb)
32263 -stack-list-arguments 1
32264 ^done,
32265 stack-args=[
32266 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
32267 frame=@{level="1",
32268 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
32269 frame=@{level="2",args=[
32270 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
32271 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
32272 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
32273 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
32274 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
32275 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
32276 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
32277 (gdb)
32278 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
32279 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
32280 (gdb)
32281 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
32282 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
32283 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
32284 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
32285 (gdb)
32286 @end smallexample
32287
32288 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
32289
32290
32291 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
32292 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
32293 @findex -stack-list-frames
32294
32295 @subsubheading Synopsis
32296
32297 @smallexample
32298 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
32299 @end smallexample
32300
32301 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
32302 following info:
32303
32304 @table @samp
32305 @item @var{level}
32306 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
32307 @item @var{addr}
32308 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
32309 @item @var{func}
32310 Function name.
32311 @item @var{file}
32312 File name of the source file where the function lives.
32313 @item @var{fullname}
32314 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
32315 @item @var{line}
32316 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
32317 @item @var{from}
32318 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
32319 if the frame's function is not known.
32320 @item @var{arch}
32321 Frame's architecture.
32322 @end table
32323
32324 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
32325 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
32326 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
32327 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
32328 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
32329 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
32330 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
32331 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
32332 Python frame filters will not be executed.
32333
32334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32335
32336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
32337
32338 @subsubheading Example
32339
32340 Full stack backtrace:
32341
32342 @smallexample
32343 (gdb)
32344 -stack-list-frames
32345 ^done,stack=
32346 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
32347 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
32348 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32349 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32350 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32351 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32352 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32353 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32354 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32355 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32356 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32357 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32358 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32359 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32360 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32361 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32362 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32363 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32364 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32365 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32366 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32367 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32368 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32369 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32370 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32371 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32372 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32373 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32374 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32375 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32376 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32377 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32378 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32379 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
32380 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
32381 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
32382 (gdb)
32383 @end smallexample
32384
32385 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
32386
32387 @smallexample
32388 (gdb)
32389 -stack-list-frames 3 5
32390 ^done,stack=
32391 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32392 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32393 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32394 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32395 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32396 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
32397 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32398 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32399 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
32400 (gdb)
32401 @end smallexample
32402
32403 Show a single frame:
32404
32405 @smallexample
32406 (gdb)
32407 -stack-list-frames 3 3
32408 ^done,stack=
32409 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32410 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
32411 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
32412 (gdb)
32413 @end smallexample
32414
32415
32416 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
32417 @findex -stack-list-locals
32418 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
32419
32420 @subsubheading Synopsis
32421
32422 @smallexample
32423 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
32424 @end smallexample
32425
32426 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
32427 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
32428 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
32429 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
32430 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
32431 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
32432 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
32433 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
32434 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
32435 Python frame filters will not be executed.
32436
32437 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
32438 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
32439 variables are still displayed, however.
32440
32441 This command is deprecated in favor of the
32442 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
32443
32444 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32445
32446 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
32447
32448 @subsubheading Example
32449
32450 @smallexample
32451 (gdb)
32452 -stack-list-locals 0
32453 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
32454 (gdb)
32455 -stack-list-locals --all-values
32456 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
32457 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
32458 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
32459 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
32460 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
32461 (gdb)
32462 @end smallexample
32463
32464 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
32465 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
32466 @findex -stack-list-variables
32467
32468 @subsubheading Synopsis
32469
32470 @smallexample
32471 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
32472 @end smallexample
32473
32474 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
32475 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
32476 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
32477 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
32478 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
32479 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
32480 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
32481
32482 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
32483 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
32484 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
32485
32486 @subsubheading Example
32487
32488 @smallexample
32489 (gdb)
32490 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
32491 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
32492 (gdb)
32493 @end smallexample
32494
32495
32496 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
32497 @findex -stack-select-frame
32498
32499 @subsubheading Synopsis
32500
32501 @smallexample
32502 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
32503 @end smallexample
32504
32505 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
32506 the stack.
32507
32508 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
32509 option to every command.
32510
32511 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32512
32513 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
32514 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
32515
32516 @subsubheading Example
32517
32518 @smallexample
32519 (gdb)
32520 -stack-select-frame 2
32521 ^done
32522 (gdb)
32523 @end smallexample
32524
32525 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32526 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
32527 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
32528
32529 @ignore
32530
32531 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
32532
32533 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
32534 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
32535 used by @code{Insight}.
32536
32537 The two main reasons for that are:
32538
32539 @enumerate 1
32540 @item
32541 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
32542
32543 @item
32544 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
32545 now).
32546 @end enumerate
32547
32548 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
32549 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
32550 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
32551 hints about their use.
32552
32553 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
32554 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
32555 least, the following operations:
32556
32557 @itemize @bullet
32558 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
32559 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
32560 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
32561 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
32562 @end itemize
32563
32564 @end ignore
32565
32566 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
32567
32568 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
32569
32570 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
32571 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
32572 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
32573 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
32574 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
32575 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
32576 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
32577 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
32578 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
32579 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
32580 object, or to change display format.
32581
32582 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
32583 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
32584 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
32585 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
32586 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
32587 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
32588 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
32589 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
32590 child will be created.
32591
32592 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
32593 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
32594 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
32595 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
32596 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
32597
32598 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
32599 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
32600 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
32601 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
32602 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
32603 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
32604 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
32605 variables that frontend has created.
32606
32607 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
32608 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
32609 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
32610 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
32611 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
32612 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
32613 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
32614 implicitly updated.
32615
32616 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
32617 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
32618 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
32619 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
32620 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
32621 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
32622 frame. Consider this example:
32623
32624 @smallexample
32625 void do_work(...)
32626 @{
32627 struct work_state state;
32628
32629 if (...)
32630 do_work(...);
32631 @}
32632 @end smallexample
32633
32634 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
32635 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
32636 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
32637 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
32638 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
32639
32640 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
32641 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
32642 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
32643 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
32644 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
32645 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
32646
32647 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
32648 access this functionality:
32649
32650 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
32651 @item @strong{Operation}
32652 @tab @strong{Description}
32653
32654 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
32655 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
32656 @item @code{-var-create}
32657 @tab create a variable object
32658 @item @code{-var-delete}
32659 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
32660 @item @code{-var-set-format}
32661 @tab set the display format of this variable
32662 @item @code{-var-show-format}
32663 @tab show the display format of this variable
32664 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
32665 @tab tells how many children this object has
32666 @item @code{-var-list-children}
32667 @tab return a list of the object's children
32668 @item @code{-var-info-type}
32669 @tab show the type of this variable object
32670 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
32671 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
32672 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
32673 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
32674 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
32675 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
32676 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
32677 @tab get the value of this variable
32678 @item @code{-var-assign}
32679 @tab set the value of this variable
32680 @item @code{-var-update}
32681 @tab update the variable and its children
32682 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
32683 @tab set frozenness attribute
32684 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
32685 @tab set range of children to display on update
32686 @end multitable
32687
32688 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
32689 how it can be used.
32690
32691 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
32692
32693 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
32694 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
32695
32696 @smallexample
32697 -enable-pretty-printing
32698 @end smallexample
32699
32700 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
32701 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
32702 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
32703 request that this functionality be enabled.
32704
32705 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
32706
32707 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
32708 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
32709
32710 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
32711 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
32712
32713 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
32714 @findex -var-create
32715
32716 @subsubheading Synopsis
32717
32718 @smallexample
32719 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
32720 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
32721 @end smallexample
32722
32723 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
32724 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
32725 register.
32726
32727 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
32728 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
32729 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
32730 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
32731 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
32732
32733 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
32734 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
32735 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
32736 object must be created.
32737
32738 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
32739 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
32740
32741 @itemize @bullet
32742 @item
32743 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
32744
32745 @item
32746 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
32747
32748 @item
32749 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
32750 @end itemize
32751
32752 @cindex dynamic varobj
32753 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
32754 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
32755 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
32756 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
32757 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
32758 compatibility for existing clients.
32759
32760 @subsubheading Result
32761
32762 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
32763 are:
32764
32765 @table @samp
32766 @item name
32767 The name of the varobj.
32768
32769 @item numchild
32770 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
32771 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
32772 @samp{has_more} attribute.
32773
32774 @item value
32775 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
32776 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
32777 will not be interesting.
32778
32779 @item type
32780 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
32781 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
32782 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
32783 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
32784 @emph{declared} one.
32785
32786 @item thread-id
32787 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
32788 thread's global identifier.
32789
32790 @item has_more
32791 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
32792 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
32793
32794 @item dynamic
32795 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32796 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32797 then this attribute will not be present.
32798
32799 @item displayhint
32800 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32801 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32802 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32803 @end table
32804
32805 Typical output will look like this:
32806
32807 @smallexample
32808 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
32809 has_more="@var{has_more}"
32810 @end smallexample
32811
32812
32813 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
32814 @findex -var-delete
32815
32816 @subsubheading Synopsis
32817
32818 @smallexample
32819 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
32820 @end smallexample
32821
32822 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
32823 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
32824
32825 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
32826
32827
32828 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
32829 @findex -var-set-format
32830
32831 @subsubheading Synopsis
32832
32833 @smallexample
32834 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
32835 @end smallexample
32836
32837 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
32838 @var{format-spec}.
32839
32840 @anchor{-var-set-format}
32841 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
32842
32843 @smallexample
32844 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
32845 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
32846 @end smallexample
32847
32848 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
32849 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
32850 for pointers, etc.).
32851
32852 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
32853 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
32854 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
32855 zero-hexadecimal format.
32856
32857 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
32858 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
32859
32860 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
32861 @findex -var-show-format
32862
32863 @subsubheading Synopsis
32864
32865 @smallexample
32866 -var-show-format @var{name}
32867 @end smallexample
32868
32869 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
32870
32871 @smallexample
32872 @var{format} @expansion{}
32873 @var{format-spec}
32874 @end smallexample
32875
32876
32877 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
32878 @findex -var-info-num-children
32879
32880 @subsubheading Synopsis
32881
32882 @smallexample
32883 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
32884 @end smallexample
32885
32886 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
32887
32888 @smallexample
32889 numchild=@var{n}
32890 @end smallexample
32891
32892 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
32893 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
32894 be available.
32895
32896
32897 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
32898 @findex -var-list-children
32899
32900 @subsubheading Synopsis
32901
32902 @smallexample
32903 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
32904 @end smallexample
32905 @anchor{-var-list-children}
32906
32907 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
32908 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
32909 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
32910 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
32911 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
32912 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
32913 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
32914 and unions.
32915
32916 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
32917 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
32918 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
32919 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
32920 reported.
32921
32922 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
32923 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
32924 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
32925 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
32926 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
32927 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
32928 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
32929 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
32930 the visible items.
32931
32932 For each child the following results are returned:
32933
32934 @table @var
32935
32936 @item name
32937 Name of the variable object created for this child.
32938
32939 @item exp
32940 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
32941 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
32942
32943 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
32944 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
32945
32946 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
32947 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
32948 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
32949 type and value are not present.
32950
32951 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
32952 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
32953 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
32954
32955 @item numchild
32956 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
32957 0.
32958
32959 @item type
32960 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
32961 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
32962 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
32963 @emph{declared} one.
32964
32965 @item value
32966 If values were requested, this is the value.
32967
32968 @item thread-id
32969 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
32970 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
32971
32972 @item frozen
32973 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
32974
32975 @item displayhint
32976 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32977 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32978 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32979
32980 @item dynamic
32981 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32982 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32983 then this attribute will not be present.
32984
32985 @end table
32986
32987 The result may have its own attributes:
32988
32989 @table @samp
32990 @item displayhint
32991 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32992 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32993 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32994
32995 @item has_more
32996 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
32997 remaining after the end of the selected range.
32998 @end table
32999
33000 @subsubheading Example
33001
33002 @smallexample
33003 (gdb)
33004 -var-list-children n
33005 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
33006 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
33007 (gdb)
33008 -var-list-children --all-values n
33009 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
33010 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
33011 @end smallexample
33012
33013
33014 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
33015 @findex -var-info-type
33016
33017 @subsubheading Synopsis
33018
33019 @smallexample
33020 -var-info-type @var{name}
33021 @end smallexample
33022
33023 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
33024 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
33025 @value{GDBN} CLI:
33026
33027 @smallexample
33028 type=@var{typename}
33029 @end smallexample
33030
33031
33032 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
33033 @findex -var-info-expression
33034
33035 @subsubheading Synopsis
33036
33037 @smallexample
33038 -var-info-expression @var{name}
33039 @end smallexample
33040
33041 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
33042 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
33043 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
33044
33045 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
33046 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
33047
33048 @smallexample
33049 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
33050 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
33051 @end smallexample
33052
33053 @noindent
33054 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
33055 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
33056
33057 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
33058 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
33059 is of limited use.
33060
33061 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
33062 @findex -var-info-path-expression
33063
33064 @subsubheading Synopsis
33065
33066 @smallexample
33067 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
33068 @end smallexample
33069
33070 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
33071 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
33072 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
33073 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
33074 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
33075 watchpoint from a variable object.
33076
33077 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
33078 and will give an error when invoked on one.
33079
33080 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
33081 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
33082 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
33083 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
33084 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
33085 @smallexample
33086 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
33087 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
33088 @end smallexample
33089
33090 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
33091 @findex -var-show-attributes
33092
33093 @subsubheading Synopsis
33094
33095 @smallexample
33096 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
33097 @end smallexample
33098
33099 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
33100
33101 @smallexample
33102 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
33103 @end smallexample
33104
33105 @noindent
33106 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
33107
33108 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
33109 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
33110
33111 @subsubheading Synopsis
33112
33113 @smallexample
33114 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
33115 @end smallexample
33116
33117 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
33118 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
33119 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
33120 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
33121 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
33122 the current display format will be used. The current display format
33123 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
33124
33125 @smallexample
33126 value=@var{value}
33127 @end smallexample
33128
33129 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
33130 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
33131
33132 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
33133 @findex -var-assign
33134
33135 @subsubheading Synopsis
33136
33137 @smallexample
33138 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
33139 @end smallexample
33140
33141 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
33142 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
33143 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
33144 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
33145
33146 @subsubheading Example
33147
33148 @smallexample
33149 (gdb)
33150 -var-assign var1 3
33151 ^done,value="3"
33152 (gdb)
33153 -var-update *
33154 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
33155 (gdb)
33156 @end smallexample
33157
33158 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
33159 @findex -var-update
33160
33161 @subsubheading Synopsis
33162
33163 @smallexample
33164 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
33165 @end smallexample
33166
33167 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
33168 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
33169 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
33170 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
33171 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
33172 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
33173 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
33174 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
33175 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
33176 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
33177 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
33178 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
33179 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
33180
33181 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
33182 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
33183 diagnostic.
33184
33185 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
33186 only the selected range of children will be reported.
33187
33188 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
33189 @samp{changelist}.
33190
33191 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
33192
33193 @table @samp
33194 @item name
33195 The name of the varobj.
33196
33197 @item value
33198 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
33199 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
33200
33201 @item in_scope
33202 @anchor{-var-update}
33203 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
33204
33205 @table @code
33206 @item "true"
33207 The variable object's current value is valid.
33208
33209 @item "false"
33210 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
33211 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
33212 scope.
33213
33214 @item "invalid"
33215 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
33216 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
33217 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
33218 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
33219 objects.
33220 @end table
33221
33222 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
33223 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
33224
33225 @item type_changed
33226 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
33227 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
33228 be @samp{false}.
33229
33230 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
33231 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
33232 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
33233 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
33234 unset.
33235
33236 @item new_type
33237 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
33238 hold the new type.
33239
33240 @item new_num_children
33241 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
33242 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
33243
33244 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
33245 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
33246 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
33247 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
33248 children which may be available.
33249
33250 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
33251 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
33252 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
33253 only happen at the end of the update range).
33254
33255 @item displayhint
33256 The display hint, if any.
33257
33258 @item has_more
33259 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
33260 available outside the varobj's update range.
33261
33262 @item dynamic
33263 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
33264 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
33265 then this attribute will not be present.
33266
33267 @item new_children
33268 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
33269 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
33270 be listed in this attribute.
33271 @end table
33272
33273 @subsubheading Example
33274
33275 @smallexample
33276 (gdb)
33277 -var-assign var1 3
33278 ^done,value="3"
33279 (gdb)
33280 -var-update --all-values var1
33281 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
33282 type_changed="false"@}]
33283 (gdb)
33284 @end smallexample
33285
33286 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
33287 @findex -var-set-frozen
33288 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
33289
33290 @subsubheading Synopsis
33291
33292 @smallexample
33293 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
33294 @end smallexample
33295
33296 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
33297 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
33298 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
33299 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
33300 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
33301 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
33302 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
33303 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
33304 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
33305 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
33306 @code{-var-update} does.
33307
33308 @subsubheading Example
33309
33310 @smallexample
33311 (gdb)
33312 -var-set-frozen V 1
33313 ^done
33314 (gdb)
33315 @end smallexample
33316
33317 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
33318 @findex -var-set-update-range
33319 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
33320
33321 @subsubheading Synopsis
33322
33323 @smallexample
33324 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
33325 @end smallexample
33326
33327 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
33328 @code{-var-update}.
33329
33330 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
33331 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
33332 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
33333 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
33334
33335 @subsubheading Example
33336
33337 @smallexample
33338 (gdb)
33339 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
33340 ^done
33341 @end smallexample
33342
33343 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
33344 @findex -var-set-visualizer
33345 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
33346
33347 @subsubheading Synopsis
33348
33349 @smallexample
33350 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
33351 @end smallexample
33352
33353 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
33354
33355 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
33356 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
33357
33358 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
33359 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
33360 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
33361 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
33362 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
33363 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
33364 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
33365
33366 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
33367 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
33368 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
33369 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
33370
33371 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
33372 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
33373 can be used to check this.
33374
33375 @subsubheading Example
33376
33377 Resetting the visualizer:
33378
33379 @smallexample
33380 (gdb)
33381 -var-set-visualizer V None
33382 ^done
33383 @end smallexample
33384
33385 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
33386
33387 @smallexample
33388 (gdb)
33389 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
33390 ^done
33391 @end smallexample
33392
33393 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
33394 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
33395
33396 @smallexample
33397 (gdb)
33398 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
33399 ^done
33400 @end smallexample
33401
33402 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33403 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
33404 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
33405
33406 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
33407 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
33408 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
33409 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
33410
33411 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
33412 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
33413
33414 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
33415 @c @subheading -data-assign
33416 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
33417 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
33418 @c set variable
33419 @c @subsubheading Example
33420 @c N.A.
33421
33422 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
33423 @findex -data-disassemble
33424
33425 @subsubheading Synopsis
33426
33427 @smallexample
33428 -data-disassemble
33429 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
33430 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
33431 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
33432 -- @var{mode}
33433 @end smallexample
33434
33435 @noindent
33436 Where:
33437
33438 @table @samp
33439 @item @var{start-addr}
33440 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
33441 @item @var{end-addr}
33442 is the end address
33443 @item @var{addr}
33444 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
33445 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
33446 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
33447 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
33448 @item @var{filename}
33449 is the name of the file to disassemble
33450 @item @var{linenum}
33451 is the line number to disassemble around
33452 @item @var{lines}
33453 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
33454 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
33455 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
33456 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
33457 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
33458 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
33459 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
33460 are displayed.
33461 @item @var{mode}
33462 is one of:
33463 @itemize @bullet
33464 @item 0 disassembly only
33465 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
33466 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
33467 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
33468 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
33469 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
33470 @end itemize
33471
33472 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
33473 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
33474 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
33475 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
33476 @end table
33477
33478 @subsubheading Result
33479
33480 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
33481 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
33482 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
33483
33484 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
33485 following fields:
33486
33487 @table @code
33488 @item address
33489 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
33490
33491 @item func-name
33492 The name of the function this instruction is within.
33493
33494 @item offset
33495 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
33496
33497 @item inst
33498 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
33499
33500 @item opcodes
33501 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
33502 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
33503
33504 @end table
33505
33506 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
33507 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
33508
33509 @table @code
33510 @item line
33511 The line number within @samp{file}.
33512
33513 @item file
33514 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
33515 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
33516 used.
33517
33518 @item fullname
33519 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
33520 using the source file search path
33521 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
33522 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
33523
33524 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
33525 present in the debug information.
33526
33527 @item line_asm_insn
33528 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
33529 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
33530 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
33531 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
33532 @samp{opcodes}.
33533
33534 @end table
33535
33536 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
33537 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
33538 adjust its format.
33539
33540 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33541
33542 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
33543
33544 @subsubheading Example
33545
33546 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
33547
33548 @smallexample
33549 (gdb)
33550 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
33551 ^done,
33552 asm_insns=[
33553 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
33554 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
33555 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
33556 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
33557 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
33558 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
33559 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
33560 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
33561 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
33562 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
33563 (gdb)
33564 @end smallexample
33565
33566 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
33567 @code{main}.
33568
33569 @smallexample
33570 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
33571 ^done,asm_insns=[
33572 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
33573 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
33574 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
33575 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
33576 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
33577 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
33578 [@dots{}]
33579 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
33580 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
33581 (gdb)
33582 @end smallexample
33583
33584 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
33585
33586 @smallexample
33587 (gdb)
33588 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
33589 ^done,asm_insns=[
33590 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
33591 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
33592 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
33593 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
33594 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
33595 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
33596 (gdb)
33597 @end smallexample
33598
33599 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
33600
33601 @smallexample
33602 (gdb)
33603 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
33604 ^done,asm_insns=[
33605 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
33606 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33607 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33608 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
33609 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
33610 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
33611 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33612 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33613 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
33614 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
33615 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
33616 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
33617 (gdb)
33618 @end smallexample
33619
33620
33621 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
33622 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
33623
33624 @subsubheading Synopsis
33625
33626 @smallexample
33627 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
33628 @end smallexample
33629
33630 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
33631 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
33632 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
33633
33634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33635
33636 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
33637 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
33638 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
33639
33640 @subsubheading Example
33641
33642 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
33643 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
33644 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
33645 output.
33646
33647 @smallexample
33648 211-data-evaluate-expression A
33649 211^done,value="1"
33650 (gdb)
33651 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
33652 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
33653 (gdb)
33654 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
33655 411^done,value="4"
33656 (gdb)
33657 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
33658 511^done,value="4"
33659 (gdb)
33660 @end smallexample
33661
33662
33663 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
33664 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
33665
33666 @subsubheading Synopsis
33667
33668 @smallexample
33669 -data-list-changed-registers
33670 @end smallexample
33671
33672 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
33673
33674 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33675
33676 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
33677 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
33678
33679 @subsubheading Example
33680
33681 On a PPC MBX board:
33682
33683 @smallexample
33684 (gdb)
33685 -exec-continue
33686 ^running
33687
33688 (gdb)
33689 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
33690 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
33691 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
33692 (gdb)
33693 -data-list-changed-registers
33694 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
33695 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
33696 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
33697 (gdb)
33698 @end smallexample
33699
33700
33701 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
33702 @findex -data-list-register-names
33703
33704 @subsubheading Synopsis
33705
33706 @smallexample
33707 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
33708 @end smallexample
33709
33710 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
33711 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
33712 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
33713 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
33714 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
33715 include empty register names.
33716
33717 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33718
33719 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
33720 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
33721 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
33722
33723 @subsubheading Example
33724
33725 For the PPC MBX board:
33726 @smallexample
33727 (gdb)
33728 -data-list-register-names
33729 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
33730 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
33731 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
33732 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
33733 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
33734 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
33735 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
33736 (gdb)
33737 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
33738 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
33739 (gdb)
33740 @end smallexample
33741
33742 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
33743 @findex -data-list-register-values
33744
33745 @subsubheading Synopsis
33746
33747 @smallexample
33748 -data-list-register-values
33749 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
33750 @end smallexample
33751
33752 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
33753 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
33754 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
33755 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
33756 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
33757 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
33758
33759 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
33760
33761 @table @code
33762 @item x
33763 Hexadecimal
33764 @item o
33765 Octal
33766 @item t
33767 Binary
33768 @item d
33769 Decimal
33770 @item r
33771 Raw
33772 @item N
33773 Natural
33774 @end table
33775
33776 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33777
33778 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
33779 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
33780
33781 @subsubheading Example
33782
33783 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
33784 don't appear in the actual output):
33785
33786 @smallexample
33787 (gdb)
33788 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
33789 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
33790 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
33791 (gdb)
33792 -data-list-register-values x
33793 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
33794 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
33795 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
33796 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
33797 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
33798 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
33799 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
33800 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
33801 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
33802 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
33803 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
33804 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
33805 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
33806 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
33807 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
33808 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
33809 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
33810 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
33811 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
33812 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
33813 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
33814 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
33815 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
33816 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
33817 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
33818 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
33819 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
33820 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
33821 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
33822 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
33823 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
33824 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
33825 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
33826 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
33827 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
33828 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
33829 (gdb)
33830 @end smallexample
33831
33832
33833 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
33834 @findex -data-read-memory
33835
33836 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
33837
33838 @subsubheading Synopsis
33839
33840 @smallexample
33841 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
33842 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
33843 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
33844 @end smallexample
33845
33846 @noindent
33847 where:
33848
33849 @table @samp
33850 @item @var{address}
33851 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
33852 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33853 quoted using the C convention.
33854
33855 @item @var{word-format}
33856 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
33857 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
33858 ,Output Formats}).
33859
33860 @item @var{word-size}
33861 The size of each memory word in bytes.
33862
33863 @item @var{nr-rows}
33864 The number of rows in the output table.
33865
33866 @item @var{nr-cols}
33867 The number of columns in the output table.
33868
33869 @item @var{aschar}
33870 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
33871 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
33872 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
33873 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
33874
33875 @item @var{byte-offset}
33876 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
33877 @end table
33878
33879 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
33880 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
33881 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
33882 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
33883 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
33884 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
33885 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
33886 @samp{addr}.
33887
33888 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
33889 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
33890 @samp{prev-page}.
33891
33892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33893
33894 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
33895 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
33896
33897 @subsubheading Example
33898
33899 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
33900 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
33901 word. Display each word in hex.
33902
33903 @smallexample
33904 (gdb)
33905 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
33906 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
33907 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
33908 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
33909 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
33910 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
33911 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
33912 (gdb)
33913 @end smallexample
33914
33915 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
33916 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
33917
33918 @smallexample
33919 (gdb)
33920 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
33921 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
33922 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
33923 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
33924 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
33925 (gdb)
33926 @end smallexample
33927
33928 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
33929 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
33930 used as the non-printable character.
33931
33932 @smallexample
33933 (gdb)
33934 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
33935 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
33936 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
33937 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
33938 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33939 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33940 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33941 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33942 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
33943 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
33944 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
33945 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
33946 (gdb)
33947 @end smallexample
33948
33949 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
33950 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
33951
33952 @subsubheading Synopsis
33953
33954 @smallexample
33955 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
33956 @var{address} @var{count}
33957 @end smallexample
33958
33959 @noindent
33960 where:
33961
33962 @table @samp
33963 @item @var{address}
33964 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
33965 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33966 quoted using the C convention.
33967
33968 @item @var{count}
33969 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
33970 literal.
33971
33972 @item @var{offset}
33973 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
33974 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
33975 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
33976 arithmetics itself.
33977
33978 @end table
33979
33980 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
33981 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
33982 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
33983 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
33984 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
33985 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
33986
33987 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
33988 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
33989 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
33990 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
33991 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
33992 well for reading across a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
33993 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
33994 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
33995
33996 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
33997 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
33998 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
33999 and has the following fields:
34000
34001 @table @code
34002 @item begin
34003 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
34004
34005 @item end
34006 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
34007
34008 @item offset
34009 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
34010 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
34011
34012 @item contents
34013 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
34014
34015 @end table
34016
34017
34018
34019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34020
34021 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
34022
34023 @subsubheading Example
34024
34025 @smallexample
34026 (gdb)
34027 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
34028 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
34029 end="0xbffff15e",
34030 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
34031 (gdb)
34032 @end smallexample
34033
34034
34035 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
34036 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
34037
34038 @subsubheading Synopsis
34039
34040 @smallexample
34041 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
34042 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
34043 @end smallexample
34044
34045 @noindent
34046 where:
34047
34048 @table @samp
34049 @item @var{address}
34050 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
34051 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
34052 be quoted using the C convention.
34053
34054 @item @var{contents}
34055 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
34056 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
34057
34058 @item @var{count}
34059 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
34060 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
34061 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
34062 @var{count} memory units.
34063
34064 @end table
34065
34066 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34067
34068 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
34069
34070 @subsubheading Example
34071
34072 @smallexample
34073 (gdb)
34074 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
34075 ^done
34076 (gdb)
34077 @end smallexample
34078
34079 @smallexample
34080 (gdb)
34081 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
34082 ^done
34083 (gdb)
34084 @end smallexample
34085
34086 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34087 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
34088 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
34089
34090 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
34091 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
34092
34093 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
34094 @findex -trace-find
34095
34096 @subsubheading Synopsis
34097
34098 @smallexample
34099 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
34100 @end smallexample
34101
34102 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
34103 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
34104 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
34105
34106 @table @samp
34107
34108 @item none
34109 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
34110
34111 @item frame-number
34112 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
34113 that index.
34114
34115 @item tracepoint-number
34116 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
34117 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
34118
34119 @item pc
34120 An address is required as parameter. Finds
34121 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
34122 address.
34123
34124 @item pc-inside-range
34125 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
34126 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
34127 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
34128
34129 @item pc-outside-range
34130 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
34131 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
34132 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
34133
34134 @item line
34135 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
34136 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
34137 the specified location.
34138
34139 @end table
34140
34141 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
34142 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
34143
34144 @table @samp
34145 @item found
34146 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
34147 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
34148
34149 @item traceframe
34150 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
34151 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
34152
34153 @item tracepoint
34154 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
34155 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
34156
34157 @item frame
34158 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
34159 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
34160 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
34161
34162 @end table
34163
34164 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34165
34166 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
34167
34168 @subheading -trace-define-variable
34169 @findex -trace-define-variable
34170
34171 @subsubheading Synopsis
34172
34173 @smallexample
34174 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
34175 @end smallexample
34176
34177 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
34178 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
34179 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
34180 with the @samp{$} character.
34181
34182 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34183
34184 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
34185
34186 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
34187 @findex -trace-frame-collected
34188
34189 @subsubheading Synopsis
34190
34191 @smallexample
34192 -trace-frame-collected
34193 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
34194 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
34195 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
34196 [--memory-contents]
34197 @end smallexample
34198
34199 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
34200 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
34201 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
34202 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
34203 See the output description table below for more details.
34204
34205 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
34206 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
34207 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
34208 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
34209 memory range and which is a computed expression.
34210
34211 For instance, if the actions were
34212 @smallexample
34213 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
34214 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
34215 @end smallexample
34216
34217 @noindent
34218 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
34219 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
34220 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
34221 objects would be computed expressions.
34222
34223 An example output would be:
34224
34225 @smallexample
34226 (gdb)
34227 -trace-frame-collected
34228 ^done,
34229 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
34230 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
34231 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
34232 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
34233 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
34234 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
34235 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
34236 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
34237 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
34238 ...
34239 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
34240 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
34241 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
34242 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
34243 (gdb)
34244 @end smallexample
34245
34246 Where:
34247
34248 @table @code
34249 @item explicit-variables
34250 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
34251 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
34252 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
34253 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
34254 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
34255 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
34256 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
34257 arrays, structures and unions.
34258
34259 @item computed-expressions
34260 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
34261 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
34262 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
34263 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
34264
34265 @item registers
34266 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
34267 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
34268 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
34269 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
34270 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
34271
34272 @item tvars
34273 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
34274 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
34275 current value are returned.
34276
34277 @item memory
34278 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
34279 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
34280 collected memory range and has the following fields:
34281
34282 @table @code
34283 @item address
34284 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
34285
34286 @item length
34287 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
34288
34289 @item contents
34290 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
34291 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
34292
34293 @end table
34294
34295 @end table
34296
34297 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34298
34299 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
34300
34301 @subsubheading Example
34302
34303 @subheading -trace-list-variables
34304 @findex -trace-list-variables
34305
34306 @subsubheading Synopsis
34307
34308 @smallexample
34309 -trace-list-variables
34310 @end smallexample
34311
34312 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
34313 table has the following fields:
34314
34315 @table @samp
34316 @item name
34317 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
34318
34319 @item initial
34320 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
34321 field is always present.
34322
34323 @item current
34324 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
34325 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
34326 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
34327 presently running.
34328
34329 @end table
34330
34331 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34332
34333 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
34334
34335 @subsubheading Example
34336
34337 @smallexample
34338 (gdb)
34339 -trace-list-variables
34340 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
34341 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
34342 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
34343 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
34344 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
34345 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
34346 (gdb)
34347 @end smallexample
34348
34349 @subheading -trace-save
34350 @findex -trace-save
34351
34352 @subsubheading Synopsis
34353
34354 @smallexample
34355 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
34356 @end smallexample
34357
34358 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
34359 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
34360 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
34361 to perform the save.
34362
34363 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
34364 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
34365 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
34366
34367 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34368
34369 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
34370
34371
34372 @subheading -trace-start
34373 @findex -trace-start
34374
34375 @subsubheading Synopsis
34376
34377 @smallexample
34378 -trace-start
34379 @end smallexample
34380
34381 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
34382 have any fields.
34383
34384 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34385
34386 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
34387
34388 @subheading -trace-status
34389 @findex -trace-status
34390
34391 @subsubheading Synopsis
34392
34393 @smallexample
34394 -trace-status
34395 @end smallexample
34396
34397 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
34398 the following fields:
34399
34400 @table @samp
34401
34402 @item supported
34403 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
34404 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
34405 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
34406 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
34407 started. This field is always present.
34408
34409 @item running
34410 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
34411 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
34412 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
34413
34414 @item stop-reason
34415 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
34416 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
34417 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
34418 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
34419 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
34420 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
34421 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
34422 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
34423 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
34424
34425 @item stopping-tracepoint
34426 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
34427 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
34428 @samp{passcount}.
34429
34430 @item frames
34431 @itemx frames-created
34432 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
34433 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
34434 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
34435 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
34436
34437 @item buffer-size
34438 @itemx buffer-free
34439 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
34440 remaining space. These fields are optional.
34441
34442 @item circular
34443 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
34444 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
34445 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
34446 and may fill up.
34447
34448 @item disconnected
34449 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
34450 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
34451 that the trace run will stop.
34452
34453 @item trace-file
34454 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
34455 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
34456
34457 @end table
34458
34459 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34460
34461 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
34462
34463 @subheading -trace-stop
34464 @findex -trace-stop
34465
34466 @subsubheading Synopsis
34467
34468 @smallexample
34469 -trace-stop
34470 @end smallexample
34471
34472 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
34473 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
34474 @samp{running} fields are not output.
34475
34476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34477
34478 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
34479
34480
34481 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34482 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
34483 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
34484
34485
34486 @ignore
34487 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
34488 @findex -symbol-info-address
34489
34490 @subsubheading Synopsis
34491
34492 @smallexample
34493 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
34494 @end smallexample
34495
34496 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
34497
34498 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34499
34500 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
34501
34502 @subsubheading Example
34503 N.A.
34504
34505
34506 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
34507 @findex -symbol-info-file
34508
34509 @subsubheading Synopsis
34510
34511 @smallexample
34512 -symbol-info-file
34513 @end smallexample
34514
34515 Show the file for the symbol.
34516
34517 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34518
34519 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
34520 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
34521
34522 @subsubheading Example
34523 N.A.
34524 @end ignore
34525
34526 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-functions} Command
34527 @findex -symbol-info-functions
34528 @anchor{-symbol-info-functions}
34529
34530 @subsubheading Synopsis
34531
34532 @smallexample
34533 -symbol-info-functions [--include-nondebug]
34534 [--type @var{type_regexp}]
34535 [--name @var{name_regexp}]
34536 [--max-results @var{limit}]
34537 @end smallexample
34538
34539 @noindent
34540 Return a list containing the names and types for all global functions
34541 taken from the debug information. The functions are grouped by source
34542 file, and shown with the line number on which each function is
34543 defined.
34544
34545 The @code{--include-nondebug} option causes the output to include
34546 code symbols from the symbol table.
34547
34548 The options @code{--type} and @code{--name} allow the symbols returned
34549 to be filtered based on either the name of the function, or the type
34550 signature of the function.
34551
34552 The option @code{--max-results} restricts the command to return no
34553 more than @var{limit} results. If exactly @var{limit} results are
34554 returned then there might be additional results available if a higher
34555 limit is used.
34556
34557 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34558
34559 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info functions}.
34560
34561 @subsubheading Example
34562 @smallexample
34563 @group
34564 (gdb)
34565 -symbol-info-functions
34566 ^done,symbols=
34567 @{debug=
34568 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34569 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34570 symbols=[@{line="36", name="f4", type="void (int *)",
34571 description="void f4(int *);"@},
34572 @{line="42", name="main", type="int ()",
34573 description="int main();"@},
34574 @{line="30", name="f1", type="my_int_t (int, int)",
34575 description="static my_int_t f1(int, int);"@}]@},
34576 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34577 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34578 symbols=[@{line="33", name="f2", type="float (another_float_t)",
34579 description="float f2(another_float_t);"@},
34580 @{line="39", name="f3", type="int (another_int_t)",
34581 description="int f3(another_int_t);"@},
34582 @{line="27", name="f1", type="another_float_t (int)",
34583 description="static another_float_t f1(int);"@}]@}]@}
34584 @end group
34585 @group
34586 (gdb)
34587 -symbol-info-functions --name f1
34588 ^done,symbols=
34589 @{debug=
34590 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34591 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34592 symbols=[@{line="30", name="f1", type="my_int_t (int, int)",
34593 description="static my_int_t f1(int, int);"@}]@},
34594 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34595 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34596 symbols=[@{line="27", name="f1", type="another_float_t (int)",
34597 description="static another_float_t f1(int);"@}]@}]@}
34598 @end group
34599 @group
34600 (gdb)
34601 -symbol-info-functions --type void
34602 ^done,symbols=
34603 @{debug=
34604 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34605 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34606 symbols=[@{line="36", name="f4", type="void (int *)",
34607 description="void f4(int *);"@}]@}]@}
34608 @end group
34609 @group
34610 (gdb)
34611 -symbol-info-functions --include-nondebug
34612 ^done,symbols=
34613 @{debug=
34614 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34615 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34616 symbols=[@{line="36", name="f4", type="void (int *)",
34617 description="void f4(int *);"@},
34618 @{line="42", name="main", type="int ()",
34619 description="int main();"@},
34620 @{line="30", name="f1", type="my_int_t (int, int)",
34621 description="static my_int_t f1(int, int);"@}]@},
34622 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34623 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34624 symbols=[@{line="33", name="f2", type="float (another_float_t)",
34625 description="float f2(another_float_t);"@},
34626 @{line="39", name="f3", type="int (another_int_t)",
34627 description="int f3(another_int_t);"@},
34628 @{line="27", name="f1", type="another_float_t (int)",
34629 description="static another_float_t f1(int);"@}]@}],
34630 nondebug=
34631 [@{address="0x0000000000400398",name="_init"@},
34632 @{address="0x00000000004003b0",name="_start"@},
34633 ...
34634 ]@}
34635 @end group
34636 @end smallexample
34637
34638 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-module-functions} Command
34639 @findex -symbol-info-module-functions
34640 @anchor{-symbol-info-module-functions}
34641
34642 @subsubheading Synopsis
34643
34644 @smallexample
34645 -symbol-info-module-functions [--module @var{module_regexp}]
34646 [--name @var{name_regexp}]
34647 [--type @var{type_regexp}]
34648 @end smallexample
34649
34650 @noindent
34651 Return a list containing the names of all known functions within all
34652 know Fortran modules. The functions are grouped by source file and
34653 containing module, and shown with the line number on which each
34654 function is defined.
34655
34656 The option @code{--module} only returns results for modules matching
34657 @var{module_regexp}. The option @code{--name} only returns functions
34658 whose name matches @var{name_regexp}, and @code{--type} only returns
34659 functions whose type matches @var{type_regexp}.
34660
34661 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34662
34663 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info module functions}.
34664
34665 @subsubheading Example
34666
34667 @smallexample
34668 @group
34669 (gdb)
34670 -symbol-info-module-functions
34671 ^done,symbols=
34672 [@{module="mod1",
34673 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34674 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34675 symbols=[@{line="21",name="mod1::check_all",type="void (void)",
34676 description="void mod1::check_all(void);"@}]@}]@},
34677 @{module="mod2",
34678 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34679 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34680 symbols=[@{line="30",name="mod2::check_var_i",type="void (void)",
34681 description="void mod2::check_var_i(void);"@}]@}]@},
34682 @{module="mod3",
34683 files=[@{filename="/projec/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34684 fullname="/projec/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34685 symbols=[@{line="21",name="mod3::check_all",type="void (void)",
34686 description="void mod3::check_all(void);"@},
34687 @{line="27",name="mod3::check_mod2",type="void (void)",
34688 description="void mod3::check_mod2(void);"@}]@}]@},
34689 @{module="modmany",
34690 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34691 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34692 symbols=[@{line="35",name="modmany::check_some",type="void (void)",
34693 description="void modmany::check_some(void);"@}]@}]@},
34694 @{module="moduse",
34695 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34696 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34697 symbols=[@{line="44",name="moduse::check_all",type="void (void)",
34698 description="void moduse::check_all(void);"@},
34699 @{line="49",name="moduse::check_var_x",type="void (void)",
34700 description="void moduse::check_var_x(void);"@}]@}]@}]
34701 @end group
34702 @end smallexample
34703
34704 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-module-variables} Command
34705 @findex -symbol-info-module-variables
34706 @anchor{-symbol-info-module-variables}
34707
34708 @subsubheading Synopsis
34709
34710 @smallexample
34711 -symbol-info-module-variables [--module @var{module_regexp}]
34712 [--name @var{name_regexp}]
34713 [--type @var{type_regexp}]
34714 @end smallexample
34715
34716 @noindent
34717 Return a list containing the names of all known variables within all
34718 know Fortran modules. The variables are grouped by source file and
34719 containing module, and shown with the line number on which each
34720 variable is defined.
34721
34722 The option @code{--module} only returns results for modules matching
34723 @var{module_regexp}. The option @code{--name} only returns variables
34724 whose name matches @var{name_regexp}, and @code{--type} only returns
34725 variables whose type matches @var{type_regexp}.
34726
34727 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34728
34729 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info module variables}.
34730
34731 @subsubheading Example
34732
34733 @smallexample
34734 @group
34735 (gdb)
34736 -symbol-info-module-variables
34737 ^done,symbols=
34738 [@{module="mod1",
34739 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34740 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34741 symbols=[@{line="18",name="mod1::var_const",type="integer(kind=4)",
34742 description="integer(kind=4) mod1::var_const;"@},
34743 @{line="17",name="mod1::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
34744 description="integer(kind=4) mod1::var_i;"@}]@}]@},
34745 @{module="mod2",
34746 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34747 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34748 symbols=[@{line="28",name="mod2::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
34749 description="integer(kind=4) mod2::var_i;"@}]@}]@},
34750 @{module="mod3",
34751 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34752 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34753 symbols=[@{line="18",name="mod3::mod1",type="integer(kind=4)",
34754 description="integer(kind=4) mod3::mod1;"@},
34755 @{line="17",name="mod3::mod2",type="integer(kind=4)",
34756 description="integer(kind=4) mod3::mod2;"@},
34757 @{line="19",name="mod3::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
34758 description="integer(kind=4) mod3::var_i;"@}]@}]@},
34759 @{module="modmany",
34760 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34761 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34762 symbols=[@{line="33",name="modmany::var_a",type="integer(kind=4)",
34763 description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_a;"@},
34764 @{line="33",name="modmany::var_b",type="integer(kind=4)",
34765 description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_b;"@},
34766 @{line="33",name="modmany::var_c",type="integer(kind=4)",
34767 description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_c;"@},
34768 @{line="33",name="modmany::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
34769 description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_i;"@}]@}]@},
34770 @{module="moduse",
34771 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34772 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34773 symbols=[@{line="42",name="moduse::var_x",type="integer(kind=4)",
34774 description="integer(kind=4) moduse::var_x;"@},
34775 @{line="42",name="moduse::var_y",type="integer(kind=4)",
34776 description="integer(kind=4) moduse::var_y;"@}]@}]@}]
34777 @end group
34778 @end smallexample
34779
34780 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-modules} Command
34781 @findex -symbol-info-modules
34782 @anchor{-symbol-info-modules}
34783
34784 @subsubheading Synopsis
34785
34786 @smallexample
34787 -symbol-info-modules [--name @var{name_regexp}]
34788 [--max-results @var{limit}]
34789
34790 @end smallexample
34791
34792 @noindent
34793 Return a list containing the names of all known Fortran modules. The
34794 modules are grouped by source file, and shown with the line number on
34795 which each modules is defined.
34796
34797 The option @code{--name} allows the modules returned to be filtered
34798 based the name of the module.
34799
34800 The option @code{--max-results} restricts the command to return no
34801 more than @var{limit} results. If exactly @var{limit} results are
34802 returned then there might be additional results available if a higher
34803 limit is used.
34804
34805 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34806
34807 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info modules}.
34808
34809 @subsubheading Example
34810 @smallexample
34811 @group
34812 (gdb)
34813 -symbol-info-modules
34814 ^done,symbols=
34815 @{debug=
34816 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34817 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34818 symbols=[@{line="16",name="mod1"@},
34819 @{line="22",name="mod2"@}]@},
34820 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34821 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34822 symbols=[@{line="16",name="mod3"@},
34823 @{line="22",name="modmany"@},
34824 @{line="26",name="moduse"@}]@}]@}
34825 @end group
34826 @group
34827 (gdb)
34828 -symbol-info-modules --name mod[123]
34829 ^done,symbols=
34830 @{debug=
34831 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34832 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
34833 symbols=[@{line="16",name="mod1"@},
34834 @{line="22",name="mod2"@}]@},
34835 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34836 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
34837 symbols=[@{line="16",name="mod3"@}]@}]@}
34838 @end group
34839 @end smallexample
34840
34841 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-types} Command
34842 @findex -symbol-info-types
34843 @anchor{-symbol-info-types}
34844
34845 @subsubheading Synopsis
34846
34847 @smallexample
34848 -symbol-info-types [--name @var{name_regexp}]
34849 [--max-results @var{limit}]
34850
34851 @end smallexample
34852
34853 @noindent
34854 Return a list of all defined types. The types are grouped by source
34855 file, and shown with the line number on which each user defined type
34856 is defined. Some base types are not defined in the source code but
34857 are added to the debug information by the compiler, for example
34858 @code{int}, @code{float}, etc.; these types do not have an associated
34859 line number.
34860
34861 The option @code{--name} allows the list of types returned to be
34862 filtered by name.
34863
34864 The option @code{--max-results} restricts the command to return no
34865 more than @var{limit} results. If exactly @var{limit} results are
34866 returned then there might be additional results available if a higher
34867 limit is used.
34868
34869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34870
34871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info types}.
34872
34873 @subsubheading Example
34874 @smallexample
34875 @group
34876 (gdb)
34877 -symbol-info-types
34878 ^done,symbols=
34879 @{debug=
34880 [@{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34881 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34882 symbols=[@{name="float"@},
34883 @{name="int"@},
34884 @{line="27",name="typedef int my_int_t;"@}]@},
34885 @{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34886 fullname="/project/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34887 symbols=[@{line="24",name="typedef float another_float_t;"@},
34888 @{line="23",name="typedef int another_int_t;"@},
34889 @{name="float"@},
34890 @{name="int"@}]@}]@}
34891 @end group
34892 @group
34893 (gdb)
34894 -symbol-info-types --name _int_
34895 ^done,symbols=
34896 @{debug=
34897 [@{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34898 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34899 symbols=[@{line="27",name="typedef int my_int_t;"@}]@},
34900 @{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34901 fullname="/project/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34902 symbols=[@{line="23",name="typedef int another_int_t;"@}]@}]@}
34903 @end group
34904 @end smallexample
34905
34906 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-variables} Command
34907 @findex -symbol-info-variables
34908 @anchor{-symbol-info-variables}
34909
34910 @subsubheading Synopsis
34911
34912 @smallexample
34913 -symbol-info-variables [--include-nondebug]
34914 [--type @var{type_regexp}]
34915 [--name @var{name_regexp}]
34916 [--max-results @var{limit}]
34917
34918 @end smallexample
34919
34920 @noindent
34921 Return a list containing the names and types for all global variables
34922 taken from the debug information. The variables are grouped by source
34923 file, and shown with the line number on which each variable is
34924 defined.
34925
34926 The @code{--include-nondebug} option causes the output to include
34927 data symbols from the symbol table.
34928
34929 The options @code{--type} and @code{--name} allow the symbols returned
34930 to be filtered based on either the name of the variable, or the type
34931 of the variable.
34932
34933 The option @code{--max-results} restricts the command to return no
34934 more than @var{limit} results. If exactly @var{limit} results are
34935 returned then there might be additional results available if a higher
34936 limit is used.
34937
34938 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34939
34940 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info variables}.
34941
34942 @subsubheading Example
34943 @smallexample
34944 @group
34945 (gdb)
34946 -symbol-info-variables
34947 ^done,symbols=
34948 @{debug=
34949 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34950 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34951 symbols=[@{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
34952 description="static float global_f1;"@},
34953 @{line="24",name="global_i1",type="int",
34954 description="static int global_i1;"@}]@},
34955 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34956 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34957 symbols=[@{line="21",name="global_f2",type="int",
34958 description="int global_f2;"@},
34959 @{line="20",name="global_i2",type="int",
34960 description="int global_i2;"@},
34961 @{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
34962 description="static float global_f1;"@},
34963 @{line="18",name="global_i1",type="int",
34964 description="static int global_i1;"@}]@}]@}
34965 @end group
34966 @group
34967 (gdb)
34968 -symbol-info-variables --name f1
34969 ^done,symbols=
34970 @{debug=
34971 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34972 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34973 symbols=[@{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
34974 description="static float global_f1;"@}]@},
34975 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34976 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34977 symbols=[@{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
34978 description="static float global_f1;"@}]@}]@}
34979 @end group
34980 @group
34981 (gdb)
34982 -symbol-info-variables --type float
34983 ^done,symbols=
34984 @{debug=
34985 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34986 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
34987 symbols=[@{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
34988 description="static float global_f1;"@}]@},
34989 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34990 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
34991 symbols=[@{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
34992 description="static float global_f1;"@}]@}]@}
34993 @end group
34994 @group
34995 (gdb)
34996 -symbol-info-variables --include-nondebug
34997 ^done,symbols=
34998 @{debug=
34999 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
35000 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
35001 symbols=[@{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
35002 description="static float global_f1;"@},
35003 @{line="24",name="global_i1",type="int",
35004 description="static int global_i1;"@}]@},
35005 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
35006 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
35007 symbols=[@{line="21",name="global_f2",type="int",
35008 description="int global_f2;"@},
35009 @{line="20",name="global_i2",type="int",
35010 description="int global_i2;"@},
35011 @{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
35012 description="static float global_f1;"@},
35013 @{line="18",name="global_i1",type="int",
35014 description="static int global_i1;"@}]@}],
35015 nondebug=
35016 [@{address="0x00000000004005d0",name="_IO_stdin_used"@},
35017 @{address="0x00000000004005d8",name="__dso_handle"@}
35018 ...
35019 ]@}
35020 @end group
35021 @end smallexample
35022
35023 @ignore
35024 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
35025 @findex -symbol-info-line
35026
35027 @subsubheading Synopsis
35028
35029 @smallexample
35030 -symbol-info-line
35031 @end smallexample
35032
35033 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
35034
35035 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35036
35037 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
35038 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
35039
35040 @subsubheading Example
35041 N.A.
35042
35043
35044 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
35045 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
35046
35047 @subsubheading Synopsis
35048
35049 @smallexample
35050 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
35051 @end smallexample
35052
35053 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
35054
35055 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35056
35057 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
35058
35059 @subsubheading Example
35060 N.A.
35061
35062
35063 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
35064 @findex -symbol-list-functions
35065
35066 @subsubheading Synopsis
35067
35068 @smallexample
35069 -symbol-list-functions
35070 @end smallexample
35071
35072 List the functions in the executable.
35073
35074 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35075
35076 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
35077 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
35078
35079 @subsubheading Example
35080 N.A.
35081 @end ignore
35082
35083
35084 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
35085 @findex -symbol-list-lines
35086
35087 @subsubheading Synopsis
35088
35089 @smallexample
35090 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
35091 @end smallexample
35092
35093 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
35094 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
35095 ascending PC order.
35096
35097 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35098
35099 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
35100
35101 @subsubheading Example
35102 @smallexample
35103 (gdb)
35104 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
35105 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
35106 (gdb)
35107 @end smallexample
35108
35109
35110 @ignore
35111 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
35112 @findex -symbol-list-types
35113
35114 @subsubheading Synopsis
35115
35116 @smallexample
35117 -symbol-list-types
35118 @end smallexample
35119
35120 List all the type names.
35121
35122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35123
35124 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
35125 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
35126
35127 @subsubheading Example
35128 N.A.
35129
35130
35131 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
35132 @findex -symbol-list-variables
35133
35134 @subsubheading Synopsis
35135
35136 @smallexample
35137 -symbol-list-variables
35138 @end smallexample
35139
35140 List all the global and static variable names.
35141
35142 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35143
35144 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
35145
35146 @subsubheading Example
35147 N.A.
35148
35149
35150 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
35151 @findex -symbol-locate
35152
35153 @subsubheading Synopsis
35154
35155 @smallexample
35156 -symbol-locate
35157 @end smallexample
35158
35159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35160
35161 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
35162
35163 @subsubheading Example
35164 N.A.
35165
35166
35167 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
35168 @findex -symbol-type
35169
35170 @subsubheading Synopsis
35171
35172 @smallexample
35173 -symbol-type @var{variable}
35174 @end smallexample
35175
35176 Show type of @var{variable}.
35177
35178 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35179
35180 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
35181 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
35182
35183 @subsubheading Example
35184 N.A.
35185 @end ignore
35186
35187
35188 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35189 @node GDB/MI File Commands
35190 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
35191
35192 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
35193 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
35194
35195 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
35196 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
35197
35198 @subsubheading Synopsis
35199
35200 @smallexample
35201 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
35202 @end smallexample
35203
35204 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
35205 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
35206 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
35207 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
35208 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
35209 notification.
35210
35211 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35212
35213 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
35214
35215 @subsubheading Example
35216
35217 @smallexample
35218 (gdb)
35219 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
35220 ^done
35221 (gdb)
35222 @end smallexample
35223
35224
35225 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
35226 @findex -file-exec-file
35227
35228 @subsubheading Synopsis
35229
35230 @smallexample
35231 -file-exec-file @var{file}
35232 @end smallexample
35233
35234 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
35235 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
35236 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
35237 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
35238 notification.
35239
35240 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35241
35242 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
35243
35244 @subsubheading Example
35245
35246 @smallexample
35247 (gdb)
35248 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
35249 ^done
35250 (gdb)
35251 @end smallexample
35252
35253
35254 @ignore
35255 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
35256 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
35257
35258 @subsubheading Synopsis
35259
35260 @smallexample
35261 -file-list-exec-sections
35262 @end smallexample
35263
35264 List the sections of the current executable file.
35265
35266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35267
35268 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
35269 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
35270 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
35271
35272 @subsubheading Example
35273 N.A.
35274 @end ignore
35275
35276
35277 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
35278 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
35279
35280 @subsubheading Synopsis
35281
35282 @smallexample
35283 -file-list-exec-source-file
35284 @end smallexample
35285
35286 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
35287 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
35288 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
35289 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
35290
35291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35292
35293 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
35294
35295 @subsubheading Example
35296
35297 @smallexample
35298 (gdb)
35299 123-file-list-exec-source-file
35300 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
35301 (gdb)
35302 @end smallexample
35303
35304
35305 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
35306 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
35307
35308 @subsubheading Synopsis
35309
35310 @smallexample
35311 -file-list-exec-source-files
35312 @end smallexample
35313
35314 List the source files for the current executable.
35315
35316 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
35317 name) of a source file.
35318
35319 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35320
35321 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
35322 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
35323
35324 @subsubheading Example
35325 @smallexample
35326 (gdb)
35327 -file-list-exec-source-files
35328 ^done,files=[
35329 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
35330 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
35331 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
35332 (gdb)
35333 @end smallexample
35334
35335 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
35336 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
35337
35338 @subsubheading Synopsis
35339
35340 @smallexample
35341 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
35342 @end smallexample
35343
35344 List the shared libraries in the program.
35345 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
35346 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
35347
35348 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35349
35350 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
35351 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
35352 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
35353 library. Each range has the following fields:
35354
35355 @table @samp
35356 @item from
35357 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
35358 @item to
35359 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
35360 @end table
35361
35362 @subsubheading Example
35363 @smallexample
35364 (gdb)
35365 -file-list-exec-source-files
35366 ^done,shared-libraries=[
35367 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
35368 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
35369 (gdb)
35370 @end smallexample
35371
35372
35373 @ignore
35374 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
35375 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
35376
35377 @subsubheading Synopsis
35378
35379 @smallexample
35380 -file-list-symbol-files
35381 @end smallexample
35382
35383 List symbol files.
35384
35385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35386
35387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
35388
35389 @subsubheading Example
35390 N.A.
35391 @end ignore
35392
35393
35394 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
35395 @findex -file-symbol-file
35396
35397 @subsubheading Synopsis
35398
35399 @smallexample
35400 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
35401 @end smallexample
35402
35403 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
35404 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
35405 produced, except for a completion notification.
35406
35407 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35408
35409 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
35410
35411 @subsubheading Example
35412
35413 @smallexample
35414 (gdb)
35415 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
35416 ^done
35417 (gdb)
35418 @end smallexample
35419
35420 @ignore
35421 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35422 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
35423 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
35424
35425 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
35426
35427 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
35428
35429 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
35430
35431 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
35432
35433 @c @subheading -overlay-map
35434
35435 @c @subheading -overlay-off
35436
35437 @c @subheading -overlay-on
35438
35439 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
35440
35441 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35442 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
35443 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
35444
35445 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
35446
35447 @c @subheading -signal-handle
35448
35449 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
35450
35451 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
35452 @end ignore
35453
35454
35455 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35456 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
35457 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
35458
35459
35460 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
35461 @findex -target-attach
35462
35463 @subsubheading Synopsis
35464
35465 @smallexample
35466 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
35467 @end smallexample
35468
35469 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
35470 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
35471 group, the id previously returned by
35472 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
35473
35474 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35475
35476 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
35477
35478 @subsubheading Example
35479 @smallexample
35480 (gdb)
35481 -target-attach 34
35482 =thread-created,id="1"
35483 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
35484 ^done
35485 (gdb)
35486 @end smallexample
35487
35488 @ignore
35489 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
35490 @findex -target-compare-sections
35491
35492 @subsubheading Synopsis
35493
35494 @smallexample
35495 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
35496 @end smallexample
35497
35498 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
35499 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
35500
35501 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35502
35503 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
35504
35505 @subsubheading Example
35506 N.A.
35507 @end ignore
35508
35509
35510 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
35511 @findex -target-detach
35512
35513 @subsubheading Synopsis
35514
35515 @smallexample
35516 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
35517 @end smallexample
35518
35519 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
35520 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
35521 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
35522
35523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35524
35525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
35526
35527 @subsubheading Example
35528
35529 @smallexample
35530 (gdb)
35531 -target-detach
35532 ^done
35533 (gdb)
35534 @end smallexample
35535
35536
35537 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
35538 @findex -target-disconnect
35539
35540 @subsubheading Synopsis
35541
35542 @smallexample
35543 -target-disconnect
35544 @end smallexample
35545
35546 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
35547 generally not resumed.
35548
35549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35550
35551 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
35552
35553 @subsubheading Example
35554
35555 @smallexample
35556 (gdb)
35557 -target-disconnect
35558 ^done
35559 (gdb)
35560 @end smallexample
35561
35562
35563 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
35564 @findex -target-download
35565
35566 @subsubheading Synopsis
35567
35568 @smallexample
35569 -target-download
35570 @end smallexample
35571
35572 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
35573 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
35574
35575 @table @samp
35576 @item section
35577 The name of the section.
35578 @item section-sent
35579 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
35580 @item section-size
35581 The size of the section.
35582 @item total-sent
35583 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
35584 @item total-size
35585 The size of the overall executable to download.
35586 @end table
35587
35588 @noindent
35589 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
35590 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
35591
35592 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
35593 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
35594
35595 @table @samp
35596 @item section
35597 The name of the section.
35598 @item section-size
35599 The size of the section.
35600 @item total-size
35601 The size of the overall executable to download.
35602 @end table
35603
35604 @noindent
35605 At the end, a summary is printed.
35606
35607 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35608
35609 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
35610
35611 @subsubheading Example
35612
35613 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
35614 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
35615
35616 @smallexample
35617 (gdb)
35618 -target-download
35619 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
35620 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
35621 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
35622 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
35623 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
35624 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
35625 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
35626 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
35627 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
35628 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
35629 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
35630 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
35631 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
35632 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
35633 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
35634 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
35635 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
35636 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
35637 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
35638 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
35639 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
35640 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
35641 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
35642 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
35643 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
35644 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
35645 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
35646 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
35647 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
35648 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
35649 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
35650 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
35651 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
35652 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
35653 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
35654 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
35655 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
35656 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
35657 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
35658 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
35659 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
35660 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
35661 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
35662 write-rate="429"
35663 (gdb)
35664 @end smallexample
35665
35666
35667 @ignore
35668 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
35669 @findex -target-exec-status
35670
35671 @subsubheading Synopsis
35672
35673 @smallexample
35674 -target-exec-status
35675 @end smallexample
35676
35677 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
35678 not, for instance).
35679
35680 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35681
35682 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
35683
35684 @subsubheading Example
35685 N.A.
35686
35687
35688 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
35689 @findex -target-list-available-targets
35690
35691 @subsubheading Synopsis
35692
35693 @smallexample
35694 -target-list-available-targets
35695 @end smallexample
35696
35697 List the possible targets to connect to.
35698
35699 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35700
35701 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
35702
35703 @subsubheading Example
35704 N.A.
35705
35706
35707 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
35708 @findex -target-list-current-targets
35709
35710 @subsubheading Synopsis
35711
35712 @smallexample
35713 -target-list-current-targets
35714 @end smallexample
35715
35716 Describe the current target.
35717
35718 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35719
35720 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
35721 other things).
35722
35723 @subsubheading Example
35724 N.A.
35725
35726
35727 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
35728 @findex -target-list-parameters
35729
35730 @subsubheading Synopsis
35731
35732 @smallexample
35733 -target-list-parameters
35734 @end smallexample
35735
35736 @c ????
35737 @end ignore
35738
35739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35740
35741 No equivalent.
35742
35743 @subsubheading Example
35744 N.A.
35745
35746 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
35747 @findex -target-flash-erase
35748
35749 @subsubheading Synopsis
35750
35751 @smallexample
35752 -target-flash-erase
35753 @end smallexample
35754
35755 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
35756
35757 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
35758
35759 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
35760 addresses and memory region sizes.
35761
35762 @smallexample
35763 (gdb)
35764 -target-flash-erase
35765 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
35766 (gdb)
35767 @end smallexample
35768
35769 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
35770 @findex -target-select
35771
35772 @subsubheading Synopsis
35773
35774 @smallexample
35775 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
35776 @end smallexample
35777
35778 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
35779
35780 @table @samp
35781 @item @var{type}
35782 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
35783 @item @var{parameters}
35784 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
35785 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
35786 @end table
35787
35788 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
35789 which the target program is, in the following form:
35790
35791 @smallexample
35792 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
35793 args=[@var{arg list}]
35794 @end smallexample
35795
35796 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35797
35798 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
35799
35800 @subsubheading Example
35801
35802 @smallexample
35803 (gdb)
35804 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
35805 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
35806 (gdb)
35807 @end smallexample
35808
35809 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35810 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
35811 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
35812
35813
35814 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
35815 @findex -target-file-put
35816
35817 @subsubheading Synopsis
35818
35819 @smallexample
35820 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
35821 @end smallexample
35822
35823 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
35824 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
35825
35826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35827
35828 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
35829
35830 @subsubheading Example
35831
35832 @smallexample
35833 (gdb)
35834 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
35835 ^done
35836 (gdb)
35837 @end smallexample
35838
35839
35840 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
35841 @findex -target-file-get
35842
35843 @subsubheading Synopsis
35844
35845 @smallexample
35846 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
35847 @end smallexample
35848
35849 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
35850 on the host system.
35851
35852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35853
35854 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
35855
35856 @subsubheading Example
35857
35858 @smallexample
35859 (gdb)
35860 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
35861 ^done
35862 (gdb)
35863 @end smallexample
35864
35865
35866 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
35867 @findex -target-file-delete
35868
35869 @subsubheading Synopsis
35870
35871 @smallexample
35872 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
35873 @end smallexample
35874
35875 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
35876
35877 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35878
35879 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
35880
35881 @subsubheading Example
35882
35883 @smallexample
35884 (gdb)
35885 -target-file-delete remotefile
35886 ^done
35887 (gdb)
35888 @end smallexample
35889
35890
35891 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35892 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
35893 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
35894
35895 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
35896 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
35897
35898 @subsubheading Synopsis
35899
35900 @smallexample
35901 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
35902 @end smallexample
35903
35904 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
35905 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
35906 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
35907
35908 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35909
35910 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
35911
35912 @subsubheading Result
35913
35914 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
35915 defined for each exception:
35916
35917 @table @samp
35918 @item name
35919 The name of the exception.
35920
35921 @item address
35922 The address of the exception.
35923
35924 @end table
35925
35926 @subsubheading Example
35927
35928 @smallexample
35929 -info-ada-exceptions aint
35930 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
35931 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
35932 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
35933 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
35934 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
35935 @end smallexample
35936
35937 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
35938
35939 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
35940 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
35941 Catchpoint Commands}.
35942
35943
35944 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35945 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
35946 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
35947
35948 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
35949 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
35950 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
35951 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
35952
35953 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
35954 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
35955 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
35956
35957 @subsubheading Synopsis
35958
35959 @smallexample
35960 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
35961 @end smallexample
35962
35963 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
35964
35965 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
35966 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
35967 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
35968 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
35969 dash.
35970
35971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35972
35973 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
35974
35975 @subsubheading Result
35976
35977 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
35978
35979 @table @samp
35980 @item exists
35981 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
35982 @code{"false"} otherwise.
35983
35984 @end table
35985
35986 @subsubheading Example
35987
35988 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
35989
35990 @smallexample
35991 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
35992 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
35993 @end smallexample
35994
35995 @noindent
35996 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
35997 to the debugger:
35998
35999 @smallexample
36000 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
36001 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
36002 @end smallexample
36003
36004 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
36005 @findex -list-features
36006 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
36007
36008 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
36009 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
36010 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
36011 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
36012 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
36013 startup.
36014
36015 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
36016 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
36017 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
36018 is given below.
36019
36020 Example output:
36021
36022 @smallexample
36023 (gdb) -list-features
36024 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
36025 @end smallexample
36026
36027 The current list of features is:
36028
36029 @ftable @samp
36030 @item frozen-varobjs
36031 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
36032 as possible presence of the @code{frozen} field in the output
36033 of @code{-varobj-create}.
36034 @item pending-breakpoints
36035 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
36036 command.
36037 @item python
36038 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
36039 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
36040 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
36041 @item thread-info
36042 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
36043 @item data-read-memory-bytes
36044 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
36045 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
36046 @item breakpoint-notifications
36047 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
36048 CLI will be announced via async records.
36049 @item ada-task-info
36050 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
36051 @item language-option
36052 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
36053 option (@pxref{Context management}).
36054 @item info-gdb-mi-command
36055 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
36056 @item undefined-command-error-code
36057 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
36058 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
36059 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
36060 @item exec-run-start-option
36061 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
36062 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
36063 @item data-disassemble-a-option
36064 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
36065 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
36066 @end ftable
36067
36068 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
36069 @findex -list-target-features
36070
36071 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
36072 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
36073 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
36074 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
36075 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
36076 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
36077 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
36078 Example output:
36079
36080 @smallexample
36081 (gdb) -list-target-features
36082 ^done,result=["async"]
36083 @end smallexample
36084
36085 The current list of features is:
36086
36087 @table @samp
36088 @item async
36089 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
36090 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
36091 while the target is running.
36092
36093 @item reverse
36094 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
36095 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36096
36097 @end table
36098
36099 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
36100 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
36101 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
36102
36103 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
36104
36105 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
36106 @findex -gdb-exit
36107
36108 @subsubheading Synopsis
36109
36110 @smallexample
36111 -gdb-exit
36112 @end smallexample
36113
36114 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
36115
36116 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36117
36118 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
36119
36120 @subsubheading Example
36121
36122 @smallexample
36123 (gdb)
36124 -gdb-exit
36125 ^exit
36126 @end smallexample
36127
36128
36129 @ignore
36130 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
36131 @findex -exec-abort
36132
36133 @subsubheading Synopsis
36134
36135 @smallexample
36136 -exec-abort
36137 @end smallexample
36138
36139 Kill the inferior running program.
36140
36141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36142
36143 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
36144
36145 @subsubheading Example
36146 N.A.
36147 @end ignore
36148
36149
36150 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
36151 @findex -gdb-set
36152
36153 @subsubheading Synopsis
36154
36155 @smallexample
36156 -gdb-set
36157 @end smallexample
36158
36159 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
36160 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
36161
36162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36163
36164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
36165
36166 @subsubheading Example
36167
36168 @smallexample
36169 (gdb)
36170 -gdb-set $foo=3
36171 ^done
36172 (gdb)
36173 @end smallexample
36174
36175
36176 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
36177 @findex -gdb-show
36178
36179 @subsubheading Synopsis
36180
36181 @smallexample
36182 -gdb-show
36183 @end smallexample
36184
36185 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
36186
36187 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36188
36189 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
36190
36191 @subsubheading Example
36192
36193 @smallexample
36194 (gdb)
36195 -gdb-show annotate
36196 ^done,value="0"
36197 (gdb)
36198 @end smallexample
36199
36200 @c @subheading -gdb-source
36201
36202
36203 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
36204 @findex -gdb-version
36205
36206 @subsubheading Synopsis
36207
36208 @smallexample
36209 -gdb-version
36210 @end smallexample
36211
36212 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
36213
36214 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36215
36216 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
36217 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
36218
36219 @subsubheading Example
36220
36221 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
36222 @c box in TeX.
36223 @smallexample
36224 (gdb)
36225 -gdb-version
36226 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
36227 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
36228 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
36229 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
36230 ~ certain conditions.
36231 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
36232 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
36233 ~ details.
36234 ~This GDB was configured as
36235 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
36236 ^done
36237 (gdb)
36238 @end smallexample
36239
36240 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
36241 @findex -list-thread-groups
36242
36243 @subheading Synopsis
36244
36245 @smallexample
36246 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
36247 @end smallexample
36248
36249 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
36250 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
36251 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
36252 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
36253 top-level thread groups.
36254
36255 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
36256 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
36257 available on the target.
36258
36259 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
36260 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
36261 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
36262 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
36263 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
36264 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
36265 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
36266 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
36267
36268 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
36269 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
36270 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
36271 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
36272 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
36273 @samp{threads} field.
36274
36275 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
36276 the following caveats:
36277
36278 @itemize @bullet
36279 @item
36280 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
36281 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
36282 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
36283
36284 @item
36285 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
36286 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
36287 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
36288 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
36289 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
36290 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
36291
36292 @end itemize
36293
36294 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
36295 have the following fields:
36296
36297 @table @code
36298 @item id
36299 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
36300 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
36301 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
36302
36303 @item type
36304 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
36305 valid type.
36306
36307 @item pid
36308 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
36309 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
36310
36311 @item exit-code
36312 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
36313 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
36314 only if the process is not running.
36315
36316 @item num_children
36317 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
36318 absent for an available thread group.
36319
36320 @item threads
36321 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
36322 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
36323 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
36324
36325 @item cores
36326 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
36327 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
36328 such information is not available.
36329
36330 @item executable
36331 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
36332 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
36333 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
36334
36335 @end table
36336
36337 @subheading Example
36338
36339 @smallexample
36340 @value{GDBP}
36341 -list-thread-groups
36342 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
36343 -list-thread-groups 17
36344 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
36345 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
36346 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
36347 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
36348 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
36349 -list-thread-groups --available
36350 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
36351 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
36352 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
36353 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
36354 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
36355 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
36356 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
36357 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
36358 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
36359 @end smallexample
36360
36361 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
36362 @findex -info-os
36363
36364 @subsubheading Synopsis
36365
36366 @smallexample
36367 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
36368 @end smallexample
36369
36370 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
36371 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
36372 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
36373 of data of that type.
36374
36375 The types of information available depend on the target operating
36376 system.
36377
36378 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36379
36380 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
36381
36382 @subsubheading Example
36383
36384 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
36385 like this:
36386
36387 @smallexample
36388 @value{GDBP}
36389 -info-os
36390 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
36391 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
36392 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
36393 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
36394 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
36395 col2="CPUs"@},
36396 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
36397 col2="File descriptors"@},
36398 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
36399 col2="Kernel modules"@},
36400 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
36401 col2="Message queues"@},
36402 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
36403 col2="Processes"@},
36404 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
36405 col2="Process groups"@},
36406 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
36407 col2="Semaphores"@},
36408 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
36409 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
36410 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
36411 col2="Sockets"@},
36412 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
36413 col2="Threads"@}]
36414 @value{GDBP}
36415 -info-os processes
36416 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
36417 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
36418 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
36419 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
36420 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
36421 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
36422 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
36423 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
36424 ...
36425 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
36426 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
36427 (gdb)
36428 @end smallexample
36429
36430 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
36431 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
36432 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
36433 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
36434 @code{info os} omits it.)
36435
36436 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
36437 @findex -add-inferior
36438
36439 @subheading Synopsis
36440
36441 @smallexample
36442 -add-inferior
36443 @end smallexample
36444
36445 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors Connections and Programs}). The created
36446 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
36447 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
36448 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
36449 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
36450 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
36451
36452 @subheading Example
36453
36454 @smallexample
36455 @value{GDBP}
36456 -add-inferior
36457 ^done,inferior="i3"
36458 @end smallexample
36459
36460 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
36461 @findex -interpreter-exec
36462
36463 @subheading Synopsis
36464
36465 @smallexample
36466 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
36467 @end smallexample
36468 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
36469
36470 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
36471
36472 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
36473
36474 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
36475
36476 @subheading Example
36477
36478 @smallexample
36479 (gdb)
36480 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
36481 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
36482 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
36483 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
36484 ^done
36485 (gdb)
36486 @end smallexample
36487
36488 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
36489 @findex -inferior-tty-set
36490
36491 @subheading Synopsis
36492
36493 @smallexample
36494 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
36495 @end smallexample
36496
36497 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
36498
36499 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
36500
36501 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
36502
36503 @subheading Example
36504
36505 @smallexample
36506 (gdb)
36507 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
36508 ^done
36509 (gdb)
36510 @end smallexample
36511
36512 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
36513 @findex -inferior-tty-show
36514
36515 @subheading Synopsis
36516
36517 @smallexample
36518 -inferior-tty-show
36519 @end smallexample
36520
36521 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
36522
36523 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
36524
36525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
36526
36527 @subheading Example
36528
36529 @smallexample
36530 (gdb)
36531 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
36532 ^done
36533 (gdb)
36534 -inferior-tty-show
36535 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
36536 (gdb)
36537 @end smallexample
36538
36539 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
36540 @findex -enable-timings
36541
36542 @subheading Synopsis
36543
36544 @smallexample
36545 -enable-timings [yes | no]
36546 @end smallexample
36547
36548 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
36549 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
36550 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
36551 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
36552
36553 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
36554
36555 No equivalent.
36556
36557 @subheading Example
36558
36559 @smallexample
36560 (gdb)
36561 -enable-timings
36562 ^done
36563 (gdb)
36564 -break-insert main
36565 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
36566 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
36567 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
36568 times="0"@},
36569 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
36570 (gdb)
36571 -enable-timings no
36572 ^done
36573 (gdb)
36574 -exec-run
36575 ^running
36576 (gdb)
36577 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
36578 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
36579 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
36580 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
36581 (gdb)
36582 @end smallexample
36583
36584 @subheading The @code{-complete} Command
36585 @findex -complete
36586
36587 @subheading Synopsis
36588
36589 @smallexample
36590 -complete @var{command}
36591 @end smallexample
36592
36593 Show a list of completions for partially typed CLI @var{command}.
36594
36595 This command is intended for @sc{gdb/mi} frontends that cannot use two separate
36596 CLI and MI channels --- for example: because of lack of PTYs like on Windows or
36597 because @value{GDBN} is used remotely via a SSH connection.
36598
36599 @subheading Result
36600
36601 The result consists of two or three fields:
36602
36603 @table @samp
36604 @item completion
36605 This field contains the completed @var{command}. If @var{command}
36606 has no known completions, this field is omitted.
36607
36608 @item matches
36609 This field contains a (possibly empty) array of matches. It is always present.
36610
36611 @item max_completions_reached
36612 This field contains @code{1} if number of known completions is above
36613 @code{max-completions} limit (@pxref{Completion}), otherwise it contains
36614 @code{0}. It is always present.
36615
36616 @end table
36617
36618 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
36619
36620 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{complete}.
36621
36622 @subheading Example
36623
36624 @smallexample
36625 (gdb)
36626 -complete br
36627 ^done,completion="break",
36628 matches=["break","break-range"],
36629 max_completions_reached="0"
36630 (gdb)
36631 -complete "b ma"
36632 ^done,completion="b ma",
36633 matches=["b madvise","b main"],max_completions_reached="0"
36634 (gdb)
36635 -complete "b push_b"
36636 ^done,completion="b push_back(",
36637 matches=[
36638 "b A::push_back(void*)",
36639 "b std::string::push_back(char)",
36640 "b std::vector<int, std::allocator<int> >::push_back(int&&)"],
36641 max_completions_reached="0"
36642 (gdb)
36643 -complete "nonexist"
36644 ^done,matches=[],max_completions_reached="0"
36645 (gdb)
36646
36647 @end smallexample
36648
36649 @node Annotations
36650 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
36651
36652 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
36653 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
36654 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
36655 relatively high level.
36656
36657 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
36658 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
36659
36660 @ignore
36661 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
36662 @end ignore
36663
36664 @menu
36665 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
36666 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
36667 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
36668 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
36669 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
36670 * Annotations for Running::
36671 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
36672 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
36673 @end menu
36674
36675 @node Annotations Overview
36676 @section What is an Annotation?
36677 @cindex annotations
36678
36679 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
36680 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
36681 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
36682 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
36683 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
36684 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
36685 cannot contain newline characters.
36686
36687 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
36688 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
36689 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
36690 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
36691 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
36692 means those three characters as output.
36693
36694 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
36695 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
36696 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
36697 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
36698 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
36699 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
36700 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
36701 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
36702 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
36703
36704 @table @code
36705 @kindex set annotate
36706 @item set annotate @var{level}
36707 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
36708 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
36709
36710 @item show annotate
36711 @kindex show annotate
36712 Show the current annotation level.
36713 @end table
36714
36715 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
36716
36717 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
36718
36719 @smallexample
36720 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
36721 GNU gdb 6.0
36722 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
36723 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
36724 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
36725 under certain conditions.
36726 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
36727 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
36728 for details.
36729 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
36730
36731 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
36732 (@value{GDBP})
36733 ^Z^Zprompt
36734 @kbd{quit}
36735
36736 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
36737 $
36738 @end smallexample
36739
36740 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
36741 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
36742 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
36743 output from @value{GDBN}.
36744
36745 @node Server Prefix
36746 @section The Server Prefix
36747 @cindex server prefix
36748
36749 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
36750 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
36751 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
36752 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
36753 a transparent manner.
36754
36755 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
36756 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
36757 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
36758 @code{print} command.
36759
36760 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
36761 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
36762
36763 @node Prompting
36764 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
36765
36766 @cindex annotations for prompts
36767 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
36768 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
36769 over, etc.
36770
36771 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
36772 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
36773 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
36774 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
36775 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
36776 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
36777 features the following annotations:
36778
36779 @smallexample
36780 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
36781 ^Z^Zprompt
36782 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
36783 @end smallexample
36784
36785 The input types are
36786
36787 @table @code
36788 @findex pre-prompt annotation
36789 @findex prompt annotation
36790 @findex post-prompt annotation
36791 @item prompt
36792 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
36793
36794 @findex pre-commands annotation
36795 @findex commands annotation
36796 @findex post-commands annotation
36797 @item commands
36798 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
36799 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
36800
36801 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
36802 @findex overload-choice annotation
36803 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
36804 @item overload-choice
36805 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
36806
36807 @findex pre-query annotation
36808 @findex query annotation
36809 @findex post-query annotation
36810 @item query
36811 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
36812
36813 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
36814 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
36815 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
36816 @item prompt-for-continue
36817 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
36818 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
36819 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
36820 presence of annotations.
36821 @end table
36822
36823 @node Errors
36824 @section Errors
36825 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
36826
36827 @findex quit annotation
36828 @smallexample
36829 ^Z^Zquit
36830 @end smallexample
36831
36832 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
36833
36834 @findex error annotation
36835 @smallexample
36836 ^Z^Zerror
36837 @end smallexample
36838
36839 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
36840
36841 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
36842 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
36843 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
36844 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
36845 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
36846 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
36847 to the top level.
36848
36849 @findex error-begin annotation
36850 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
36851
36852 @smallexample
36853 ^Z^Zerror-begin
36854 @end smallexample
36855
36856 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
36857 message.
36858
36859 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
36860 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
36861 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
36862
36863 @node Invalidation
36864 @section Invalidation Notices
36865
36866 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
36867 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
36868 changed.
36869
36870 @table @code
36871 @findex frames-invalid annotation
36872 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
36873
36874 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
36875 have changed.
36876
36877 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
36878 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
36879
36880 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
36881 deleted a breakpoint.
36882 @end table
36883
36884 @node Annotations for Running
36885 @section Running the Program
36886 @cindex annotations for running programs
36887
36888 @findex starting annotation
36889 @findex stopping annotation
36890 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
36891 @code{step} or @code{continue},
36892
36893 @smallexample
36894 ^Z^Zstarting
36895 @end smallexample
36896
36897 is output. When the program stops,
36898
36899 @smallexample
36900 ^Z^Zstopped
36901 @end smallexample
36902
36903 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
36904 annotations describe how the program stopped.
36905
36906 @table @code
36907 @findex exited annotation
36908 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
36909 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
36910 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
36911
36912 @findex signalled annotation
36913 @findex signal-name annotation
36914 @findex signal-name-end annotation
36915 @findex signal-string annotation
36916 @findex signal-string-end annotation
36917 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
36918 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
36919 annotation continues:
36920
36921 @smallexample
36922 @var{intro-text}
36923 ^Z^Zsignal-name
36924 @var{name}
36925 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
36926 @var{middle-text}
36927 ^Z^Zsignal-string
36928 @var{string}
36929 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
36930 @var{end-text}
36931 @end smallexample
36932
36933 @noindent
36934 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
36935 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
36936 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
36937 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
36938 user's benefit and have no particular format.
36939
36940 @findex signal annotation
36941 @item ^Z^Zsignal
36942 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
36943 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
36944 terminated with it.
36945
36946 @findex breakpoint annotation
36947 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
36948 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
36949
36950 @findex watchpoint annotation
36951 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
36952 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
36953 @end table
36954
36955 @node Source Annotations
36956 @section Displaying Source
36957 @cindex annotations for source display
36958
36959 @findex source annotation
36960 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
36961
36962 @smallexample
36963 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
36964 @end smallexample
36965
36966 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
36967 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
36968 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
36969 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
36970 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
36971 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
36972 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
36973 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
36974 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
36975 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
36976 depend on the language).
36977
36978 @node JIT Interface
36979 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
36980 @cindex just-in-time compilation
36981 @cindex JIT compilation interface
36982
36983 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
36984 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
36985 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
36986 performance while maintaining platform independence.
36987
36988 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
36989 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
36990 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
36991 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
36992 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
36993 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
36994
36995 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
36996 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
36997 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
36998 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
36999 LLVM JIT.
37000
37001 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
37002 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
37003 variable and calling a function at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
37004 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
37005 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
37006 out about additional code.
37007
37008 @menu
37009 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
37010 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
37011 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
37012 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
37013 @end menu
37014
37015 @node Declarations
37016 @section JIT Declarations
37017
37018 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
37019 implement the interface:
37020
37021 @smallexample
37022 typedef enum
37023 @{
37024 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
37025 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
37026 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
37027 @} jit_actions_t;
37028
37029 struct jit_code_entry
37030 @{
37031 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
37032 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
37033 const char *symfile_addr;
37034 uint64_t symfile_size;
37035 @};
37036
37037 struct jit_descriptor
37038 @{
37039 uint32_t version;
37040 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
37041 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
37042 uint32_t action_flag;
37043 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
37044 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
37045 @};
37046
37047 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
37048 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
37049
37050 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
37051 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
37052 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
37053 @end smallexample
37054
37055 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
37056 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
37057 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
37058
37059 @node Registering Code
37060 @section Registering Code
37061
37062 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
37063
37064 @itemize @bullet
37065 @item
37066 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
37067 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
37068
37069 @item
37070 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
37071 file.
37072
37073 @item
37074 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
37075
37076 @item
37077 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
37078
37079 @item
37080 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
37081 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
37082 @end itemize
37083
37084 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
37085 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
37086 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
37087 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
37088
37089 @node Unregistering Code
37090 @section Unregistering Code
37091
37092 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
37093
37094 @itemize @bullet
37095 @item
37096 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
37097
37098 @item
37099 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
37100
37101 @item
37102 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
37103 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
37104 @end itemize
37105
37106 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
37107 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
37108
37109 @node Custom Debug Info
37110 @section Custom Debug Info
37111 @cindex custom JIT debug info
37112 @cindex JIT debug info reader
37113
37114 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
37115 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
37116 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
37117 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
37118 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
37119 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
37120 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
37121 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
37122 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
37123
37124 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
37125 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
37126 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
37127 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
37128 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
37129 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
37130 compiler.
37131
37132 @menu
37133 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
37134 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
37135 @end menu
37136
37137 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
37138 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
37139 @kindex jit-reader-load
37140 @kindex jit-reader-unload
37141
37142 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
37143 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
37144
37145 @table @code
37146 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
37147 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
37148 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
37149 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
37150 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
37151 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
37152 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
37153
37154 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
37155 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
37156 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
37157 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
37158 @code{jit-reader-load}.
37159
37160 @item jit-reader-unload
37161 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
37162
37163 @end table
37164
37165 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
37166 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
37167 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
37168
37169 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
37170 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
37171
37172 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
37173 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
37174 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
37175 the system include directory.
37176
37177 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
37178 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
37179 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
37180
37181 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
37182 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
37183
37184 @findex gdb_init_reader
37185 @smallexample
37186 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
37187 @end smallexample
37188
37189 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
37190
37191 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
37192 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
37193 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
37194 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
37195 (@code{get_frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
37196 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
37197
37198 @smallexample
37199 struct gdb_reader_funcs
37200 @{
37201 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
37202 int reader_version;
37203
37204 /* For use by the reader. */
37205 void *priv_data;
37206
37207 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
37208 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
37209 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
37210 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
37211 @};
37212 @end smallexample
37213
37214 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
37215 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
37216
37217 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
37218 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
37219 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
37220 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
37221 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
37222 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
37223 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
37224 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
37225 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
37226 target's address space.
37227
37228 @node In-Process Agent
37229 @chapter In-Process Agent
37230 @cindex debugging agent
37231 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
37232 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
37233 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
37234 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
37235 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
37236 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
37237 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
37238 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
37239 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
37240 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
37241 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
37242 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
37243 behavior without interrupting it.
37244
37245 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
37246 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
37247 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
37248 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
37249 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
37250 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
37251 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
37252 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
37253 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
37254
37255 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
37256 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
37257 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
37258 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
37259
37260 @anchor{Control Agent}
37261 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
37262 debugging with the following commands:
37263
37264 @table @code
37265 @kindex set agent on
37266 @item set agent on
37267 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
37268 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
37269 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
37270 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
37271 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
37272 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
37273
37274 @kindex set agent off
37275 @item set agent off
37276 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
37277 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
37278
37279 @kindex show agent
37280 @item show agent
37281 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
37282 the in-process agent.
37283 @end table
37284
37285 @menu
37286 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
37287 @end menu
37288
37289 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
37290 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
37291 @cindex in-process agent protocol
37292
37293 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
37294 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
37295 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
37296 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
37297 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
37298 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
37299 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
37300 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
37301 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
37302
37303 @menu
37304 * IPA Protocol Objects::
37305 * IPA Protocol Commands::
37306 @end menu
37307
37308 @node IPA Protocol Objects
37309 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
37310 @cindex ipa protocol objects
37311
37312 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
37313 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
37314
37315 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
37316 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
37317 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
37318 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
37319
37320 @enumerate
37321 @item
37322 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
37323 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
37324 @item
37325 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
37326 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
37327 the other one.
37328 @end enumerate
37329
37330 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
37331
37332 @enumerate
37333 @item
37334 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
37335 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
37336 @anchor{agent expression object}
37337 @item
37338 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
37339 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
37340 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
37341 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
37342 @item
37343 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37344 @anchor{tracepoint object}
37345
37346 @end enumerate
37347
37348 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
37349 object:
37350
37351 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
37352 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
37353 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
37354 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
37355 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
37356 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
37357 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
37358 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
37359 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
37360 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
37361 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
37362 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
37363 memory address for collecting.
37364 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
37365 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
37366 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
37367 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
37368 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
37369 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
37370 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
37371 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
37372 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
37373 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
37374 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
37375 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
37376 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
37377 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
37378 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
37379 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
37380 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
37381 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
37382 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
37383 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
37384 @ref{agent expression object}
37385 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
37386 @ref{agent expression object}
37387 @item actions @tab variable
37388 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
37389 @end multitable
37390
37391 @node IPA Protocol Commands
37392 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
37393 @cindex ipa protocol commands
37394
37395 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
37396 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
37397
37398 @table @samp
37399
37400 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
37401 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
37402 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
37403 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
37404 in IPA finally.
37405
37406 Replies:
37407 @table @samp
37408 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
37409 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
37410 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
37411 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
37412 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
37413 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
37414 @item E @var{NN}
37415 for an error
37416
37417 @end table
37418
37419 @item close
37420 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
37421 is about to kill inferiors.
37422
37423 @item qTfSTM
37424 @xref{qTfSTM}.
37425 @item qTsSTM
37426 @xref{qTsSTM}.
37427 @item qTSTMat
37428 @xref{qTSTMat}.
37429 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
37430 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
37431
37432 Replies:
37433 @table @samp
37434 @item E @var{NN}
37435 for an error
37436 @end table
37437 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
37438 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
37439 @end table
37440
37441 @node GDB Bugs
37442 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
37443 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
37444 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
37445
37446 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
37447
37448 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
37449 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
37450 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
37451 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
37452
37453 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
37454 information that enables us to fix the bug.
37455
37456 @menu
37457 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
37458 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
37459 @end menu
37460
37461 @node Bug Criteria
37462 @section Have You Found a Bug?
37463 @cindex bug criteria
37464
37465 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
37466
37467 @itemize @bullet
37468 @cindex fatal signal
37469 @cindex debugger crash
37470 @cindex crash of debugger
37471 @item
37472 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
37473 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
37474
37475 @cindex error on valid input
37476 @item
37477 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
37478 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
37479 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
37480
37481 @cindex invalid input
37482 @item
37483 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
37484 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
37485 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
37486 for traditional practice''.
37487
37488 @item
37489 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
37490 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
37491 @end itemize
37492
37493 @node Bug Reporting
37494 @section How to Report Bugs
37495 @cindex bug reports
37496 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
37497
37498 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
37499 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
37500 contact that organization first.
37501
37502 You can find contact information for many support companies and
37503 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
37504 distribution.
37505 @c should add a web page ref...
37506
37507 @ifset BUGURL
37508 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
37509 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
37510 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
37511 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
37512 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
37513 be used.
37514
37515 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
37516 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
37517 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
37518 @samp{bug-gdb}.
37519
37520 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
37521 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
37522 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
37523 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
37524 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
37525 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
37526 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
37527 bug reports to the mailing list.
37528 @end ifset
37529 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
37530 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
37531 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
37532 @end ifclear
37533 @end ifset
37534
37535 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
37536 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
37537 fact or leave it out, state it!
37538
37539 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
37540 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
37541 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
37542 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
37543 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
37544 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
37545 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
37546 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
37547 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
37548
37549 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
37550 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
37551 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
37552 self-contained.
37553
37554 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
37555 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
37556 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
37557 bugs properly.
37558
37559 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
37560
37561 @itemize @bullet
37562 @item
37563 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
37564 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
37565 version}.
37566
37567 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
37568 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
37569
37570 @item
37571 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
37572 version number.
37573
37574 @item
37575 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
37576 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
37577 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
37578 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
37579
37580 @item
37581 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
37582 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
37583
37584 @item
37585 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
37586 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
37587 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
37588 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
37589 those compilers.
37590
37591 @item
37592 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
37593 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
37594 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
37595 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
37596
37597 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
37598 and then we might not encounter the bug.
37599
37600 @item
37601 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
37602 reproduce the bug.
37603
37604 @item
37605 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
37606 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
37607
37608 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
37609 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
37610 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
37611 a chance to make a mistake.
37612
37613 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
37614 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
37615 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
37616 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
37617 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
37618 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
37619 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
37620 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
37621
37622 @pindex script
37623 @cindex recording a session script
37624 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
37625 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
37626 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
37627 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
37628
37629 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
37630 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
37631
37632 @item
37633 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
37634 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
37635 it by context, not by line number.
37636
37637 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
37638 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
37639
37640 @end itemize
37641
37642 Here are some things that are not necessary:
37643
37644 @itemize @bullet
37645 @item
37646 A description of the envelope of the bug.
37647
37648 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
37649 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
37650 changes will not affect it.
37651
37652 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
37653 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
37654 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
37655 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
37656
37657 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
37658 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
37659 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
37660 less time, and so on.
37661
37662 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
37663 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
37664
37665 @item
37666 A patch for the bug.
37667
37668 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
37669 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
37670 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
37671 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
37672
37673 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
37674 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
37675 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
37676 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
37677
37678 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
37679 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
37680 help us to understand.
37681
37682 @item
37683 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
37684
37685 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
37686 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
37687 @end itemize
37688
37689 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
37690 @c and consists of the two following files:
37691 @c rluser.texi
37692 @c hsuser.texi
37693 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
37694 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
37695 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
37696 @include rluser.texi
37697 @include hsuser.texi
37698 @end ifclear
37699
37700 @node In Memoriam
37701 @appendix In Memoriam
37702
37703 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
37704 contributors:
37705
37706 @table @code
37707 @item Fred Fish
37708 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
37709 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
37710 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
37711
37712 @item Michael Snyder
37713 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
37714 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
37715 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
37716 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
37717 @end table
37718
37719 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
37720 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
37721
37722 @node Formatting Documentation
37723 @appendix Formatting Documentation
37724
37725 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
37726 @cindex reference card
37727 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
37728 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
37729 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
37730 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
37731 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
37732 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
37733
37734 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
37735 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
37736
37737 @smallexample
37738 make refcard.dvi
37739 @end smallexample
37740
37741 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
37742 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
37743 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
37744 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
37745 your @sc{dvi} output program.
37746
37747 @cindex documentation
37748
37749 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
37750 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
37751 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
37752 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
37753 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
37754 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
37755
37756 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
37757 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
37758 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
37759 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
37760 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
37761 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
37762 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
37763 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
37764
37765 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
37766 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
37767 @code{makeinfo}.
37768
37769 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
37770 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
37771 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
37772
37773 @smallexample
37774 cd gdb
37775 make gdb.info
37776 @end smallexample
37777
37778 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
37779 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
37780 Texinfo definitions file.
37781
37782 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
37783 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
37784 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
37785 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
37786 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
37787 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
37788 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
37789
37790 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
37791 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
37792 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
37793 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
37794 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
37795 directory.
37796
37797 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
37798 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
37799 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
37800 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
37801
37802 @smallexample
37803 make gdb.dvi
37804 @end smallexample
37805
37806 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
37807
37808 @node Installing GDB
37809 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
37810 @cindex installation
37811
37812 @menu
37813 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
37814 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
37815 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
37816 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
37817 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
37818 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
37819 @end menu
37820
37821 @node Requirements
37822 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
37823 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
37824
37825 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
37826 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
37827
37828 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
37829 @table @asis
37830 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
37831 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
37832 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
37833
37834 @item GNU make
37835 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
37836 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
37837
37838 @item GMP (The GNU Multiple Precision Arithmetic Library)
37839 @value{GDBN} now uses GMP to perform some of its arithmetics.
37840 This library may be included with your operating system distribution;
37841 if it is not, you can get the latest version from
37842 @url{https://gmplib.org/}. If GMP is installed at an unusual path,
37843 you can use the @option{--with-libgmp-prefix} option to specify
37844 its location.
37845
37846 @end table
37847
37848 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
37849 @table @asis
37850 @item Expat
37851 @anchor{Expat}
37852 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
37853 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
37854 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
37855 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
37856 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
37857 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
37858
37859 Expat is used for:
37860
37861 @itemize @bullet
37862 @item
37863 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
37864 @item
37865 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
37866 @item
37867 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
37868 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
37869 @item
37870 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
37871 @item
37872 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
37873 @item
37874 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
37875 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
37876 @end itemize
37877
37878 @item Guile
37879 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
37880 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
37881 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
37882 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
37883 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
37884 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
37885
37886 @item iconv
37887 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
37888 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
37889 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
37890 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
37891
37892 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
37893 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
37894 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
37895 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
37896 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
37897
37898 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
37899 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
37900 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
37901 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
37902 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
37903
37904 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
37905 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
37906 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
37907 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
37908 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
37909 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
37910 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
37911 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
37912 code to @samp{libiconv}.
37913
37914 @item lzma
37915 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
37916 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
37917 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
37918 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
37919 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
37920 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
37921 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
37922
37923 @item MPFR
37924 @anchor{MPFR}
37925 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
37926 library. This library may be included with your operating system
37927 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
37928 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
37929 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
37930 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
37931 option to specify its location.
37932
37933 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
37934 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
37935 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
37936 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
37937
37938 @item Python
37939 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
37940 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
37941 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
37942 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
37943 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
37944 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
37945 installation of Python.
37946
37947 @item zlib
37948 @cindex compressed debug sections
37949 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
37950 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
37951 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
37952 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
37953 information in such binaries.
37954
37955 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
37956 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
37957 @url{http://zlib.net}.
37958 @end table
37959
37960 @node Running Configure
37961 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
37962 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
37963 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
37964 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
37965 build the @code{gdb} program.
37966 @iftex
37967 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
37968 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
37969 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
37970 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
37971 @end iftex
37972
37973 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
37974 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
37975 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
37976
37977 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
37978 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
37979
37980 @table @code
37981 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
37982 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
37983
37984 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
37985 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
37986
37987 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
37988 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
37989
37990 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
37991 @sc{gnu} include files
37992
37993 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
37994 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
37995
37996 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
37997 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
37998
37999 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
38000 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
38001 @end table
38002
38003 There may be other subdirectories as well.
38004
38005 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
38006 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
38007 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
38008
38009 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
38010 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
38011 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
38012 argument.
38013
38014 For example:
38015
38016 @smallexample
38017 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
38018 ./configure
38019 make
38020 @end smallexample
38021
38022 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
38023 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
38024 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
38025 directories.
38026
38027 @need 750
38028 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
38029 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
38030 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
38031
38032 @smallexample
38033 sh configure
38034 @end smallexample
38035
38036 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
38037 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
38038 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
38039 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
38040 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
38041 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
38042 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
38043 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
38044 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
38045
38046 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
38047 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
38048 install it with @code{make install}.
38049
38050 @node Separate Objdir
38051 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
38052
38053 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
38054 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
38055 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
38056 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
38057 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
38058 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
38059 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
38060 program specified there.
38061
38062 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
38063 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
38064 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
38065 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
38066 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
38067 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
38068
38069 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
38070 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
38071
38072 @smallexample
38073 @group
38074 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
38075 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
38076 cd ../gdb-sun4
38077 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
38078 make
38079 @end group
38080 @end smallexample
38081
38082 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
38083 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
38084 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
38085 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
38086 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
38087 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
38088
38089 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
38090 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
38091 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
38092 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
38093 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
38094
38095 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
38096 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
38097 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
38098 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
38099 You specify a cross-debugging target by
38100 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
38101
38102 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
38103 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
38104 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
38105
38106 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
38107 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
38108 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
38109 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
38110 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
38111
38112 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
38113 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
38114 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
38115 with each other.
38116
38117 @node Config Names
38118 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
38119
38120 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
38121 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
38122 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
38123 of information in the following pattern:
38124
38125 @smallexample
38126 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
38127 @end smallexample
38128
38129 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
38130 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
38131 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
38132
38133 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
38134 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
38135 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
38136 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
38137 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
38138 abbreviations---for example:
38139
38140 @smallexample
38141 % sh config.sub i386-linux
38142 i386-pc-linux-gnu
38143 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
38144 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
38145 % sh config.sub hp9k700
38146 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
38147 % sh config.sub sun4
38148 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
38149 % sh config.sub sun3
38150 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
38151 % sh config.sub i986v
38152 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
38153 @end smallexample
38154
38155 @noindent
38156 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
38157 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
38158
38159 @node Configure Options
38160 @section @file{configure} Options
38161
38162 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
38163 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
38164 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
38165 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
38166 explanation of @file{configure}.
38167
38168 @smallexample
38169 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
38170 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
38171 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
38172 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
38173 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
38174 @end smallexample
38175
38176 @noindent
38177 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
38178 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
38179 @samp{--}.
38180
38181 @table @code
38182 @item --help
38183 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
38184
38185 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
38186 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
38187 @file{@var{dir}}.
38188
38189 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
38190 Configure the source to install programs under directory
38191 @file{@var{dir}}.
38192
38193 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
38194 @need 2000
38195 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
38196 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
38197 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
38198 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
38199 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
38200 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
38201 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
38202 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
38203 @var{dirname}.
38204
38205 @item --target=@var{target}
38206 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
38207 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
38208 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
38209
38210 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
38211 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
38212 @end table
38213
38214 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
38215 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
38216 options not described here.
38217
38218 @table @code
38219 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
38220 @itemx --enable-targets=all
38221 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
38222 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
38223 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
38224
38225 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
38226 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
38227 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
38228 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadir} (which can be set using
38229 @code{--datadir}).
38230
38231 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
38232 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
38233 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
38234 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
38235 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
38236 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
38237 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
38238 after it is built.
38239
38240 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
38241 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
38242
38243 @item --disable-gdbmi
38244 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
38245 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
38246
38247 @item --enable-tui
38248 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
38249 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
38250 supported).
38251
38252 @item --with-curses
38253 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
38254 terminal operations.
38255
38256 @item --with-debuginfod
38257 Build @value{GDBN} with libdebuginfod, the debuginfod client library.
38258 Used to automatically fetch source files and separate debug files from
38259 debuginfod servers using the associated executable's build ID. Enabled
38260 by default if libdebuginfod is installed and found at configure time.
38261 debuginfod is packaged with elfutils, starting with version 0.178. You
38262 can get the latest version from `https://sourceware.org/elfutils/'.
38263
38264 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
38265 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
38266 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
38267 details.
38268
38269 @item --with-system-readline
38270 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
38271 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}. Readline 7 or newer is
38272 required; this is enforced by the build system.
38273
38274 @item --with-system-zlib
38275 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
38276 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
38277
38278 @item --with-expat
38279 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
38280 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
38281 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
38282 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
38283 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
38284 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
38285 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
38286 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
38287
38288 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
38289
38290 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
38291 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
38292 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
38293 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
38294 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
38295
38296 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
38297 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
38298
38299 @item --with-lzma
38300 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
38301 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
38302 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
38303 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
38304 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
38305 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
38306
38307 @item --with-mpfr
38308 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
38309 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
38310 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
38311 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
38312 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
38313 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
38314 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
38315 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
38316 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
38317
38318 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
38319 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
38320 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
38321 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
38322 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
38323 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
38324 of Python supported by GDB is 2.6. The optional argument @var{python}
38325 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
38326 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
38327 Python is installed.
38328
38329 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
38330 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
38331 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
38332 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
38333 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
38334 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
38335 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
38336 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
38337 compile and link against Guile.
38338
38339 @item --without-included-regex
38340 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
38341 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
38342 the GNU C library.
38343
38344 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
38345 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
38346 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
38347 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
38348 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
38349 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
38350 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
38351 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
38352
38353 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
38354 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
38355 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
38356 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
38357 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
38358 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
38359
38360 @item --with-system-gdbinit-dir=@var{directory}
38361 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load init files from a
38362 system-wide directory. @var{directory} should be an absolute directory
38363 name. If @var{directory} is in a directory under the configured
38364 prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to another location after being
38365 built, the location of the system-wide init directory will be
38366 adjusted accordingly.
38367
38368 @item --enable-build-warnings
38369 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
38370 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
38371 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
38372 compiler you are using.
38373
38374 @item --enable-werror
38375 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
38376 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
38377 outputs any warning messages.
38378
38379 @item --enable-ubsan
38380 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
38381 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
38382 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
38383 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
38384 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
38385 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
38386 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
38387 @end table
38388
38389 @node System-wide configuration
38390 @section System-wide configuration and settings
38391 @cindex system-wide init file
38392
38393 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file and a
38394 system-wide init file directory; this file and files in that directory
38395 (if they have a recognized file extension) will be read and executed at
38396 startup (@pxref{Startup, , What @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
38397
38398 Here are the corresponding configure options:
38399
38400 @table @code
38401 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
38402 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
38403 @var{file}.
38404 @item --with-system-gdbinit-dir=@var{directory}
38405 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file directory
38406 is @var{directory}.
38407 @end table
38408
38409 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
38410 they may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
38411
38412 @itemize @bullet
38413 @item
38414 If the default location of this init file/directory contains @file{$prefix},
38415 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
38416 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
38417 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
38418 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
38419 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
38420
38421 @item
38422 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
38423 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
38424 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
38425 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
38426 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
38427 @end itemize
38428
38429 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
38430 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
38431 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
38432 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
38433 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
38434 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
38435 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
38436 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
38437 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
38438 reread.
38439
38440 This applies similarly to the system-wide directory specified in
38441 @option{--with-system-gdbinit-dir}.
38442
38443 Any supported scripting language can be used for these init files, as long
38444 as the file extension matches the scripting language. To be interpreted
38445 as regular @value{GDBN} commands, the files needs to have a @file{.gdb}
38446 extension.
38447
38448 @menu
38449 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
38450 @end menu
38451
38452 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
38453 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
38454 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
38455
38456 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
38457 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
38458 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
38459 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
38460 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
38461 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
38462
38463 The following scripts are currently available:
38464 @itemize @bullet
38465
38466 @item @file{elinos.py}
38467 @pindex elinos.py
38468 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
38469 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
38470 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
38471 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
38472 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
38473 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
38474
38475 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
38476 @pindex wrs-linux.py
38477 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
38478 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
38479 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
38480 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
38481
38482 @end itemize
38483
38484 @node Maintenance Commands
38485 @appendix Maintenance Commands
38486 @cindex maintenance commands
38487 @cindex internal commands
38488
38489 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
38490 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
38491 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
38492 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
38493 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
38494
38495 @table @code
38496 @kindex maint agent
38497 @kindex maint agent-eval
38498 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
38499 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
38500 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
38501 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
38502 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
38503 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
38504 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
38505 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
38506 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
38507 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
38508 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
38509 addition and return the sum.
38510 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
38511 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
38512
38513 @kindex maint agent-printf
38514 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
38515 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
38516 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
38517 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
38518 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
38519
38520 @kindex maint info breakpoints
38521 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
38522 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
38523 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
38524 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
38525 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
38526 is shown:
38527
38528 @table @code
38529 @item breakpoint
38530 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
38531
38532 @item watchpoint
38533 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
38534
38535 @item longjmp
38536 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
38537 @code{longjmp} calls.
38538
38539 @item longjmp resume
38540 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
38541
38542 @item until
38543 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
38544
38545 @item finish
38546 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
38547
38548 @item shlib events
38549 Shared library events.
38550
38551 @end table
38552
38553 @kindex maint info btrace
38554 @item maint info btrace
38555 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
38556
38557 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
38558 @item maint btrace packet-history
38559 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
38560 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
38561 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
38562 recording format.
38563
38564 @table @code
38565 @item bts
38566 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
38567 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
38568
38569 @table @asis
38570 @item Block number
38571 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
38572 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
38573 @item Highest @samp{PC}
38574 @end table
38575
38576 @item pt
38577 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
38578 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
38579 information is printed:
38580
38581 @table @asis
38582 @item Packet number
38583 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
38584 @item Trace offset
38585 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
38586 @item Packet opcode and payload
38587 @end table
38588 @end table
38589
38590 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
38591 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
38592 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
38593 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
38594 needed.
38595
38596 @kindex maint btrace clear
38597 @item maint btrace clear
38598 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
38599 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
38600
38601 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
38602 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
38603 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
38604 buffer.
38605
38606 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
38607 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
38608 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
38609 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
38610 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
38611 packet history.
38612
38613 @kindex set displaced-stepping
38614 @kindex show displaced-stepping
38615 @cindex displaced stepping support
38616 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
38617 @item set displaced-stepping
38618 @itemx show displaced-stepping
38619 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
38620 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
38621 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
38622 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
38623 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
38624
38625 @table @code
38626 @item set displaced-stepping on
38627 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
38628 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
38629
38630 @item set displaced-stepping off
38631 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
38632 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
38633
38634 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
38635 @item set displaced-stepping auto
38636 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
38637 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
38638 architecture supports displaced stepping.
38639 @end table
38640
38641 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
38642 @item maint check-psymtabs
38643 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
38644 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
38645
38646 @kindex maint check-symtabs
38647 @item maint check-symtabs
38648 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
38649
38650 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
38651 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
38652 Expand symbol tables.
38653 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
38654 names matching @var{regexp}.
38655
38656 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
38657 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
38658 @cindex demangler crashes
38659 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
38660 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
38661 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
38662 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
38663 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
38664 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
38665 option to terminate the current session.
38666
38667 @kindex maint cplus first_component
38668 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
38669 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
38670
38671 @kindex maint cplus namespace
38672 @item maint cplus namespace
38673 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
38674
38675 @kindex maint deprecate
38676 @kindex maint undeprecate
38677 @cindex deprecated commands
38678 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
38679 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
38680 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
38681 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
38682 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
38683 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
38684 the replacement as part of the warning.
38685
38686 @kindex maint dump-me
38687 @item maint dump-me
38688 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
38689 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
38690 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
38691 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
38692
38693 @kindex maint internal-error
38694 @kindex maint internal-warning
38695 @kindex maint demangler-warning
38696 @cindex demangler crashes
38697 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
38698 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
38699 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
38700
38701 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
38702 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
38703 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
38704 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
38705 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
38706 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
38707 @value{GDBN} session.
38708
38709 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
38710 used as the text of the error or warning message.
38711
38712 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
38713
38714 @smallexample
38715 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
38716 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
38717 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
38718 debugging may prove unreliable.
38719 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
38720 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
38721 (@value{GDBP})
38722 @end smallexample
38723
38724 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
38725 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
38726 @cindex demangler crashes
38727
38728 @kindex maint set internal-error
38729 @kindex maint show internal-error
38730 @kindex maint set internal-warning
38731 @kindex maint show internal-warning
38732 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
38733 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
38734 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
38735 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
38736 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
38737 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
38738 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
38739 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
38740 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
38741 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
38742 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
38743 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
38744 described in the table below.
38745
38746 @table @samp
38747 @item quit
38748 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
38749 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
38750
38751 @item corefile
38752 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
38753 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
38754 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
38755 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
38756 disabled.
38757 @end table
38758
38759 @kindex maint packet
38760 @item maint packet @var{text}
38761 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
38762 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
38763 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
38764 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
38765 checksum.
38766
38767 @kindex maint print architecture
38768 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
38769 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
38770 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
38771
38772 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
38773 @item maint print c-tdesc @r{[}-single-feature@r{]} @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
38774 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
38775 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
38776 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
38777 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
38778 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
38779 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
38780 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
38781 modify XML target descriptions.
38782
38783 When the optional flag @samp{-single-feature} is provided then the
38784 target description being processed (either the default, or from
38785 @var{file}) must only contain a single feature. The source file
38786 produced is different in this case.
38787
38788 @kindex maint print xml-tdesc
38789 @item maint print xml-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
38790 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as an XML
38791 file. By default print the target description for the current target,
38792 but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, then that file is
38793 read in by GDB and then used to produce the description. The
38794 @var{file} should be an XML document, of the form described in
38795 @ref{Target Description Format}.
38796
38797 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
38798 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
38799 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
38800 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
38801
38802 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
38803 @kindex maint check libthread-db
38804 @item maint check libthread-db
38805 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
38806 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
38807 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
38808 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
38809 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
38810 on some platforms when debugging core files.
38811
38812 @kindex maint print core-file-backed-mappings
38813 @cindex memory address space mappings
38814 @item maint print core-file-backed-mappings
38815 Print the file-backed mappings which were loaded from a core file note.
38816 This output represents state internal to @value{GDBN} and should be
38817 similar to the mappings displayed by the @code{info proc mappings}
38818 command.
38819
38820 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
38821 @item maint print dummy-frames
38822 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
38823
38824 @smallexample
38825 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
38826 @dots{}
38827 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
38828 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
38829 58 return (a + b);
38830 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
38831 @dots{}
38832 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
38833 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
38834 (@value{GDBP})
38835 @end smallexample
38836
38837 Takes an optional file parameter.
38838
38839 @kindex maint print registers
38840 @kindex maint print raw-registers
38841 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
38842 @kindex maint print register-groups
38843 @kindex maint print remote-registers
38844 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
38845 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
38846 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
38847 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
38848 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
38849 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
38850
38851 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
38852 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
38853 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
38854 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
38855 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
38856 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
38857 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
38858 and offsets in the `G' packets.
38859
38860 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
38861 write the information.
38862
38863 @kindex maint print reggroups
38864 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
38865 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
38866 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
38867 information.
38868
38869 The register groups info looks like this:
38870
38871 @smallexample
38872 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
38873 Group Type
38874 general user
38875 float user
38876 all user
38877 vector user
38878 system user
38879 save internal
38880 restore internal
38881 @end smallexample
38882
38883 @kindex maint flush register-cache
38884 @kindex flushregs
38885 @cindex register cache, flushing
38886 @item maint flush register-cache
38887 @itemx flushregs
38888 Flush the contents of the register cache and as a consequence the
38889 frame cache. This command is useful when debugging issues related to
38890 register fetching, or frame unwinding. The command @code{flushregs}
38891 is deprecated in favor of @code{maint flush register-cache}.
38892
38893 @kindex maint print objfiles
38894 @cindex info for known object files
38895 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
38896 Print a dump of all known object files.
38897 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
38898 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
38899 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
38900
38901 @kindex maint print user-registers
38902 @cindex user registers
38903 @item maint print user-registers
38904 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
38905 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
38906 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
38907 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
38908 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
38909 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
38910 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
38911
38912 @kindex maint print section-scripts
38913 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
38914 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
38915 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
38916 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
38917 matching @var{regexp}.
38918 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
38919 and the full path if known.
38920 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
38921
38922 @kindex maint print statistics
38923 @cindex bcache statistics
38924 @item maint print statistics
38925 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
38926 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
38927 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
38928 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
38929 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
38930 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
38931 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
38932 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
38933 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
38934 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
38935 lengths.
38936
38937 @kindex maint print target-stack
38938 @cindex target stack description
38939 @item maint print target-stack
38940 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
38941 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
38942 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
38943 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
38944 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
38945 address.
38946
38947 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
38948 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
38949
38950 @kindex maint print type
38951 @cindex type chain of a data type
38952 @item maint print type @var{expr}
38953 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
38954 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
38955 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
38956 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
38957 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
38958
38959 @kindex maint selftest
38960 @cindex self tests
38961 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
38962 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
38963 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
38964 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
38965 name will by ran.
38966
38967 @kindex maint info selftests
38968 @cindex self tests
38969 @item maint info selftests
38970 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
38971
38972 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
38973 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
38974 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
38975 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
38976 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
38977 information.
38978
38979 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
38980 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
38981 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
38982 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
38983 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
38984 always see the disassembly form.
38985
38986 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
38987
38988 @smallexample
38989 (gdb) info addr argc
38990 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
38991 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
38992 @end smallexample
38993
38994 For more information on these expressions, see
38995 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
38996
38997 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
38998 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
38999 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
39000 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
39001 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
39002
39003 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
39004 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
39005 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
39006 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
39007 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
39008 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
39009 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
39010 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
39011 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
39012
39013 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
39014 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
39015 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
39016 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
39017 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
39018
39019 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
39020 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
39021 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
39022 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
39023 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
39024 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
39025
39026 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
39027 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
39028 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
39029
39030 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
39031 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
39032 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
39033 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
39034
39035 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
39036 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
39037
39038 @kindex maint set worker-threads
39039 @kindex maint show worker-threads
39040 @item maint set worker-threads
39041 @item maint show worker-threads
39042 Control the number of worker threads that may be used by @value{GDBN}.
39043 On capable hosts, @value{GDBN} may use multiple threads to speed up
39044 certain CPU-intensive operations, such as demangling symbol names.
39045 While the number of threads used by @value{GDBN} may vary, this
39046 command can be used to set an upper bound on this number. The default
39047 is @code{unlimited}, which lets @value{GDBN} choose a reasonable
39048 number. Note that this only controls worker threads started by
39049 @value{GDBN} itself; libraries used by @value{GDBN} may start threads
39050 of their own.
39051
39052 @kindex maint set profile
39053 @kindex maint show profile
39054 @cindex profiling GDB
39055 @item maint set profile
39056 @itemx maint show profile
39057 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
39058
39059 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
39060 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
39061 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
39062 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
39063 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
39064 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
39065 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
39066
39067 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
39068 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
39069
39070 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
39071 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
39072 @cindex hardware debug registers
39073 @item maint set show-debug-regs
39074 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
39075 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
39076 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
39077 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
39078 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
39079 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
39080
39081 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
39082 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
39083 @item maint set show-all-tib
39084 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
39085 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
39086 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
39087 command.
39088
39089 @kindex maint set target-async
39090 @kindex maint show target-async
39091 @item maint set target-async
39092 @itemx maint show target-async
39093 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
39094 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
39095 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
39096 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
39097
39098 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
39099 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
39100 @item maint set target-non-stop
39101 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
39102
39103 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
39104 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
39105 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
39106 if supported by the target.
39107
39108 @table @code
39109 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
39110 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
39111 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
39112
39113 @item maint set target-non-stop on
39114 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
39115 does not indicate support.
39116
39117 @item maint set target-non-stop off
39118 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
39119 target supports it.
39120 @end table
39121
39122 @kindex maint set tui-resize-message
39123 @kindex maint show tui-resize-message
39124 @item maint set tui-resize-message
39125 @item maint show tui-resize-message
39126 Control whether @value{GDBN} displays a message each time the terminal
39127 is resized when in TUI mode. The default is @code{off}, which means
39128 that @value{GDBN} is silent during resizes. When @code{on},
39129 @value{GDBN} will display a message after a resize is completed; the
39130 message will include a number indicating how many times the terminal
39131 has been resized. This setting is intended for use by the test suite,
39132 where it would otherwise be difficult to determine when a resize and
39133 refresh has been completed.
39134
39135 @kindex maint set per-command
39136 @kindex maint show per-command
39137 @item maint set per-command
39138 @itemx maint show per-command
39139 @cindex resources used by commands
39140
39141 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
39142 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
39143
39144 @table @code
39145 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
39146 @itemx maint show per-command space
39147 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
39148 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
39149 took, following the command's own output.
39150 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
39151 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
39152
39153 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
39154 @itemx maint show per-command time
39155 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
39156 for each command.
39157 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
39158 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
39159 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
39160 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
39161 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
39162 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
39163 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
39164 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
39165 spent by the program been debugged.
39166 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
39167 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
39168
39169 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
39170 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
39171 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
39172 for each command.
39173 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
39174
39175 @enumerate a
39176 @item
39177 number of symbol tables
39178 @item
39179 number of primary symbol tables
39180 @item
39181 number of blocks in the blockvector
39182 @end enumerate
39183 @end table
39184
39185 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
39186 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
39187 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
39188 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
39189 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
39190 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
39191 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
39192 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
39193 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
39194 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
39195
39196 @kindex maint space
39197 @cindex memory used by commands
39198 @item maint space @var{value}
39199 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
39200 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
39201
39202 @kindex maint time
39203 @cindex time of command execution
39204 @item maint time @var{value}
39205 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
39206 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
39207
39208 @kindex maint translate-address
39209 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
39210 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
39211 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
39212 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
39213 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
39214 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
39215 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
39216
39217 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
39218 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
39219 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
39220
39221 @kindex maint test-options
39222 @item maint test-options require-delimiter
39223 @itemx maint test-options unknown-is-error
39224 @itemx maint test-options unknown-is-operand
39225 These commands are used by the testsuite to validate the command
39226 options framework. The @code{require-delimiter} variant requires a
39227 double-dash delimiter to indicate end of options. The
39228 @code{unknown-is-error} and @code{unknown-is-operand} do not. The
39229 @code{unknown-is-error} variant throws an error on unknown option,
39230 while @code{unknown-is-operand} treats unknown options as the start of
39231 the command's operands. When run, the commands output the result of
39232 the processed options. When completed, the commands store the
39233 internal result of completion in a variable exposed by the @code{maint
39234 show test-options-completion-result} command.
39235
39236 @kindex maint show test-options-completion-result
39237 @item maint show test-options-completion-result
39238 Shows the result of completing the @code{maint test-options}
39239 subcommands. This is used by the testsuite to validate completion
39240 support in the command options framework.
39241
39242 @kindex maint set test-settings
39243 @kindex maint show test-settings
39244 @item maint set test-settings @var{kind}
39245 @itemx maint show test-settings @var{kind}
39246 These are representative commands for each @var{kind} of setting type
39247 @value{GDBN} supports. They are used by the testsuite for exercising
39248 the settings infrastructure.
39249
39250 @kindex maint with
39251 @item maint with @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
39252 Like the @code{with} command, but works with @code{maintenance set}
39253 variables. This is used by the testsuite to exercise the @code{with}
39254 command's infrastructure.
39255
39256 @end table
39257
39258 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
39259 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
39260
39261 @table @code
39262 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
39263 @kindex set watchdog
39264 @cindex watchdog timer
39265 @cindex timeout for commands
39266 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
39267 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
39268 reports and error and the command is aborted.
39269
39270 @item show watchdog
39271 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
39272 @end table
39273
39274 @node Remote Protocol
39275 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
39276
39277 @menu
39278 * Overview::
39279 * Packets::
39280 * Stop Reply Packets::
39281 * General Query Packets::
39282 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
39283 * Tracepoint Packets::
39284 * Host I/O Packets::
39285 * Interrupts::
39286 * Notification Packets::
39287 * Remote Non-Stop::
39288 * Packet Acknowledgment::
39289 * Examples::
39290 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
39291 * Library List Format::
39292 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
39293 * Memory Map Format::
39294 * Thread List Format::
39295 * Traceframe Info Format::
39296 * Branch Trace Format::
39297 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
39298 @end menu
39299
39300 @node Overview
39301 @section Overview
39302
39303 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
39304 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
39305 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
39306 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
39307
39308 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
39309 transmitted and received data, respectively.
39310
39311 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
39312 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
39313 @cindex remote serial protocol
39314 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
39315 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
39316 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
39317 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
39318 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
39319
39320 @smallexample
39321 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
39322 @end smallexample
39323 @noindent
39324
39325 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
39326 @noindent
39327 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
39328 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
39329 eight bit unsigned checksum).
39330
39331 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
39332 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
39333
39334 @smallexample
39335 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
39336 @end smallexample
39337
39338 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
39339 @noindent
39340 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
39341 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
39342 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
39343
39344 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
39345 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
39346 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
39347 retransmission):
39348
39349 @smallexample
39350 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
39351 <- @code{+}
39352 @end smallexample
39353 @noindent
39354
39355 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
39356 once a connection is established.
39357 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
39358
39359 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
39360 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
39361 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
39362 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
39363 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
39364 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
39365 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
39366
39367 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
39368 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
39369 exceptions).
39370
39371 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
39372 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
39373 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
39374 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
39375
39376 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
39377 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
39378 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
39379
39380 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
39381 @anchor{Binary Data}
39382 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
39383 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
39384 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
39385 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
39386 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
39387 binary data.
39388
39389 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
39390 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
39391 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
39392 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
39393 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
39394 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
39395 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
39396 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
39397 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
39398 (described next).
39399
39400 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
39401 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
39402 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
39403 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
39404 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
39405 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
39406 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
39407 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
39408 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
39409 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
39410 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
39411 3}} more times.
39412
39413 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
39414 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
39415 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
39416 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
39417 @samp{0*"00}.
39418
39419 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
39420 error number. That number is not well defined.
39421
39422 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
39423 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
39424 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
39425 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
39426 on that response.
39427
39428 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{?} command to
39429 tell @value{GDBN} the reason for halting, @samp{g} and @samp{G}
39430 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
39431 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
39432 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue) command, and if
39433 the target architecture supports hardware-assisted single-stepping,
39434 the @samp{s} (step) command. Stubs that support multi-threading
39435 targets should support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands
39436 are optional.
39437
39438 @node Packets
39439 @section Packets
39440
39441 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
39442 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
39443 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
39444 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
39445
39446 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
39447 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
39448 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
39449 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
39450 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
39451 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
39452 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
39453 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
39454 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
39455 @var{baz}.
39456
39457 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
39458 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
39459 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
39460 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
39461 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
39462 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
39463 pick any thread.
39464
39465 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
39466 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
39467 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
39468 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
39469 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
39470 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
39471 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
39472 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
39473 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
39474 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
39475 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
39476 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
39477 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
39478
39479 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
39480 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
39481 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
39482 more information.
39483
39484 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
39485 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
39486
39487 Here are the packet descriptions.
39488
39489 @table @samp
39490
39491 @item !
39492 @cindex @samp{!} packet
39493 @anchor{extended mode}
39494 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
39495 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
39496 debugged.
39497
39498 Reply:
39499 @table @samp
39500 @item OK
39501 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
39502 @end table
39503
39504 @item ?
39505 @cindex @samp{?} packet
39506 @anchor{? packet}
39507 This is sent when connection is first established to query the reason
39508 the target halted. The reply is the same as for step and continue.
39509 This packet has a special interpretation when the target is in
39510 non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
39511
39512 Reply:
39513 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
39514
39515 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
39516 @cindex @samp{A} packet
39517 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
39518 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
39519 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
39520
39521 Reply:
39522 @table @samp
39523 @item OK
39524 The arguments were set.
39525 @item E @var{NN}
39526 An error occurred.
39527 @end table
39528
39529 @item b @var{baud}
39530 @cindex @samp{b} packet
39531 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
39532 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
39533
39534 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
39535 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
39536 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
39537
39538 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
39539 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
39540 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
39541 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
39542 of view, nothing actually happened.}
39543
39544 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
39545 @cindex @samp{B} packet
39546 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
39547 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
39548
39549 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
39550 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
39551
39552 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
39553 @anchor{bc}
39554 @item bc
39555 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
39556 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
39557
39558 Reply:
39559 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
39560
39561 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
39562 @anchor{bs}
39563 @item bs
39564 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
39565 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
39566
39567 Reply:
39568 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
39569
39570 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
39571 @cindex @samp{c} packet
39572 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
39573 is omitted, resume at current address.
39574
39575 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
39576 packet}.
39577
39578 Reply:
39579 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
39580
39581 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
39582 @cindex @samp{C} packet
39583 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
39584 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
39585
39586 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
39587 packet}.
39588
39589 Reply:
39590 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
39591
39592 @item d
39593 @cindex @samp{d} packet
39594 Toggle debug flag.
39595
39596 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
39597 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
39598
39599 @item D
39600 @itemx D;@var{pid}
39601 @cindex @samp{D} packet
39602 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
39603 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
39604 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
39605
39606 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
39607 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
39608 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
39609 big-endian hex string.
39610
39611 Reply:
39612 @table @samp
39613 @item OK
39614 for success
39615 @item E @var{NN}
39616 for an error
39617 @end table
39618
39619 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
39620 @cindex @samp{F} packet
39621 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
39622 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
39623 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
39624
39625 @item g
39626 @anchor{read registers packet}
39627 @cindex @samp{g} packet
39628 Read general registers.
39629
39630 Reply:
39631 @table @samp
39632 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
39633 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
39634 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
39635 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
39636 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
39637 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
39638
39639 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
39640 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
39641 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
39642 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
39643 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
39644 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
39645 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
39646 have been collected, and both have zero value:
39647
39648 @smallexample
39649 -> @code{g}
39650 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
39651 @end smallexample
39652
39653 @item E @var{NN}
39654 for an error.
39655 @end table
39656
39657 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
39658 @cindex @samp{G} packet
39659 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
39660 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
39661
39662 Reply:
39663 @table @samp
39664 @item OK
39665 for success
39666 @item E @var{NN}
39667 for an error
39668 @end table
39669
39670 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
39671 @cindex @samp{H} packet
39672 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
39673 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
39674 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
39675 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
39676 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
39677 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
39678 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
39679
39680 Reply:
39681 @table @samp
39682 @item OK
39683 for success
39684 @item E @var{NN}
39685 for an error
39686 @end table
39687
39688 @c FIXME: JTC:
39689 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
39690 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
39691 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
39692 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
39693 @c described. For example:
39694 @c
39695 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
39696 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
39697 @c otherwise returns current registers.
39698 @c
39699 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
39700 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
39701 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
39702
39703 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
39704 @anchor{cycle step packet}
39705 @cindex @samp{i} packet
39706 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
39707 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
39708 step starting at that address.
39709
39710 @item I
39711 @cindex @samp{I} packet
39712 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
39713 step packet}.
39714
39715 @item k
39716 @cindex @samp{k} packet
39717 Kill request.
39718
39719 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
39720
39721 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
39722 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
39723
39724 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
39725
39726 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
39727 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
39728 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
39729
39730 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
39731 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
39732 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
39733
39734 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
39735 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
39736 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
39737 (@pxref{? packet}).
39738
39739 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
39740 @cindex @samp{m} packet
39741 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
39742 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
39743 any particular boundary.
39744
39745 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
39746 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
39747 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
39748 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
39749 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
39750 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
39751 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
39752 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
39753
39754 Reply:
39755 @table @samp
39756 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
39757 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
39758 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
39759 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
39760 @item E @var{NN}
39761 @var{NN} is errno
39762 @end table
39763
39764 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
39765 @cindex @samp{M} packet
39766 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
39767 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
39768 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
39769
39770 Reply:
39771 @table @samp
39772 @item OK
39773 for success
39774 @item E @var{NN}
39775 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
39776 written).
39777 @end table
39778
39779 @item p @var{n}
39780 @cindex @samp{p} packet
39781 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
39782 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
39783 register value is encoded.
39784
39785 Reply:
39786 @table @samp
39787 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
39788 the register's value
39789 @item E @var{NN}
39790 for an error
39791 @item @w{}
39792 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
39793 @end table
39794
39795 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
39796 @anchor{write register packet}
39797 @cindex @samp{P} packet
39798 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
39799 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
39800 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
39801
39802 Reply:
39803 @table @samp
39804 @item OK
39805 for success
39806 @item E @var{NN}
39807 for an error
39808 @end table
39809
39810 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
39811 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
39812 @cindex @samp{q} packet
39813 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
39814 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
39815 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
39816
39817 @item r
39818 @cindex @samp{r} packet
39819 Reset the entire system.
39820
39821 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
39822
39823 @item R @var{XX}
39824 @cindex @samp{R} packet
39825 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
39826 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
39827
39828 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
39829
39830 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
39831 @cindex @samp{s} packet
39832 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
39833 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
39834
39835 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
39836 packet}.
39837
39838 Reply:
39839 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
39840
39841 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
39842 @anchor{step with signal packet}
39843 @cindex @samp{S} packet
39844 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
39845 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
39846
39847 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
39848 packet}.
39849
39850 Reply:
39851 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
39852
39853 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
39854 @cindex @samp{t} packet
39855 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
39856 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
39857 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
39858
39859 @item T @var{thread-id}
39860 @cindex @samp{T} packet
39861 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
39862
39863 Reply:
39864 @table @samp
39865 @item OK
39866 thread is still alive
39867 @item E @var{NN}
39868 thread is dead
39869 @end table
39870
39871 @item v
39872 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
39873 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
39874
39875 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
39876 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
39877 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
39878 The process ID is a
39879 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
39880 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
39881 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
39882
39883 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
39884 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
39885 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
39886 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
39887 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
39888 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
39889 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
39890 @c stopping or restarting threads.
39891
39892 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
39893
39894 Reply:
39895 @table @samp
39896 @item E @var{nn}
39897 for an error
39898 @item @r{Any stop packet}
39899 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
39900 @item OK
39901 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
39902 @end table
39903
39904 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
39905 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
39906 @anchor{vCont packet}
39907 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
39908
39909 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
39910 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
39911 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
39912 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
39913 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
39914 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
39915 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
39916 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
39917 error.
39918
39919 Currently supported actions are:
39920
39921 @table @samp
39922 @item c
39923 Continue.
39924 @item C @var{sig}
39925 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
39926 @item s
39927 Step.
39928 @item S @var{sig}
39929 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
39930 @item t
39931 Stop.
39932 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
39933 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
39934 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
39935 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
39936 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
39937 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
39938
39939 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
39940 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
39941 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
39942 jumps to @var{start}).
39943
39944 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
39945 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
39946 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
39947
39948 @end table
39949
39950 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
39951 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
39952 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
39953
39954 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
39955 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
39956 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
39957 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
39958 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
39959 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
39960 as an implementation detail.
39961
39962 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
39963 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
39964 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
39965 stopped.
39966
39967 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
39968 @value{GDBN} acknowledges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
39969 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
39970
39971 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
39972 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
39973
39974 Reply:
39975 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
39976
39977 @item vCont?
39978 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
39979 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
39980
39981 Reply:
39982 @table @samp
39983 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
39984 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
39985 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
39986 @item @w{}
39987 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
39988 @end table
39989
39990 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
39991 @item vCtrlC
39992 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
39993 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
39994 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
39995 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
39996 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
39997 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
39998 variant.
39999
40000 Reply:
40001 @table @samp
40002 @item E @var{nn}
40003 for an error
40004 @item OK
40005 for success
40006 @end table
40007
40008 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
40009 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
40010 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
40011 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
40012
40013 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
40014 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
40015 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
40016 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
40017 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
40018 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
40019 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
40020 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
40021 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
40022 packet is received.
40023
40024 Reply:
40025 @table @samp
40026 @item OK
40027 for success
40028 @item E @var{NN}
40029 for an error
40030 @end table
40031
40032 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
40033 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
40034 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
40035 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
40036 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
40037 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
40038 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
40039 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
40040 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
40041 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
40042 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
40043 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
40044
40045
40046 Reply:
40047 @table @samp
40048 @item OK
40049 for success
40050 @item E.memtype
40051 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
40052 @item E @var{NN}
40053 for an error
40054 @end table
40055
40056 @item vFlashDone
40057 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
40058 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
40059 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
40060 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
40061 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
40062 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
40063 request is completed.
40064
40065 @item vKill;@var{pid}
40066 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
40067 @anchor{vKill packet}
40068 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
40069 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
40070 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
40071 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
40072
40073 Reply:
40074 @table @samp
40075 @item E @var{nn}
40076 for an error
40077 @item OK
40078 for success
40079 @end table
40080
40081 @item vMustReplyEmpty
40082 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
40083 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
40084 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
40085 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
40086
40087 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
40088 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
40089 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
40090 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
40091 packets then it is possible that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
40092 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
40093
40094 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
40095 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
40096 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
40097 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
40098 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
40099 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
40100 state.
40101
40102 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
40103
40104 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
40105
40106 Reply:
40107 @table @samp
40108 @item E @var{nn}
40109 for an error
40110 @item @r{Any stop packet}
40111 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
40112 @end table
40113
40114 @item vStopped
40115 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
40116 @xref{Notification Packets}.
40117
40118 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
40119 @anchor{X packet}
40120 @cindex @samp{X} packet
40121 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
40122 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
40123 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
40124 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40125
40126 Reply:
40127 @table @samp
40128 @item OK
40129 for success
40130 @item E @var{NN}
40131 for an error
40132 @end table
40133
40134 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
40135 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
40136 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
40137 @cindex @samp{z} packet
40138 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
40139 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
40140 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
40141
40142 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
40143 separately.
40144
40145 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
40146 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
40147 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
40148 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
40149 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
40150 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
40151
40152 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
40153 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
40154 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
40155 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
40156 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
40157 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
40158
40159 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
40160 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
40161 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
40162 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
40163 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
40164 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
40165 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
40166 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
40167 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
40168 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
40169 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
40170 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
40171 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
40172
40173 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
40174 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
40175
40176 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
40177 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
40178
40179 @table @samp
40180
40181 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
40182 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
40183 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
40184
40185 @end table
40186
40187 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
40188 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
40189 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
40190 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
40191 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
40192 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
40193 separators. Each expression has the following form:
40194
40195 @table @samp
40196
40197 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
40198 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
40199 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
40200
40201 @end table
40202
40203 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
40204 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
40205 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
40206 target, is not defined.}
40207
40208 Reply:
40209 @table @samp
40210 @item OK
40211 success
40212 @item @w{}
40213 not supported
40214 @item E @var{NN}
40215 for an error
40216 @end table
40217
40218 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
40219 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
40220 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
40221 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
40222 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
40223 address @var{addr}.
40224
40225 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
40226 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
40227 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
40228 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
40229
40230 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
40231 movement.}
40232
40233 Reply:
40234 @table @samp
40235 @item OK
40236 success
40237 @item @w{}
40238 not supported
40239 @item E @var{NN}
40240 for an error
40241 @end table
40242
40243 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
40244 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
40245 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
40246 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
40247 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
40248 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
40249
40250 Reply:
40251 @table @samp
40252 @item OK
40253 success
40254 @item @w{}
40255 not supported
40256 @item E @var{NN}
40257 for an error
40258 @end table
40259
40260 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
40261 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
40262 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
40263 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
40264 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
40265 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
40266
40267 Reply:
40268 @table @samp
40269 @item OK
40270 success
40271 @item @w{}
40272 not supported
40273 @item E @var{NN}
40274 for an error
40275 @end table
40276
40277 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
40278 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
40279 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
40280 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
40281 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
40282 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
40283
40284 Reply:
40285 @table @samp
40286 @item OK
40287 success
40288 @item @w{}
40289 not supported
40290 @item E @var{NN}
40291 for an error
40292 @end table
40293
40294 @end table
40295
40296 @node Stop Reply Packets
40297 @section Stop Reply Packets
40298 @cindex stop reply packets
40299
40300 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
40301 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
40302 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
40303 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
40304 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
40305 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
40306 @value{GDBN} source code.
40307
40308 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
40309 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
40310 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
40311
40312 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
40313 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
40314 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
40315 components.
40316
40317 @table @samp
40318
40319 @item S @var{AA}
40320 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
40321 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
40322 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
40323
40324 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
40325 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
40326 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
40327 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
40328 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
40329 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
40330 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
40331 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
40332
40333 @itemize @bullet
40334 @item
40335 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
40336 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
40337 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
40338 two-digit hex number.
40339
40340 @item
40341 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
40342 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
40343
40344 @item
40345 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
40346 the core on which the stop event was detected.
40347
40348 @item
40349 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
40350 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
40351 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
40352 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
40353
40354 @item
40355 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
40356 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
40357 future.
40358 @end itemize
40359
40360 The currently defined stop reasons are:
40361
40362 @table @samp
40363 @item watch
40364 @itemx rwatch
40365 @itemx awatch
40366 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
40367 hex.
40368
40369 @item syscall_entry
40370 @itemx syscall_return
40371 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
40372 syscall number, in hex.
40373
40374 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
40375 @item library
40376 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
40377 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
40378 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
40379
40380 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
40381 @item replaylog
40382 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
40383 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
40384 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
40385 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
40386 for more information.
40387
40388 @item swbreak
40389 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
40390 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
40391 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
40392 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
40393 part must be left empty.
40394
40395 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
40396 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
40397 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
40398 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
40399 address.
40400
40401 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
40402 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
40403 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
40404 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
40405 indicating support.
40406
40407 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
40408
40409 @item hwbreak
40410 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
40411 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
40412
40413 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
40414 apply.
40415
40416 @cindex fork events, remote reply
40417 @item fork
40418 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
40419 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
40420 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
40421 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
40422 fork events.
40423
40424 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
40425 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
40426 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
40427 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
40428 indicating support.
40429
40430 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
40431 @item vfork
40432 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
40433 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
40434 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
40435 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
40436 vfork events.
40437
40438 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
40439 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
40440 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
40441 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
40442 indicating support.
40443
40444 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
40445 @item vforkdone
40446 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
40447 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
40448 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
40449 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
40450 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
40451
40452 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
40453 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
40454 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
40455 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
40456 indicating support.
40457
40458 @cindex exec events, remote reply
40459 @item exec
40460 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
40461 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
40462 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
40463
40464 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
40465 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
40466 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
40467 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
40468 indicating support.
40469
40470 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
40471 @anchor{thread create event}
40472 @item create
40473 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
40474 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
40475 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
40476 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
40477 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
40478 @var{r} part is ignored.
40479
40480 @end table
40481
40482 @item W @var{AA}
40483 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
40484 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
40485 applicable to certain targets.
40486
40487 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
40488 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
40489 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
40490 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
40491 hex strings.
40492
40493 @item X @var{AA}
40494 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
40495 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
40496
40497 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
40498 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
40499 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
40500 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
40501 hex strings.
40502
40503 @anchor{thread exit event}
40504 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
40505 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
40506
40507 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
40508 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
40509 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
40510 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
40511
40512 @item N
40513 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
40514 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
40515 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
40516 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
40517 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
40518 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
40519 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
40520 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
40521 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
40522 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
40523 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
40524 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
40525 support.
40526
40527 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
40528 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
40529 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
40530 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
40531 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
40532
40533 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
40534 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
40535 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
40536 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
40537 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
40538 system calls.
40539
40540 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
40541 this very system call.
40542
40543 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
40544 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
40545 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
40546 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40547 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
40548 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
40549
40550 @end table
40551
40552 @node General Query Packets
40553 @section General Query Packets
40554 @cindex remote query requests
40555
40556 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
40557 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
40558 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
40559 sending information to and from the stub.
40560
40561 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
40562 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
40563 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
40564 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
40565 conventions:
40566
40567 @itemize @bullet
40568 @item
40569 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
40570 @item
40571 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
40572 letter.
40573 @item
40574 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
40575 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
40576 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
40577 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
40578 @end itemize
40579
40580 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
40581 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
40582 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
40583 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
40584 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
40585 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
40586 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
40587 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
40588 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
40589 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
40590 packet.}.
40591
40592 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
40593 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
40594 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
40595 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
40596 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
40597
40598 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
40599
40600 @table @samp
40601
40602 @item QAgent:1
40603 @itemx QAgent:0
40604 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
40605 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
40606
40607 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
40608 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
40609 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
40610 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
40611 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
40612 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
40613 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
40614 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
40615 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
40616 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
40617 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
40618
40619 @item qC
40620 @cindex current thread, remote request
40621 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
40622 Return the current thread ID.
40623
40624 Reply:
40625 @table @samp
40626 @item QC @var{thread-id}
40627 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
40628 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
40629 @item @r{(anything else)}
40630 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
40631 @end table
40632
40633 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
40634 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
40635 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
40636 @anchor{qCRC packet}
40637 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
40638 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
40639 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
40640 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
40641
40642 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
40643 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
40644 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
40645 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
40646 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
40647 detect trailing zeros.
40648
40649 Reply:
40650 @table @samp
40651 @item E @var{NN}
40652 An error (such as memory fault)
40653 @item C @var{crc32}
40654 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
40655 @end table
40656
40657 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
40658 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
40659 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
40660 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
40661 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
40662 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
40663 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
40664 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
40665 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
40666 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
40667 randomization.
40668
40669 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
40670
40671 Reply:
40672 @table @samp
40673 @item OK
40674 The request succeeded.
40675
40676 @item E @var{nn}
40677 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40678
40679 @item @w{}
40680 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
40681 by the stub.
40682 @end table
40683
40684 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40685 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40686 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
40687 address space randomization.
40688
40689 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
40690 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
40691 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
40692 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
40693 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
40694 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
40695 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
40696 inferior using a shell or not.
40697
40698 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
40699 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
40700 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
40701 values are considered an error.
40702
40703 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
40704 mode}).
40705
40706 Reply:
40707 @table @samp
40708 @item OK
40709 The request succeeded.
40710
40711 @item E @var{nn}
40712 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40713 @end table
40714
40715 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40716 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40717 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
40718 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
40719
40720 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
40721 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
40722
40723 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
40724 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
40725 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
40726 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
40727 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
40728 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
40729 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
40730 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
40731 environment}).
40732
40733 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
40734 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
40735 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
40736 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
40737 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
40738 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
40739 not be present.
40740
40741 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
40742 mode}).
40743
40744 Reply:
40745 @table @samp
40746 @item OK
40747 The request succeeded.
40748 @end table
40749
40750 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40751 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40752 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
40753 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
40754 inferior.
40755
40756 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
40757 @pxref{set environment}.
40758
40759 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
40760 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
40761 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
40762 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
40763 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
40764 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
40765 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
40766 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
40767
40768 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
40769 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
40770
40771 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
40772 mode}).
40773
40774 Reply:
40775 @table @samp
40776 @item OK
40777 The request succeeded.
40778 @end table
40779
40780 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40781 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40782 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
40783 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
40784 inferior.
40785
40786 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
40787 @pxref{unset environment}.
40788
40789 @item QEnvironmentReset
40790 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
40791 @cindex reset environment, remote request
40792 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
40793 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
40794 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
40795 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
40796 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
40797 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
40798 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
40799 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
40800 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
40801
40802 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
40803 mode}).
40804
40805 Reply:
40806 @table @samp
40807 @item OK
40808 The request succeeded.
40809 @end table
40810
40811 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40812 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40813 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
40814 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
40815 inferior.
40816
40817 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
40818 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
40819 @cindex set working directory, remote request
40820 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
40821 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
40822 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
40823
40824 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
40825 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
40826 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
40827 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
40828 directory to its original, empty value.
40829
40830 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
40831 mode}).
40832
40833 Reply:
40834 @table @samp
40835 @item OK
40836 The request succeeded.
40837 @end table
40838
40839 @item qfThreadInfo
40840 @itemx qsThreadInfo
40841 @cindex list active threads, remote request
40842 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
40843 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
40844 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
40845 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
40846 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
40847 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
40848 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
40849 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
40850
40851 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
40852
40853 Reply:
40854 @table @samp
40855 @item m @var{thread-id}
40856 A single thread ID
40857 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
40858 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
40859 @item l
40860 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40861 @end table
40862
40863 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40864 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
40865 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
40866 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
40867 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
40868 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
40869 fields.
40870
40871 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
40872 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
40873 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
40874 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
40875 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
40876
40877 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
40878 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
40879 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
40880 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
40881 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
40882
40883 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
40884 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
40885
40886 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
40887 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
40888 information associated with the variable.)
40889
40890 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
40891 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
40892 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
40893 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
40894 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
40895 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
40896
40897 Reply:
40898 @table @samp
40899 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
40900 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
40901 local storage requested.
40902
40903 @item E @var{nn}
40904 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40905
40906 @item @w{}
40907 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
40908 @end table
40909
40910 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
40911 @cindex get thread information block address
40912 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
40913 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
40914
40915 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
40916
40917 Reply:
40918 @table @samp
40919 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
40920 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
40921 thread information block.
40922
40923 @item E @var{nn}
40924 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
40925 address could not be retrieved.
40926
40927 @item @w{}
40928 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
40929 @end table
40930
40931 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
40932 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
40933 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
40934 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
40935 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
40936 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
40937 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
40938
40939 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
40940
40941 Reply:
40942 @table @samp
40943 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
40944 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
40945 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
40946 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
40947 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
40948 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
40949 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
40950 @end table
40951
40952 @item qOffsets
40953 @cindex section offsets, remote request
40954 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
40955 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
40956 image.
40957
40958 Reply:
40959 @table @samp
40960 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
40961 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
40962 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
40963 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
40964 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
40965 segments by the supplied offsets.
40966
40967 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
40968 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
40969 to the @code{Bss} section.}
40970
40971 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
40972 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
40973 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
40974 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
40975 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
40976 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
40977 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
40978 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
40979 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
40980 @end table
40981
40982 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
40983 @cindex thread information, remote request
40984 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
40985 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
40986 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
40987 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
40988
40989 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
40990 (see below).
40991
40992 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
40993
40994 @item QNonStop:1
40995 @itemx QNonStop:0
40996 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
40997 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
40998 @anchor{QNonStop}
40999 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
41000 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
41001
41002 Reply:
41003 @table @samp
41004 @item OK
41005 The request succeeded.
41006
41007 @item E @var{nn}
41008 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
41009
41010 @item @w{}
41011 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
41012 the stub.
41013 @end table
41014
41015 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
41016 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
41017 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
41018 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
41019
41020 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
41021 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
41022 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
41023 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
41024 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
41025 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
41026 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
41027
41028 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
41029 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
41030 is listed, every system call should be reported.
41031
41032 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
41033 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
41034 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
41035 report the requested syscalls.
41036
41037 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
41038 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
41039
41040 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
41041 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
41042 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
41043 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
41044
41045 Reply:
41046 @table @samp
41047 @item OK
41048 The request succeeded.
41049
41050 @item E @var{nn}
41051 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
41052
41053 @item @w{}
41054 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
41055 the stub.
41056 @end table
41057
41058 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
41059 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
41060 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
41061 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
41062
41063 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
41064 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
41065 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
41066 @anchor{QPassSignals}
41067 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
41068 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
41069 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
41070 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
41071 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
41072 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
41073 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
41074 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
41075 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
41076
41077 Reply:
41078 @table @samp
41079 @item OK
41080 The request succeeded.
41081
41082 @item E @var{nn}
41083 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
41084
41085 @item @w{}
41086 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
41087 the stub.
41088 @end table
41089
41090 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
41091 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
41092 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
41093 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
41094
41095 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
41096 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
41097 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
41098 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
41099 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
41100 Others should be silently discarded.
41101
41102 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
41103 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
41104 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
41105 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
41106 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
41107 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
41108 signals.
41109
41110 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
41111 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
41112
41113 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
41114 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
41115 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
41116 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
41117 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
41118
41119 Reply:
41120 @table @samp
41121 @item OK
41122 The request succeeded.
41123
41124 @item E @var{nn}
41125 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
41126
41127 @item @w{}
41128 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
41129 by the stub.
41130 @end table
41131
41132 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
41133 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
41134 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
41135 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
41136
41137 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
41138 @item QThreadEvents:1
41139 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
41140 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
41141 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
41142
41143 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
41144 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
41145 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
41146 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
41147 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
41148 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
41149 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
41150 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
41151 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
41152 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
41153
41154 Reply:
41155 @table @samp
41156 @item OK
41157 The request succeeded.
41158
41159 @item E @var{nn}
41160 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
41161
41162 @item @w{}
41163 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
41164 the stub.
41165 @end table
41166
41167 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
41168 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
41169
41170 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
41171 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
41172 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
41173 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
41174 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
41175 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
41176 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
41177 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
41178 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
41179
41180 Reply:
41181 @table @samp
41182 @item OK
41183 A command response with no output.
41184 @item @var{OUTPUT}
41185 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
41186 @item E @var{NN}
41187 Indicate a badly formed request.
41188 @item @w{}
41189 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
41190 @end table
41191
41192 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
41193 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
41194 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
41195 packets.)
41196
41197 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
41198 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
41199 @ifnotinfo
41200 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
41201 @end ifnotinfo
41202 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
41203 @anchor{qSearch memory}
41204 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
41205 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
41206 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
41207
41208 Reply:
41209 @table @samp
41210 @item 0
41211 The pattern was not found.
41212 @item 1,address
41213 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
41214 @item E @var{NN}
41215 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
41216 @item @w{}
41217 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
41218 @end table
41219
41220 @item QStartNoAckMode
41221 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
41222 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
41223 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
41224 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
41225
41226 Reply:
41227 @table @samp
41228 @item OK
41229 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
41230 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this response,
41231 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
41232 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
41233 @item @w{}
41234 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
41235 @end table
41236
41237 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
41238 @cindex supported packets, remote query
41239 @cindex features of the remote protocol
41240 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
41241 @anchor{qSupported}
41242 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
41243 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
41244 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
41245 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
41246 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
41247 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
41248 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
41249 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
41250 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
41251 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
41252 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
41253 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
41254 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
41255 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
41256
41257 Reply:
41258 @table @samp
41259 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
41260 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
41261 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
41262 possible forms).
41263 @item @w{}
41264 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
41265 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
41266 @end table
41267
41268 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
41269 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
41270 are:
41271
41272 @table @samp
41273 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
41274 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
41275 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
41276 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
41277 @item @var{name}+
41278 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
41279 need an associated value.
41280 @item @var{name}-
41281 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
41282 @item @var{name}?
41283 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
41284 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
41285 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
41286 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
41287 @end table
41288
41289 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
41290 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
41291 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
41292 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
41293 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
41294
41295 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
41296 are defined:
41297
41298 @table @samp
41299 @item multiprocess
41300 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
41301 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
41302 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
41303 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
41304 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
41305
41306 @item xmlRegisters
41307 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
41308 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
41309 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
41310 description.
41311
41312 @item qRelocInsn
41313 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
41314 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
41315 instruction reply packet}).
41316
41317 @item swbreak
41318 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
41319 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
41320
41321 @item hwbreak
41322 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
41323 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
41324
41325 @item fork-events
41326 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
41327 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
41328 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
41329 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
41330
41331 @item vfork-events
41332 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
41333 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
41334 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
41335 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
41336
41337 @item exec-events
41338 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
41339 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
41340 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
41341 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
41342
41343 @item vContSupported
41344 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
41345 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
41346 @end table
41347
41348 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
41349 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
41350 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
41351 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
41352 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
41353 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
41354 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
41355 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
41356 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
41357 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
41358 all the features it supports.
41359
41360 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
41361 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
41362
41363 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
41364 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
41365 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
41366 form response.
41367
41368 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
41369 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
41370 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
41371 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
41372
41373 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
41374 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
41375 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
41376 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
41377 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
41378
41379 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
41380
41381 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
41382 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
41383 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
41384 @item Feature Name
41385 @tab Value Required
41386 @tab Default
41387 @tab Probe Allowed
41388
41389 @item @samp{PacketSize}
41390 @tab Yes
41391 @tab @samp{-}
41392 @tab No
41393
41394 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
41395 @tab No
41396 @tab @samp{-}
41397 @tab Yes
41398
41399 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
41400 @tab No
41401 @tab @samp{-}
41402 @tab Yes
41403
41404 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
41405 @tab No
41406 @tab @samp{-}
41407 @tab Yes
41408
41409 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
41410 @tab No
41411 @tab @samp{-}
41412 @tab Yes
41413
41414 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
41415 @tab No
41416 @tab @samp{-}
41417 @tab Yes
41418
41419 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41420 @tab No
41421 @tab @samp{-}
41422 @tab Yes
41423
41424 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
41425 @tab No
41426 @tab @samp{-}
41427 @tab Yes
41428
41429 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
41430 @tab No
41431 @tab @samp{-}
41432 @tab No
41433
41434 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
41435 @tab No
41436 @tab @samp{-}
41437 @tab Yes
41438
41439 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
41440 @tab No
41441 @tab @samp{-}
41442 @tab Yes
41443
41444 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
41445 @tab No
41446 @tab @samp{-}
41447 @tab Yes
41448
41449 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
41450 @tab No
41451 @tab @samp{-}
41452 @tab Yes
41453
41454 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
41455 @tab No
41456 @tab @samp{-}
41457 @tab Yes
41458
41459 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
41460 @tab No
41461 @tab @samp{-}
41462 @tab Yes
41463
41464 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
41465 @tab No
41466 @tab @samp{-}
41467 @tab Yes
41468
41469 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
41470 @tab No
41471 @tab @samp{-}
41472 @tab Yes
41473
41474 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
41475 @tab Yes
41476 @tab @samp{-}
41477 @tab Yes
41478
41479 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
41480 @tab Yes
41481 @tab @samp{-}
41482 @tab Yes
41483
41484 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
41485 @tab Yes
41486 @tab @samp{-}
41487 @tab Yes
41488
41489 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
41490 @tab Yes
41491 @tab @samp{-}
41492 @tab Yes
41493
41494 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
41495 @tab Yes
41496 @tab @samp{-}
41497 @tab Yes
41498
41499 @item @samp{QNonStop}
41500 @tab No
41501 @tab @samp{-}
41502 @tab Yes
41503
41504 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
41505 @tab No
41506 @tab @samp{-}
41507 @tab Yes
41508
41509 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
41510 @tab No
41511 @tab @samp{-}
41512 @tab Yes
41513
41514 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
41515 @tab No
41516 @tab @samp{-}
41517 @tab Yes
41518
41519 @item @samp{multiprocess}
41520 @tab No
41521 @tab @samp{-}
41522 @tab No
41523
41524 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
41525 @tab No
41526 @tab @samp{-}
41527 @tab No
41528
41529 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
41530 @tab No
41531 @tab @samp{-}
41532 @tab No
41533
41534 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
41535 @tab No
41536 @tab @samp{-}
41537 @tab No
41538
41539 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
41540 @tab No
41541 @tab @samp{-}
41542 @tab No
41543
41544 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
41545 @tab No
41546 @tab @samp{-}
41547 @tab No
41548
41549 @item @samp{QAgent}
41550 @tab No
41551 @tab @samp{-}
41552 @tab No
41553
41554 @item @samp{QAllow}
41555 @tab No
41556 @tab @samp{-}
41557 @tab No
41558
41559 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
41560 @tab No
41561 @tab @samp{-}
41562 @tab No
41563
41564 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
41565 @tab No
41566 @tab @samp{-}
41567 @tab No
41568
41569 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
41570 @tab No
41571 @tab @samp{-}
41572 @tab No
41573
41574 @item @samp{tracenz}
41575 @tab No
41576 @tab @samp{-}
41577 @tab No
41578
41579 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
41580 @tab No
41581 @tab @samp{-}
41582 @tab No
41583
41584 @item @samp{swbreak}
41585 @tab No
41586 @tab @samp{-}
41587 @tab No
41588
41589 @item @samp{hwbreak}
41590 @tab No
41591 @tab @samp{-}
41592 @tab No
41593
41594 @item @samp{fork-events}
41595 @tab No
41596 @tab @samp{-}
41597 @tab No
41598
41599 @item @samp{vfork-events}
41600 @tab No
41601 @tab @samp{-}
41602 @tab No
41603
41604 @item @samp{exec-events}
41605 @tab No
41606 @tab @samp{-}
41607 @tab No
41608
41609 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
41610 @tab No
41611 @tab @samp{-}
41612 @tab No
41613
41614 @item @samp{no-resumed}
41615 @tab No
41616 @tab @samp{-}
41617 @tab No
41618
41619 @end multitable
41620
41621 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
41622
41623 @table @samp
41624 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
41625 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
41626 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
41627 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
41628 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
41629 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
41630 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
41631 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
41632 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
41633 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
41634
41635 @item qXfer:auxv:read
41636 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
41637 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
41638
41639 @item qXfer:btrace:read
41640 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
41641 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
41642
41643 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
41644 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
41645 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
41646
41647 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
41648 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
41649 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
41650
41651 @item qXfer:features:read
41652 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
41653 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
41654
41655 @item qXfer:libraries:read
41656 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
41657 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
41658
41659 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
41660 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
41661 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
41662
41663 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
41664 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
41665 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
41666 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
41667
41668 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
41669 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
41670 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
41671
41672 @item qXfer:sdata:read
41673 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
41674 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
41675
41676 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
41677 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
41678 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
41679
41680 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
41681 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
41682 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
41683
41684 @item qXfer:threads:read
41685 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
41686 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
41687
41688 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
41689 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
41690 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
41691
41692 @item qXfer:uib:read
41693 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
41694 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
41695
41696 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
41697 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
41698 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
41699
41700 @item QNonStop
41701 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
41702 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
41703
41704 @item QCatchSyscalls
41705 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
41706 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
41707
41708 @item QPassSignals
41709 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
41710 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
41711
41712 @item QStartNoAckMode
41713 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
41714 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
41715
41716 @item multiprocess
41717 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
41718 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
41719 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
41720 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
41721 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
41722 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
41723 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
41724 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
41725 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
41726 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
41727 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
41728
41729 @item qXfer:osdata:read
41730 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
41731 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
41732
41733 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
41734 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
41735 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
41736 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
41737
41738 @item ConditionalTracepoints
41739 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
41740 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
41741
41742 @item ReverseContinue
41743 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
41744 (@pxref{bc}).
41745
41746 @item ReverseStep
41747 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
41748 (@pxref{bs}).
41749
41750 @item TracepointSource
41751 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
41752 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
41753
41754 @item QAgent
41755 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
41756
41757 @item QAllow
41758 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
41759
41760 @item QDisableRandomization
41761 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
41762
41763 @item StaticTracepoint
41764 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
41765 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
41766
41767 @item InstallInTrace
41768 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
41769 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
41770
41771 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
41772 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
41773 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
41774 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
41775
41776 @item QTBuffer:size
41777 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
41778 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
41779
41780 @item tracenz
41781 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
41782 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
41783 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
41784
41785 @item BreakpointCommands
41786 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
41787 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
41788 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
41789
41790 @item Qbtrace:off
41791 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
41792
41793 @item Qbtrace:bts
41794 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
41795
41796 @item Qbtrace:pt
41797 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
41798
41799 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
41800 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
41801
41802 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
41803 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
41804
41805 @item swbreak
41806 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
41807 breakpoints.
41808
41809 @item hwbreak
41810 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
41811 breakpoints.
41812
41813 @item fork-events
41814 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
41815
41816 @item vfork-events
41817 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
41818 and vforkdone events.
41819
41820 @item exec-events
41821 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
41822
41823 @item vContSupported
41824 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
41825 @samp{vCont?} packet.
41826
41827 @item QThreadEvents
41828 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
41829
41830 @item no-resumed
41831 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
41832
41833 @end table
41834
41835 @item qSymbol::
41836 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
41837 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
41838 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
41839 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
41840
41841 Reply:
41842 @table @samp
41843 @item OK
41844 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
41845 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
41846 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
41847 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
41848 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
41849 below.
41850 @end table
41851
41852 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
41853 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
41854
41855 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
41856 target has previously requested.
41857
41858 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
41859 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
41860 will be empty.
41861
41862 Reply:
41863 @table @samp
41864 @item OK
41865 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
41866 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
41867 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
41868 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
41869 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
41870 @end table
41871
41872 @item qTBuffer
41873 @itemx QTBuffer
41874 @itemx QTDisconnected
41875 @itemx QTDP
41876 @itemx QTDPsrc
41877 @itemx QTDV
41878 @itemx qTfP
41879 @itemx qTfV
41880 @itemx QTFrame
41881 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
41882
41883 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
41884
41885 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
41886 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
41887 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
41888 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
41889 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
41890 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
41891 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
41892 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
41893 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
41894 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
41895 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
41896
41897 Reply:
41898 @table @samp
41899 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
41900 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
41901 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
41902 the thread's attributes.
41903 @end table
41904
41905 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
41906 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
41907 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
41908 packets.)
41909
41910 @item QTNotes
41911 @itemx qTP
41912 @itemx QTSave
41913 @itemx qTsP
41914 @itemx qTsV
41915 @itemx QTStart
41916 @itemx QTStop
41917 @itemx QTEnable
41918 @itemx QTDisable
41919 @itemx QTinit
41920 @itemx QTro
41921 @itemx qTStatus
41922 @itemx qTV
41923 @itemx qTfSTM
41924 @itemx qTsSTM
41925 @itemx qTSTMat
41926 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
41927
41928 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
41929 @cindex read special object, remote request
41930 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
41931 @anchor{qXfer read}
41932 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
41933 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
41934 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
41935 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
41936 additional details about what data to access.
41937
41938 Reply:
41939 @table @samp
41940 @item m @var{data}
41941 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
41942 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
41943 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
41944 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
41945 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
41946 request.
41947
41948 @item l @var{data}
41949 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
41950 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
41951 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
41952
41953 @item l
41954 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
41955 There is no more data to be read.
41956
41957 @item E00
41958 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
41959
41960 @item E @var{nn}
41961 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
41962 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
41963
41964 @item @w{}
41965 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
41966 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
41967 @end table
41968
41969 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
41970 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
41971 formats, listed above.
41972
41973 @table @samp
41974 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
41975 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
41976 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
41977 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
41978
41979 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
41980 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
41981
41982 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
41983 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
41984
41985 Return a description of the current branch trace.
41986 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
41987 packet may have one of the following values:
41988
41989 @table @code
41990 @item all
41991 Returns all available branch trace.
41992
41993 @item new
41994 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
41995 the last read request.
41996
41997 @item delta
41998 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
41999 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
42000 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
42001 used to stitch traces together.
42002
42003 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
42004 @end table
42005
42006 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
42007 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
42008
42009 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
42010 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
42011
42012 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
42013 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
42014
42015 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
42016 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
42017
42018 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
42019 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
42020 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
42021 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
42022 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
42023 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
42024 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
42025
42026 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42027 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
42028
42029 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
42030 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
42031 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
42032 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
42033 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
42034
42035 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42036 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
42037
42038 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
42039 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
42040 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
42041 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
42042 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
42043
42044 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
42045 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
42046 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
42047
42048 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42049 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
42050
42051 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
42052 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
42053 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
42054 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
42055 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
42056 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
42057 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
42058 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
42059
42060 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
42061 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
42062
42063 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42064 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
42065
42066 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
42067 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
42068 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
42069 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
42070
42071 @table @code
42072 @item start=@var{address}
42073 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
42074 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
42075 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
42076 chosen as the starting point.
42077
42078 @item prev=@var{address}
42079 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
42080 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
42081 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
42082 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
42083 exists prior to the starting point.
42084
42085 @end table
42086
42087 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
42088 ignored.
42089
42090 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
42091 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
42092 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
42093 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
42094 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
42095
42096 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42097 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
42098
42099 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
42100 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
42101
42102 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
42103 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
42104 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
42105 Action Lists}.
42106
42107 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42108 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
42109 (@pxref{qSupported}).
42110
42111 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
42112 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
42113 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
42114 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
42115 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
42116
42117 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42118 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
42119 (@pxref{qSupported}).
42120
42121 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
42122 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
42123 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
42124 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
42125 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
42126
42127 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42128 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
42129
42130 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
42131 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
42132
42133 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
42134 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
42135 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
42136
42137 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42138 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
42139
42140 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
42141 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
42142
42143 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
42144 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
42145
42146 This packet is not probed by default.
42147
42148 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
42149 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
42150 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
42151 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
42152 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
42153
42154 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42155 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
42156
42157 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
42158 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
42159 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
42160 @xref{Operating System Information}.
42161
42162 @end table
42163
42164 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
42165 @cindex write data into object, remote request
42166 @anchor{qXfer write}
42167 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
42168 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
42169 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
42170 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
42171 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
42172 to access.
42173
42174 Reply:
42175 @table @samp
42176 @item @var{nn}
42177 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
42178 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
42179
42180 @item E00
42181 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
42182
42183 @item E @var{nn}
42184 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
42185 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
42186
42187 @item @w{}
42188 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
42189 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
42190 @end table
42191
42192 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
42193 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
42194 formats, listed above.
42195
42196 @table @samp
42197 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
42198 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
42199 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
42200 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
42201 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
42202
42203 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42204 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
42205 (@pxref{qSupported}).
42206 @end table
42207
42208 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
42209 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
42210 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
42211 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
42212 must respond with an empty packet.
42213
42214 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
42215 @cindex query attached, remote request
42216 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
42217 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
42218 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
42219 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
42220 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
42221 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
42222 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
42223
42224 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
42225 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
42226 the @code{quit} command.
42227
42228 Reply:
42229 @table @samp
42230 @item 1
42231 The remote server attached to an existing process.
42232 @item 0
42233 The remote server created a new process.
42234 @item E @var{NN}
42235 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
42236 @end table
42237
42238 @item Qbtrace:bts
42239 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
42240
42241 Reply:
42242 @table @samp
42243 @item OK
42244 Branch tracing has been enabled.
42245 @item E.errtext
42246 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
42247 @end table
42248
42249 @item Qbtrace:pt
42250 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
42251
42252 Reply:
42253 @table @samp
42254 @item OK
42255 Branch tracing has been enabled.
42256 @item E.errtext
42257 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
42258 @end table
42259
42260 @item Qbtrace:off
42261 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
42262
42263 Reply:
42264 @table @samp
42265 @item OK
42266 Branch tracing has been disabled.
42267 @item E.errtext
42268 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
42269 @end table
42270
42271 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
42272 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
42273 btrace recording method in bts format.
42274
42275 Reply:
42276 @table @samp
42277 @item OK
42278 The ring buffer size has been set.
42279 @item E.errtext
42280 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
42281 @end table
42282
42283 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
42284 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
42285 btrace recording method in pt format.
42286
42287 Reply:
42288 @table @samp
42289 @item OK
42290 The ring buffer size has been set.
42291 @item E.errtext
42292 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
42293 @end table
42294
42295 @end table
42296
42297 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
42298 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
42299
42300 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
42301 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
42302 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
42303
42304 @menu
42305 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
42306 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
42307 @end menu
42308
42309 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
42310 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
42311
42312 @menu
42313 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
42314 @end menu
42315
42316 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
42317 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
42318 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
42319
42320 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
42321
42322 @table @r
42323
42324 @item 2
42325 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
42326
42327 @item 3
42328 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
42329
42330 @item 4
42331 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
42332
42333 @end table
42334
42335 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
42336 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
42337
42338 @menu
42339 * MIPS Register packet Format::
42340 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
42341 @end menu
42342
42343 @node MIPS Register packet Format
42344 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
42345 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
42346
42347 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
42348 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
42349 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
42350 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
42351 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
42352 most-significant -- least-significant.
42353
42354 @table @r
42355
42356 @item MIPS32
42357 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
42358 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
42359 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
42360
42361 @item MIPS64
42362 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
42363 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
42364 as @code{MIPS32}.
42365
42366 @end table
42367
42368 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
42369 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
42370 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
42371
42372 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
42373
42374 @table @r
42375
42376 @item 2
42377 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
42378
42379 @item 3
42380 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
42381
42382 @item 4
42383 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
42384
42385 @item 5
42386 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
42387
42388 @end table
42389
42390 @node Tracepoint Packets
42391 @section Tracepoint Packets
42392 @cindex tracepoint packets
42393 @cindex packets, tracepoint
42394
42395 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
42396 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
42397
42398 @table @samp
42399
42400 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
42401 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
42402 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
42403 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
42404 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
42405 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
42406 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
42407 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
42408 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
42409 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
42410 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
42411 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
42412 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
42413 actions.
42414
42415 Replies:
42416 @table @samp
42417 @item OK
42418 The packet was understood and carried out.
42419 @item qRelocInsn
42420 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
42421 @item @w{}
42422 The packet was not recognized.
42423 @end table
42424
42425 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
42426 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
42427 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
42428 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
42429 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
42430 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
42431 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
42432
42433 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
42434 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
42435 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
42436 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
42437 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
42438 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
42439 tracepoint actions.
42440
42441 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
42442 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
42443 following forms:
42444
42445 @table @samp
42446
42447 @item R @var{mask}
42448 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
42449 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
42450 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
42451 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
42452 not fit in a 32-bit word.
42453
42454 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
42455 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
42456 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
42457 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
42458 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
42459 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
42460 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
42461
42462 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
42463 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
42464 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
42465 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
42466 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
42467 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
42468 packet).
42469
42470 @end table
42471
42472 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
42473 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
42474 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
42475 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
42476 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
42477 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
42478 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
42479 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
42480
42481 Replies:
42482 @table @samp
42483 @item OK
42484 The packet was understood and carried out.
42485 @item qRelocInsn
42486 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
42487 @item @w{}
42488 The packet was not recognized.
42489 @end table
42490
42491 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
42492 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
42493 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
42494 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
42495 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
42496 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
42497 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
42498 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
42499
42500 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
42501 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
42502 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
42503 fit in a single packet.
42504 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
42505 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
42506
42507 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
42508 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
42509 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
42510 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
42511
42512 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
42513 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
42514 query packets.
42515
42516 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
42517 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
42518 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
42519 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
42520 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
42521 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
42522 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
42523 be found.
42524
42525 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
42526 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
42527 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
42528 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
42529 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
42530 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
42531 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
42532 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
42533 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
42534 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
42535 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
42536 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
42537 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
42538 variable.
42539
42540 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
42541 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
42542 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
42543 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
42544 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
42545
42546 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
42547 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
42548 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
42549 one of the following forms:
42550
42551 @table @samp
42552 @item F @var{f}
42553 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
42554 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
42555 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
42556
42557 @item T @var{t}
42558 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
42559 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
42560
42561 @end table
42562
42563 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
42564 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
42565 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
42566 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
42567
42568 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
42569 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
42570 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
42571 is a hexadecimal number.
42572
42573 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
42574 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
42575 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
42576 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
42577 numbers.
42578
42579 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
42580 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
42581 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
42582
42583 @item qTMinFTPILen
42584 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
42585 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
42586 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
42587 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
42588 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
42589 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
42590 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
42591 arrange for that.
42592
42593 Replies:
42594
42595 @table @samp
42596 @item 0
42597 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
42598 @item @var{length}
42599 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
42600 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
42601 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
42602 regardless of size.
42603 @item E
42604 An error has occurred.
42605 @item @w{}
42606 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
42607 @end table
42608
42609 @item QTStart
42610 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
42611 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
42612 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
42613 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
42614 instruction reply packet}).
42615
42616 @item QTStop
42617 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
42618 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
42619
42620 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
42621 @anchor{QTEnable}
42622 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
42623 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
42624 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
42625 of data from it will resume.
42626
42627 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
42628 @anchor{QTDisable}
42629 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
42630 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
42631 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
42632 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
42633
42634 @item QTinit
42635 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
42636 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
42637
42638 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
42639 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
42640 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
42641 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
42642 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
42643
42644 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
42645 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
42646 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
42647 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
42648
42649 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
42650 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
42651 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
42652 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
42653 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
42654 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
42655
42656 @item qTStatus
42657 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
42658 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
42659
42660 The reply has the form:
42661
42662 @table @samp
42663
42664 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
42665 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
42666 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
42667 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
42668
42669 @end table
42670
42671 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
42672 explanations as one of the optional fields:
42673
42674 @table @samp
42675
42676 @item tnotrun:0
42677 No trace has been run yet.
42678
42679 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
42680 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
42681 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
42682 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
42683 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
42684
42685 @item tfull:0
42686 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
42687
42688 @item tdisconnected:0
42689 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
42690
42691 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
42692 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
42693
42694 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
42695 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
42696 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
42697 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
42698 is hex encoded.
42699
42700 @item tunknown:0
42701 The trace stopped for some other reason.
42702
42703 @end table
42704
42705 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
42706 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
42707 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
42708 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
42709 trace.
42710
42711 @table @samp
42712
42713 @item tframes:@var{n}
42714 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
42715
42716 @item tcreated:@var{n}
42717 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
42718 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
42719
42720 @item tsize:@var{n}
42721 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
42722
42723 @item tfree:@var{n}
42724 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
42725
42726 @item circular:@var{n}
42727 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
42728 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
42729 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
42730 and may fill up.
42731
42732 @item disconn:@var{n}
42733 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
42734 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
42735 that the trace run will stop.
42736
42737 @end table
42738
42739 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
42740 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
42741 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
42742 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
42743 address @var{addr}.
42744
42745 Replies:
42746 @table @samp
42747 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
42748 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
42749 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
42750 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
42751 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
42752
42753 @end table
42754
42755 @item qTV:@var{var}
42756 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
42757 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
42758 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
42759
42760 Replies:
42761 @table @samp
42762 @item V@var{value}
42763 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
42764 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
42765 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
42766 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
42767 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
42768 program is running.
42769
42770 @item U
42771 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
42772 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
42773 was not collected.
42774 @end table
42775
42776 @item qTfP
42777 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
42778 @itemx qTsP
42779 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
42780 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
42781 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
42782 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
42783 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
42784 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
42785
42786 @item qTfV
42787 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
42788 @itemx qTsV
42789 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
42790 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
42791 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
42792 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
42793 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
42794 trace state variables.
42795
42796 @item qTfSTM
42797 @itemx qTsSTM
42798 @anchor{qTfSTM}
42799 @anchor{qTsSTM}
42800 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
42801 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
42802 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
42803 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
42804 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
42805 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
42806
42807 Reply:
42808 @table @samp
42809 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
42810 A single marker
42811 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
42812 a comma-separated list of markers
42813 @item l
42814 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
42815 @item E @var{nn}
42816 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
42817 @item @w{}
42818 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
42819 stub.
42820 @end table
42821
42822 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
42823 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
42824
42825 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
42826 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
42827 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
42828 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
42829 @dfn{last}).
42830
42831 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
42832 @anchor{qTSTMat}
42833 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
42834 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
42835 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
42836 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
42837 tracepoint markers.
42838
42839 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
42840 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
42841 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
42842 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
42843 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
42844 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
42845
42846 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
42847 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
42848 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
42849 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
42850 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
42851 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
42852 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
42853 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
42854 available.
42855
42856 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
42857 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
42858 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
42859
42860 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
42861 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
42862 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
42863 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
42864 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
42865 use whatever size it prefers.
42866
42867 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
42868 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
42869 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
42870 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
42871 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
42872
42873 @end table
42874
42875 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
42876 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
42877 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
42878 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
42879 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
42880 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
42881 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
42882 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
42883 it had executed in the original location.
42884
42885 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
42886 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
42887 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
42888 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
42889 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
42890 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
42891 format of the request is:
42892
42893 @table @samp
42894 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
42895
42896 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
42897 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
42898 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
42899 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
42900 memory starting at @var{to}.
42901 @end table
42902
42903 Replies:
42904 @table @samp
42905 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
42906 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
42907 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
42908 @item E @var{NN}
42909 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
42910 relocating the instruction.
42911 @end table
42912
42913 @node Host I/O Packets
42914 @section Host I/O Packets
42915 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
42916 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
42917
42918 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
42919 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
42920 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
42921 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
42922 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
42923 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
42924 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
42925 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
42926 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
42927 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
42928
42929 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
42930 its arguments. They have this format:
42931
42932 @table @samp
42933
42934 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
42935 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
42936 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
42937 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
42938 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
42939 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
42940 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
42941 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
42942 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
42943
42944 @end table
42945
42946 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
42947
42948 @table @samp
42949
42950 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
42951 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
42952 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
42953 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
42954 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
42955 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
42956 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
42957 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
42958 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
42959 @var{attachment}.
42960
42961 @item @w{}
42962 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
42963
42964 @end table
42965
42966 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
42967
42968 @table @samp
42969 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
42970 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
42971 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
42972 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
42973 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
42974 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
42975 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
42976
42977 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
42978 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
42979 -1 if an error occurs.
42980
42981 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
42982 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
42983 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
42984 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
42985 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
42986 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
42987 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
42988 @var{count} was zero.
42989
42990 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
42991 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
42992 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
42993 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
42994 some characters were escaped.
42995
42996 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
42997 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
42998 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
42999 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
43000 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
43001 packet is used. @samp{vFile:pwrite} returns the number of bytes written,
43002 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
43003 error occurred.
43004
43005 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
43006 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
43007 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
43008 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
43009 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
43010 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
43011
43012 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
43013 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
43014 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
43015
43016 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
43017 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
43018 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
43019
43020 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
43021 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
43022 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
43023 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
43024 some characters were escaped.
43025
43026 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
43027 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
43028 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
43029 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
43030 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
43031 inferior(s).
43032
43033 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
43034 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
43035 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
43036 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
43037 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
43038 operation.
43039
43040 @end table
43041
43042 @node Interrupts
43043 @section Interrupts
43044 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
43045 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
43046
43047 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
43048 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
43049 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
43050 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
43051
43052 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
43053 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
43054 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
43055 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
43056 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
43057
43058 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
43059 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
43060 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
43061 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
43062 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
43063 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
43064 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
43065 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
43066
43067 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
43068 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
43069 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
43070
43071 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
43072 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
43073 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
43074 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
43075 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
43076 @code{0x03}.
43077
43078 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
43079 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
43080 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
43081 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
43082 currently-executing threads and processes.
43083 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
43084 running program, it should send one of the stop
43085 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
43086 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
43087 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
43088 Interrupts received while the
43089 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
43090 it is resumed next time.
43091
43092 @node Notification Packets
43093 @section Notification Packets
43094 @cindex notification packets
43095 @cindex packets, notification
43096
43097 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
43098 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
43099 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
43100 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
43101 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
43102 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
43103 is not a problem.
43104
43105 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
43106 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
43107 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
43108 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
43109 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
43110 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
43111 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
43112
43113 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
43114 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
43115
43116 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
43117 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
43118 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
43119 not they understand it.
43120
43121 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
43122 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
43123 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
43124 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
43125 recipients.
43126
43127 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
43128 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
43129 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
43130 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
43131 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
43132
43133 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
43134 @table @samp
43135 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
43136 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
43137 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
43138 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
43139 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
43140 @item @var{ack}
43141 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
43142 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
43143 @end table
43144
43145 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
43146 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
43147
43148 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
43149 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
43150 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
43151 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
43152 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
43153 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
43154 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
43155 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
43156 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
43157 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
43158
43159 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
43160 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
43161 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
43162 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
43163 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
43164 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
43165
43166 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
43167 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
43168 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
43169 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
43170 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
43171
43172 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
43173 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
43174 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
43175 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
43176 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
43177 normally.
43178
43179 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
43180 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
43181 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
43182 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
43183 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
43184 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
43185 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
43186 the process shall be repeated.
43187
43188 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
43189 following example:
43190 @smallexample
43191 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
43192 @code{...}
43193 -> @code{vStopped}
43194 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
43195 -> @code{vStopped}
43196 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
43197 -> @code{vStopped}
43198 <- @code{OK}
43199 @end smallexample
43200
43201 The following notifications are defined:
43202 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
43203
43204 @item Notification
43205 @tab Ack
43206 @tab Event
43207 @tab Description
43208
43209 @item Stop
43210 @tab vStopped
43211 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
43212 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
43213 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
43214 @value{GDBN}.
43215 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
43216
43217 @end multitable
43218
43219 @node Remote Non-Stop
43220 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
43221
43222 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
43223 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
43224 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
43225 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
43226
43227 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
43228 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
43229 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
43230 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
43231 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
43232 probe the target state after a mode change.
43233
43234 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
43235 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
43236 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
43237 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
43238 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
43239 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
43240 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
43241 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
43242 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
43243 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
43244 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
43245
43246 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
43247 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
43248 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
43249 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
43250 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
43251 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
43252 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
43253 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
43254 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
43255 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
43256 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
43257 @samp{OK}.
43258
43259 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
43260 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
43261 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
43262 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
43263 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
43264 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
43265 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
43266 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
43267 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
43268 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
43269 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
43270 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
43271 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
43272
43273 @node Packet Acknowledgment
43274 @section Packet Acknowledgment
43275
43276 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
43277 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
43278 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
43279 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
43280 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
43281 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
43282 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
43283
43284 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
43285 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
43286 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
43287 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
43288 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
43289
43290 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
43291 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
43292 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
43293 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
43294
43295 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
43296 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
43297 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
43298 @pxref{qSupported}.
43299 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
43300 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
43301 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
43302 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
43303 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
43304 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
43305 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
43306
43307 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
43308 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
43309 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
43310 connection.
43311 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
43312 new connection is established,
43313 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
43314 for the current connection, once disabled.
43315
43316 @node Examples
43317 @section Examples
43318
43319 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
43320 does not get any direct output:
43321
43322 @smallexample
43323 -> @code{R00}
43324 <- @code{+}
43325 @emph{target restarts}
43326 -> @code{?}
43327 <- @code{+}
43328 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
43329 -> @code{+}
43330 @end smallexample
43331
43332 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
43333
43334 @smallexample
43335 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
43336 <- @code{+}
43337 -> @code{s}
43338 <- @code{+}
43339 @emph{time passes}
43340 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
43341 -> @code{+}
43342 -> @code{g}
43343 <- @code{+}
43344 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
43345 -> @code{+}
43346 @end smallexample
43347
43348 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
43349 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
43350 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
43351
43352 @menu
43353 * File-I/O Overview::
43354 * Protocol Basics::
43355 * The F Request Packet::
43356 * The F Reply Packet::
43357 * The Ctrl-C Message::
43358 * Console I/O::
43359 * List of Supported Calls::
43360 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
43361 * Constants::
43362 * File-I/O Examples::
43363 @end menu
43364
43365 @node File-I/O Overview
43366 @subsection File-I/O Overview
43367 @cindex file-i/o overview
43368
43369 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
43370 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
43371 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
43372 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
43373 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
43374 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
43375
43376 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
43377 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
43378 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
43379 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
43380 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
43381
43382 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
43383 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
43384 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
43385 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
43386 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
43387 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
43388 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
43389
43390 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
43391 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
43392 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
43393 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
43394 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
43395
43396 @smallexample
43397 (@value{GDBP}) continue
43398 <- target requests 'system call X'
43399 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
43400 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
43401 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
43402 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
43403 @end smallexample
43404
43405 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
43406 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
43407 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
43408 system are not supported by this protocol.
43409
43410 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
43411
43412 @node Protocol Basics
43413 @subsection Protocol Basics
43414 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
43415
43416 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
43417 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
43418 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
43419 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
43420 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
43421 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
43422 to call the appropriate host system call:
43423
43424 @itemize @bullet
43425 @item
43426 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
43427
43428 @item
43429 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
43430 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
43431 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
43432 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
43433
43434 @end itemize
43435
43436 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
43437
43438 @itemize @bullet
43439 @item
43440 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
43441 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
43442 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
43443 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
43444 packet.
43445
43446 @item
43447 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
43448 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
43449
43450 @item
43451 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
43452
43453 @item
43454 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
43455
43456 @item
43457 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
43458 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
43459 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
43460 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
43461 packet.
43462
43463 @end itemize
43464
43465 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
43466 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
43467
43468 @itemize @bullet
43469 @item
43470 Return value.
43471
43472 @item
43473 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
43474
43475 @item
43476 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
43477
43478 @end itemize
43479
43480 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
43481 the latest continue or step action.
43482
43483 @node The F Request Packet
43484 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
43485 @cindex file-i/o request packet
43486 @cindex @code{F} request packet
43487
43488 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
43489
43490 @table @samp
43491 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
43492
43493 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
43494 This is just the name of the function.
43495
43496 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
43497 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
43498 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
43499 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
43500 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
43501 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
43502 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
43503
43504 @end table
43505
43506
43507
43508 @node The F Reply Packet
43509 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
43510 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
43511 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
43512
43513 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
43514
43515 @table @samp
43516
43517 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
43518
43519 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
43520
43521 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
43522 representation.
43523 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
43524
43525 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
43526 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
43527 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
43528
43529 @smallexample
43530 F0,0,C
43531 @end smallexample
43532
43533 @noindent
43534 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
43535
43536 @smallexample
43537 F-1,4,C
43538 @end smallexample
43539
43540 @noindent
43541 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
43542
43543 @end table
43544
43545
43546 @node The Ctrl-C Message
43547 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
43548 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
43549
43550 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
43551 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
43552 the target should behave as if it had
43553 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
43554 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
43555 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
43556 packet.
43557
43558 It's important for the target to know in which
43559 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
43560
43561 @itemize @bullet
43562 @item
43563 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
43564
43565 @item
43566 The system call on the host has been finished.
43567
43568 @end itemize
43569
43570 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
43571 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
43572 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
43573 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
43574 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
43575 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
43576
43577 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
43578 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
43579 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
43580 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
43581 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
43582 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
43583 or the full action has been completed.
43584
43585 @node Console I/O
43586 @subsection Console I/O
43587 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
43588
43589 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
43590 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
43591 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
43592 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
43593 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
43594 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
43595 conditions is met:
43596
43597 @itemize @bullet
43598 @item
43599 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
43600 @code{read}
43601 system call is treated as finished.
43602
43603 @item
43604 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
43605 newline.
43606
43607 @item
43608 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
43609 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
43610
43611 @end itemize
43612
43613 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
43614 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
43615 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
43616 is stopped at the user's request.
43617
43618
43619 @node List of Supported Calls
43620 @subsection List of Supported Calls
43621 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
43622
43623 @menu
43624 * open::
43625 * close::
43626 * read::
43627 * write::
43628 * lseek::
43629 * rename::
43630 * unlink::
43631 * stat/fstat::
43632 * gettimeofday::
43633 * isatty::
43634 * system::
43635 @end menu
43636
43637 @node open
43638 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
43639 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
43640
43641 @table @asis
43642 @item Synopsis:
43643 @smallexample
43644 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
43645 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
43646 @end smallexample
43647
43648 @item Request:
43649 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
43650
43651 @noindent
43652 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
43653
43654 @table @code
43655 @item O_CREAT
43656 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
43657 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
43658 are concerned.
43659
43660 @item O_EXCL
43661 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
43662 an error and open() fails.
43663
43664 @item O_TRUNC
43665 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
43666 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
43667 truncated to zero length.
43668
43669 @item O_APPEND
43670 The file is opened in append mode.
43671
43672 @item O_RDONLY
43673 The file is opened for reading only.
43674
43675 @item O_WRONLY
43676 The file is opened for writing only.
43677
43678 @item O_RDWR
43679 The file is opened for reading and writing.
43680 @end table
43681
43682 @noindent
43683 Other bits are silently ignored.
43684
43685
43686 @noindent
43687 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
43688
43689 @table @code
43690 @item S_IRUSR
43691 User has read permission.
43692
43693 @item S_IWUSR
43694 User has write permission.
43695
43696 @item S_IRGRP
43697 Group has read permission.
43698
43699 @item S_IWGRP
43700 Group has write permission.
43701
43702 @item S_IROTH
43703 Others have read permission.
43704
43705 @item S_IWOTH
43706 Others have write permission.
43707 @end table
43708
43709 @noindent
43710 Other bits are silently ignored.
43711
43712
43713 @item Return value:
43714 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
43715 occurred.
43716
43717 @item Errors:
43718
43719 @table @code
43720 @item EEXIST
43721 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
43722
43723 @item EISDIR
43724 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
43725
43726 @item EACCES
43727 The requested access is not allowed.
43728
43729 @item ENAMETOOLONG
43730 @var{pathname} was too long.
43731
43732 @item ENOENT
43733 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
43734
43735 @item ENODEV
43736 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
43737
43738 @item EROFS
43739 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
43740 write access was requested.
43741
43742 @item EFAULT
43743 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
43744
43745 @item ENOSPC
43746 No space on device to create the file.
43747
43748 @item EMFILE
43749 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
43750
43751 @item ENFILE
43752 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
43753 has been reached.
43754
43755 @item EINTR
43756 The call was interrupted by the user.
43757 @end table
43758
43759 @end table
43760
43761 @node close
43762 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
43763 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
43764
43765 @table @asis
43766 @item Synopsis:
43767 @smallexample
43768 int close(int fd);
43769 @end smallexample
43770
43771 @item Request:
43772 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
43773
43774 @item Return value:
43775 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
43776
43777 @item Errors:
43778
43779 @table @code
43780 @item EBADF
43781 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
43782
43783 @item EINTR
43784 The call was interrupted by the user.
43785 @end table
43786
43787 @end table
43788
43789 @node read
43790 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
43791 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
43792
43793 @table @asis
43794 @item Synopsis:
43795 @smallexample
43796 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
43797 @end smallexample
43798
43799 @item Request:
43800 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
43801
43802 @item Return value:
43803 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
43804 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
43805 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
43806
43807 @item Errors:
43808
43809 @table @code
43810 @item EBADF
43811 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
43812 reading.
43813
43814 @item EFAULT
43815 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
43816
43817 @item EINTR
43818 The call was interrupted by the user.
43819 @end table
43820
43821 @end table
43822
43823 @node write
43824 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
43825 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
43826
43827 @table @asis
43828 @item Synopsis:
43829 @smallexample
43830 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
43831 @end smallexample
43832
43833 @item Request:
43834 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
43835
43836 @item Return value:
43837 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
43838 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
43839 is returned.
43840
43841 @item Errors:
43842
43843 @table @code
43844 @item EBADF
43845 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
43846 writing.
43847
43848 @item EFAULT
43849 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
43850
43851 @item EFBIG
43852 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
43853 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
43854
43855 @item ENOSPC
43856 No space on device to write the data.
43857
43858 @item EINTR
43859 The call was interrupted by the user.
43860 @end table
43861
43862 @end table
43863
43864 @node lseek
43865 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
43866 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
43867
43868 @table @asis
43869 @item Synopsis:
43870 @smallexample
43871 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
43872 @end smallexample
43873
43874 @item Request:
43875 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
43876
43877 @var{flag} is one of:
43878
43879 @table @code
43880 @item SEEK_SET
43881 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
43882
43883 @item SEEK_CUR
43884 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
43885 bytes.
43886
43887 @item SEEK_END
43888 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
43889 bytes.
43890 @end table
43891
43892 @item Return value:
43893 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
43894 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
43895 value of -1 is returned.
43896
43897 @item Errors:
43898
43899 @table @code
43900 @item EBADF
43901 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
43902
43903 @item ESPIPE
43904 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
43905
43906 @item EINVAL
43907 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
43908
43909 @item EINTR
43910 The call was interrupted by the user.
43911 @end table
43912
43913 @end table
43914
43915 @node rename
43916 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
43917 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
43918
43919 @table @asis
43920 @item Synopsis:
43921 @smallexample
43922 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
43923 @end smallexample
43924
43925 @item Request:
43926 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
43927
43928 @item Return value:
43929 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
43930
43931 @item Errors:
43932
43933 @table @code
43934 @item EISDIR
43935 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
43936 directory.
43937
43938 @item EEXIST
43939 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
43940
43941 @item EBUSY
43942 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
43943 process.
43944
43945 @item EINVAL
43946 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
43947 of itself.
43948
43949 @item ENOTDIR
43950 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
43951 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
43952 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
43953
43954 @item EFAULT
43955 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
43956
43957 @item EACCES
43958 No access to the file or the path of the file.
43959
43960 @item ENAMETOOLONG
43961
43962 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
43963
43964 @item ENOENT
43965 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
43966
43967 @item EROFS
43968 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
43969
43970 @item ENOSPC
43971 The device containing the file has no room for the new
43972 directory entry.
43973
43974 @item EINTR
43975 The call was interrupted by the user.
43976 @end table
43977
43978 @end table
43979
43980 @node unlink
43981 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
43982 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
43983
43984 @table @asis
43985 @item Synopsis:
43986 @smallexample
43987 int unlink(const char *pathname);
43988 @end smallexample
43989
43990 @item Request:
43991 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
43992
43993 @item Return value:
43994 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
43995
43996 @item Errors:
43997
43998 @table @code
43999 @item EACCES
44000 No access to the file or the path of the file.
44001
44002 @item EPERM
44003 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
44004
44005 @item EBUSY
44006 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
44007 being used by another process.
44008
44009 @item EFAULT
44010 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
44011
44012 @item ENAMETOOLONG
44013 @var{pathname} was too long.
44014
44015 @item ENOENT
44016 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
44017
44018 @item ENOTDIR
44019 A component of the path is not a directory.
44020
44021 @item EROFS
44022 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
44023
44024 @item EINTR
44025 The call was interrupted by the user.
44026 @end table
44027
44028 @end table
44029
44030 @node stat/fstat
44031 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
44032 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
44033 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
44034
44035 @table @asis
44036 @item Synopsis:
44037 @smallexample
44038 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
44039 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
44040 @end smallexample
44041
44042 @item Request:
44043 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
44044 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
44045
44046 @item Return value:
44047 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
44048
44049 @item Errors:
44050
44051 @table @code
44052 @item EBADF
44053 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
44054
44055 @item ENOENT
44056 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
44057 path is an empty string.
44058
44059 @item ENOTDIR
44060 A component of the path is not a directory.
44061
44062 @item EFAULT
44063 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
44064
44065 @item EACCES
44066 No access to the file or the path of the file.
44067
44068 @item ENAMETOOLONG
44069 @var{pathname} was too long.
44070
44071 @item EINTR
44072 The call was interrupted by the user.
44073 @end table
44074
44075 @end table
44076
44077 @node gettimeofday
44078 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
44079 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
44080
44081 @table @asis
44082 @item Synopsis:
44083 @smallexample
44084 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
44085 @end smallexample
44086
44087 @item Request:
44088 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
44089
44090 @item Return value:
44091 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
44092
44093 @item Errors:
44094
44095 @table @code
44096 @item EINVAL
44097 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
44098
44099 @item EFAULT
44100 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
44101 @end table
44102
44103 @end table
44104
44105 @node isatty
44106 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
44107 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
44108
44109 @table @asis
44110 @item Synopsis:
44111 @smallexample
44112 int isatty(int fd);
44113 @end smallexample
44114
44115 @item Request:
44116 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
44117
44118 @item Return value:
44119 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
44120
44121 @item Errors:
44122
44123 @table @code
44124 @item EINTR
44125 The call was interrupted by the user.
44126 @end table
44127
44128 @end table
44129
44130 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
44131 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
44132 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
44133 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
44134 needed.
44135
44136
44137 @node system
44138 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
44139 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
44140
44141 @table @asis
44142 @item Synopsis:
44143 @smallexample
44144 int system(const char *command);
44145 @end smallexample
44146
44147 @item Request:
44148 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
44149
44150 @item Return value:
44151 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
44152 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
44153 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
44154 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
44155 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
44156 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
44157 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
44158
44159 @item Errors:
44160
44161 @table @code
44162 @item EINTR
44163 The call was interrupted by the user.
44164 @end table
44165
44166 @end table
44167
44168 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
44169 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
44170 the host is simplified before it's returned
44171 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
44172 is discarded, and the return value consists
44173 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
44174
44175 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
44176 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
44177 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
44178
44179 @table @code
44180 @item set remote system-call-allowed
44181 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
44182 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
44183 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
44184
44185 @item show remote system-call-allowed
44186 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
44187 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
44188 protocol.
44189 @end table
44190
44191 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
44192 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
44193 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
44194
44195 @menu
44196 * Integral Datatypes::
44197 * Pointer Values::
44198 * Memory Transfer::
44199 * struct stat::
44200 * struct timeval::
44201 @end menu
44202
44203 @node Integral Datatypes
44204 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
44205 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
44206
44207 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
44208 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
44209 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
44210
44211 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
44212 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
44213
44214 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
44215
44216 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
44217 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
44218
44219 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
44220
44221 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
44222 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
44223 byte order.
44224
44225 @node Pointer Values
44226 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
44227 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
44228
44229 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
44230 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
44231 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
44232 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
44233
44234 @smallexample
44235 @code{1aaf/12}
44236 @end smallexample
44237
44238 @noindent
44239 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
44240 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
44241 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
44242 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
44243
44244 @smallexample
44245 @code{123456/d}
44246 @end smallexample
44247
44248 @node Memory Transfer
44249 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
44250 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
44251
44252 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
44253 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
44254 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
44255 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
44256 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
44257 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
44258 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
44259
44260
44261 @node struct stat
44262 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
44263 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
44264
44265 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
44266 is defined as follows:
44267
44268 @smallexample
44269 struct stat @{
44270 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
44271 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
44272 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
44273 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
44274 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
44275 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
44276 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
44277 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
44278 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
44279 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
44280 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
44281 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
44282 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
44283 @};
44284 @end smallexample
44285
44286 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
44287 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
44288 structure is of size 64 bytes.
44289
44290 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
44291 range of values.
44292
44293 @table @code
44294
44295 @item st_dev
44296 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
44297
44298 @item st_ino
44299 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
44300
44301 @item st_mode
44302 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
44303 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
44304
44305 @item st_uid
44306 @itemx st_gid
44307 @itemx st_rdev
44308 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
44309
44310 @item st_atime
44311 @itemx st_mtime
44312 @itemx st_ctime
44313 These values have a host and file system dependent
44314 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
44315 support exact timing values.
44316 @end table
44317
44318 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
44319 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
44320 continuing.
44321
44322 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
44323 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
44324 get truncated on the target.
44325
44326 @node struct timeval
44327 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
44328 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
44329
44330 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
44331 is defined as follows:
44332
44333 @smallexample
44334 struct timeval @{
44335 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
44336 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
44337 @};
44338 @end smallexample
44339
44340 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
44341 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
44342 structure is of size 8 bytes.
44343
44344 @node Constants
44345 @subsection Constants
44346 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
44347
44348 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
44349 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
44350 values before and after the call as needed.
44351
44352 @menu
44353 * Open Flags::
44354 * mode_t Values::
44355 * Errno Values::
44356 * Lseek Flags::
44357 * Limits::
44358 @end menu
44359
44360 @node Open Flags
44361 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
44362 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
44363
44364 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
44365
44366 @smallexample
44367 O_RDONLY 0x0
44368 O_WRONLY 0x1
44369 O_RDWR 0x2
44370 O_APPEND 0x8
44371 O_CREAT 0x200
44372 O_TRUNC 0x400
44373 O_EXCL 0x800
44374 @end smallexample
44375
44376 @node mode_t Values
44377 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
44378 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
44379
44380 All values are given in octal representation.
44381
44382 @smallexample
44383 S_IFREG 0100000
44384 S_IFDIR 040000
44385 S_IRUSR 0400
44386 S_IWUSR 0200
44387 S_IXUSR 0100
44388 S_IRGRP 040
44389 S_IWGRP 020
44390 S_IXGRP 010
44391 S_IROTH 04
44392 S_IWOTH 02
44393 S_IXOTH 01
44394 @end smallexample
44395
44396 @node Errno Values
44397 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
44398 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
44399
44400 All values are given in decimal representation.
44401
44402 @smallexample
44403 EPERM 1
44404 ENOENT 2
44405 EINTR 4
44406 EBADF 9
44407 EACCES 13
44408 EFAULT 14
44409 EBUSY 16
44410 EEXIST 17
44411 ENODEV 19
44412 ENOTDIR 20
44413 EISDIR 21
44414 EINVAL 22
44415 ENFILE 23
44416 EMFILE 24
44417 EFBIG 27
44418 ENOSPC 28
44419 ESPIPE 29
44420 EROFS 30
44421 ENAMETOOLONG 91
44422 EUNKNOWN 9999
44423 @end smallexample
44424
44425 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
44426 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
44427
44428 @node Lseek Flags
44429 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
44430 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
44431
44432 @smallexample
44433 SEEK_SET 0
44434 SEEK_CUR 1
44435 SEEK_END 2
44436 @end smallexample
44437
44438 @node Limits
44439 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
44440 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
44441
44442 All values are given in decimal representation.
44443
44444 @smallexample
44445 INT_MIN -2147483648
44446 INT_MAX 2147483647
44447 UINT_MAX 4294967295
44448 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
44449 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
44450 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
44451 @end smallexample
44452
44453 @node File-I/O Examples
44454 @subsection File-I/O Examples
44455 @cindex file-i/o examples
44456
44457 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
44458 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
44459
44460 @smallexample
44461 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
44462 @emph{request memory read from target}
44463 -> @code{m1234,6}
44464 <- XXXXXX
44465 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
44466 -> @code{F6}
44467 @end smallexample
44468
44469 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
44470 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
44471
44472 @smallexample
44473 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
44474 @emph{request memory write to target}
44475 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
44476 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
44477 -> @code{F6}
44478 @end smallexample
44479
44480 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
44481 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
44482
44483 @smallexample
44484 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
44485 -> @code{F-1,9}
44486 @end smallexample
44487
44488 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
44489 host is called:
44490
44491 @smallexample
44492 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
44493 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
44494 <- @code{T02}
44495 @end smallexample
44496
44497 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
44498 host is called:
44499
44500 @smallexample
44501 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
44502 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
44503 <- @code{T02}
44504 @end smallexample
44505
44506 @node Library List Format
44507 @section Library List Format
44508 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
44509
44510 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
44511 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
44512 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
44513 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
44514 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
44515 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
44516 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
44517 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
44518 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
44519 are loaded.
44520
44521 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
44522 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
44523 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
44524 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
44525
44526 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
44527 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
44528 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
44529 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
44530 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
44531 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
44532
44533 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
44534 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
44535
44536 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
44537 offset, looks like this:
44538
44539 @smallexample
44540 <library-list>
44541 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
44542 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
44543 </library>
44544 </library-list>
44545 @end smallexample
44546
44547 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
44548 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
44549
44550 @smallexample
44551 <library-list>
44552 <library name="sharedlib.o">
44553 <section address="0x10000000"/>
44554 <section address="0x20000000"/>
44555 <section address="0x30000000"/>
44556 </library>
44557 </library-list>
44558 @end smallexample
44559
44560 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
44561
44562 @smallexample
44563 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
44564 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
44565 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
44566 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
44567 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
44568 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
44569 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
44570 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
44571 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
44572 @end smallexample
44573
44574 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
44575 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
44576 section for each library.
44577
44578 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
44579 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
44580 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
44581
44582 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
44583 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
44584 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
44585 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
44586
44587 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
44588 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
44589 target, the following parameters are reported:
44590
44591 @itemize @minus
44592 @item
44593 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
44594 @code{struct link_map}.
44595 @item
44596 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
44597 (Thread Local Storage) access.
44598 @item
44599 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
44600 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
44601 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
44602 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
44603 @item
44604 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
44605 @end itemize
44606
44607 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
44608 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
44609 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
44610
44611 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
44612 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
44613
44614 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
44615 looks like this:
44616
44617 @smallexample
44618 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
44619 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
44620 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
44621 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
44622 l_ld="0x152350"/>
44623 </library-list-svr>
44624 @end smallexample
44625
44626 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
44627
44628 @smallexample
44629 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
44630 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
44631 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
44632 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
44633 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
44634 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
44635 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
44636 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
44637 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
44638 @end smallexample
44639
44640 @node Memory Map Format
44641 @section Memory Map Format
44642 @cindex memory map format
44643
44644 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
44645 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
44646 memory map.
44647
44648 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
44649 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
44650 lists memory regions.
44651
44652 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
44653 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
44654
44655 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
44656
44657 @smallexample
44658 <?xml version="1.0"?>
44659 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
44660 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
44661 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
44662 <memory-map>
44663 region...
44664 </memory-map>
44665 @end smallexample
44666
44667 Each region can be either:
44668
44669 @itemize
44670
44671 @item
44672 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
44673 bytes from there:
44674
44675 @smallexample
44676 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
44677 @end smallexample
44678
44679
44680 @item
44681 A region of read-only memory:
44682
44683 @smallexample
44684 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
44685 @end smallexample
44686
44687
44688 @item
44689 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
44690 bytes in length:
44691
44692 @smallexample
44693 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
44694 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
44695 </memory>
44696 @end smallexample
44697
44698 @end itemize
44699
44700 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
44701 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
44702 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
44703
44704 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
44705
44706 @smallexample
44707 <!-- ................................................... -->
44708 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
44709 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
44710 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
44711 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
44712 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
44713 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
44714 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
44715 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
44716 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
44717 and its type, or device. -->
44718 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
44719 start CDATA #REQUIRED
44720 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
44721 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
44722 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
44723 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
44724 @end smallexample
44725
44726 @node Thread List Format
44727 @section Thread List Format
44728 @cindex thread list format
44729
44730 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
44731 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
44732 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
44733 the following structure:
44734
44735 @smallexample
44736 <?xml version="1.0"?>
44737 <threads>
44738 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
44739 ... description ...
44740 </thread>
44741 </threads>
44742 @end smallexample
44743
44744 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
44745 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
44746 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
44747 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
44748 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
44749 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
44750 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
44751 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
44752
44753
44754 @node Traceframe Info Format
44755 @section Traceframe Info Format
44756 @cindex traceframe info format
44757
44758 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
44759 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
44760 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
44761 collected in a traceframe.
44762
44763 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
44764 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
44765
44766 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
44767 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
44768
44769 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
44770
44771 @smallexample
44772 <?xml version="1.0"?>
44773 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
44774 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
44775 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
44776 <traceframe-info>
44777 block...
44778 </traceframe-info>
44779 @end smallexample
44780
44781 Each traceframe block can be either:
44782
44783 @itemize
44784
44785 @item
44786 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
44787 @var{length} bytes from there:
44788
44789 @smallexample
44790 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
44791 @end smallexample
44792
44793 @item
44794 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
44795 collected:
44796
44797 @smallexample
44798 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
44799 @end smallexample
44800
44801 @end itemize
44802
44803 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
44804
44805 @smallexample
44806 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
44807 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
44808
44809 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
44810 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
44811 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
44812 <!ELEMENT tvar>
44813 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
44814 @end smallexample
44815
44816 @node Branch Trace Format
44817 @section Branch Trace Format
44818 @cindex branch trace format
44819
44820 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
44821 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
44822 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
44823 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
44824
44825 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
44826 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
44827
44828 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
44829 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
44830
44831 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
44832
44833 @smallexample
44834 <?xml version="1.0"?>
44835 <!DOCTYPE btrace
44836 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
44837 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
44838 <btrace>
44839 block...
44840 </btrace>
44841 @end smallexample
44842
44843 @itemize
44844
44845 @item
44846 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
44847 and ending at @var{end}:
44848
44849 @smallexample
44850 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
44851 @end smallexample
44852
44853 @end itemize
44854
44855 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
44856
44857 @smallexample
44858 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
44859 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
44860
44861 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
44862 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
44863 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
44864
44865 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
44866
44867 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
44868
44869 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
44870 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
44871 family CDATA #REQUIRED
44872 model CDATA #REQUIRED
44873 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
44874
44875 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
44876 @end smallexample
44877
44878 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
44879 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
44880 @cindex branch trace configuration format
44881
44882 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
44883 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
44884 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
44885
44886 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
44887 settings for that format. The following information is described:
44888
44889 @table @code
44890 @item bts
44891 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
44892 @table @code
44893 @item size
44894 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
44895 @end table
44896 @item pt
44897 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
44898 PT}) format.
44899 @table @code
44900 @item size
44901 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
44902 @end table
44903 @end table
44904
44905 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
44906 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
44907
44908 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
44909
44910 @smallexample
44911 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
44912 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
44913
44914 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
44915 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
44916
44917 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
44918 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
44919 @end smallexample
44920
44921 @include agentexpr.texi
44922
44923 @node Target Descriptions
44924 @appendix Target Descriptions
44925 @cindex target descriptions
44926
44927 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
44928 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
44929 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
44930 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
44931 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
44932 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
44933 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
44934
44935 @itemize @bullet
44936 @item
44937 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
44938 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
44939 @item
44940 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
44941 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
44942 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
44943 @item
44944 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
44945 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
44946 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
44947 @end itemize
44948
44949 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
44950 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
44951 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
44952 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
44953 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
44954
44955 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
44956 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
44957
44958 @menu
44959 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
44960 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
44961 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
44962 descriptions.
44963 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
44964 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
44965 @end menu
44966
44967 @node Retrieving Descriptions
44968 @section Retrieving Descriptions
44969
44970 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
44971 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
44972 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
44973 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
44974 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
44975 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
44976 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
44977 Format}.
44978
44979 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
44980 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
44981 specify a file are:
44982
44983 @table @code
44984 @cindex set tdesc filename
44985 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
44986 Read the target description from @var{path}.
44987
44988 @cindex unset tdesc filename
44989 @item unset tdesc filename
44990 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
44991 will use the description supplied by the current target.
44992
44993 @cindex show tdesc filename
44994 @item show tdesc filename
44995 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
44996 @end table
44997
44998
44999 @node Target Description Format
45000 @section Target Description Format
45001 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
45002
45003 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
45004 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
45005 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
45006 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
45007 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
45008 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
45009 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
45010
45011 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
45012 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
45013 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
45014 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
45015 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
45016
45017 Here is a simple target description:
45018
45019 @smallexample
45020 <target version="1.0">
45021 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
45022 </target>
45023 @end smallexample
45024
45025 @noindent
45026 This minimal description only says that the target uses
45027 the x86-64 architecture.
45028
45029 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
45030 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
45031 are explained further below.
45032
45033 @smallexample
45034 <?xml version="1.0"?>
45035 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
45036 <target version="1.0">
45037 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
45038 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
45039 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
45040 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
45041 </target>
45042 @end smallexample
45043
45044 @noindent
45045 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
45046 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
45047 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
45048 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
45049 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
45050 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
45051 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
45052 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
45053 the version mismatch.
45054
45055 @subsection Inclusion
45056 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
45057 @cindex XInclude
45058 @ifnotinfo
45059 @cindex <xi:include>
45060 @end ifnotinfo
45061
45062 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
45063 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
45064 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
45065 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
45066 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
45067
45068 @smallexample
45069 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
45070 @end smallexample
45071
45072 @noindent
45073 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
45074 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
45075 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
45076 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
45077 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
45078 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
45079 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
45080 original description.
45081
45082 @subsection Architecture
45083 @cindex <architecture>
45084
45085 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
45086
45087 @smallexample
45088 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
45089 @end smallexample
45090
45091 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
45092 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
45093
45094 @subsection OS ABI
45095 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
45096
45097 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
45098 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
45099
45100 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
45101
45102 @smallexample
45103 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
45104 @end smallexample
45105
45106 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
45107 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
45108
45109 @subsection Compatible Architecture
45110 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
45111
45112 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
45113 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
45114
45115 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
45116
45117 @smallexample
45118 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
45119 @end smallexample
45120
45121 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
45122 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
45123
45124 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
45125 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
45126 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
45127 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
45128 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
45129 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
45130 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
45131
45132 @smallexample
45133 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
45134 <compatible>spu</compatible>
45135 @end smallexample
45136
45137 @subsection Features
45138 @cindex <feature>
45139
45140 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
45141 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
45142 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
45143 has this form:
45144
45145 @smallexample
45146 <feature name="@var{name}">
45147 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
45148 @var{reg}@dots{}
45149 </feature>
45150 @end smallexample
45151
45152 @noindent
45153 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
45154 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
45155 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
45156 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
45157
45158 @subsection Types
45159
45160 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
45161 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
45162 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
45163 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
45164 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
45165 and enum types.
45166
45167 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
45168 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
45169 Types must be defined before they are used.
45170
45171 @cindex <vector>
45172 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
45173 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
45174 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
45175 @var{count}:
45176
45177 @smallexample
45178 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
45179 @end smallexample
45180
45181 @cindex <union>
45182 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
45183 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
45184 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
45185 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
45186
45187 @smallexample
45188 <union id="@var{id}">
45189 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
45190 @dots{}
45191 </union>
45192 @end smallexample
45193
45194 @cindex <struct>
45195 @cindex <flags>
45196 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
45197 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
45198 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
45199 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
45200 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
45201 specified.
45202
45203 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
45204
45205 @smallexample
45206 <struct id="@var{id}">
45207 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
45208 @dots{}
45209 </struct>
45210 @end smallexample
45211
45212 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
45213 No implicit padding is added.
45214
45215 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
45216
45217 @smallexample
45218 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
45219 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
45220 @dots{}
45221 </struct>
45222 @end smallexample
45223
45224 @smallexample
45225 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
45226 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
45227 @dots{}
45228 </flags>
45229 @end smallexample
45230
45231 The @var{name} value is required.
45232 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
45233 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
45234 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
45235
45236 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
45237 is optional.
45238 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
45239 and zero represents the least significant bit.
45240
45241 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
45242 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
45243
45244 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
45245
45246 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
45247 defining them with @samp{struct}:
45248
45249 @itemize @bullet
45250 @item
45251 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
45252 @item
45253 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
45254 @end itemize
45255
45256 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
45257 defining them with @samp{flags}:
45258
45259 @itemize @bullet
45260 @item
45261 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
45262
45263 @smallexample
45264 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
45265 $1 = 42
45266 @end smallexample
45267
45268 @end itemize
45269
45270 @subsection Registers
45271 @cindex <reg>
45272
45273 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
45274
45275 @smallexample
45276 <reg name="@var{name}"
45277 bitsize="@var{size}"
45278 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
45279 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
45280 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
45281 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
45282 @end smallexample
45283
45284 @noindent
45285 The components are as follows:
45286
45287 @table @var
45288
45289 @item name
45290 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
45291
45292 @item bitsize
45293 The register's size, in bits.
45294
45295 @item regnum
45296 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
45297 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
45298 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
45299 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
45300 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
45301 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
45302 in order of increasing register number.
45303
45304 @item save-restore
45305 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
45306 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
45307 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
45308 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
45309 ABI.
45310
45311 @item type
45312 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
45313 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
45314 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
45315 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
45316 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
45317 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
45318
45319 @item group
45320 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
45321 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
45322 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
45323 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
45324 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
45325 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
45326 @code{info registers}.
45327
45328 @end table
45329
45330 @node Predefined Target Types
45331 @section Predefined Target Types
45332 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
45333
45334 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
45335 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
45336 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
45337 types. The currently supported types are:
45338
45339 @table @code
45340
45341 @item bool
45342 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
45343
45344 @item int8
45345 @itemx int16
45346 @itemx int24
45347 @itemx int32
45348 @itemx int64
45349 @itemx int128
45350 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
45351
45352 @item uint8
45353 @itemx uint16
45354 @itemx uint24
45355 @itemx uint32
45356 @itemx uint64
45357 @itemx uint128
45358 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
45359
45360 @item code_ptr
45361 @itemx data_ptr
45362 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
45363 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
45364 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
45365 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
45366 may be marked as data pointers.
45367
45368 @item ieee_single
45369 Single precision IEEE floating point.
45370
45371 @item ieee_double
45372 Double precision IEEE floating point.
45373
45374 @item arm_fpa_ext
45375 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
45376
45377 @item i387_ext
45378 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
45379
45380 @item i386_eflags
45381 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
45382
45383 @item i386_mxcsr
45384 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
45385
45386 @end table
45387
45388 @node Enum Target Types
45389 @section Enum Target Types
45390 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
45391
45392 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
45393 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
45394
45395 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
45396
45397 @smallexample
45398 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
45399 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
45400 @dots{}
45401 </enum>
45402 @end smallexample
45403
45404 Enums must be defined before they are used.
45405
45406 @smallexample
45407 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
45408 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
45409 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
45410 </enum>
45411 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
45412 <field name="X" start="0"/>
45413 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
45414 </flags>
45415 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
45416 @end smallexample
45417
45418 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
45419 would be printed as:
45420
45421 @smallexample
45422 (gdb) info register flags
45423 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
45424 @end smallexample
45425
45426 @node Standard Target Features
45427 @section Standard Target Features
45428 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
45429
45430 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
45431 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
45432 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
45433 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
45434 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
45435 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
45436 can recognize them.
45437
45438 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
45439 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
45440 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
45441 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
45442 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
45443 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
45444 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
45445 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
45446
45447 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
45448 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
45449 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
45450
45451 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
45452 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
45453 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
45454 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
45455
45456 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
45457 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
45458 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
45459
45460 @menu
45461 * AArch64 Features::
45462 * ARC Features::
45463 * ARM Features::
45464 * i386 Features::
45465 * MicroBlaze Features::
45466 * MIPS Features::
45467 * M68K Features::
45468 * NDS32 Features::
45469 * Nios II Features::
45470 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
45471 * PowerPC Features::
45472 * RISC-V Features::
45473 * RX Features::
45474 * S/390 and System z Features::
45475 * Sparc Features::
45476 * TIC6x Features::
45477 @end menu
45478
45479
45480 @node AArch64 Features
45481 @subsection AArch64 Features
45482 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
45483
45484 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
45485 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
45486 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
45487
45488 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
45489 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
45490 and @samp{fpcr}.
45491
45492 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
45493 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
45494 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
45495
45496 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.pauth} feature is optional. If present,
45497 it should contain registers @samp{pauth_dmask} and @samp{pauth_cmask}.
45498
45499 @node ARC Features
45500 @subsection ARC Features
45501 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
45502
45503 ARC processors are so configurable that even core registers and their numbers
45504 are not predetermined completely. Moreover, @emph{flags} and @emph{PC}
45505 registers, which are important to @value{GDBN}, are not ``core'' registers in
45506 ARC. Therefore, there are two features that their presence is mandatory:
45507 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core} and @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux}.
45508
45509 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core} feature is required for all targets. It must
45510 contain registers:
45511
45512 @itemize @minus
45513 @item
45514 @samp{r0} through @samp{r25} for normal register file targets.
45515 @item
45516 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, and @samp{r10} through @samp{r15} for reduced
45517 register file targets.
45518 @item
45519 @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}@footnote{Not necessary for ARCv1.},
45520 @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count}, @samp{pcl}.
45521 @end itemize
45522
45523 In case of an ARCompact target (ARCv1 ISA), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core}
45524 feature may contain registers @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2}. While in case
45525 of ARC EM and ARC HS targets (ARCv2 ISA), register @samp{ilink} may be present.
45526 The difference between ARCv1 and ARCv2 is the naming of registers @emph{29th}
45527 and @emph{30th}. They are called @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} for ARCv1 and
45528 are optional. For ARCv2, they are called @samp{ilink} and @samp{r30} and only
45529 @samp{ilink} is optional. The optionality of @samp{ilink*} registers is
45530 because of their inaccessibility during user space debugging sessions.
45531
45532 Extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59} are optional and their
45533 existence depends on the configuration. When debugging GNU/Linux applications,
45534 i.e.@: user space debugging, these core registers are not available.
45535
45536 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux} feature is required for all ARC targets. Here
45537 is the list of registers pertinent to this feature:
45538
45539 @itemize @minus
45540 @item
45541 mandatory: @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
45542 @item
45543 optional: @samp{lp_start}, @samp{lp_end}, and @samp{bta}.
45544 @end itemize
45545
45546 @node ARM Features
45547 @subsection ARM Features
45548 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
45549
45550 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
45551 ARM targets.
45552 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
45553 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
45554
45555 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
45556 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
45557 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
45558 and @samp{xpsr}.
45559
45560 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
45561 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
45562
45563 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
45564 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
45565 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
45566 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
45567
45568 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
45569 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
45570 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
45571 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
45572 halves of the double-precision registers.
45573
45574 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
45575 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
45576 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
45577 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
45578 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
45579 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
45580
45581 @node i386 Features
45582 @subsection i386 Features
45583 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
45584
45585 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
45586 targets. It should describe the following registers:
45587
45588 @itemize @minus
45589 @item
45590 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
45591 @item
45592 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
45593 @item
45594 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
45595 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
45596 @item
45597 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
45598 @item
45599 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
45600 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
45601 @end itemize
45602
45603 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
45604
45605 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
45606 describe registers:
45607
45608 @itemize @minus
45609 @item
45610 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
45611 @item
45612 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
45613 @item
45614 @samp{mxcsr}
45615 @end itemize
45616
45617 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
45618 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
45619 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
45620
45621 @itemize @minus
45622 @item
45623 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
45624 @item
45625 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
45626 @end itemize
45627
45628 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
45629 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
45630
45631 @itemize @minus
45632 @item
45633 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
45634 @item
45635 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
45636 @end itemize
45637
45638 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
45639 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
45640
45641 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
45642 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
45643
45644 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
45645 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
45646 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
45647
45648 @itemize @minus
45649 @item
45650 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
45651 @end itemize
45652
45653 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
45654
45655 @itemize @minus
45656 @item
45657 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
45658 @end itemize
45659
45660 It should
45661 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
45662
45663 @itemize @minus
45664 @item
45665 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
45666 @item
45667 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
45668 @end itemize
45669
45670 It should
45671 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
45672
45673 @itemize @minus
45674 @item
45675 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
45676 @end itemize
45677
45678 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
45679 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
45680 valid for i386 and amd64.
45681
45682 @node MicroBlaze Features
45683 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
45684 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
45685
45686 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
45687 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
45688 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
45689 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
45690 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
45691
45692 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
45693 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
45694
45695 @node MIPS Features
45696 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
45697 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
45698
45699 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
45700 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
45701 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
45702 on the target.
45703
45704 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
45705 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
45706 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
45707
45708 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
45709 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
45710 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
45711 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
45712
45713 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
45714 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
45715 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
45716 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
45717
45718 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
45719 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
45720 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
45721
45722 @node M68K Features
45723 @subsection M68K Features
45724 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
45725
45726 @table @code
45727 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
45728 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
45729 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
45730 One of those features must be always present.
45731 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
45732 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
45733 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
45734 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
45735
45736 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
45737 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
45738 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
45739 @samp{fpiaddr}.
45740
45741 Note that, despite the fact that this feature's name says
45742 @samp{coldfire}, it is used to describe any floating point registers.
45743 The size of the registers must match the main m68k flavor; so, for
45744 example, if the primary feature is reported as @samp{coldfire}, then
45745 64-bit floating point registers are required.
45746 @end table
45747
45748 @node NDS32 Features
45749 @subsection NDS32 Features
45750 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
45751
45752 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
45753 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
45754 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
45755 and @samp{pc}.
45756
45757 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
45758 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
45759 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
45760 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
45761
45762 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
45763 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
45764 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
45765 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
45766 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
45767 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
45768 support to it could be totally removed some day.
45769
45770 @node Nios II Features
45771 @subsection Nios II Features
45772 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
45773
45774 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
45775 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
45776 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
45777 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
45778 @samp{mpuacc}).
45779
45780 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
45781 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
45782 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
45783
45784 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
45785 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
45786 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
45787
45788 @node PowerPC Features
45789 @subsection PowerPC Features
45790 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
45791
45792 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
45793 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
45794 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
45795 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
45796
45797 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
45798 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
45799
45800 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
45801 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, and
45802 @samp{vrsave}. @value{GDBN} will define pseudo-registers @samp{v0}
45803 through @samp{v31} as aliases for the corresponding @samp{vrX}
45804 registers.
45805
45806 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
45807 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} will
45808 combine these registers with the floating point registers (@samp{f0}
45809 through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} through
45810 @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} through
45811 @samp{vs63}, the set of vector-scalar registers for POWER7.
45812 Therefore, this feature requires both @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} and
45813 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec}.
45814
45815 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
45816 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
45817 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
45818 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
45819 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
45820 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
45821 user.
45822
45823 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
45824 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
45825
45826 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
45827 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
45828
45829 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
45830 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
45831
45832 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
45833 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
45834 64-bit wide.
45835
45836 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
45837 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
45838 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
45839 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
45840
45841 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
45842 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
45843 64-bit wide.
45844
45845 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
45846 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
45847 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
45848 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
45849 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
45850 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
45851 wide.
45852
45853 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
45854 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
45855 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
45856 @samp{cfpscr}.
45857
45858 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
45859 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
45860 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
45861 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
45862 wide.
45863
45864 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
45865 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
45866 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
45867 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
45868 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
45869 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
45870 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
45871 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
45872 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
45873
45874 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
45875 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
45876
45877 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
45878 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
45879
45880 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
45881 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
45882
45883
45884 @node RISC-V Features
45885 @subsection RISC-V Features
45886 @cindex target descriptions, RISC-V Features
45887
45888 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.cpu} feature is required for RISC-V
45889 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{x0} through
45890 @samp{x31}, and @samp{pc}. Either the architectural names (@samp{x0},
45891 @samp{x1}, etc) can be used, or the ABI names (@samp{zero}, @samp{ra},
45892 etc).
45893
45894 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.fpu} feature is optional. If present, it
45895 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fflags},
45896 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr}. As with the cpu feature, either the
45897 architectural register names, or the ABI names can be used.
45898
45899 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.virtual} feature is optional. If present,
45900 it should contain registers that are not backed by real registers on
45901 the target, but are instead virtual, where the register value is
45902 derived from other target state. In many ways these are like
45903 @value{GDBN}s pseudo-registers, except implemented by the target.
45904 Currently the only register expected in this set is the one byte
45905 @samp{priv} register that contains the target's privilege level in the
45906 least significant two bits.
45907
45908 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.csr} feature is optional. If present, it
45909 should contain all of the target's standard CSRs. Standard CSRs are
45910 those defined in the RISC-V specification documents. There is some
45911 overlap between this feature and the fpu feature; the @samp{fflags},
45912 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr} registers could be in either feature. The
45913 expectation is that these registers will be in the fpu feature if the
45914 target has floating point hardware, but can be moved into the csr
45915 feature if the target has the floating point control registers, but no
45916 other floating point hardware.
45917
45918 @node RX Features
45919 @subsection RX Features
45920 @cindex target descriptions, RX Features
45921
45922 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.rx.core} feature is required for RX
45923 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{r0} through
45924 @samp{r15}, @samp{usp}, @samp{isp}, @samp{psw}, @samp{pc}, @samp{intb},
45925 @samp{bpsw}, @samp{bpc}, @samp{fintv}, @samp{fpsw}, and @samp{acc}.
45926
45927 @node S/390 and System z Features
45928 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
45929 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
45930 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
45931
45932 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
45933 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
45934 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
45935 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
45936 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
45937 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
45938 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
45939 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
45940 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
45941
45942 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
45943 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
45944 @samp{fpc}.
45945
45946 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
45947 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
45948
45949 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
45950 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
45951 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
45952 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
45953 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
45954 32-bit wide.
45955
45956 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
45957 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
45958 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
45959
45960 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
45961 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
45962 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
45963 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
45964 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
45965 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
45966 @samp{v31}.
45967
45968 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
45969 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
45970 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
45971
45972 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
45973 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
45974 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
45975
45976 @node Sparc Features
45977 @subsection Sparc Features
45978 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
45979 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
45980 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
45981 targets. It should describe the following registers:
45982
45983 @itemize @minus
45984 @item
45985 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
45986 @item
45987 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
45988 @item
45989 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
45990 @item
45991 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
45992 @end itemize
45993
45994 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
45995
45996 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
45997 targets. It should describe the following registers:
45998
45999 @itemize @minus
46000 @item
46001 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
46002 @item
46003 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
46004 @end itemize
46005
46006 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
46007 targets. It should describe the following registers:
46008
46009 @itemize @minus
46010 @item
46011 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
46012 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
46013 @item
46014 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
46015 for sparc64
46016 @end itemize
46017
46018 @node TIC6x Features
46019 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
46020 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
46021 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
46022 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
46023 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
46024 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
46025
46026 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
46027 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
46028 through @samp{B31}.
46029
46030 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
46031 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
46032
46033 @node Operating System Information
46034 @appendix Operating System Information
46035 @cindex operating system information
46036
46037 @menu
46038 * Process list::
46039 @end menu
46040
46041 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
46042 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
46043 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
46044 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
46045 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
46046 on a different aspect of target.
46047
46048 Operating system information is retrieved from the target via the
46049 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
46050 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
46051 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
46052
46053 @node Process list
46054 @appendixsection Process list
46055 @cindex operating system information, process list
46056
46057 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
46058 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
46059 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
46060 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
46061
46062 An example document is:
46063
46064 @smallexample
46065 <?xml version="1.0"?>
46066 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
46067 <osdata type="processes">
46068 <item>
46069 <column name="pid">1</column>
46070 <column name="user">root</column>
46071 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
46072 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
46073 </item>
46074 </osdata>
46075 @end smallexample
46076
46077 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
46078 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
46079 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
46080 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
46081 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
46082 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
46083 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
46084
46085 @node Trace File Format
46086 @appendix Trace File Format
46087 @cindex trace file format
46088
46089 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
46090 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
46091
46092 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
46093 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
46094 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
46095 in the future.
46096
46097 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
46098 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
46099 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
46100 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
46101 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
46102 of this section.
46103
46104 @table @code
46105 @item R @var{size}
46106 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
46107 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
46108 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
46109 a single trace file.
46110
46111 @item status @var{status}
46112 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
46113 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
46114 file.
46115
46116 @item tp @var{payload}
46117 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
46118 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
46119 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
46120 reply packets.
46121
46122 @item tsv @var{payload}
46123 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
46124 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
46125 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
46126 reply packets.
46127
46128 @item tdesc @var{payload}
46129 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
46130 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
46131 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
46132 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
46133 file. Includes are not allowed.
46134
46135 @end table
46136
46137 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
46138 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
46139 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
46140 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
46141 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
46142 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
46143 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
46144 endianness.
46145
46146 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
46147
46148 @table @code
46149 @item R @var{bytes}
46150 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
46151 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
46152 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
46153
46154 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
46155 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
46156 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
46157 @var{length} bytes.
46158
46159 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
46160 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
46161 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
46162
46163 @end table
46164
46165 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
46166 of blocks.
46167
46168 @node Index Section Format
46169 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
46170 @cindex .gdb_index section format
46171 @cindex index section format
46172
46173 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
46174 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
46175 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
46176 description.
46177
46178 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
46179 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
46180 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
46181 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
46182 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
46183 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
46184
46185 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
46186
46187 @enumerate
46188 @item
46189 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
46190 unless otherwise noted:
46191
46192 @enumerate
46193 @item
46194 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
46195 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
46196 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
46197 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
46198 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
46199 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
46200 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
46201
46202 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
46203 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
46204 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
46205 currently not flagged as deprecated.
46206
46207 @item
46208 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
46209
46210 @item
46211 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
46212 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
46213 to the next offset.
46214
46215 @item
46216 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
46217
46218 @item
46219 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
46220
46221 @item
46222 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
46223 @end enumerate
46224
46225 @item
46226 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
46227 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
46228 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
46229 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
46230 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
46231 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
46232 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
46233 CU indices.
46234
46235 @item
46236 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
46237 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
46238 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
46239 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
46240
46241 @item
46242 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
46243 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
46244
46245 @enumerate
46246 @item
46247 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
46248
46249 @item
46250 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
46251 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
46252
46253 @item
46254 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
46255 @end enumerate
46256
46257 @item
46258 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
46259 the hash table is always a power of 2.
46260
46261 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
46262 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
46263 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
46264 constant pool.
46265
46266 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
46267 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
46268 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
46269
46270 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
46271 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
46272 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
46273 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
46274 index version:
46275
46276 @table @asis
46277 @item Version 4
46278 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
46279
46280 @item Versions 5 to 7
46281 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
46282 @end table
46283
46284 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
46285
46286 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
46287 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
46288 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
46289 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
46290 collision.
46291
46292 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
46293 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
46294 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
46295 the code.
46296
46297 @item
46298 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
46299 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
46300 strings.
46301
46302 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
46303 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
46304 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
46305 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
46306 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
46307 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
46308
46309 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
46310 @end enumerate
46311
46312 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
46313 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
46314 CU index+attributes value for each use.
46315
46316 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
46317 (bit 0 = LSB):
46318
46319 @table @asis
46320
46321 @item Bits 0-23
46322 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
46323 @item Bits 24-27
46324 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
46325 @item Bits 28-30
46326 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
46327
46328 @table @asis
46329 @item 0
46330 This value is reserved and should not be used.
46331 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
46332 with previous versions of the index.
46333 @item 1
46334 The symbol is a type.
46335 @item 2
46336 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
46337 @item 3
46338 The symbol is a function.
46339 @item 4
46340 Any other kind of symbol.
46341 @item 5,6,7
46342 These values are reserved.
46343 @end table
46344
46345 @item Bit 31
46346 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
46347
46348 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
46349 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
46350 @value{GDBN} sources.
46351
46352 @end table
46353
46354 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
46355 global/static attributes in the index.
46356
46357 @smallexample
46358 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
46359 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
46360 switch (die->tag)
46361 @{
46362 case DW_TAG_typedef:
46363 case DW_TAG_base_type:
46364 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
46365 kind = TYPE;
46366 is_static = 1;
46367 break;
46368 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
46369 kind = VARIABLE;
46370 is_static = language != CPLUS;
46371 break;
46372 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
46373 kind = FUNCTION;
46374 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
46375 break;
46376 case DW_TAG_constant:
46377 kind = VARIABLE;
46378 is_static = ! is_external;
46379 break;
46380 case DW_TAG_variable:
46381 kind = VARIABLE;
46382 is_static = ! is_external;
46383 break;
46384 case DW_TAG_namespace:
46385 kind = TYPE;
46386 is_static = 0;
46387 break;
46388 case DW_TAG_class_type:
46389 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
46390 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
46391 case DW_TAG_union_type:
46392 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
46393 kind = TYPE;
46394 is_static = language != CPLUS;
46395 break;
46396 default:
46397 assert (0);
46398 @}
46399 @end smallexample
46400
46401 @node Man Pages
46402 @appendix Manual pages
46403 @cindex Man pages
46404
46405 @menu
46406 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
46407 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
46408 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
46409 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
46410 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
46411 @end menu
46412
46413 @node gdb man
46414 @heading gdb man
46415
46416 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
46417
46418 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
46419 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
46420 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
46421 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
46422 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
46423 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
46424 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
46425 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
46426 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
46427 @c man end
46428
46429 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
46430 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
46431 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
46432 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
46433
46434 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
46435 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
46436
46437 @itemize @bullet
46438 @item
46439 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
46440
46441 @item
46442 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
46443
46444 @item
46445 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
46446
46447 @item
46448 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
46449 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
46450 @end itemize
46451
46452 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
46453 Modula-2.
46454
46455 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
46456 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
46457 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
46458 by using the command @code{help}.
46459
46460 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
46461 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
46462 executable program as the argument:
46463
46464 @smallexample
46465 gdb program
46466 @end smallexample
46467
46468 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
46469
46470 @smallexample
46471 gdb program core
46472 @end smallexample
46473
46474 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument or use option
46475 @code{-p}, if you want to debug a running process:
46476
46477 @smallexample
46478 gdb program 1234
46479 gdb -p 1234
46480 @end smallexample
46481
46482 @noindent
46483 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234}. With option @option{-p} you
46484 can omit the @var{program} filename.
46485
46486 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
46487
46488 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
46489 @table @env
46490 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
46491 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
46492
46493 @item run [@var{arglist}]
46494 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
46495
46496 @item bt
46497 Backtrace: display the program stack.
46498
46499 @item print @var{expr}
46500 Display the value of an expression.
46501
46502 @item c
46503 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
46504
46505 @item next
46506 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
46507 function calls in the line.
46508
46509 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
46510 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
46511
46512 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
46513 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
46514
46515 @item step
46516 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
46517 function calls in the line.
46518
46519 @item help [@var{name}]
46520 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
46521 about using @value{GDBN}.
46522
46523 @item quit
46524 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
46525 @end table
46526
46527 @ifset man
46528 For full details on @value{GDBN},
46529 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
46530 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
46531 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
46532 @end ifset
46533 @c man end
46534
46535 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
46536 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
46537 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
46538 encountered with no
46539 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
46540 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
46541 Many options have
46542 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
46543 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
46544 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
46545 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
46546 more usual convention.)
46547
46548 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
46549 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
46550 option is used.
46551
46552 @table @env
46553 @item -help
46554 @itemx -h
46555 List all options, with brief explanations.
46556
46557 @item -symbols=@var{file}
46558 @itemx -s @var{file}
46559 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
46560
46561 @item -write
46562 Enable writing into executable and core files.
46563
46564 @item -exec=@var{file}
46565 @itemx -e @var{file}
46566 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
46567 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
46568 dump.
46569
46570 @item -se=@var{file}
46571 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
46572 file.
46573
46574 @item -core=@var{file}
46575 @itemx -c @var{file}
46576 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
46577
46578 @item -command=@var{file}
46579 @itemx -x @var{file}
46580 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
46581
46582 @item -ex @var{command}
46583 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
46584
46585 @item -directory=@var{directory}
46586 @itemx -d @var{directory}
46587 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
46588
46589 @item -nh
46590 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.config/gdb/gdbinit} or
46591 @file{~/.gdbinit}.
46592
46593 @item -nx
46594 @itemx -n
46595 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
46596
46597 @item -quiet
46598 @itemx -q
46599 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
46600 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
46601
46602 @item -batch
46603 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
46604 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
46605 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
46606 commands in the command files.
46607
46608 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
46609 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
46610 more useful, the message
46611
46612 @smallexample
46613 Program exited normally.
46614 @end smallexample
46615
46616 @noindent
46617 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
46618 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
46619
46620 @item -cd=@var{directory}
46621 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
46622 instead of the current directory.
46623
46624 @item -fullname
46625 @itemx -f
46626 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
46627 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
46628 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
46629 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
46630 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
46631 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
46632 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
46633 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
46634
46635 @item -b @var{bps}
46636 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
46637 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
46638
46639 @item -tty=@var{device}
46640 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
46641 @end table
46642 @c man end
46643
46644 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
46645 @ifset man
46646 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
46647 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
46648 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
46649
46650 @smallexample
46651 info gdb
46652 @end smallexample
46653
46654 @noindent
46655 should give you access to the complete manual.
46656
46657 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
46658 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
46659 @end ifset
46660 @c man end
46661
46662 @node gdbserver man
46663 @heading gdbserver man
46664
46665 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
46666 @format
46667 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
46668 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
46669
46670 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
46671
46672 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
46673 @c man end
46674 @end format
46675
46676 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
46677 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
46678 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
46679
46680 @ifclear man
46681 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
46682 @end ifclear
46683 @ifset man
46684 Usage (server (target) side):
46685 @end ifset
46686
46687 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
46688 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
46689 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
46690 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
46691
46692 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
46693 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
46694 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
46695
46696 @smallexample
46697 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
46698 @end smallexample
46699
46700 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
46701
46702 @smallexample
46703 @ifset man
46704 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
46705 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
46706 @end ifset
46707 @ifclear man
46708 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
46709 @end ifclear
46710 @end smallexample
46711
46712 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
46713 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
46714 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
46715
46716 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
46717
46718 @smallexample
46719 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
46720 @end smallexample
46721
46722 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
46723 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
46724 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
46725 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
46726 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
46727 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
46728 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
46729 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
46730 print an error message and exit.
46731
46732 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
46733 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
46734
46735 @smallexample
46736 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
46737 @end smallexample
46738
46739 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
46740 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
46741
46742 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
46743 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
46744 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
46745 the program you want to debug.
46746
46747 @smallexample
46748 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
46749 @end smallexample
46750
46751 @ifclear man
46752 @subheading Usage (host side)
46753 @end ifclear
46754 @ifset man
46755 Usage (host side):
46756 @end ifset
46757
46758 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
46759 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
46760 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
46761 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
46762 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
46763 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
46764 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
46765 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
46766 descriptor. For example:
46767
46768 @smallexample
46769 @ifset man
46770 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
46771 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
46772 @end ifset
46773 @ifclear man
46774 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
46775 @end ifclear
46776 @end smallexample
46777
46778 @noindent
46779 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
46780
46781 @smallexample
46782 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
46783 @end smallexample
46784
46785 @noindent
46786 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
46787 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
46788 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
46789 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
46790 `Connection refused'.
46791
46792 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
46793 described in
46794 @ifset man
46795 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors Connections and Programs}
46796 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors Connections and Programs'}.
46797 @end ifset
46798 @ifclear man
46799 @ref{Inferiors Connections and Programs}.
46800 @end ifclear
46801 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
46802
46803 @smallexample
46804 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
46805 @end smallexample
46806
46807 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
46808 case.
46809 @c man end
46810
46811 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
46812 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
46813
46814 @itemize @bullet
46815
46816 @item
46817 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
46818
46819 @smallexample
46820 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
46821 @end smallexample
46822
46823 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
46824 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
46825 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
46826 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
46827 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
46828 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
46829 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
46830
46831 @item
46832 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
46833 program:
46834
46835 @smallexample
46836 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
46837 @end smallexample
46838
46839 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
46840 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
46841 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
46842 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
46843
46844 @item
46845 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
46846
46847 @smallexample
46848 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
46849 @end smallexample
46850
46851 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
46852 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
46853 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
46854 debug several processes in the same session.
46855 @end itemize
46856
46857 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
46858
46859 @table @env
46860
46861 @item --help
46862 List all options, with brief explanations.
46863
46864 @item --version
46865 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
46866
46867 @item --attach
46868 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
46869
46870 @smallexample
46871 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
46872 @end smallexample
46873
46874 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
46875 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
46876
46877 @item --multi
46878 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
46879 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
46880 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
46881 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
46882
46883 @smallexample
46884 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
46885 @end smallexample
46886
46887 @item --debug
46888 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
46889 process.
46890 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
46891 the developers.
46892
46893 @item --remote-debug
46894 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
46895 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
46896 the developers.
46897
46898 @item --debug-file=@var{filename}
46899 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to send any debug output to the given @var{filename}.
46900 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
46901 the developers.
46902
46903 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
46904 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
46905 of debugging output.
46906 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
46907
46908 @item --wrapper
46909 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
46910 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
46911 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
46912 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
46913
46914 @item --once
46915 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
46916 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
46917 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
46918 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
46919
46920 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
46921
46922 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
46923 @c QDisableRandomization.
46924
46925 @end table
46926 @c man end
46927
46928 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
46929 @ifset man
46930 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
46931 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
46932 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
46933
46934 @smallexample
46935 info gdb
46936 @end smallexample
46937
46938 should give you access to the complete manual.
46939
46940 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
46941 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
46942 @end ifset
46943 @c man end
46944
46945 @node gcore man
46946 @heading gcore
46947
46948 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
46949
46950 @format
46951 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
46952 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
46953 @c man end
46954 @end format
46955
46956 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
46957 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
46958 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
46959 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
46960 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
46961 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
46962 its job the program remains running without any change.
46963 @c man end
46964
46965 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
46966 @table @env
46967 @item -a
46968 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
46969 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
46970 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
46971 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
46972 dump-excluded-mappings}).
46973
46974 @item -o @var{prefix}
46975 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
46976 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
46977 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
46978 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
46979 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
46980 @end table
46981 @c man end
46982
46983 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
46984 @ifset man
46985 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
46986 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
46987 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
46988
46989 @smallexample
46990 info gdb
46991 @end smallexample
46992
46993 @noindent
46994 should give you access to the complete manual.
46995
46996 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
46997 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
46998 @end ifset
46999 @c man end
47000
47001 @node gdbinit man
47002 @heading gdbinit
47003
47004 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
47005
47006 @format
47007 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
47008 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
47009 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
47010 @end ifset
47011
47012 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR
47013 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR}/*
47014 @end ifset
47015
47016 ~/.config/gdb/gdbinit
47017
47018 ~/.gdbinit
47019
47020 ./.gdbinit
47021 @c man end
47022 @end format
47023
47024 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
47025 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
47026 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
47027 described in
47028 @ifset man
47029 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
47030 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
47031 @end ifset
47032 @ifclear man
47033 @ref{Sequences}.
47034 @end ifclear
47035
47036 Please read more in
47037 @ifset man
47038 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
47039 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
47040 @end ifset
47041 @ifclear man
47042 @ref{Startup}.
47043 @end ifclear
47044
47045 @table @env
47046 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
47047 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
47048 @end ifset
47049 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
47050 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
47051 @end ifclear
47052 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
47053 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
47054 See more in
47055 @ifset man
47056 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
47057 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
47058 @end ifset
47059 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR
47060 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR}
47061 @end ifset
47062 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR
47063 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit-dir} during compilation)
47064 @end ifclear
47065 System-wide initialization directory. All files in this directory are
47066 executed on startup unless user specified @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or
47067 @code{-n}, as long as they have a recognized file extension.
47068 See more in
47069 @ifset man
47070 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
47071 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
47072 @end ifset
47073 @ifclear man
47074 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
47075 @end ifclear
47076
47077 @item @file{~/.config/gdb/gdbinit} or @file{~/.gdbinit}
47078 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
47079 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
47080
47081 @item @file{.gdbinit}
47082 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
47083 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
47084 See more in
47085 @ifset man
47086 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
47087 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
47088 @end ifset
47089 @ifclear man
47090 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
47091 @end ifclear
47092 @end table
47093 @c man end
47094
47095 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
47096 @ifset man
47097 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
47098
47099 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
47100 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
47101 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
47102
47103 @smallexample
47104 info gdb
47105 @end smallexample
47106
47107 should give you access to the complete manual.
47108
47109 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
47110 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
47111 @end ifset
47112 @c man end
47113
47114 @node gdb-add-index man
47115 @heading gdb-add-index
47116 @pindex gdb-add-index
47117 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
47118
47119 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
47120
47121 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
47122 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
47123 @c man end
47124
47125 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
47126 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
47127 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
47128 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
47129 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
47130 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
47131
47132 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
47133 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
47134 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
47135 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
47136 named @code{.debug_*}).
47137
47138 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
47139 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
47140 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
47141 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
47142
47143 See more in
47144 @ifset man
47145 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
47146 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
47147 @end ifset
47148 @ifclear man
47149 @ref{Index Files}.
47150 @end ifclear
47151 @c man end
47152
47153 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
47154 @ifset man
47155 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
47156 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
47157 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
47158
47159 @smallexample
47160 info gdb
47161 @end smallexample
47162
47163 should give you access to the complete manual.
47164
47165 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
47166 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
47167 @end ifset
47168 @c man end
47169
47170 @include gpl.texi
47171
47172 @node GNU Free Documentation License
47173 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
47174 @include fdl.texi
47175
47176 @node Concept Index
47177 @unnumbered Concept Index
47178
47179 @printindex cp
47180
47181 @node Command and Variable Index
47182 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
47183
47184 @printindex fn
47185
47186 @tex
47187 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
47188 % meantime:
47189 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
47190 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
47191 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
47192 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
47193 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
47194 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
47195 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
47196 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
47197 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
47198 \page\colophon
47199 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
47200 @end tex
47201
47202 @bye